BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES INC
424B5, 1999-07-30
ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES
Previous: BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES INC, 8-K, 1999-07-30
Next: UROCOR INC, 10-Q, 1999-07-30
















<PAGE>

PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(TO PROSPECTUS DATED JULY 23, 1999)

                                  $298,454,000
                                 (APPROXIMATE)

                   BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES, INC.
                                   DEPOSITOR

                                     [LOGO]
                           SELLER AND MASTER SERVICER

                    ASSET-BACKED CERTIFICATES, SERIES 1999-1
     DISTRIBUTIONS ARE PAYABLE ON THE 25TH DAY OF EACH MONTH, COMMENCING IN
                                  AUGUST 1999.

                           ------------------------

  CONSIDER CAREFULLY THE RISK
  FACTORS BEGINNING ON PAGE S-10
  IN THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
  AND ON PAGE 15 IN THE
  PROSPECTUS.

  The certificates represent
  obligations of the trust only
  and do not represent an
  interest in or obligation of
  Bear Stearns Asset Backed
  Securities, Inc., Countrywide
  Home Loans, Inc. or any of
  their affiliates.

  This prospectus supplement may
  be used to offer and sell the
  offered certificates only if
  accompanied by the prospectus.

  The following classes of certificates are being offered pursuant
  to this prospectus supplement and the accompanying prospectus:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                            ORIGINAL                                           ORIGINAL
                          CERTIFICATE                                        CERTIFICATE
                           PRINCIPAL     PASS-THROUGH                         PRINCIPAL        PASS-THROUGH
                           BALANCE(1)      RATE                               BALANCE(1)           RATE
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
   <S>                   <C>             <C>             <C>                 <C>             <C>
     Class AF-1           $ 49,806,000      6.61%        Class MF-2          $  5,075,000       8.37%(2)(3)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class AF-2           $ 12,734,000      7.04%        Class BF            $  4,757,000       8.50%(2)(3)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class AF-3           $ 19,803,000      7.18%        Class AV-1          $142,420,000          (4)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class AF-4           $  9,950,000      7.46%(2)     Class MV-1          $ 12,011,000          (4)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class AF-5           $  9,199,000      7.77%(2)(3)  Class MV-2          $  7,722,000          (4)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class AF-6           $  8,880,000      7.40%(2)(3)  Class BV            $  9,437,000          (4)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class MF-1           $  6,660,000      7.76%(2)(3)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

(1) This amount is subject to a permitted variance in the aggregate of plus or
    minus 10%.

(2) The pass-through rates for the Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6,
    Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF certificates will be subject to an
    interest rate cap as described in this prospectus supplement under
    'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of
    Interest.'

(3) The pass-through rates for the Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1,
    Class MF-2 and Class BF certificates will increase by 0.50% per annum after
    the related optional termination date as described in this prospectus
    supplement under 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions --
    Distributions of Interest.'

(4) The pass-through rates for the offered adjustable rate certificates will
    adjust monthly, will be subject to increase after the related optional
    termination date, and will be subject to an interest rate cap, in each case
    as described in this prospectus supplement under 'Description of the
    Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of Interest.'

THE CERTIFICATES

     The certificates represent interests in a pool of fixed and adjustable
     rate, conventional, sub-prime mortgage loans that are secured by first and
     second liens on one- to four-family residential properties, as described in
     this prospectus supplement.

     The Class MF-1, Class MF-2, Class BF, Class MV-1, Class MV-2 and Class BV
     certificates (which classes are sometimes called 'subordinated
     certificates') are subordinated to the other classes of offered
     certificates in the related certificate group (which other classes of
     offered certificates are sometimes called 'senior certificates').
     Subordination provides a form of credit enhancement for the senior
     certificates. In addition, among the subordinated certificates,
     certificates with lower priority are subordinated to classes with higher
     priority as described in this prospectus supplement.

     Delinquencies and losses realized upon liquidation of mortgage loans in the
     pool may adversely affect the yield to investors in the certificates, and
     the investors in the subordinated certificates in particular.

OPTIONAL TERMINATION

     The master servicer will have the option to purchase the assets of a loan
     group on any distribution date on which the principal balance of the
     related mortgage loans and any related foreclosed real estate owned by the
     trust fund as of such date has declined to or below 10% of the principal
     balance of such mortgage loans as of July 1, 1999.

     If the trust fund includes foreclosed real estate owned by the trust fund,
     then the proceeds from the exercise of the right of optional termination
     may not be sufficient to pay certificateholders what they would otherwise
     be entitled to be paid.

NEITHER THE SEC NOR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION HAS APPROVED THESE
SECURITIES OR DETERMINED THAT THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR THE PROSPECTUS IS
ACCURATE OR COMPLETE. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

     We expect that the offered certificates will be ready for delivery in
book-entry form only through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company,
Cedelbank and the Euroclear System on or about July 30, 1999. The offered
certificates will be offered in Europe and the United States of America.

BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.                      COUNTRYWIDE SECURITIES CORPORATION

July 23, 1999






<PAGE>

           TABLE OF CONTENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
                                        PAGE
                                       ------
<S>                                    <C>
Summary..............................     S-4
Risk Factors.........................    S-10
The Mortgage Pool....................    S-17
Servicing of the Mortgage Loans......    S-29
Description of the Certificates......    S-36
Yield, Prepayment and Maturity
  Considerations.....................    S-53
Use of Proceeds......................    S-64
Federal Income Tax Consequences......    S-64
State Taxes..........................    S-66
ERISA Considerations.................    S-67
Method of Distribution...............    S-69
Legal Matters........................    S-70
Ratings..............................    S-70
Index of Defined Terms...............    S-71
Annex I: Global Clearance, Settlement
  and Tax Documentation Procedures...     A-1

<CAPTION>
             PROSPECTUS
                                        PAGE
                                       ------
<S>                                    <C>
Prospectus Supplement................       3
Reports to Holders...................       3
Available Information................       3
Incorporation of Certain Documents by
  Reference..........................       4
Summary of Terms.....................       5
Risk Factors.........................      15
Description of the Securities........      18
The Trust Funds......................      21
Enhancement..........................      27
Servicing of Loans...................      29
The Agreements.......................      35
Certain Legal Aspects of Loans.......      42
The Depositor........................      50
Use of Proceeds......................      50
Certain Federal Income Tax
  Considerations.....................      50
State Tax Considerations.............      71
ERISA Considerations.................      71
Legal Investment.....................      74
Plan of Distribution.................      74
Legal Matters........................      74
Glossary of Terms....................      75
</TABLE>

                       S-2



<PAGE>

              IMPORTANT NOTICE ABOUT INFORMATION PRESENTED IN THIS
             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS

                           ------------------------

     We describe the certificates in two separate documents that provide varying
levels of detail: (a) the accompanying prospectus, which provides general
information, some of which may not apply to your certificates and (b) this
prospectus supplement, which describes the specific terms of your certificates.
If there is conflicting information between this prospectus supplement and the
accompanying prospectus, you should rely on the information in this prospectus
supplement.

     Cross-references are included in this prospectus supplement and the
accompanying prospectus to captions in these materials where you can find
further discussions about related topics. The table of contents on page S-2
above provides the pages on which these captions are located.

     You can find a listing of the pages where capitalized terms used in this
prospectus supplement are defined under the caption 'Index of Defined Terms'
beginning on page S-71 in this prospectus supplement. You can find a listing of
the pages where certain capitalized terms used in the accompanying prospectus
are defined under the caption 'Glossary of Terms' beginning on page 75 in the
accompanying prospectus. Any capitalized terms that are used but not defined in
this prospectus supplement have the meanings assigned in the prospectus.

                                      S-3







<PAGE>

                                    SUMMARY

THIS SUMMARY HIGHLIGHTS SELECTED INFORMATION FROM THIS DOCUMENT AND DOES NOT
CONTAIN ALL OF THE INFORMATION THAT YOU NEED TO CONSIDER WHEN MAKING YOUR
INVESTMENT DECISION. TO UNDERSTAND ALL OF THE TERMS OF AN OFFERING OF THE
CERTIFICATES, READ THIS ENTIRE DOCUMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS
CAREFULLY.

CERTAIN STATEMENTS CONTAINED IN OR INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE IN THIS PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS CONSIST OF FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
RELATING TO FUTURE ECONOMIC PERFORMANCE OR PROJECTIONS AND OTHER FINANCIAL
ITEMS. THESE STATEMENTS CAN BE IDENTIFIED BY THE USE OF FORWARD-LOOKING WORDS
SUCH AS 'MAY,' 'WILL,' 'SHOULD,' 'EXPECTS,' 'BELIEVES,' 'ANTICIPATES,'
'ESTIMATES,' OR OTHER COMPARABLE WORDS. FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS ARE SUBJECT
TO A VARIETY OF RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES THAT COULD CAUSE ACTUAL RESULTS TO
DIFFER FROM THE PROJECTED RESULTS. THOSE RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES INCLUDE,
AMONG OTHERS, GENERAL ECONOMIC AND BUSINESS CONDITIONS, REGULATORY INITIATIVES
AND COMPLIANCE WITH GOVERNMENTAL REGULATIONS, CUSTOMER PREFERENCES AND VARIOUS
OTHER MATTERS, MANY OF WHICH ARE BEYOND OUR CONTROL. BECAUSE WE CANNOT PREDICT
THE FUTURE, WHAT ACTUALLY HAPPENS MAY BE VERY DIFFERENT FROM WHAT WE PREDICT
IN OUR FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS.

THE CERTIFICATES

Asset-Backed Certificates, Series 1999-1, represent an undivided beneficial
ownership interest in a trust fund that consists primarily of a pool of fixed
and adjustable rate, conventional, sub-prime mortgage loans that are secured by
first and second liens on one- to four-family residential properties and certain
other property and assets described in this prospectus supplement.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- General' in this prospectus supplement.

ORIGINATORS

Amresco Residential Mortgage Corporation, with respect to approximately 92.45%
of the mortgage loans, and Provident Funding Associates, L.P., with respect to
approximately 7.55% of the mortgage loans.

DEPOSITOR

Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc., a Delaware corporation and a limited
purpose finance subsidiary of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc. and an affiliate
of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.

See 'The Depositor' in the prospectus.

SELLER AND MASTER SERVICER

Countrywide Home Loans, Inc., a New York corporation and a subsidiary of
Countrywide Credit Industries, Inc.

See 'Servicing of the Mortgage Loans' in this prospectus supplement.

TRUSTEE

The Bank of New York, a New York banking corporation.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- The Trustee' in this prospectus
supplement.

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT

The pooling and servicing agreement among the seller and master servicer, the
depositor and the trustee, under which the trust fund will be formed.

CUT-OFF DATE

July 1, 1999.

CLOSING DATE

On or about July 30, 1999.

THE MORTGAGE LOANS

The aggregate principal balance of the mortgage loans as of the cut-off date is
$298,454,982.15. The mortgage loans will be divided into two separate groups
based on whether the interest rate on the related mortgage loans is fixed or
adjustable. Each such group of mortgage loans is referred to as a 'loan group.'
The fixed rate loan group will consist solely of fixed rate mortgage loans that
are secured by first and second liens on mortgaged properties. The adjustable
rate loan group will consist solely of adjustable rate mortgage loans that are
secured by first liens on mortgaged properties.

                                      S-4



<PAGE>

FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP

The following table summarizes the characteristics of the mortgage loans in the
fixed rate loan group as of the cut-off date:

<TABLE>
<S>                             <C>
Number of Mortgage Loans.....                     1,580
Aggregate Principal
  Balance....................           $126,864,888.10
Average Principal Balance....                $80,294.23
Range of Principal                        $13,208.79 to
  Balances...................               $447,334.42
Range of Mortgage Rates......         6.625% to 14.500%
Weighted Average Mortgage
  Rate.......................                    9.709%
Weighted Average Combined
  Loan-to-Value Ratio........                    75.47%
Weighted Average Scheduled
  Remaining Term
  to Maturity................                330 months
Range of Scheduled Remaining
  Term to Maturity...........  109 months to 360 months
Type of Mortgaged Premises...
    Single-family detached
      dwellings..............                    79.80%
    Planned unit
      developments...........                     7.55%
    2-4 family dwellings.....                     7.70%
    Condominiums.............                     4.50%
    Manufactured housing
      (treated as real
      property)..............                     0.45%
First liens..................                    98.25%
Second liens.................                     1.75%
</TABLE>

ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP

The following table summarizes the characteristics of the mortgage loans in the
adjustable rate loan group as of the cut-off date:

<TABLE>
<S>                            <C>
Number of Mortgage Loans.....                     1,607
Aggregate Principal
  Balance....................           $171,590,094.05
Average Principal Balance....               $106,776.66
Range of Principal                        $11,690.52 to
  Balances...................               $498,044.67
Mortgage Interest Rates
    Current Weighted Average
      Mortgage Rate..........                    9.768%
    Range of Current Mortgage
      Rates..................         6.875% to 13.750%
    Weighted Average Maximum
      Mortgage Rate..........                   16.674%
    Range of Maximum Mortgage
      Rates..................        13.700% to 20.750%
    Weighted Average Minimum
      Mortgage Rate..........                    9.755%
    Range of Minimum Mortgage
      Rates..................         0.000% to 13.750%
Weighted Average
  Loan-to-Value Ratio........                    77.61%
Weighted Average Scheduled
  Remaining Term
  to Maturity................                355 months
Range of Scheduled Remaining
  Term to Maturity...........   48 months to 360 months
Type of Mortgaged Premises
    Single-family detached
      dwellings..............                    80.07%
    Planned unit
      developments...........                     8.43%
    Condominiums.............                     4.35%
    2-4 family dwellings.....                     6.67%
    Manufactured housing
      (treated as real
      property)..............                     0.42%
    Other....................                     0.06%
</TABLE>

As described in this prospectus supplement under 'The Mortgage Pool,' the
interest rates for the adjustable rate mortgage loans will generally adjust
semi-annually, subject to certain caps and floors, as described herein.

Approximately 87.77% of the mortgage loans in the adjustable rate loan group are
mortgage loans that initially have a fixed rate of interest for two, three or
five years following their origination, and thereafter have an adjustable rate
of interest for the remaining life of the loan, as described under 'The Mortgage
Pool -- Additional Information Regarding the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans' in
this prospectus supplement.

See 'The Mortgage Pool' in this prospectus supplement.

DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

GENERAL

The certificates are being issued in two certificate groups. The certificates
listed below under the column entitled 'offered fixed rate certificates' will
represent interests in the fixed rate loan group. The certificates listed below
under the column entitled 'offered adjustable rate certificates' will represent
interests in the adjustable rate loan group.

The trust will also issue the Class BF-IO Certificates, Class BV-IO Certificates
and a class of residual certificates designated as the Class R Certificates,
none of which are offered by this prospectus supplement.

The original certificate principal balances, pass-through rates and last
scheduled distribution dates for the offered certificates are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                         ORIGINAL                          LAST
                       CERTIFICATE     PASS-            SCHEDULED
                        PRINCIPAL     THROUGH          DISTRIBUTION
        CLASS           BALANCE(1)     RATE              DATE(2)
        -----           ----------     ----              -------
<S>                    <C>            <C>           <C>
Offered Fixed Rate
 Certificates
 Class AF-1..........  $ 49,806,000    6.61%             June 25, 2019
 Class AF-2..........  $ 12,734,000    7.04%        September 25, 2022
 Class AF-3..........  $ 19,803,000    7.18%             June 25, 2026
 Class AF-4..........  $  9,950,000    7.46%(3)      December 25, 2027
 Class AF-5..........  $  9,199,000    7.77%(3)(4)      March 25, 2029
 Class AF-6..........  $  8,880,000    7.40%(3)(4)      March 25, 2029
 Class MF-1..........  $  6,660,000    7.76%(3)(4)      March 25, 2029
 Class MF-2..........  $  5,075,000    8.37%(3)(4)      March 25, 2029
 Class BF............  $  4,757,000    8.50%(3)(4)      March 25, 2029
Offered Adjustable
 Rate Certificates
 Class AV-1..........  $142,420,000    (5)              April 25, 2029
 Class MV-1..........  $ 12,011,000    (5)              April 25, 2029
 Class MV-2..........  $  7,722,000    (5)              April 25, 2029
 Class BV............  $  9,437,000    (5)              April 25, 2029
</TABLE>

(1) The original certificate principal balance of the offered certificates will
    be subject to a permitted variance in the aggregate of plus or

                                      S-5



<PAGE>

    minus 10%, depending on the amount of mortgage loans actually delivered on
    the closing date.

(2) Each date was determined as described under 'Yield, Prepayment and Maturity
    Considerations' in this prospectus supplement.

(3) The pass-through rates for the Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6,
    Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF certificates will be subject to an
    interest rate cap as described in this prospectus supplement under
    'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of
    Interest.'

(4) The pass-through rates for the Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1, Class
    MF-2 and Class BF certificates will increase by 0.50% per annum after the
    related optional termination date as described in this prospectus supplement
    under 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of
    Interest.'

(5) The pass-through rates for the offered adjustable rate certificates will
    adjust monthly, will be subject to increase after the related optional
    termination date, and will be subject to an interest rate cap, in each case
    as described in this prospectus supplement under 'Description of the
    Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of Interest.'

RECORD DATE

The last business day of the month preceding the month of a distribution date.

DENOMINATIONS

$25,000 and multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

REGISTRATION OF CERTIFICATES

The certificates will initially be issued in book-entry form. Persons acquiring
beneficial ownership interests in the certificates may elect to hold their
beneficial interests through The Depository Trust Company, in the United States,
or Cedelbank or the Euroclear System, in Europe.

See 'Description of Certificates -- Book-Entry Certificates' in this prospectus
supplement.

PASS-THROUGH RATES

The pass-through rates for the offered fixed rate certificates are the
respective per annum fixed rates as set forth and described on the cover of this
prospectus supplement. On any distribution date, the pass-through rates per
annum for the offered fixed rate certificates will be subject to an interest
rate cap equal to the weighted average of the net mortgage rates on the fixed
rate mortgage loans (which interest rate cap is called the 'fixed net rate
cap').

The pass-through rates for the offered adjustable rate certificates are variable
rates that may change from distribution date to distribution date. On any
distribution date, the pass-through rate per annum for each class of offered
adjustable rate certificates will be equal to the least of:

  LIBOR plus the pass-through margin for such class,

  the weighted average of the maximum net interest rates on the adjustable rate
  mortgage loans, and

  a maximum per annum rate referred to as the 'adjustable rate available funds
  cap,' calculated as described under 'Description of the Certificates --
  Distributions -- Distributions of Interest' in this prospectus supplement.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of
Interest' and ' -- Calculation of One-Month LIBOR' in this prospectus
supplement.

If on any distribution date, the pass-through rate for a class of offered fixed
rate certificates is based on the fixed net rate cap, or the pass-through rate
for a class of offered adjustable rate certificates is based on the adjustable
rate available funds cap, the holders of those certificates will receive a
smaller amount of interest than such holders would have received on such
distribution date had the pass-through rate for that class not been calculated
based on the fixed net rate cap or the adjustable rate available funds cap, as
applicable. The amount by which a certificateholder's interest payment has been
reduced by operation of the fixed net rate cap or the adjustable rate available
funds cap will be paid to such certificateholder on future distribution dates to
the extent that money is available to make such payments.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions' in this prospectus
supplement.

DISTRIBUTION DATES

The trustee will make distributions on the certificates on the 25th day of each
calendar month beginning in August 1999 to the appropriate holders of record. If
the 25th day of a month is not a business day, then the distributions

                                      S-6



<PAGE>

will be made on the next business day after the 25th day of the month.

INTEREST PAYMENTS

On each distribution date holders of the offered certificates will be entitled
to receive:

  the interest that has accrued on such certificates at the related pass-through
  rate during the related accrual period, and

  any interest due on a prior distribution date that was not paid.

The 'accrual period' for the fixed rate certificates will be the calendar month
immediately preceding the calendar month in which a distribution date occurs.
The 'accrual period' for the adjustable rate certificates will be the period
from and including the preceding distribution date (or from the closing date, in
the case of the first distribution date) to and including the day prior to the
current distribution date. Calculations of interest on the fixed rate
certificates will be based on a 360-day year that consists of twelve 30-day
months. Calculations of interest on the adjustable rate certificates will be
based on a 360-day year and the actual number of days elapsed during the related
accrual period.

There are certain circumstances that could reduce the amount of interest paid to
you.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions -- Distributions of
Interest' in this prospectus supplement.

PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS

On each distribution date, certificateholders will receive a distribution of
principal on their certificates if there is cash available on that date for the
payment of principal. Monthly principal distributions:

  will generally include principal payments on the mortgage loans in the related
  loan group, and

  until certain overcollateralization levels have been reached, will include
  excess interest payments on the mortgage loans.

Certificateholders should review the priority of payments described under
'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions' in this prospectus
supplement.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions' and
' -- Overcollateralization and Crosscollateralization Provisions' in
this prospectus supplement.

CREDIT ENHANCEMENT

Credit enhancements provide limited protection to certain holders of
certificates against shortfalls in payments received on the mortgage loans. This
transaction employs the following forms of credit enhancement.

SUBORDINATION

The issuance of senior certificates and subordinated certificates by the trust
is designed to increase the likelihood that senior certificateholders will
receive regular payments of interest and principal. Among the fixed rate
certificates, the Class AF-1, Class AF-2, Class AF-3, Class AF-4, Class AF-5 and
Class AF-6 Certificates constitute the 'senior certificates,' and the
Class MF-1, Class MF-2, Class BF and Class BF-IO Certificates constitute the
'subordinated certificates.' Among the adjustable rate certificates, the
Class AV-1 Certificates constitute the 'senior certificates,' and the
Class MV-1, Class MV-2, Class BV and Class BV-IO Certificates constitute the
'subordinated certificates.'

The certificates that have been designated as senior certificates will have a
payment priority over the certificates that are designated as subordinated
certificates. Within the classes of subordinated certificates of a certificate
group,

  certificates that have a class M-1 designation will have payment priority over
  certificates of the same certificate group that have a class M-2 designation
  and any class B designation;

  certificates that have a class M-2 designation will have payment priority over
  certificates of the same certificate group that have any class B designation;
  and

  the Class BF and Class BV Certificates will have payment priority over the
  Class BF-IO and Class BV-IO Certificates, respectively.

Subordination is designed to provide the holders of certificates having a higher
payment priority with protection against most losses realized when the remaining
unpaid principal balance on a mortgage loan exceeds the amount of proceeds
recovered upon the liquidation of that mortgage loan. In general, this loss
protection is accomplished by allocating the realized losses among subordinated
certificates, beginning with the subordinated certificates with the lowest
payment priority, until the principal amount of that subordinated class has been
reduced to zero. Realized losses would then be allocated to the

                                      S-7



<PAGE>

next most junior class of subordinated certificates, until the principal balance
of each class of subordinated certificates was reduced to zero. Thereafter,
realized losses would be applied to the senior certificates on a pro rata basis.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions' in this prospectus
supplement.

OVERCOLLATERALIZATION AND CROSS-COLLATERALIZATION

When excess interest payments received in respect of the mortgage loans of a
loan group are used to reduce principal owed on the related certificates, the
aggregate principal balance of the mortgage loans in such loan group may become
greater than the principal balance of such related certificates. If this occurs,
a certificate group will be 'overcollateralized,' and on any distribution date,
the amount of any such overcollateralization will be available to absorb the
related certificates' share of losses from liquidated mortgage loans, if such
losses are not otherwise covered. The required level of overcollateralization
will vary by loan group and may change over time.

Each group of mortgage loans is expected to generate more interest than is
needed to pay interest on the related classes of certificates because the
weighted average interest rate of the mortgage loans in each loan group is
expected to be higher than the weighted average pass-through rate on the related
certificates. Any interest payments received in respect of the mortgage loans of
a loan group in excess of the amount that is needed to pay interest on the
certificates of the related certificate group will be used to reduce the total
principal balance of such certificates until a required level of
overcollateralization has been achieved.

In addition, the principal payment rules require that, under certain
circumstances, excess interest generated by one loan group be used with respect
to the other loan group; this is called 'cross-collateralization.'

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Overcollateralization and Cross-
Collateralization Provisions' in this prospectus supplement.

ADVANCES

The master servicer will make cash advances with respect to delinquent payments
of principal and interest on the mortgage loans to the extent that the master
servicer reasonably believes that such cash advances can be repaid from future
payments on the related mortgage loans. If the master servicer fails to make any
such advances, the trustee may be obligated to do so, as described in this
prospectus supplement. These cash advances are only intended to maintain a
regular flow of scheduled interest and principal payments on the certificates
and are not intended to guarantee or insure against losses.

See 'Servicing of the Mortgage Loans' in this prospectus supplement.

OPTIONAL TERMINATION

The master servicer may purchase all of the remaining assets in a loan group
after the principal balance of the related mortgage loans and any related
foreclosed real estate owned by the trust fund has declined to or below 10% of
the principal balance of the mortgage loans in such loan group as of July 1,
1999. Such a purchase by the master servicer will result in the early retirement
of all certificates in the related certificate group.

See 'Description of the Certificates -- Optional Termination' in this prospectus
supplement.

FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

For federal income tax purposes, the trust will comprise multiple real estate
mortgage investment conduits, organized in a tiered REMIC structure. The
certificates offered by this prospectus supplement and the Class BF-IO and
Class BV-IO Certificates will represent beneficial ownership of REMIC 'regular
interests' in the upper tier REMIC identified in the pooling and servicing
agreement.

The residual certificates will represent the beneficial ownership of the sole
class of 'residual interest' in each REMIC. Certain classes of offered
certificates may be issued with original issue discount for federal income tax
purposes.

The adjustable rate certificates will also represent the beneficial interest in
the right to receive payments from the adjustable rate carryover reserve fund
pursuant to an interest rate cap agreement contained in the pooling and
servicing agreement.

The treatment of the rights of the holders of the Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class
AF-6, Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF Certificates in excess of the weighted
average net mortgage rate of the fixed rate mortgage loans is unclear for
federal income tax purposes. The rights of such certificates to interest
carryforward amounts may be treated as representing beneficial interests in

                                      S-8



<PAGE>

the right to receive payments from a separate reserve fund pursuant to an
interest rate cap agreement treated as a notional principal contract.
Alternatively, the rights of such certificates to interest carryforward amounts
may be treated as representing beneficial interests in an entity taxable as a
partnership for federal income tax purposes with the Class BF-IO Certificates in
respect of the Class BF-IO Certificates' entitlement to interest.

See 'Federal Income Tax Consequences' in this prospectus supplement and 'Certain
Federal Income Tax Considerations' in the prospectus for additional information
concerning the application of federal income tax laws.

LEGAL INVESTMENT

None of the classes of offered certificates will be 'mortgage related
securities' for purposes of the Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of
1984.

See 'Legal Investment' in the prospectus.

ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

The Class AF-1, Class AF-2, Class AF-3, Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6 and
Class AV-1 Certificates may be purchased by a pension or other employee benefit
plan subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or Section
4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, so long as certain conditions are
met. A fiduciary of an employee benefit plan must determine that the purchase of
a certificate is consistent with its fiduciary duties under applicable law and
does not result in a nonexempt prohibited transaction under applicable law.

See 'ERISA Considerations' in this prospectus supplement and in the prospectus.

RATINGS

The classes of certificates listed below will not be offered unless they receive
the respective ratings set forth below from Moody's Investors Service, Inc. and
Fitch IBCA, Inc.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                Moody's          Fitch
 Class          Rating           Rating
 -----           ------          ------
<S>             <C>              <C>
AF-1              Aaa             AAA
AF-2              Aaa             AAA
AF-3              Aaa             AAA
AF-4              Aaa             AAA
AF-5              Aaa             AAA
AF-6              Aaa             AAA
AV-1              Aaa             AAA
MF-1              Aa2              AA
MV-1              Aa2              AA
MF-2               A2              A
MV-2               A2              A
BF                Baa3            BBB-
BV                Baa2            BBB-
</TABLE>

A rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities and either
rating agency can revise or withdraw such ratings at any time. In general,
ratings address credit risk and do not address the likelihood of prepayments.

See 'Ratings' in this prospectus supplement and 'Risk Factors -- Ratings are not
Recommendations' in the prospectus.

                                      S-9






<PAGE>

                                  RISK FACTORS

IN ADDITION TO THE MATTERS DESCRIBED ELSEWHERE IN THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND
THE PROSPECTUS, YOU SHOULD CAREFULLY CONSIDER THE FOLLOWING RISK FACTORS BEFORE
DECIDING TO PURCHASE A CERTIFICATE.

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
THE SUBORDINATED CERTIFICATES HAVE A
GREATER RISK OF LOSS THAN SENIOR
CERTIFICATES..............................  When certain classes of certificates provide credit
                                            enhancement for other classes of certificates this is
                                            sometimes referred to as 'subordination.' For purposes
                                            of this prospectus supplement, 'related subordinated
                                            classes' means:

                                              with respect to the senior certificates of a certificate
                                              group, the certificates of the same certificate group
                                              that have a Class M or Class B designation,

                                              with respect to the certificates that have a Class M-1
                                              designation, the certificates of the same certificate
                                              group that have a Class M-2 designation or any Class B
                                              designation,

                                              with respect to the certificates that have a Class M-2
                                              designation, the certificates of the same certificate
                                              group that have any Class B designation; and

                                              with respect to the Class BF and Class BV Certificates,
                                              the Class BF-IO and Class BV-IO Certificates,
                                              respectively.

                                            Credit enhancement will be provided for the
                                            certificates, first, by the right of the holders of the
                                            certificates to receive certain payments of principal
                                            prior to the related subordinated classes and, second,
                                            by the allocation of realized losses to the related
                                            subordinated classes. This form of credit enhancement is
                                            provided by using collections on the mortgage loans
                                            otherwise payable to the holders of the related
                                            subordinated classes to pay amounts due on the more
                                            senior classes. Such collections comprise the sole
                                            source of funds from which such credit enhancement is
                                            provided. Realized losses are allocated to the
                                            subordinated certificates, beginning with the
                                            subordinated certificates with the lowest payment
                                            priority, until the principal amount of that
                                            subordinated class has been reduced to zero. This means
                                            that with respect to the certificates offered by this
                                            prospectus supplement, realized losses on the mortgage
                                            loans of a particular loan group would first be
                                            allocated to the Class BF or Class BV Certificates, as
                                            applicable, until the principal balance of such
                                            Class BF or Class BV Certificates was reduced to zero.
                                            Subsequent realized losses would be allocated to the
                                            next most junior class of subordinated certificates,
                                            until the principal balance of that class of
                                            subordinated certificates was reduced to zero.
                                            Accordingly, if the aggregate principal balance of the
                                            related subordinated classes were to be reduced to zero,
                                            delinquencies and defaults on the mortgage loans would
                                            reduce the amount of funds available for monthly
                                            distributions to holders of the remaining certificates.

                                            You should fully consider the risks of investing in a
                                            subordinated certificate, including the risk that you
                                            may not fully recover your initial investment as a
                                            result of realized losses.

                                            See 'Description of the Certificates' in this prospectus
                                            supplement.
</TABLE>

                                      S-10



<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
POTENTIAL INADEQUACY OF CREDIT
ENHANCEMENT...............................  Each group of mortgage loans is expected to generate
                                            more interest than is needed to pay interest on the
                                            related classes of certificates because the weighted
                                            average interest rate on the related mortgage loans is
                                            expected to be higher than the weighted average pass-
                                            through rate on the related classes of certificates. If
                                            the related mortgage loans generate more interest than
                                            is needed to pay interest on the related certificates,
                                            such 'excess interest' will be used to make additional
                                            principal payments on the related certificates, which
                                            will reduce the total principal balance of such
                                            certificates below the aggregate principal balance of
                                            the related mortgage loans, thereby creating
                                            'overcollateralization.' Overcollateralization is
                                            intended to provide limited protection to
                                            certificateholders by absorbing the related
                                            certificates' share of losses from liquidated mortgage
                                            loans. However, we cannot assure you that enough excess
                                            interest will be generated on the mortgage loans of
                                            either loan group to establish or maintain the required
                                            levels of overcollateralization for the related
                                            certificate group.

                                            The excess interest available on any distribution date
                                            will be affected by the actual amount of interest
                                            received, collected or recovered in respect of the
                                            mortgage loans during the preceding month. Such amount
                                            will be influenced by changes in the weighted average of
                                            the mortgage rates resulting from prepayments and
                                            liquidations of the related mortgage loans as well as
                                            from adjustments of the mortgage rates on adjustable
                                            rate mortgage loans. Because the index used to determine
                                            the mortgage rates on the adjustable rate mortgage loans
                                            is different from the index used to determine the
                                            pass-through rates on the related certificates, it is
                                            possible that the pass-through rates on the related
                                            certificates may be higher than the interest rates on
                                            the related mortgage loans. In that event, it may be
                                            necessary to apply all or a portion of the available
                                            excess interest to make required payments of interest on
                                            the related classes of certificates. As a result, excess
                                            interest may be unavailable for any other purpose.

                                            If the protection afforded by overcollateralization and
                                            cross-collateralization is insufficient, then the
                                            holders of the certificates could experience a loss on
                                            their investment.

RISK REGARDING ADJUSTMENTS OF THE
MORTGAGE RATES............................  The pass-through rate on each class of adjustable rate
                                            certificates adjusts monthly and is generally based on
                                            one-month LIBOR. The mortgage rates on the adjustable
                                            rate mortgage loans generally adjust semi-annually
                                            (except with respect to 87.77% of the mortgage loans in
                                            the adjustable rate loan group, the related interest
                                            rates are initially fixed for a period of two, three or
                                            five years before they begin adjusting semi-annually)
                                            and are based on six-month LIBOR. Because six-month
                                            LIBOR may respond to different economic and market
                                            factors than one-month LIBOR, there is not necessarily a
                                            correlation in movement between such indices. For
                                            example, it is possible that the interest rates on
                                            certain of the mortgage loans may decline while the
                                            pass-through rates on the related certificates are
                                            stable or rising. In addition, although it is possible
                                            that both the mortgage rates and certificate
                                            pass-through rates may decline or increase during the
                                            same period, because of the
</TABLE>

                                      S-11



<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            difference between interest rate adjustment periods and
                                            pass-through rate adjustment periods, mortgage rates may
                                            decline or increase more slowly than the related
                                            certificate pass-through rates.

                                            This absence of a correlation between movement in the
                                            mortgage rates and the certificate pass-through rates
                                            may reduce the interest payable on the adjustable rate
                                            certificates because of the imposition of a pass-through
                                            rate cap called the 'adjustable rate available funds
                                            cap.'

                                            If on any distribution date the pass-through rate for a
                                            class of offered fixed rate certificates is based on the
                                            fixed net rate cap, or the pass-through rate for a class
                                            of offered adjustable rate certificates is based on the
                                            adjustable rate available funds cap, the holders of
                                            those certificates will receive a smaller amount of
                                            interest than such holders would have received on such
                                            distribution date had the pass-through rate for that
                                            class not been calculated based on the fixed net rate
                                            cap or the adjustable rate available funds cap, as
                                            applicable. Although it is intended that the amount by
                                            which a certificateholder's interest payment has been
                                            reduced by operation of the fixed net rate cap or
                                            adjustable rate available funds cap, as the case may be,
                                            will be paid to such certificateholder on future
                                            distribution dates, we cannot assure you that excess
                                            funds will be available to make any such payments.
DEFAULTS ON SECOND LIEN FIXED RATE
MORTGAGE LOANS COULD RESULT IN PAYMENT
DELAY OR LOSS.............................  As of the cut-off date, approximately 1.75% of the
                                            mortgage loans in the fixed rate loan group will be
                                            secured by second mortgages on residential properties.
                                            In the case of liquidations, fixed rate mortgage loans
                                            secured by second mortgages are entitled to proceeds
                                            that remain from the sale of the related mortgaged
                                            property after any related first lien mortgage loan and
                                            prior statutory liens have been repaid in full and any
                                            related foreclosure costs have been paid. If those
                                            proceeds are insufficient to satisfy the mortgage loans
                                            secured by second mortgages and prior liens and costs in
                                            the aggregate, the trust fund and, accordingly, holders
                                            of the offered fixed rate certificates will bear:

                                               the risk of delay in distributions while any deficiency
                                               judgment against the borrower is sought, and

                                               the risk of loss if the deficiency judgment cannot be
                                               obtained or is not realized upon.

                                            See 'Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans' in the
                                            prospectus.

BALLOON LOANS MAY HAVE HIGH RATES OF
DEFAULT...................................  With respect to approximately 4.53% of the mortgage
                                            loans in the fixed rate loan group (by cut-off date
                                            principal balance), borrowers make monthly payments of
                                            principal that are less than sufficient to amortize such
                                            mortgage loans by their maturity. These loans are
                                            commonly called 'balloon loans.' As a result of these
                                            lower monthly payments, a borrower generally will be
                                            required to pay a large remaining principal balance upon
                                            the maturity of such balloon loan. The ability of a
                                            borrower to make such a payment may depend on its
                                            ability to obtain refinancing of the balance due on the
                                            mortgage loan. In addition, an increase in prevailing
                                            market interest rates over the loan rate on the mortgage
                                            loan at origination may
</TABLE>

                                      S-12



<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            reduce the borrower's ability to obtain refinancing and
                                            to pay the principal balance of the mortgage loan at its
                                            maturity.

CASH FLOW CONSIDERATIONS AND RISKS COULD
CAUSE PAYMENT DELAYS AND LOSSES...........  There could be substantial delays in the liquidation of
                                            defaulted mortgage loans and corresponding delays in
                                            your receiving your portion of the proceeds of such
                                            liquidation. These delays could last up to several
                                            years. Furthermore, an action to obtain a deficiency
                                            judgment is regulated by statutes and rules, and the
                                            amount of a deficiency judgment may be limited by law.
                                            In the event of a default by a borrower, these
                                            restrictions may impede the ability of the master
                                            servicer to foreclose on or to sell the mortgaged
                                            property or to obtain a deficiency judgment. In
                                            addition, liquidation expenses (such as legal and
                                            appraisal fees, real estate taxes and maintenance and
                                            preservation expenses) will reduce the amount of
                                            security for the mortgage loans and, in turn, reduce the
                                            proceeds payable to certificateholders.

                                            In the event that:

                                               the mortgaged properties fail to provide adequate
                                               security for the related mortgage loans, and

                                               the protection provided by the subordination of certain
                                               classes and the availability of overcollateralization
                                               are insufficient to cover any shortfall,

                                            you could lose all or a portion of the money you paid
                                            for the certificates.

YIELD AND REINVESTMENT COULD BE ADVERSELY
AFFECTED BY UNPREDICTABILITY OF
PREPAYMENTS...............................  No one can accurately predict the level of prepayments
                                            that the trust fund will experience. The trust fund's
                                            prepayment experience may be affected by many factors,
                                            including:

                                               general economic conditions,

                                               the level of prevailing interest rates,

                                               the availability of alternative financing, and

                                               homeowner mobility.

                                            In addition, substantially all of the mortgage loans
                                            contain due-on-sale provisions, and the master servicer
                                            intends to enforce those provisions unless doing so is
                                            not permitted by applicable law or the master servicer,
                                            in a manner consistent with reasonable commercial
                                            practice, permits the purchaser of the mortgaged
                                            property in question to assume the related mortgage
                                            loan. See 'The Mortgage Pool' and 'Yield, Prepayment and
                                            Maturity Considerations' in this prospectus supplement
                                            and 'Certain Legal Aspects of the Loans -- Due-on-Sale
                                            Clauses in Mortgage Loans' in the prospectus for a
                                            description of certain provisions of the mortgage loans
                                            that may affect the prepayment experience on the
                                            mortgage loans.

                                            The weighted average life of the certificates will be
                                            sensitive to the rate and timing of principal payments
                                            (including prepayments) on the mortgage loans, which may
                                            fluctuate significantly from time to time.
</TABLE>

                                      S-13



<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            You should note that:

                                               generally, if you purchase your certificates at a
                                               discount and principal is repaid on the related mortgage
                                               loans slower than you anticipate, then your yield may
                                               be lower than you anticipate;

                                               generally, if you purchase your certificates at a
                                               premium and principal is repaid on the related mortgage
                                               loans faster than you anticipate, then your yield may
                                               be lower than you anticipate;

                                               if you purchase an adjustable rate certificate, your
                                               yield will also be sensitive to the level of one-month
                                               LIBOR, the timing of adjustment of the pass-through
                                               rate on your certificate as it relates to the timing of
                                               adjustment of the interest rates on the underlying
                                               mortgage loans, the level of the mortgage index and
                                               other limitations on the pass-through rate of such
                                               certificate, as described further in this prospectus
                                               supplement; and

                                               you bear the reinvestment risks resulting from a faster
                                               or slower rate of principal payments than you expected.

                                            See 'Yield, Prepayment and Maturity Considerations' in
                                            this prospectus supplement.

REDUCTION IN CERTIFICATE RATING COULD
HAVE AN ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE VALUE
OF THE CERTIFICATES.......................  The ratings of the certificates will depend primarily on
                                            an assessment by the rating agencies of the underlying
                                            related mortgage loans, the amount of
                                            overcollateralization and the subordination afforded by
                                            certain classes of certificates. The rating by each of
                                            the rating agencies of the certificates is not a
                                            recommendation to purchase, hold or sell the
                                            certificates because that rating does not address the
                                            market price of the certificates or suitability for a
                                            particular investor.

                                            The rating agencies may suspend, reduce or withdraw the
                                            ratings on the certificates at anytime. Any such
                                            reduction in, or suspension or withdrawal of, the
                                            ratings assigned to the certificates would probably
                                            reduce the market value of the certificates and may
                                            affect your ability to sell them.

DISTRIBUTION TO AND RIGHTS OF INVESTORS
COULD BE ADVERSELY AFFECTED BY THE
BANKRUPTCY OR INSOLVENCY OF CERTAIN
PARTIES...................................  Countrywide Home Loans, Inc. will treat its transfer of
                                            the mortgage loans to the depositor as a sale of the
                                            mortgage loans. However, if Countrywide Home Loans, Inc.
                                            becomes bankrupt, the trustee in bankruptcy of
                                            Countrywide Home Loans, Inc. may argue that the mortgage
                                            loans were not sold but were only pledged to secure a
                                            loan to Countrywide Home Loans, Inc. If that argument is
                                            made, you could experience delays or reduction in
                                            payments on the certificates. If that argument is
                                            successful, the bankruptcy trustee could elect to sell
                                            the mortgage loans and pay down the certificates early.
                                            Thus, you could lose the right to future payments of
                                            interest, and might suffer reinvestment loss in a lower
                                            interest rate environment.

                                            In addition, if the master servicer becomes bankrupt, a
                                            bankruptcy trustee or receiver may have the power to
                                            prevent the trustee from appointing a successor master
                                            servicer. Any related delays in
</TABLE>

                                      S-14



<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            servicing could result in increased delinquencies or
                                            losses on the mortgage loans.

DEVELOPMENTS IN CALIFORNIA OR HAWAII COULD
HAVE DISPROPORTIONATE EFFECT ON THE
MORTGAGE LOANS DUE TO GEOGRAPHIC
CONCENTRATION OF MORTGAGED PROPERTIES.....  Approximately 17.13% and 16.85% of the fixed rate
                                            mortgage loans in the related loan group as of the
                                            cut-off date are secured by mortgaged properties that
                                            are located in the States of Hawaii and California,
                                            respectively. Approximately 21.12% of the adjustable
                                            rate mortgage loans in the related loan group as of the
                                            cut-off date are secured by mortgaged properties that
                                            are located in the State of California. Property in
                                            these states (particularly California) may be more
                                            susceptible than homes located in other parts of the
                                            country to certain types of uninsurable hazards, such as
                                            earthquakes, floods, mudslides and other natural
                                            disasters. In addition,

                                               economic conditions in California or Hawaii (as
                                               applicable) (which may or may not affect real property
                                               values) may affect the ability of borrowers to repay
                                               their loans on time;

                                               declines in the California or Hawaii (as applicable)
                                               residential real estate market may reduce the values of
                                               properties located in California or Hawaii (as
                                               applicable), which would result in an increase in the
                                               loan-to-value ratios; and

                                               any increase in the market value of properties located
                                               in California or Hawaii (as applicable) would reduce the
                                               loan-to-value ratios and could, therefore, make
                                               alternative sources of financing available to the
                                               borrowers at lower interest rates, which could result
                                               in an increased rate of prepayment of the mortgage
                                               loans.

LIMITED LIQUIDITY OF CERTIFICATES.........  Each underwriter intends to make a secondary market in
                                            the classes of certificates purchased by it, but no
                                            underwriter has any obligation to do so. We cannot
                                            assure you that a secondary market will develop or, if
                                            it develops, that it will continue. Consequently, you
                                            may not be able to sell your certificates readily or at
                                            prices that will enable you to realize your desired
                                            yield. The market values of the certificates are likely
                                            to fluctuate, and such fluctuations may be significant
                                            and could result in significant losses to you.

                                            The secondary markets for asset backed securities have
                                            experienced periods of illiquidity and can be expected
                                            to do so in the future. Illiquidity can have a severely
                                            adverse effect on the prices of certificates that are
                                            especially sensitive to prepayment, credit or interest
                                            rate risk, or that have been structured to meet the
                                            investment requirements of limited categories of
                                            investors.

LIMITED LIQUIDITY OF BOOK-ENTRY
CERTIFICATES..............................  Because transactions in the certificates can be effected
                                            only through DTC, Cedelbank, Euroclear, participating
                                            organizations, indirect participants and certain banks,
                                            your ability to pledge a certificate to persons or
                                            entities that do not participate in the DTC, Cedelbank
                                            or Euroclear System or otherwise to take actions in
                                            respect of such certificates, may be limited due to lack
                                            of a physical certificate. You may also experience some
                                            delay in the receipt of distributions of interest and
                                            principal on the certificates since such distributions
                                            will be forwarded by the trustee to DTC and DTC will
                                            credit such
</TABLE>

                                      S-15



<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            distributions to the accounts of its participants which
                                            will thereafter credit them to your account either
                                            directly or indirectly through indirect participants.

                                            See 'Description of the Certificates -- Book-Entry
                                            Certificates' in this prospectus supplement.

CERTIFICATEHOLDERS COULD BE ADVERSELY
AFFECTED BY THE ABSENCE OF YEAR 2000
COMPLIANCE................................  The master servicer has made and will continue to make
                                            investments to identify, modify or replace any computer
                                            systems that are not year 2000 compliant and to address
                                            other related issues associated with the change of the
                                            millennium. In the event that computer problems arise
                                            out of a failure of such efforts to be completed on
                                            time, or in the event that the computer systems of the
                                            master servicer or the trustee are not fully year 2000
                                            compliant, the resulting disruptions in the collection
                                            or distribution of receipts on the mortgage loans could
                                            materially and adversely affect the holders of the
                                            certificates.
</TABLE>



                                      S-16







<PAGE>

                               THE MORTGAGE POOL

GENERAL

     Certain information with respect to the conventional, sub-prime mortgage
loans (the 'Mortgage Loans') expected to be included in the pool of mortgage
loans (the 'Mortgage Pool') included in the trust fund (the 'Trust Fund') is set
forth below. Prior to the Closing Date, Mortgage Loans may be removed from the
Mortgage Pool and other Mortgage Loans may be substituted therefor. Bear Stearns
Asset Backed Securities, Inc. (the 'Depositor') believes that the information
set forth herein with respect to the Mortgage Pool as presently constituted is
representative of the characteristics of the Mortgage Pool as it will be
constituted at the Closing Date, although certain characteristics of the
Mortgage Loans in the Mortgage Pool may vary. Unless otherwise indicated,
information presented below expressed as a percentage (other than rates of
interest) are approximate percentages based on (a) the aggregate principal
balance of the related group of Mortgage Loans as of July 1, 1999 (such date,
the 'Cut-off Date,' and such aggregate principal balance, a 'Cut-off Date
Principal Balance'), or (b) the aggregate principal balance of all of the
Mortgage Loans in the Mortgage Loans in the Mortgage Pool as of the Cut-off Date
(the 'Cut-off Date Pool Principal Balance').

     All of the Mortgage Loans to be included in the Trust Fund will be
evidenced by promissory notes (the 'Mortgage Notes') secured by first and second
lien deeds of trust, security deeds or mortgages on one- to four-family
residential properties (the 'Mortgaged Properties') which are located in 39
states and the District of Columbia. Each Mortgage Loan in the Trust Fund will
be assigned to one of two mortgage loan groups ('Fixed Rate Loan Group' and
'Adjustable Rate Loan Group,' and each a 'Loan Group'), comprised of Mortgage
Loans that bear interest at fixed rates, in the case of the Fixed Rate Loan
Group (such Mortgage Loans, the 'Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans'), and adjustable
rates, in the case of the Adjustable Rate Loan Group (such Mortgage Loans, the
'Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans').

     All of the Mortgage Loans to be included in the Trust Fund will provide for
the amortization of the amount financed over a series of monthly payments and
will provide for payments due as of the first day of each month. The Mortgage
Loans to be included in the Trust Fund have been purchased by Countrywide Home
Loans, Inc. from Bear Stearns Mortgage Capital Corporation (an affiliate of the
Depositor) ('Mortgage Capital') in a privately negotiated transaction. Mortgage
Capital acquired the Mortgage Loans in privately negotiated transactions from
Amresco Residential Mortgage Corporation ('Amresco') and Provident Funding
Associates, L.P. ('Provident'). The Mortgage Loans were originated substantially
in accordance with the underwriting criteria for sub-prime ('B&C') quality
Mortgage Loans described herein under ' -- Underwriting Guidelines.' Sub-prime
mortgage loans are generally mortgage loans made to borrowers with prior credit
difficulties.

     Scheduled monthly payments made by the Mortgagors on the Mortgage Loans
('Scheduled Payments') either earlier or later than the scheduled due dates
thereof will not affect the amortization schedule or the relative application of
such payments to principal and interest. The Mortgage Notes generally provide
for a grace period for monthly payments. Any Mortgage Loan may be prepaid in
full or in part at any time; however, approximately 4.97%, 8.98% and 68.39% of
the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group and 24.09%, 8.70% and 45.23% of
the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group (by Cut-off Date Principal
Balance) provide for the payment by the borrower of a prepayment charge on full
prepayments typically made within two, three and five years, respectively, from
the date of execution of the related Mortgage Note.

     The Cut-off Date Pool Principal Balance is $298,454,982.15, which is equal
to the aggregate Stated Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans as of the
Cut-off Date. The Mortgage Loans to be transferred by the Depositor to the Trust
Fund on the Closing Date will consist of 3,187 Mortgage Loans, of which
approximately 49.58% are fixed rate mortgage loans and approximately 50.42% are
adjustable rate mortgage loans.

     Fixed Rate Loan Group. The aggregate of the Stated Principal Balances for
the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date is
$126,864,888.10. The average Stated Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in
the Fixed Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date was $80,294.23, the minimum
Stated Principal Balance as of the Cut-off Date was $13,208.79, and the maximum
Stated Principal Balance as of the Cut-off Date was $447,334.42. The minimum
Mortgage Rate and the maximum Mortgage Rate of the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed
Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date were approximately 6.625% and 14.500% per
annum, respectively, and the weighted average Mortgage Rate as of the Cut-off
Date was approximately 9.709% per annum. The remaining term to scheduled
maturity for the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off
Date ranged from approximately 109 months to 360 months and the weighted average
remaining

                                      S-17



<PAGE>

term to stated maturity as of the Cut-off Date was approximately 330 months. As
of the Cut-off Date, approximately 79.80% of the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed
Rate Loan Group were secured by Mortgaged Properties which are single-family
detached residences and approximately 88.73% were owner-occupied. As of the
Cut-off Date, approximately 17.13%, 16.85%, 9.87% and 9.14% of the Mortgage
Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group are secured by Mortgaged Properties located
in Hawaii, California, Texas and Pennsylvania, respectively. As of the Cut-off
Date, approximately 4.53% of the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group
constitute Balloon Loans. As of the Cut-off Date, 1.69% of the Mortgage Loans in
the Fixed Rate Loan Group were 30 or more days delinquent. Approximately 98.25%
of the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group are secured by first liens on
the related Mortgaged Properties, and approximately 1.75% of the Mortgage Loans
in the Fixed Rate Loan Group are secured by second liens on the related
Mortgaged Properties.

     Adjustable Rate Loan Group. The aggregate of the Stated Principal Balances
for the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date
is $171,590,094.05. The average Stated Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans
in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date was $106,776.66, the
minimum Stated Principal Balance as of the Cut-off Date was $11,690.52, and the
maximum Stated Principal Balance as of the Cut-off Date was $498,044.67. The
minimum current Mortgage Rate and the maximum current Mortgage Rate of the
Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date were
approximately 6.875% and 13.750% per annum, respectively, and the weighted
average Mortgage Rate as of the Cut-off Date was approximately 9.768% per annum.
The remaining term to scheduled maturity for the Mortgage Loans in the
Adjustable Rate Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date ranged from approximately 48
to 360 months and the weighted average remaining term to scheduled maturity as
of the Cut-off Date was approximately 355 months. As of the Cut-off Date,
approximately 80.07% of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group
were secured by Mortgaged Properties which are single-family detached residences
and approximately 94.25% were owner-occupied. As of the Cut-off Date,
approximately 21.12%, 7.84%, 7.81%, 5.87% and 5.51% of the Mortgage Loans in the
Adjustable Rate Loan Group are secured by Mortgaged Properties located in
California, Ohio, Florida, Oregon and Pennsylvania, respectively. None of the
Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group constitute Balloon Loans. As of
the Cut-off Date, 1.84% of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group
were 30 or more days delinquent. All of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable
Rate Loan Group are secured by first liens on the related Mortgaged Properties.

     Additional Information Regarding the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans. Each
of the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans will have a Mortgage Rate which is subject
to semi-annual adjustment on the first day of the months specified in the
related Mortgage Note (each such date, an 'Adjustment Date') to equal the sum,
rounded to the nearest 0.125%, of (i) the average of the London interbank
offered rates for six-month U.S. dollar deposits in the London market, as set
forth in The Wall Street Journal, or, if such rate ceases to be published in The
Wall Street Journal or becomes unavailable for any reason, then based upon a new
index selected by the Trustee, as holder of the related Mortgage Note, based on
comparable information, in each case as most recently announced as of a date 45
days prior to such Adjustment Date (the 'Mortgage Index'), and (ii) a fixed
percentage amount specified in the related Mortgage Note (the 'Gross Margin');
provided, however, that the Mortgage Rate for substantially all of the
Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans will not increase or decrease by more than 1.500%
on any Adjustment Date (the 'Periodic Rate Cap'), with the exception of the
initial Adjustment Date for certain of the 2/28 Mortgage Loans, 3/27 Mortgage
Loans and 5/25 Mortgage Loans (each defined below), which are subject to a
different initial Periodic Rate Cap, which is set forth in the Mortgage Note.
Substantially all of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group were
originated with Mortgage Rates less than the sum of the then applicable Mortgage
Index and the related Gross Margin. Approximately 84.19% of the Mortgage Loans
in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group have fixed Mortgage Rates for approximately
24 months after origination thereof (the '2/28 Mortgage Loans'), approximately
2.74% of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group have fixed
Mortgage Rates for approximately 36 months after origination thereof (the '3/27
Mortgage Loans') and approximately 0.84% of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable
Rate Loan Group have fixed Mortgage Rates for approximately 60 months after
origination thereof (the '5/25 Mortgage Loans'), in each case before becoming
subject to the semi-annual adjustment described in the preceding sentences. Each
of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group will provide that over
the life of each such Mortgage Loan the Mortgage Rate will in no event be more
than a specified rate (the 'Maximum Mortgage Rate'). As of the Cut-off Date, the
weighted average Maximum Mortgage Rate for the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was
16.674%. Effective with the first payment due on an Adjustable Rate

                                      S-18



<PAGE>

Mortgage Loan after each related Adjustment Date, the monthly payment will be
adjusted to an amount which will fully amortize the outstanding principal
balance of the Mortgage Loan over its remaining term.

     Loan-to-Value Ratio and Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio. The 'Loan-to-Value
Ratio' of a Mortgage Loan is equal to (i) the principal balance of such Mortgage
Loan at the date of origination, divided by (ii) the Collateral Value of the
related Mortgaged Property. The 'Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio' of a Mortgage
Loan at any given time is the ratio, expressed as a percentage, of (i) the sum
of (a) the original principal balance of the Mortgage Loan and (b) the
outstanding principal balance at the date of origination of the Mortgage Loan of
any senior mortgage loan(s) or, in the case of any open-ended senior mortgage
loan, the maximum available line of credit with respect to such mortgage loan,
regardless of any lesser amount actually outstanding at the date of origination
of the Mortgage Loan, to (ii) the Collateral Value of the related Mortgaged
Property. The 'Collateral Value' of a Mortgaged Property is the lesser of
(x) the appraised value based on an appraisal made by an independent fee
appraiser at the time of the origination of the related Mortgage Loan, and
(y) the sales price of such Mortgaged Property at such time of origination. With
respect to a Mortgage Loan the proceeds of which were used to refinance an
existing mortgage loan, the Collateral Value is the appraised value of the
Mortgaged Property based upon the appraisal obtained at the time of refinancing.
No assurance can be given that the values of the Mortgaged Properties have
remained or will remain at their levels as of the dates of origination of the
related Mortgage Loans. The weighted average Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio as of
the Cut-off Date for the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group was
approximately 75.47% and the weighted average Loan-to-Value Ratio as of the
Cut-off Date for the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was
approximately 77.61%.

MORTGAGE LOANS

     The following information sets forth in tabular format certain information,
as of the Cut-off Date, about the Mortgage Loans. Other than with respect to
rates of interest, percentages are approximate and are stated by Stated
Principal Balance of the related Loan Group as of the Cut-off Date. The sum of
the columns below may not equal the total indicated due to rounding.

                                      S-19







<PAGE>

                        FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       MORTGAGE RATES FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
         RANGE OF           NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
    MORTGAGE RATES (%)      MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
 6.501% -  7.000%..........         7      $    970,369.40     0.76%
 7.001% -  7.500%..........        15         2,253,990.40     1.78
 7.501% -  8.000%..........        58         9,406,701.03     7.41
 8.001% -  8.500%..........       121        15,276,128.81    12.04
 8.501% -  9.000%..........       192        20,894,287.20    16.47
 9.001% -  9.500%..........       165        14,941,125.25    11.78
 9.501% - 10.000%..........       198        14,826,560.25    11.69
10.001% - 10.500%..........       197        13,195,244.17    10.40
10.501% - 11.000%..........       224        14,086,066.51    11.10
11.001% - 11.500%..........       163         9,235,849.25     7.28
11.501% - 12.000%..........       120         6,216,423.89     4.90
12.001% - 12.500%..........        53         2,840,724.56     2.24
12.501% - 13.000%..........        33         1,422,033.67     1.12
13.001% - 13.500%..........        23           853,386.49     0.67
13.501% - 14.000%..........         9           356,701.26     0.28
14.001% - 14.500%..........         2            89,295.96     0.07
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Mortgage Rate of the Mortgage
    Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group was approximately 9.709% per annum.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
               COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
     RANGE OF COMBINED      NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
 LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS (%)   MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
10.01% - 15.00%............         1      $     28,619.23     0.02%
15.01% - 20.00%............         4           152,093.22     0.12
20.01% - 25.00%............         3           115,210.39     0.09
25.01% - 30.00%............        10           448,242.41     0.35
30.01% - 35.00%............        15           762,237.94     0.60
35.01% - 40.00%............        13           913,317.46     0.72
40.01% - 45.00%............        35         1,812,589.70     1.43
45.01% - 50.00%............        22         1,621,026.06     1.28
50.01% - 55.00%............        45         2,731,305.94     2.15
55.01% - 60.00%............        57         4,322,052.21     3.41
60.01% - 65.00%............       143         8,966,750.86     7.07
65.01% - 70.00%............       169        12,232,514.68     9.64
70.01% - 75.00%............       187        15,622,823.63    12.31
75.01% - 80.00%............       390        32,885,753.91    25.92
80.01% - 85.00%............       275        23,993,709.39    18.91
85.01% - 90.00%............       211        20,256,641.07    15.97
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of
    the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group was approximately 75.47%.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
              MORTGAGE LOAN PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
         RANGE OF                             PRINCIPAL        OF
       MORTGAGE LOAN        NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
  PRINCIPAL BALANCES ($)    MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
$      0.00 - $ 25,000.00...       103     $  2,247,625.46     1.77%
$ 25,000.01 - $ 50,000.00...       546       20,973,108.28    16.53
$ 50,000.01 - $ 75,000.00...       350       21,609,770.56    17.03
$ 75,000.01 - $100,000.00...       200       17,121,514.14    13.50
$100,000.01 - $125,000.00...       112       12,531,113.68     9.88
$125,000.01 - $150,000.00...        81       11,014,462.84     8.68
$150,000.01 - $175,000.00...        54        8,713,258.21     6.87
$175,000.01 - $200,000.00...        40        7,493,890.63     5.91
$200,000.01 - $225,000.00...        27        5,665,447.33     4.47
$225,000.01 - $250,000.00...        16        3,777,960.02     2.98
$250,000.01 - $275,000.00...        13        3,430,364.56     2.70
$275,000.01 - $300,000.00...        16        4,598,638.02     3.62
$300,000.01 - $325,000.00...         8        2,532,562.88     2.00
$325,000.01 - $350,000.00...         8        2,735,917.29     2.16
$350,000.01 - $375,000.00...         2          713,052.53     0.56
$375,000.01 - $400,000.00...         1          398,824.05     0.31
$400,000.01 - $425,000.00...         1          421,327.52     0.33
greater than $450,000.00....         2          886,050.10     0.70
                                 -----      ---------------   ------
   Total....................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                 -----      ---------------   ------
                                 -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the average principal balance of the Mortgage Loans
    in the Fixed Rate Loan Group was approximately $80,294.23.

                                      S-20



<PAGE>

                             FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       STATE DISTRIBUTIONS OF
         MORTGAGED PROPERTIES FOR THE MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                       FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
                            NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
           STATE            MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>           <C>               <C>
Alabama....................         1      $     80,591.31     0.06%
Arizona....................        65         3,378,597.88     2.66
Arkansas...................         6           532,871.64     0.42
California.................       168        21,374,304.71    16.85
Colorado...................        13         1,206,476.97     0.95
Connecticut................         8           664,803.74     0.52
District of Columbia.......         7           730,424.08     0.58
Florida....................       129         9,458,142.23     7.46
Georgia....................        18         1,303,846.04     1.03
Hawaii.....................       123        21,733,176.81    17.13
Idaho......................         1            67,784.98     0.05
Illinois...................        25         1,492,225.89     1.18
Indiana....................        61         3,362,833.52     2.65
Kentucky...................         7           437,137.46     0.34
Louisiana..................        18         1,102,423.77     0.87
Maryland...................        54         2,571,125.72     2.03
Massachusetts..............        19         2,329,588.63     1.84
Michigan...................        49         3,333,788.31     2.63
Mississippi................        26         1,415,734.58     1.12
Missouri...................        39         1,936,165.20     1.53
Montana....................         3           206,842.67     0.16
Nebraska...................         3           228,156.33     0.18
Nevada.....................         5           498,821.13     0.39
New Jersey.................         8           598,768.71     0.47
New York...................        10           780,372.19     0.62
North Carolina.............        54         3,981,194.48     3.14
Ohio.......................       111         6,554,397.99     5.17
Oklahoma...................        23         1,282,218.63     1.01
Oregon.....................        19         2,205,198.59     1.74
Pennsylvania...............       175        11,594,040.15     9.14
Rhode Island...............         1            20,612.23     0.02
South Carolina.............         6           281,168.89     0.22
Tennessee..................        49         2,391,662.47     1.89
Texas......................       205        12,527,756.74     9.87
Utah.......................         9           678,550.41     0.53
Virginia...................        15         1,311,693.86     1.03
Washington.................        22         2,191,301.78     1.73
West Virginia..............         7           307,133.50     0.24
Wisconsin..................        18           712,953.88     0.56
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                TYPE OF MORTGAGED PROPERTIES FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                       FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
                            NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
       PROPERTY TYPE        MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
Single Family Detached.....     1,300      $101,235,720.04    79.80%
PUD........................        96         9,578,285.89     7.55
2-4 Family.................       108         9,772,071.85     7.70
Condominium................        65         5,702,805.39     4.50
Manufactured Housing.......        11           576,004.93     0.45
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                      OCCUPANCY TYPES FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
                            NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
      OCCUPANCY TYPE        MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
Owner-Occupied.............       246      $ 13,790,029.85    10.87%
Non-Owner Occupied.........     1,330       112,563,096.19    88.73
Vacation/Second Home.......         4           511,762.06     0.40
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) Based upon representations of the related mortgagors at the time of
    origination.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
            REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
                            NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
  REMAINING TERM (MONTHS)   MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
 61 - 120..................         5      $    141,175.97     0.11%
121 - 180..................       261        15,778,050.05    12.44
181 - 240..................        50         2,637,428.36     2.08
241 - 300..................         1            69,733.18     0.05
301 - 360..................     1,263       108,238,500.54    85.32
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average remaining months to scheduled
    maturity was approximately 330 months.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                        LOAN PURPOSE FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                       FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
                            NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
LOAN PURPOSE                MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
Refinance-Cash Out.........       987      $ 78,306,366.00    61.72%
Refinance-Rate/Term........       360        25,231,210.17    19.89
Purchase...................       233        23,327,311.93    18.39
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,580      $126,864,888.10   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

                                      S-21



<PAGE>

                     ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       MORTGAGE RATES FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                   ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
         RANGE OF           NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
    MORTGAGE RATES (%)      MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
 6.501% -  7.000%..........         2      $    304,130.06     0.18%
 7.001% -  7.500%..........        18         3,349,108.90     1.95
 7.501% -  8.000%..........        56         7,600,348.42     4.43
 8.001% -  8.500%..........        79        11,047,430.14     6.44
 8.501% -  9.000%..........       165        23,987,116.54    13.98
 9.001% -  9.500%..........       268        31,285,442.21    18.23
 9.501% - 10.000%..........       311        34,132,247.11    19.89
10.001% - 10.500%..........       228        20,687,122.53    12.06
10.501% - 11.000%..........       204        19,037,401.31    11.09
11.001% - 11.500%..........       113         8,890,157.40     5.18
11.501% - 12.000%..........        84         5,905,739.48     3.44
12.001% - 12.500%..........        42         2,790,005.33     1.63
12.501% - 13.000%..........        19         1,286,686.85     0.75
13.001% - 13.500%..........        11           742,679.36     0.43
13.501% - 14.000%..........         7           544,478.41     0.32
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Mortgage Rate of the Mortgage
    Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was approximately 9.768% per annum.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                         GROSS MARGINS FOR
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                   ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
         RANGE OF           NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
     GROSS MARGINS (%)      MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
 4.001% -  5.000%..........       164      $ 20,405,855.63    11.89%
 5.001% -  6.000%..........       582        68,098,003.24    39.69
 6.001% -  7.000%..........       549        56,304,017.17    32.81
 7.001% -  8.000%..........       275        23,195,361.68    13.52
 8.001% -  9.000%..........        33         3,288,314.45     1.92
 9.001% - 10.000%..........         4           298,541.88     0.17
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Gross Margin of the Mortgage
    Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was approximately 6.180%.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       MAXIMUM RATES FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                   ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
         RANGE OF           NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
     MAXIMUM RATES (%)      MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
13.001% - 14.000%..........         6      $  1,019,002.85     0.59%
14.001% - 15.000%..........       113        16,747,537.43     9.76
15.001% - 16.000%..........       248        35,763,058.10    20.84
16.001% - 17.000%..........       551        59,735,215.85    34.81
17.001% - 18.000%..........       414        38,371,328.80    22.36
18.001% - 19.000%..........       196        14,590,101.07     8.50
19.001% - 20.000%..........        61         4,076,692.18     2.38
20.001% - 21.000%..........        18         1,287,157.77     0.75
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Maximum Rate of the Mortgage
    Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was approximately 16.674% per annum.

                                      S-22



<PAGE>

                           ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
              MORTGAGE LOAN PRINCIPAL BALANCES FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                   ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
         RANGE OF                             PRINCIPAL        OF
       MORTGAGE LOAN        NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
  PRINCIPAL BALANCES ($)    MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
$      0.00 - $ 25,000.00...        26     $    574,789.09     0.33%
$ 25,000.01 - $ 50,000.00...       256       10,252,481.96     5.97
$ 50,000.01 - $ 75,000.00...       383       23,912,986.08    13.94
$ 75,000.01 - $100,000.00...       287       25,060,018.97    14.60
$100,000.01 - $125,000.00...       207       23,109,828.28    13.47
$125,000.01 - $150,000.00...       129       17,669,033.59    10.30
$150,000.01 - $175,000.00...        94       15,160,710.87     8.84
$175,000.01 - $200,000.00...        50        9,350,725.08     5.45
$200,000.01 - $225,000.00...        57       12,080,183.83     7.04
$225,000.01 - $250,000.00...        39        9,298,040.04     5.42
$250,000.01 - $275,000.00...        17        4,450,312.56     2.59
$275,000.01 - $300,000.00...        21        6,066,374.52     3.54
$300,000.01 - $325,000.00...        10        3,110,413.64     1.81
$325,000.01 - $350,000.00...        19        6,514,290.07     3.80
$350,000.01 - $375,000.00...         3        1,089,532.19     0.63
$375,000.01 - $400,000.00...         3        1,161,516.20     0.68
$425,000.01 - $450,000.00...         4        1,776,834.25     1.04
$450,000.01 - $475,000.00...         1          453,978.16     0.26
$475,000.01 - $500,000.00...         1          498,044.67     0.29
                                 -----      ---------------   ------
   Total....................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                 -----      ---------------   ------
                                 -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the average principal balance of the Mortgage Loans
    in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was approximately $106,776.66.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                     MINIMUM MORTGAGE RATES FOR
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                   ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
         RANGE OF                             PRINCIPAL        OF
     MINIMUM INTEREST       NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
         RATES (%)          MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
 0.000 -  5.000............         1      $     65,150.03     0.04%
 6.001 -  7.000............         3           435,142.56     0.25
 7.001 -  8.000............        77        11,168,813.66     6.51
 8.001 -  9.000............       243        35,347,662.05    20.60
 9.001 - 10.000............       580        65,180,667.67    37.99
10.001 - 11.000............       427        39,232,911.25    22.86
11.001 - 12.000............       197        14,795,896.88     8.62
12.001 - 13.000............        61         4,076,692.18     2.38
13.001 - 14.000............        18         1,287,157.77     0.75
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Minimum Mortgage Rate of the
    Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was approximately 9.755%
    per annum.

                                      S-23



<PAGE>

                           ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                    LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIO FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                   ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
         RANGE OF                             PRINCIPAL        OF
       LOAN-TO-VALUE        NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
        RATIOS (%)          MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
10.01% -  20.00%...........         1      $     25,149.80     0.01%
20.01% -  30.00%...........         6           290,731.16     0.17
30.01% -  40.00%...........        20         1,630,017.61     0.95
40.01% -  50.00%...........        30         2,425,546.06     1.41
50.01% -  60.00%...........        71         6,778,424.80     3.95
60.01% -  70.00%...........       281        25,123,736.77    14.64
70.01% -  80.00%...........       577        63,452,320.26    36.98
80.01% -  90.00%...........       618        71,327,535.93    41.57
90.01% - 100.00%...........         3           536,631.66     0.31
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average Loan-to-Value Ratio of the
    Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group was approximately 77.61%.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
             STATE DISTRIBUTION OF MORTGAGED PROPERTIES
                   FOR THE MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                     ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
                            NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
           STATE            MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
Arizona....................         3      $    187,132.10     0.11%
Arkansas...................        23         1,745,171.96     1.02
California.................       216        36,235,728.67    21.12
Colorado...................        22         2,667,166.28     1.55
Connecticut................        13         1,101,506.41     0.64
District of Columbia.......         5           584,825.95     0.34
Florida....................       122        13,401,127.08     7.81
Georgia....................        27         3,680,025.93     2.14
Hawaii.....................        27         4,935,447.54     2.88
Idaho......................         8           814,817.77     0.47
Illinois...................        44         4,103,661.42     2.39
Indiana....................        43         3,128,549.87     1.82
Iowa.......................         3           192,552.34     0.11
Kansas.....................         4           370,226.77     0.22
Kentucky...................        12           936,395.98     0.55
Louisiana..................        15         1,385,763.76     0.81
Maine......................         3           531,885.69     0.31
Maryland...................        46         4,279,192.51     2.49
Massachusetts..............        31         3,735,476.51     2.18
Michigan...................        63         6,985,340.97     4.07
Minnesota..................         7           434,450.44     0.25
Mississippi................        11           987,047.20     0.58
Missouri...................       100         7,939,291.78     4.63
Montana....................         2           174,991.82     0.10
Nebraska...................        12         1,010,503.35     0.59
Nevada.....................         6           694,286.79     0.40
New Hampshire..............        16         1,380,999.22     0.80
New Jersey.................        16         1,667,234.73     0.97
New Mexico.................         7           707,393.91     0.41
New York...................        21         3,233,388.71     1.88
North Carolina.............        38         2,886,521.02     1.68
Ohio.......................       171        13,450,421.54     7.84
Oklahoma...................        19         2,070,852.46     1.21
Oregon.....................        75        10,079,988.72     5.87
Pennsylvania...............       115         9,457,969.55     5.51
Rhode Island...............         7           480,400.33     0.28
South Carolina.............         3           273,776.97     0.16
Tennessee..................         6           650,254.90     0.38
Texas......................        65         5,775,423.37     3.37
Utah.......................        48         6,050,943.54     3.53
Virginia...................        18         2,662,362.97     1.55
Washington.................        19         2,500,516.28     1.46
West Virginia..............         8           381,433.45     0.22
Wisconsin..................        82         5,343,056.36     3.11
Wyoming....................         5           294,589.13     0.17
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

                                      S-24



<PAGE>

                           ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                 INITIAL FIXED RATE PERIOD FOR THE
                       MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                     ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
    INITIAL FIXED RATE      NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
    PERIOD -- (MONTHS)      MORTGAGE LOANS   OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
24.........................     1,398      $144,455,070.92    84.19%
36.........................        35         4,699,078.68     2.74
60.........................        10         1,447,219.44     0.84
6..........................       164        20,988,725.01    12.23
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,607      $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                    NEXT ADJUSTMENT DATE FOR THE
             2/28, 3/27 AND 5/25 MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                     ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
    NEXT ADJUSTMENT         NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
         DATE             MORTGAGE LOANS     OUTSTANDING      GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>            <C>               <C>
September-00...............         7      $  1,152,215.94     0.76%
October-00.................         5           813,935.43     0.54
November-00................        33         3,859,473.87     2.56
December-00................       150        16,233,836.14    10.77
January-01.................       268        27,806,843.88    18.45
February-01................       286        30,618,343.19    20.32
March-01...................       286        28,045,457.41    18.61
April-01...................       197        20,749,418.56    13.77
May-01.....................        32         2,587,471.14     1.72
June-01....................        89         8,333,124.19     5.53
July-01....................        47         4,490,243.32     2.98
October-01.................         2           307,226.74     0.20
December-01................         6           745,849.71     0.49
January-02.................         3           240,917.69     0.16
February-02................        17         2,665,684.28     1.77
March-02...................         1           188,642.99     0.13
April-02...................         3           318,626.13     0.21
May-02.....................         2           113,131.14     0.08
November-03................         1           135,631.83     0.09
December-03................         1            52,345.44     0.03
January-04.................         2           214,270.87     0.14
February-04................         3           203,483.94     0.14
March-04...................         1            61,921.80     0.04
April-04...................         2           779,565.56     0.52
                                -----      ---------------   ------
   Total...................     1,444      $150,717,661.19   100.00%
                                -----      ---------------   ------
                                -----      ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   NEXT ADJUSTMENT DATE FOR THE
           NON-2/28, 3/27 AND 5/25 MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                    ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                              PRINCIPAL        OF
    NEXT ADJUSTMENT         NUMBER OF          BALANCE        LOAN
         DATE             MORTGAGE LOANS     OUTSTANDING      GROUP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>              <C>              <C>
07/01/99................        38         $ 4,769,423.46    22.85%
08/01/99................        41           5,346,181.46    25.61
09/01/99................        50           7,102,574.56    34.03
10/01/99................        14           1,121,209.41     5.37
11/01/99................         4             578,054.40     2.77
12/01/99................        15           1,737,189.57     8.32
01/01/00................         1             217,800.00     1.04
                               ---         --------------   ------
   Total................       163         $20,872,432.86   100.00%
                               ---         --------------   ------
                               ---         --------------   ------
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                 TYPE OF MORTGAGED PROPERTIES FOR THE
                         MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                 AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                                 PRINCIPAL        OF
                           NUMBER OF              BALANCE        LOAN
      PROPERTY TYPE       MORTGAGE LOANS        OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>                 <C>               <C>
Single Family............        1,311        $137,397,578.87    80.07%
PUD......................           98          14,457,556.99     8.43
2-4 Family...............          115          11,444,229.27     6.67
Condominimum.............           74           7,466,030.39     4.35
Manufactured Housing.....            8             718,652.14     0.42
Other....................            1             106,046.39     0.06
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
   Total.................        1,607        $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                        OCCUPANCY TYPES FOR THE
                         MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                     ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                 AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                                 PRINCIPAL        OF
                           NUMBER OF              BALANCE        LOAN
     OCCUPANCY TYPE       MORTGAGE LOANS        OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>                 <C>               <C>
Owner-Occupied...........        1,470        $161,729,600.83    94.25%
Non-Owner Occupied.......          134           9,503,268.21     5.54
Second Home..............            3             357,225.01     0.21
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
   Total.................        1,607        $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) Based upon representation of the related mortgagors at the time of
    origination.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
              REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY FOR THE
                         MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                     ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP(1)
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                 AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                                 PRINCIPAL        OF
                           NUMBER OF              BALANCE        LOAN
 REMAINING TERM (MONTHS)  MORTGAGE LOANS        OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>                 <C>               <C>
  0 -  60................            1        $     11,690.52     0.01%
121 - 180................            5             427,121.34     0.25
241 - 300................            2             257,814.11     0.15
301 - 360................        1,599         170,893,468.08    99.59
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
   Total.................        1,607        $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) As of the Cut-off Date, the weighted average remaining months to scheduled
    maturity was approximately 355 months.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                         LOAN PURPOSE FOR THE
                         MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE
                      ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                 AGGREGATE      PERCENT
                                                 PRINCIPAL        OF
                           NUMBER OF              BALANCE        LOAN
      LOAN PURPOSE        MORTGAGE LOANS        OUTSTANDING     GROUP
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>                 <C>               <C>
Refinance-Cash Out.......          750        $ 80,041,838.52    46.65%
Refinance-Rate/Term......          295          58,789,365.82    34.26
Purchase.................          562          32,758,889.71    19.09
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
   Total.................        1,607        $171,590,094.05   100.00%
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
                                 -----        ---------------   ------
</TABLE>

                                      S-25







<PAGE>

ASSIGNMENT OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS; REPURCHASE

     Pursuant to the pooling and servicing agreement dated as of July 1, 1999
(the 'Pooling and Servicing Agreement'), among the Depositor, the Master
Servicer, Countrywide, as seller (the 'Seller'), and The Bank of New York, as
trustee (the 'Trustee'), the Depositor on the Closing Date will sell, transfer,
assign, set over and otherwise convey without recourse to the Trustee in trust
for the benefit of the Certificateholders all right, title and interest of the
Depositor in and to each Mortgage Loan and all right, title and interest in and
to all other assets included in the Trust Fund, including all principal and
interest received on or with respect to the Mortgage Loans on and after the
Cut-off Date, exclusive of principal due and interest accruing prior to the
Cut-off Date.

     In connection with such transfer and assignment, the Depositor will deliver
on the Closing Date (or with respect to up to 50% of the Mortgage Loans, not
later than thirty days after the Closing Date) the following documents
(collectively constituting the 'Trustee's Mortgage File') with respect to each
Mortgage Loan:

          (i) the original Mortgage Note, endorsed by the originator of the
     Mortgage Loan, without recourse in the following form: 'Pay to the order of
                       without recourse,' with all intervening endorsements that
     show a complete chain of endorsement from the originator to Countrywide;

          (ii) the original recorded Mortgage;

          (iii) a duly executed assignment of the Mortgage to 'The Bank of New
     York, a New York banking corporation, as trustee under the Pooling and
     Servicing Agreement dated as of July 1, 1999, Bear Stearns Asset Backed
     Securities, Inc., Asset-Backed Certificates, Series 1999-1, without
     recourse;' in recordable form, as described in the Pooling and Servicing
     Agreement;

          (iv) the original recorded assignment or assignments of the Mortgage
     together with all interim recorded assignments of such Mortgage; and

          (v) the original or duplicate original lender's title policy or, in
     the event such original title policy has not been received from the
     insurer, such original or duplicate original lender's title policy shall be
     delivered within one year of the Closing Date.

     Assignments of the Mortgage Loans to the Trustee (or its nominee) will be
recorded in the appropriate public office for real property records, except in
states (such as California) as to which an opinion of counsel is delivered to
the effect that such recording is not required to protect the Trustee's
interests in the Mortgage Loan against the claim of any subsequent transferee or
any successor to or creditor of the Depositor or the Seller. As to any Mortgage
Loan, the recording requirement exception described in the preceding sentence is
applicable only so long as the related Mortgage File is maintained in the
possession of the Trustee in one of the states to which such exception applies.
In the event any such assignment is delivered to the Trustee in blank and the
related Mortgage File is released by the Trustee pursuant to applicable
provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Trustee shall complete
such assignment as provided in subparagraph (iii) above prior to any such
release. In the event such recording is required to protect the interest of the
Trustee in the Mortgage Loans, the Master Servicer is required to cause each
previously unrecorded assignment to be submitted for recording.

     The Trustee will review the Mortgage Loan documents on or prior to the
Closing Date (or promptly after the Trustee's receipt of any document permitted
to be delivered after the Closing Date) and will hold such documents in trust
for the benefit of the holders of the Certificates. The Trustee will be
authorized to appoint a custodian to maintain possession of and, if applicable,
to review the documents relating to the Mortgage Loans as agent of the Trustee.

     In addition, Countrywide will make representations and warranties in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement as of the Cut-off Date in respect of the
Mortgage Loans. The Depositor will file the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
containing such representations and warranties with the Securities and Exchange
Commission in a report on Form 8-K within 15 days of the Closing Date.

     After the Closing Date, if any document is found to be missing or defective
in any material respect, or if Countrywide breaches a representation or warranty
with respect to any Mortgage Loan and such breach materially and adversely
affects the interests of the holders of the Certifiates in such Mortgage Loan,
the Trustee is required to notify Countrywide in writing. If Countrywide cannot
or does not cure such omission, defect or breach within 90 days of its receipt
of notice from the Trustee, Countrywide is required to repurchase the related
Mortgage Loan from the Trust Fund at a price (the 'Purchase Price') equal to
100% of the Stated Principal Balance as of the date of repurchase thereof plus
accrued and unpaid interest thereon, at a rate equal to the

                                      S-26



<PAGE>

difference between the Mortgage Rate and the Servicing Fee Rate (as defined
herein) (the 'Net Mortgage Rate') (or, if Countrywide is no longer the Master
Servicer, at the applicable Mortgage Rate) to the first day of the month
following the month of repurchase. Rather than repurchase the Mortgage Loan as
provided above, Countrywide may remove such Mortgage Loan (a 'Deleted Mortgage
Loan') from the Trust Fund and substitute in its place another Mortgage Loan of
like kind (a 'Replacement Mortgage Loan'); however, such substitution is only
permitted within two years after the Closing Date, and may not be made unless an
opinion of counsel is provided to the effect that such substitution would not
disqualify either REMIC or result in a prohibited transaction tax under the
Code. Any Replacement Mortgage Loan generally will, on the date of substitution,
among other characteristics set forth in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement,
(i) have a Stated Principal Balance, after deduction of the principal portion of
the scheduled payment due in the month of substitution, not in excess of, and
not less than 90% of, the Stated Principal Balance of the Deleted Mortgage Loan
(the amount of any shortfall to be deposited by Countrywide in the Certificate
Account not later than the succeeding Determination Date and held for
distribution to the holders of the Certificates on the related Distribution
Date), (ii) if the Deleted Mortgage Loan that is being replaced is an Adjustable
Rate Mortgage Loan, have a Maximum Mortgage Rate not more than 1% per annum
higher or lower than the Maximum Mortgage Rate of the Deleted Mortgage Loan,
(iii) if the Deleted Mortgage Loan that is being replaced is an Adjustable Rate
Mortgage Loan, have a minimum Mortgage Rate specified in its related Mortgage
Note (such rate, the 'Minimum Mortgage Rate') not more than 1% per annum higher
or lower than the Minimum Mortgage Rate of the Deleted Mortgage Loan, (iv) if
the Deleted Mortgage Loan that is being replaced is an Adjustable Rate Mortgage
Loan, have the same Mortgage Index and Periodic Rate Cap as the Deleted Mortgage
Loan and a Gross Margin not more than 1% per annum higher or lower than that of
the Deleted Mortgage Loan, (v) have the same or higher credit quality
characteristics than that of the Deleted Mortgage Loan, (vi) be accruing
interest at a rate not more than 1% per annum higher or lower than that of the
Deleted Mortgage Loan, (vii) have a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio or
Loan-to-Value Ratio, as applicable, no higher than that of the Deleted Mortgage
Loan, (viii) have a remaining term to maturity not greater than (and not more
than one year less than) that of the Deleted Mortgage Loan, (ix) not permit
conversion of the Mortgage Rate from a fixed rate to a variable rate or vice
versa, (x) provide for a prepayment charge on terms substantially similar to
those of the prepayment charge, if any, of the Deleted Mortgage Loan, (xi)
constitute the same occupancy type as the Deleted Mortgage Loan, and
(xii) comply with all of the representations and warranties set forth in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement as of the date of substitution. With respect to
any repurchase or substitution of a Mortgage Loan that is not in default or as
to which a default is not imminent, the Trustee must have received a
satisfactory opinion of counsel that such repurchase or substitution will not
cause the Trust Fund to lose the status of its REMIC elections or otherwise
subject the Trust Fund to a prohibited transaction tax. The obligation to cure,
repurchase or substitute as described above constitutes the sole remedy
available to the Certificateholders, the Trustee or the Depositor for omission
of, or a material defect in, a Mortgage Loan document or for a breach of
representation or warranty by Countrywide with respect to a Mortgage Loan. The
Master Servicer or a holder of a Residual Certificate will be obligated to pay
any prohibited transaction taxes. The Master Servicer will be entitled to
reimbursement for any such payment from the assets of the Trust Fund or from a
holder of a Residual Certificate.

UNDERWRITING GUIDELINES

     Bear Stearns Mortgage Capital Corporation, an affiliate of the Depositor
('Mortgage Capital'), purchased approximately 92.45% of the Mortgage Loans from
Amresco Residential Mortgage Corporation ('Amresco') and approximately 7.55% of
the Mortgage Loans from Provident Funding Associates, L.P. ('Provident' and,
together with Mortgage Capital, the 'Originators' and, each an 'Originator').
Mortgage Capital subsequently sold the Mortgage Loans to Countrywide in a
privately negotiated transaction. The Mortgage Loans were underwritten in
accordance with the general underwriting standards of Amresco and of Provident
for B&C quality Mortgage Loans (the 'Underwriting Guidelines').

     The Underwriting Guidelines are primarily intended to evaluate the value
and adequacy of the mortgaged property as collateral and are also intended to
consider the mortgagor's credit standing and repayment ability. On a
case-by-case basis, the related Originator may determine that, based upon
compensating factors, a prospective mortgagor not strictly qualifying under the
Underwriting Guidelines warrants an underwriting exception. Compensating factors
may include, but are not limited to, low loan-to-value ratio, low debt-to-income
ratio, good credit history, stable employment, pride of ownership and time in
residence at the applicant's current

                                      S-27



<PAGE>

address. It is expected that a substantial number of the Mortgage Loans will
represent such underwriting exceptions.

     The Underwriting Guidelines are less stringent than the standards generally
acceptable to FNMA and FHLMC with regard to the mortgagor's credit standing and
repayment ability. Mortgagors who qualify under the Underwriting Guidelines (or
under an underwriting exception thereto) generally have payment histories and
debt ratios which would not satisfy FNMA and FHLMC underwriting guidelines and
may have a record of major derogatory credit items such as outstanding judgments
or prior bankruptcies. The Underwriting Guidelines establish the maximum
permitted loan-to-value ratio for each loan type based upon these and other risk
factors.

     Under the Underwriting Guidelines, the related Originator reviews and
verifies the loan applicant's sources of income (except under the Stated Income
Documentation program), calculates the amount of income from all such sources
indicated on the loan application, reviews the credit history of the applicant,
calculates the debt-to-income ratio to determine the applicant's ability to
repay the loan and reviews the mortgaged property for compliance with the
Underwriting Guidelines. The Underwriting Guidelines are applied in accordance
with a procedure which complies with applicable federal and state laws and
regulations and requires (i) an appraisal of the mortgaged property (which
conforms to Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation ('FHLMC') and Federal
National Mortgage Corporation ('FNMA') standards generally) by qualified
independent appraisers who are approved by the related Originator and (ii) a
review of such appraisal, which review may be conducted by the related
Originator's staff appraiser or representative and, depending upon the original
principal balance and loan-to-value ratio of the mortgaged property, may include
a desk review of the original appraisal or a drive-by review appraisal of the
mortgaged property. Each appraisal includes a market data analysis based on
recent sales of comparable homes in the area and, where deemed appropriate,
replacement cost analysis based on the current cost of constructing a similar
home. The Underwriting Guidelines generally permit single-family loans with
loan-to-value ratios at origination of up to 90% for the highest credit grading
category (80% under the Stated Income Documentation program), depending on the
type and use of the property, the creditworthiness of the mortgagor and the
debt-to-income ratio. Under the Underwriting Guidelines, the maximum combined
loan-to-value ratio for purchase money mortgage loans may differ from those
applicable to refinancings.

     Each prospective mortgagor completes an application which includes
information with respect to the applicant's liabilities, income, credit history
and employment history, as well as certain other personal information. Each
Originator requires a credit report on each applicant from a credit reporting
company. The report typically contains information relating to such matters as
credit history with local and national merchants and lenders, installment debt
payments and any record of defaults, bankruptcy, repossession, suits or
judgments. Self-employed individuals are generally required to submit their two
most recent federal income tax returns. As part of their quality control
systems, the related Originator generally reverifies information with respect to
the foregoing matters that has been provided by the mortgage brokerage company
prior to funding a loan and periodically audits files based on a random sample
of closed loans. In the course of their pre-funding audit, the related
Originator generally reverifies the income of the mortgagor or, for a
self-employed individual, reviews the income documentation obtained pursuant to
the Underwriting Guidelines (except under the Stated Income Documentation
program). If the loan-to-value ratio is greater than a predetermined level, the
related Originator generally verifies the source of funds for the down payment;
however, the related Originator may not verify the source of funds if the
loan-to-value ratio is less than such level.

     The Mortgage Loans were originated consistent with and generally conform to
'Full Documentation', 'Limited Documentation', or 'Stated Income Documentation'
residential loan programs. Under each of the programs, the related Originator
generally reviews the applicant's source of income, calculates the amount of
income from sources indicated on the loan application or similar documentation,
reviews the credit history of the applicant, calculates the debt
service-to-income ratio to determine the applicant's ability to repay the loan,
reviews the type and use of the property being financed, and reviews the
property. In determining the ability of the applicant to repay the loan, a rate
is established that generally is equal to the lesser of the fully indexed
interest rate on the loan being applied for or one percent above the initial
interest rate of such loan. The Underwriting Guidelines require that mortgage
loans be underwritten in a standardized procedure which complies with applicable
federal and state laws and regulations and requires the related Originator's
underwriters to be satisfied that the value of the property being financed, as
indicated by an appraisal and a review of the appraisal, currently supports the
outstanding loan balance. In general, the maximum loan amount for mortgage loans
originated under the programs is $350,000. Mortgage loans may, however, be
originated

                                      S-28



<PAGE>

generally up to $500,000, provided the loan-to-value ratio is at least 5% below
the applicable residential loan program maximum that would otherwise apply. The
Underwriting Guidelines permit one- to four-family loans to have loan-to-value
ratios at origination of generally up to 90%, depending on, among other things,
the purpose of the mortgaged loan, the mortgagor's credit history, repayment
ability and debt service-to-income ratio, as well as the type and use of the
property. With respect to mortgage loans secured by mortgaged properties
acquired by a mortgagor under a 'lease option purchase,' the loan-to-value ratio
of the related mortgage loan is generally based on the appraised value at the
time of origination of such mortgage loan.

     The Underwriting Guidelines require that income be verified for each
applicant and that the source of funds (if any) required to be deposited by the
applicant into escrow under its various programs be as follows: Under the Full
Documentation programs, applicants generally are required to submit two written
forms of verification of stable income for 24 months (or, if the loan-to-value
ratio is less that or equal to 65% for 12 months). Under the Limited
Documentation programs, generally one such form of verification is required for
12 months. Under the Stated Income Documentation programs, generally an
applicant may be qualified based upon monthly income as stated on the mortgage
loan application if the applicant meets certain criteria. All the foregoing
programs typicially require that with respect to each applicant, there be a
telephone verification of the applicant's employment. Verification of funds (if
any) required to be deposited by the applicant into escrow in the case of a
purchase money loan is generally required under the Full Documentation program
guidelines. No such verification is required under the other programs.

     The Underwriting Guidelines require title insurance on all mortgage loans
secured by liens on real property. The Underwriting Guidelines also require that
fire and extended coverage casualty insurance be maintained on the secured
property in an amount at least equal to the principal balance of the related
mortgage loan or the replacement cost of the mortgaged property, whichever is
less.

     Under the Underwriting Guidelines, various risk categories are used to
grade the likelihood that the mortgagor will satisfy the repayment conditions of
the mortgage loan. These risk categories establish the maximum permitted
loan-to-value ratio and loan amount, given the occupancy status of the mortgaged
property and the mortgagor's credit history and debt ratio. In general, higher
credit risk mortgage loans are graded in categories which permit higher debt
ratios and more (or more recent) major derogatory credit items such as
outstanding judgments or prior bankruptcies; however, the Underwriting
Guidelines establish lower maximum loan-to-value ratios and maximum loan amounts
for loans graded in such categories.

NO RECOURSE TO THE DEPOSITOR OR COUNTRYWIDE

     As described above under ' -- Assignment of the Mortgage Loans;
Repurchase,' the Depositor will cause the Mortgage Loans to be assigned to the
Trustee, without recourse. However, Countrywide will be obligated to repurchase
or substitute for any Mortgage Loan as to which certain representations and
warranties are breached or for failure to deliver certain documents relating to
the Mortgage Loans as described above under ' -- Assignment of the Mortgage
Loans; Repurchase.' These obligations to purchase or substitute constitute the
sole remedy available to the Certificateholders or the Trustee for a breach of
any such representation or failure to deliver a constituent document.

                        SERVICING OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS

GENERAL

     The Master Servicer will service the Mortgage Loans in accordance with the
terms set forth in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. The Master Servicer may
perform any of its obligations under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement through
one or more subservicers. Notwithstanding any such subservicing arrangement, the
Master Servicer will remain liable for its servicing duties and obligations
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement as if the Master Servicer alone were
servicing the Mortgage Loans. As of the Closing Date, the Master Servicer will
service the Mortgage Loans without subservicing arrangements.

THE MASTER SERVICER

     Countrywide Home Loans, Inc., a New York corporation ('Countrywide') and a
subsidiary of Countrywide Credit Industries, Inc., will act as the master
servicer (the 'Master Servicer') of the Mortgage Loans pursuant to the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement. Countrywide is engaged primarily in the mortgage
banking business, and as such, originates, purchases, sells and services
mortgage loans. Countrywide originates mortgage loans through a retail branch
system and through mortgage loan brokers and correspondents nationwide.

                                      S-29



<PAGE>

Countrywide's mortgage loans are principally first-lien, fixed or adjustable
rate mortgage loans secured by single-family residences.

     As of June 30, 1999, Countrywide provided servicing for mortgage loans with
an aggregate principal balance of approximately $230.1 billion, substantially
all of which are being serviced for unaffiliated persons. As of June 30, 1999,
Countrywide provided servicing for approximately $3.28 billion in B&C quality
mortgage loans.

     The principal executive offices of Countrywide are located at 4500 Park
Granada, Calabasas, California 91302. Its telephone number is (818) 225-3000.
Countrywide conducts operations from its headquarters in Calabasas and from
offices throughout the nation.

LOAN SERVICING

     Countrywide services substantially all of the mortgage loans it originates
or acquires. Countrywide has established standard policies for the servicing and
collection of mortgage. Servicing includes, but is not limited to, collecting,
aggregating and remitting mortgage loan payments, accounting for principal and
interest, holding escrow (impound) funds for payment of taxes and insurance,
making inspections as required of the mortgaged properties, preparation of tax
related information in connection with the mortgage loans, supervision of
delinquent mortgage loans, loss mitigation efforts, foreclosure proceedings and,
if applicable, the disposition of mortgaged properties, and generally
administering the mortgage loans, for which it receives servicing fees.

     Billing statements with respect to mortgage loans are mailed monthly by
Countrywide. The statement details all debits and credits and specifies the
payment due. Notice of changes in the applicable loan rate are provided by
Countrywide to the mortgagor with such statements. All payments are due by the
first day of the month.

     Countrywide will pay or cause to be paid certain ongoing expenses
associated with the Trust Fund and incurred by it in connection with its
responsibilities as Master Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement,
including, without limitation, payment of the fees and disbursements of the
Trustee, any custodian appointed by the Trustee, the certificate registrar and
any paying agent, and payment of expenses incurred in enforcing the obligations
of subservicers. Countrywide will be entitled to reimbursement of expenses
incurred in enforcing the obligations of subservicers under certain limited
circumstances.

COLLECTION PROCEDURES

     Countrywide, as Master Servicer, will make reasonable efforts to collect
all payments called for under the Mortgage Loans and will, consistent with the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any applicable insurance policy, guaranty,
bankruptcy bond or alternative arrangements, follow such collection procedures
as are customary with respect to loans that are comparable to the Mortgage
Loans. Consistent with the above, Countrywide may, in its discretion, (i) waive
any assumption fee, late payment or other charge in connection with a Mortgage
Loan and (ii) to the extent not inconsistent with the coverage of such Mortgage
Loan by an insurance policy, guaranty, bankruptcy bond or alternative
arrangements, if applicable, arrange with a borrower a schedule for the
liquidation of delinquencies running for no more than 125 days after the
applicable due date for each payment. To the extent Countrywide is obligated to
make or cause to be made Advances, such obligation will remain during any period
of such an arrangement.

     In any case in which property securing a Mortgage Loan has been, or is
about to be, conveyed by the mortgagor or obligor, Countrywide, as Master
Servicer, will, to the extent it has knowledge of such conveyance or proposed
conveyance, exercise or cause to be exercised its rights to accelerate the
maturity of such Mortgage Loan under any due-on-sale clause applicable thereto,
but only if the exercise of such rights is permitted by applicable law and will
not impair or threaten to impair any recovery under any applicable insurance
policy. If these conditions are not met or if Countrywide reasonably believes it
is unable under applicable law to enforce such due-on-sale clause, Countrywide
will enter into or cause to be entered into an assumption and modification
agreement with the person to whom such property has been or is about to be
conveyed, pursuant to which such person becomes liable for repayment of the
Mortgage Loan and, to the extent permitted by applicable law, the mortgagor
remains liable thereon. Any fee collected by or on behalf of Countrywide for
entering into an assumption agreement will be retained by or on behalf of
Countrywide as additional servicing compensation. In connection with any such
assumption, the terms of the related Mortgage Loan may not be changed.

     B&C Quality Mortgage Loans Generally. When a mortgagor fails to make a
payment on a B&C quality mortgage loan, Countrywide attempts to cause the
deficiency to be cured by corresponding with the mortgagor.

                                      S-30



<PAGE>

In most cases, deficiencies are cured promptly. Pursuant to Countrywide's B&C
servicing procedures, Countrywide generally mails to the mortgagor a notice of
intent to foreclose after the loan becomes 31 days past due (two payments due
but not received) and, within 30 days thereafter, if the loan remains
delinquent, institutes appropriate legal action to foreclose on the mortgaged
property. Foreclosure proceedings may be terminated if the delinquency is cured.
Mortgage loans to borrowers in bankruptcy proceedings may be restructured in
accordance with law and with a view to maximizing recovery of such loans,
including any deficiencies.

     Once foreclosure is initiated by Countrywide, a foreclosure tracking system
is used to monitor the progress of the proceedings. The system includes state
specific parameters to monitor whether proceedings are progressing within the
time frame typical for the state in which the mortgaged property is located.
During the foreclosure proceeding, Countrywide determines the amount of the
foreclosure bid and whether to liquidate the mortgage loan.

     If foreclosed, the mortgaged property is sold at a public or private sale
and may be purchased by Countrywide. After foreclosure, Countrywide may
liquidate the mortgaged property and charge-off the loan balance which was not
recovered through liquidation proceeds.

     Servicing and charge-off policies and collection practices with respect to
B&C quality mortgage loans may change over time in accordance with, among other
things, Countrywide's business judgment, changes in the servicing portfolio and
applicable laws and regulations.

FORECLOSURE AND DELINQUENCY EXPERIENCE

     B&C Quality Mortgage Loans Generally. The following table summarizes the
delinquency and foreclosure experience, respectively, on the dates indicated, of
Countrywide's B&C quality mortgage loans. A B&C quality mortgage loan is
characterized as delinquent if the borrower has not paid the monthly payment due
within one month of the Due Date. The delinquency and foreclosure percentages
may be affected by the size and relative lack of seasoning of the servicing
portfolio because many of such loans were not outstanding long enough to give
rise to some or all of the periods of delinquency indicated in the chart below.
Moreover, the Mortgage Loans in the Trust Fund were originated in conformity
with the Originators' Underwriting Guidelines, while the B&C quality Mortgage
Loans for which for delinquency and foreclosure experience is summarized below
were generally underwritten in conformity with Countrywide's own underwriting
guidelines. Accordingly, the information should not be considered as a basis for
assessing the likelihood, amount, or severity of delinquency or losses on the
Mortgage Loans in the Trust Fund, and no assurances can be given that the
delinquency or foreclosure experience presented in the table below will be
indicative of such experience on the Mortgage Loans in the Trust Fund. The sum
of the columns below may not equal the total indicated due to rounding.

                   DELINQUENCY AND FORECLOSURE EXPERIENCE(1)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                              AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1997          AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1998            AS OF JUNE 30, 1999
                           ------------------------------   ------------------------------   ------------------------------
                               PRINCIPAL                        PRINCIPAL                        PRINCIPAL
                                BALANCE        PERCENTAGE        BALANCE        PERCENTAGE        BALANCE        PERCENTAGE
                                -------        ----------        -------        ----------        -------        ----------
<S>                        <C>                 <C>          <C>                 <C>          <C>                 <C>
Total Portfolio..........  $1,370,527,326.89        --      $2,248,667,416.28        --      $3,287,852,344.81         --
Delinquency percentage
    30-59 Days...........  $   48,214,087.76      3.52%     $  103,063,606.19      4.58%     $  142,423,532.43       4.33%
    60-89 Days...........      13,795,882.50      1.01          23,791,570.99      1.06          46,489,103.91       1.41
    90+ Days.............       5,486,263.92      0.40           3,913,233.13      0.17          12,127,203.18       0.37
                           -----------------     -----      -----------------     -----      -----------------     ------
        Total(2).........  $   67,496,234.18      4.92%     $  130,768,410.31      5.82%     $  201,039,839.52       6.11%
                           -----------------     -----      -----------------     -----      -----------------     ------
                           -----------------     -----      -----------------     -----      -----------------     ------
Foreclosure Rate(3)......  $   12,191,591.67      0.89%     $   40,596,309.61      1.81%     $   52,848,532.51       1.61%
Bankruptcy Rate(4).......  $   12,022,391.48      0.88%     $   20,237,252.48      0.90%     $   33,064,024.38       1.01%
                           -----------------     -----      -----------------     -----      -----------------     ------
                           -----------------     -----      -----------------     -----      -----------------     ------
</TABLE>
- ------------
(1) The period of delinquency is based on the number of days payments are
    contractually past due.

(2) Certain total percentages and dollar amounts may not equal the sum of the
    percentages and dollar amounts indicated in the columns due to differences
    in rounding.

(3) 'Foreclosure Rate' is the dollar amount of mortgage loans in foreclosure as
    a percentage of the total principal balance of mortgage loans outstanding as
    of the date indicated.

(4) 'Bankruptcy Rate' is the dollar amount of mortgage loans for which the
    related borrower has declared bankruptcy as a percentage of the total
    principal balance of mortgage loans outstanding as of the date indicated.

                                      S-31



<PAGE>

     Historically, a variety of factors, including the appreciation of real
estate values, have limited the loss and delinquency experience on B&C quality
mortgage loans. There can be no assurance that factors beyond Countrywide's
control, such as national or local economic conditions or downturn in the real
estate markets of its lending areas, will not result in increased rates of
delinquencies and foreclosure losses in the future.

SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     The Master Servicer will be paid a monthly fee from interest collected with
respect to each Mortgage Loan (as well as from any liquidation proceeds from a
Liquidated Mortgage Loan that are applied to accrued and unpaid interest) equal
to one-twelfth of the Stated Principal Balance thereof multiplied by the
Servicing Fee Rate (such product, the 'Servicing Fee'). The 'Servicing Fee Rate'
for each Mortgage Loan will equal 0.50% per annum. The amount of the monthly
Servicing Fee is subject to adjustment with respect to prepaid Mortgage Loans,
as described herein under ' -- Adjustment to Servicing Fee in Connection with
Certain Prepaid Mortgage Loans.' The Master Servicer is also entitled to
receive, as additional servicing compensation, amounts in respect of interest
paid on Principal Prepayments (as defined below) received from the 2nd day
through the 15th day of a month ('Prepayment Interest Excess'), all late payment
fees, assumption fees, prepayment penalties and other similar charges and all
reinvestment income earned on amounts on deposit in the Certificate Account and
Distribution Account. The Master Servicer is obligated to pay certain ongoing
expenses associated with the Mortgage Loans and incurred by the Trustee in
connection with its responsibilities under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

ADJUSTMENT TO SERVICING FEE IN CONNECTION WITH CERTAIN PREPAID MORTGAGE LOANS

     When a borrower prepays all or a portion of a Mortgage Loan between
scheduled monthly payment dates ('Due Dates'), the borrower pays interest on the
amount prepaid only to the date of prepayment. Principal Prepayments (as defined
below) received from the 2nd day through the 15th day of a month are included in
the related distribution on the 25th day of the same month, and accordingly no
shortfall in interest otherwise distributable to holders of the Offered
Certificates results. Conversely, Principal Prepayments received from the
16th day of a month to the first day of the following month are not distributed
until the 25th day of such following month, and accordingly an interest
shortfall (a 'Prepayment Interest Shortfall') would result. The period from the
16th day of the month prior to a Distribution Date (or, in the case of the first
Distribution Date, from the Cut-off Date) to and including the 15th day of the
month in which such Distribution Date occurs is herein referred to as the
'Prepayment Period.' In order to mitigate the effect of any such shortfall in
interest distributions to holders of the Offered Certificates on any
Distribution Date, one-half of the amount of the Servicing Fee otherwise payable
to the Master Servicer for such month (the 'Compensating Interest') shall, to
the extent of such shortfall, be deposited by the Master Servicer in the
Certificate Account for distribution to holders of the Offered Certificates
entitled thereto on such Distribution Date. However, any such reduction in the
Servicing Fee will be made only to the extent of one-half of the Servicing Fee
otherwise payable to the Master Servicer with respect to Scheduled Payments on
Mortgage Loans having the Due Date to which such Distribution Date relates. Any
such deposit by the Master Servicer will be reflected in the distributions to
holders of the Offered Certificates entitled thereto made on the Distribution
Date on which the Principal Prepayment received would be distributed.

ADVANCES

     Subject to the following limitations, on the Business Day prior to each
Distribution Date, the Master Servicer will be required to advance its own
funds, or funds in the Certificate Account that are not required to be
distributed on such Distribution Date, in an amount equal to the aggregate of
payments of principal and interest on the Mortgage Loans (adjusted to the
applicable Net Mortgage Rate) that were due on the related Due Date and
delinquent on the related Determination Date, together with an amount equivalent
to interest (adjusted to the applicable Net Mortgage Rate) deemed due on each
Mortgage Loan as to which the related Mortgaged Property has been acquired by
the Master Servicer through foreclosure or deed-in-lieu of foreclosure in
connection with a defaulted Mortgage Loan ('REO Property'), such latter amount
to be calculated after taking into account any rental income from such Mortgaged
Property (any such advance, an 'Advance,' and the date of any such Advance, as
described herein, a 'Master Servicer Advance Date').

     Advances are intended to maintain a regular flow of scheduled interest and
principal payments on the Offered Certificates rather than to guarantee or
insure against losses. The Master Servicer is obligated to make Advances with
respect to delinquent payments of principal of or interest on each Mortgage Loan
(with such

                                      S-32



<PAGE>

payments of interest adjusted to the related Net Mortgage Rate) to the extent
that such Advances are, in its judgment, reasonably recoverable from future
payments and collections or insurance payments or proceeds of liquidation of the
related Mortgage Loan. If the Master Servicer determines on any Determination
Date to make an Advance, such Advance will be included with the distribution to
holders of the Offered Certificates on the related Distribution Date. Any
failure by the Master Servicer to make an Advance as required under the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement will constitute an event of default thereunder, in which
case the Trustee, as successor master servicer, or such other entity as may be
appointed as successor master servicer, will be obligated to make any such
Advance in accordance with the terms of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     The Master Servicer will require the mortgagor or obligor on each Mortgage
Loan to maintain an insurance policy on buildings upon, or comprising part of,
the Mortgaged Property against loss by fire, hazards of extended coverage and
such other hazards as are customary in the area where the Mortgaged Property is
located with an insurer which is licensed to do business in the state where the
Mortgaged Property is located. All amounts collected by the Master Servicer
under any hazard insurance policy (except for amounts to be applied to the
restoration or repair of the Mortgaged Property or released to the mortgagor or
obligor in accordance with the Master Servicer's normal servicing procedures)
will be deposited in the Certificate Account. In the event that the Master
Servicer maintains a blanket policy insuring against hazard losses on all the
Mortgage Loans comprising part of the Trust Fund, it will conclusively be deemed
to have satisfied its obligation relating to the maintenance of hazard
insurance. Such blanket policy may contain a deductible clause, in which case
the Master Servicer will be required to deposit from its own funds into the
Certificate Account the amounts which would have been deposited therein but for
such clause.

     If the Mortgaged Property securing a defaulted Mortgage Loan is damaged and
proceeds, if any, from the related hazard insurance policy are insufficient to
restore the damaged Mortgaged Property, the Master Servicer is not required to
expend its own funds to restore the damaged Mortgaged Property unless it
determines (i) that such restoration will increase the proceeds to
Certificateholders on liquidation of the Mortgage Loan after reimbursement of
the Master Servicer for its expenses and (ii) that such expenses will be
recoverable by it from related Insurance Proceeds or Liquidation Proceeds.

     If recovery on a defaulted Mortgage Loan under any related insurance policy
is not available for the reasons set forth in the preceding paragraph, or if the
defaulted Mortgage Loan is not covered by an insurance policy, the Master
Servicer will be obligated to follow or cause to be followed such normal
practices and procedures as it deems necessary or advisable to realize upon the
defaulted Mortgage Loan. If the proceeds of any liquidation of the Mortgaged
Property securing the defaulted Mortgage Loan are less than the principal
balance of such Mortgage Loan plus interest accrued thereon that is payable to
Certificateholders, the Trust Fund will realize a loss in the amount of such
difference plus the aggregate of expenses incurred by the Master Servicer in
connection with such proceedings and which are reimbursable under the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement. In the unlikely event that any such proceedings result
in a total recovery which is, after reimbursement to the Master Servicer of its
expenses, in excess of the principal balance of such Mortgage Loan plus interest
accrued thereon that is payable to Certificateholders, the Master Servicer will
be entitled to withdraw or retain from the Certificate Account amounts
representing its normal servicing compensation with respect to such Mortgage
Loan and amounts representing the balance of such excess, exclusive of any
amount required by law to be forwarded to the related borrower, as additional
servicing compensation.

     If the Master Servicer or its designee recovers Insurance Proceeds which,
when added to any related Liquidation Proceeds and after deduction of certain
expenses reimbursable to the Master Servicer, exceed the principal balance of
such Mortgage Loan plus interest accrued thereon that is payable to
Certificateholders, the Master Servicer will be entitled to withdraw or retain
from the Certificate Account amounts representing its normal servicing
compensation with respect to such Mortgage Loan. In the event that the Master
Servicer has expended its own funds to restore the damaged Mortgaged Property
and such funds have not been reimbursed under the related hazard insurance
policy, it will be entitled to withdraw from the Certificate Account out of
related Liquidation Proceeds or Insurance Proceeds an amount equal to such
expenses incurred by it, in which event the Trust Fund may realize a loss up to
the amount so charged. Since Insurance Proceeds cannot exceed deficiency claims
and certain expenses incurred by the Master Servicer, no such payment or
recovery will result in a recovery to the Trust Fund which exceeds the principal
balance of the defaulted Mortgage Loan together with accrued interest thereon.

                                      S-33



<PAGE>

     The proceeds from any liquidation of a Mortgage Loan will be applied in the
following order of priority: first, to reimburse the Master Servicer for any
unreimbursed expenses incurred by it to restore the related Mortgaged Property
and any unreimbursed servicing compensation payable to the Master Servicer with
respect to such Mortgage Loan; second, to reimburse the Master Servicer for any
unreimbursed Advances with respect to such Mortgage Loan; third, to accrued and
unpaid interest (to the extent no Advance has been made for such amount) on such
Mortgage Loan; and fourth, as a recovery of principal of such Mortgage Loan.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement will provide that on or before a
specified date in each year, a firm of independent public accountants will
furnish a statement to the Trustee to the effect that, on the basis of the
examination by such firm conducted substantially in compliance with the Uniform
Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers or the Audit Program for
Mortgages serviced for FHLMC, the servicing by or on behalf of the Master
Servicer of mortgage loans or private asset backed securities, or under pooling
and servicing agreements substantially similar to each other (including the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement) was conducted in compliance with such
agreements except for any significant exceptions or errors in records that, in
the opinion of the firm, the Audit Program for Mortgages serviced for FHLMC, or
the Uniform Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers, it is required to
report. In rendering its statement such firm may rely, as to matters relating to
the direct servicing of Mortgage Loans by subservicers, upon comparable
statements for examinations conducted substantially in compliance with the
Uniform Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers or the Audit Program for
Mortgages serviced for FHLMC (rendered within one year of such statement) of
firms of independent public accountants with respect to the related subservicer.

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement will also provide for delivery to the
Trustee, on or before a specified date in each year, of an annual statement
signed by two officers of the Master Servicer to the effect that the Master
Servicer has fulfilled its obligations under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
throughout the preceding year.

     Copies of the annual accountants' statement and the statement of officers
of the Master Servicer may be obtained by Certificateholders without charge upon
written request to the Master Servicer at the address of the Master Servicer set
forth above.

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE MASTER SERVICER AND THE DEPOSITOR

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement will provide that the Master Servicer
may not resign from its obligations and duties under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement except upon a determination that its duties thereunder are no longer
permissible under applicable law. The Master Servicer may, however, be removed
from its obligations and duties as set forth in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. No such resignation will become effective until the Trustee or a
successor servicer has assumed the Master Servicer's obligations and duties
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement will further provide that neither the
Master Servicer, the Depositor nor any director, officer, employee, or agent of
the Master Servicer or the Depositor will be under any liability to the Trust
Fund or Certificateholders for any action taken or for refraining from the
taking of any action in good faith pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement, or for errors in judgment; provided, however, that neither the Master
Servicer, the Depositor nor any such person will be protected against any
liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance, bad
faith or gross negligence in the performance of duties thereunder or by reason
of reckless disregard of obligations and duties thereunder. The Pooling and
Servicing Agreement will further provide that the Master Servicer, the Depositor
and any director, officer, employee or agent of the Master Servicer or the
Depositor will be entitled to indemnification by the Trust Fund and will be held
harmless against any loss, liability or expense incurred in connection with any
legal action relating to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the
Certificates, other than any loss, liability or expense related to any specific
Mortgage Loan or Mortgage Loans (except any such loss, liability or expense
otherwise reimbursable pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) and any
loss, liability or expense incurred by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith
or gross negligence in the performance of duties thereunder or by reason of
reckless disregard of obligations and duties thereunder. In addition, the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement will provide that neither the Master Servicer
nor the Depositor will be under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend
any legal action which is not incidental to its respective responsibilities
under the Pooling and Servicing

                                      S-34



<PAGE>

Agreement and which in its opinion may involve it in any expense or liability.
The Master Servicer or the Depositor may, however, in its discretion undertake
any such action which it may deem necessary or desirable with respect to the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the rights and duties of the parties thereto
and the interests of the Certificateholders thereunder. In such event, the legal
expenses and costs of such action and any liability resulting therefrom will be
expenses, costs and liabilities of the Trust Fund and the Master Servicer or the
Depositor, as the case may be, will be entitled to be reimbursed therefor out of
funds otherwise distributable to Certificateholders.

     Any person into which the Master Servicer may be merged or consolidated, or
any person resulting from any merger or consolidation to which the Master
Servicer is a party, or any person succeeding to the business of the Master
Servicer, will be the successor of the Master Servicer under the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, provided that such person is qualified to sell mortgage
loans to, and service mortgage loans on behalf of, FNMA or FHLMC and further
provided that such merger, consolidation or succession does not adversely affect
the then current ratings of any class of Certificates.

                                      S-35






<PAGE>

                        DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

GENERAL

     The Certificates will be issued pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. Set forth below are summaries of the material terms and provisions
pursuant to which the Offered Certificates will be issued. The following
summaries are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety by reference to,
the provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. When particular
provisions or terms used in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement are referred to,
the actual provisions (including definitions of terms) are incorporated by
reference.

     The Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc., Asset-Backed Certificates
Series 1999-1 (the 'Certificates') will consist of: (a) the following fixed rate
certificates (the 'Fixed Rate Certificates'): Class AF-1, Class AF-2,
Class AF-3, Class AF-4, Class AF-5 and Class AF-6 Certificates (collectively,
the 'Class A Fixed Rate Certificates'), Class MF-1 Certificates (the
'Class MF-1 Certificates'), Class MF-2 Certificates (the 'Class MF-2
Certificates' and together with the Class MF-1 Certificates, the 'Mezzanine
Fixed Rate Certificates'), Class BF Certificates (the 'Class BF Certificates'
and together with the Mezzanine Fixed Rate Certificates, the 'Subordinated
Offered Fixed Rate Certificates') and Class BF-IO Certificates (the
'Class BF-IO Certificates'); (b) the following adjustable rate certificates (the
'Adjustable Rate Certificates'): Class AV-1 Certificates (the 'Class A
Adjustable Rate Certificates' and, together with the Class A Fixed Rate
Certificates, the 'Class A Certificates'), Class MV-1 Certificates (the
'Class MV-1 Certificates' and together with the Class MF-1 Certificates, the
'Class M-1 Certificates'), Class MV-2 Certificates (the 'Class MV-2
Certificates' and together with the Class MV-1 Certificates, the 'Mezzanine
Adjustable Rate Certificates;' and together with the Class MF-2 Certificates,
the 'Class M-2 Certificates') and Class BV Certificates (the 'Class BV
Certificates' and together with the Mezzanine Adjustable Rate Certificates, the
'Subordinated Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates;' and together with the
Class BF Certificates, the 'Class B Certificates') and Class BV-IO Certificates
(the 'Class BV-IO Certificates'; and together with the Class BF-IO Certificates,
the 'Class B-IO Certificates'); and (c) Class R Certificates (the 'Residual
Certificates'). The Mezzanine Fixed Rate Certificates and the Mezzanine
Adjustable Rate Certificates are referred to collectively as the 'Mezzanine
Certificates.' The Subordinated Offered Fixed Rate Certificates and the
Subordinated Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates are referred to collectively
as the 'Subordinated Offered Certificates.' As used herein, a 'Certificate
Group' is either the Fixed Rate Certificates or the Adjustable Rate
Certificates, as the context requires. The Class B-IO Certificates are
interest-only Certificates issued with a notional principal balance as provided
in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. Only the Fixed Rate Certificates other
than the Class BF-IO Certificates (the 'Offered Fixed Rate Certificates') and
the Adjustable Rate Certificates other than the Class BV-IO Certificates (the
'Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates' and collectively with the Offered Fixed
Rate Certificates, the 'Offered Certificates') are offered hereby. Distributions
on the Fixed Rate Certificates will be based primarily on amounts available for
distribution in respect of the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans. Distributions on the
Adjustable Rate Certificates, as a Certificate Group, will be based primarily on
amounts available for distribution in respect of the Adjustable Rate Mortgage
Loans.

     The Offered Certificates will be issued in book-entry form as described
below. The Offered Certificates will be issued in minimum dollar denominations
of $25,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

BOOK-ENTRY CERTIFICATES

     The Offered Certificates will be book-entry Certificates (the 'Book-Entry
Certificates'). Persons acquiring beneficial ownership interests in the Offered
Certificates ('Certificate Owners') may elect to hold their Offered Certificates
through the Depository Trust Company ('DTC') in the United States, or Cedelbank
('CEDEL') or the Euroclear System ('Euroclear'), in Europe, if they are
participants of such systems, or indirectly through organizations which are
participants in such systems. The Book-Entry Certificates will be issued in one
or more certificates which equal the aggregate principal balance of the Offered
Certificates and will initially be registered in the name of Cede & Co., the
nominee of DTC. CEDEL and Euroclear will hold omnibus positions on behalf of
their participants through customers' securities accounts in CEDEL's and
Euroclear's names on the books of their respective depositaries which in turn
will hold such positions in customers' securities accounts in the depositaries'
names on the books of DTC. Citibank will act as depositary for CEDEL and Chase
will act as depositary for Euroclear (in such capacities, individually the
'Relevant Depositary' and collectively the 'European Depositaries'). Investors
may hold such beneficial interests in the Book-Entry Certificates in

                                      S-36



<PAGE>

minimum denominations representing Certificate Principal Balances of $25,000 and
integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. Except as described below, no
person acquiring a Book-Entry Certificate (each, a 'beneficial owner') will be
entitled to receive a physical certificate representing such Offered Certificate
(a 'Definitive Certificate'). Unless and until Definitive Certificates are
issued, it is anticipated that the only Certificateholder of the Offered
Certificates will be Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC. Certificate Owners will not
be Certificateholders as that term is used in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. Certificate Owners are only permitted to exercise their rights
indirectly through the participating organizations that utilize the services of
DTC, including securities brokers and dealers, banks and trust companies and
clearing corporations and certain other organizations ('Participants') and DTC.

     The beneficial owner's ownership of a Book-Entry Certificate will be
recorded on the records of the brokerage firm, bank, thrift institution or other
financial intermediary (each, a 'Financial Intermediary') that maintains the
beneficial owner's account for such purpose. In turn, the Financial
Intermediary's ownership of such Book-Entry Certificate will be recorded on the
records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as agent for the Financial
Intermediary, whose interest will in turn be recorded on the records of DTC, if
the beneficial owner's Financial Intermediary is not a DTC participant and on
the records of CEDEL or Euroclear, as appropriate).

     Certificate Owners will receive all distributions of principal of, and
interest on, the Offered Certificates from the Trustee through DTC and DTC
participants. While the Offered Certificates are outstanding (except under the
circumstances described below), under the rules, regulations and procedures
creating and affecting DTC and its operations (the 'Rules'), DTC is required to
make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose behalf it acts with
respect to the Offered Certificates and is required to receive and transmit
distributions of principal of, and interest on, the Offered Certificates.
Participants and organizations which have indirect access to the DTC system,
such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through or
maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either directly or
indirectly ('Indirect Participants'), with whom Certificate Owners have accounts
with respect to Offered Certificates are similarly required to make book-entry
transfers and receive and transmit such distributions on behalf of their
respective Certificate Owners. Accordingly, although Certificate Owners will not
possess certificates, the Rules provide a mechanism by which Certificate Owners
will receive distributions and will be able to transfer their interest.

     Certificate Owners will not receive or be entitled to receive certificates
representing their respective interests in the Offered Certificates, except
under the limited circumstances described below. Unless and until Definitive
Certificates are issued, Certificate Owners who are not Participants may
transfer ownership of Offered Certificates only through Participants and
Indirect Participants by instructing such Participants and Indirect Participants
to transfer Offered Certificates, by book-entry transfer, through DTC for the
account of the purchasers of such Offered Certificates, which account is
maintained with their respective Participants. Under the Rules and in accordance
with DTC's normal procedures, transfers of ownership of Offered Certificates
will be executed through DTC and the accounts of the respective Participants at
DTC will be debited and credited. Similarly, the Participants and Indirect
Participants will make debits or credits, as the case may be, on their records
on behalf of the selling and purchasing Certificate Owners.

     Because of time zone differences, credits of securities received in CEDEL,
or Euroclear as a result of a transaction with a Participant will be made
during, subsequent securities settlement processing and dated the business day
following, the DTC settlement date. Such credits or any transactions in such
securities, settled during such processing will be reported to the relevant
Euroclear or CEDEL Participants on such business day. Cash received in CEDEL or
Euroclear, as a result of sales of securities by or through a CEDEL Participant
(as defined, below) or Euroclear Participant (as defined below) to a DTC
Participant, will be received with value on the DTC settlement date but will be
available in the relevant CEDEL or Euroclear cash account only as of the
business day following settlement in DTC. For information with respect to tax
documentation procedures, relating to the Offered Certificates, see 'Certain
Federal Income Tax Considerations -- Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors' in the
Prospectus and 'Global Clearance, Settlement And Tax Documentation
Procedures -- Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax Documentation Requirements' in
Annex I hereto.

     Transfers between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC rules.
Transfers between CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.

                                      S-37



<PAGE>

     Cross-market transfers between persons holding directly or indirectly
through DTC, on the one hand, and directly or indirectly through CEDEL
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC in
accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing system by the Relevant Depositary; however, such cross market
transactions will require delivery of instructions to the relevant European
international clearing system by the counterpart in such system in accordance
with its rules and procedures and within its established deadlines (European
time). The relevant European international clearing system will, if the
transaction meets its settlement requirements, deliver instructions to the
Relevant Depositary to take action to effect final settlement on its behalf by
delivering or receiving securities in DTC, and making or receiving payment in
accordance with normal procedures for same day funds settlement applicable to
DTC. CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants may not deliver instructions
directly to the European Depositaries.

     DTC, which is a New York-chartered limited purpose trust company, performs
services for its participants, some of which (and/or their representatives) own
DTC. In accordance with its normal procedures, DTC is expected to record the
positions held by each DTC participant in the Book-Entry Certificates, whether
held for its own account or as a nominee for another person. In general,
beneficial ownership of Book-Entry Certificates will be subject to the rules,
regulations and procedures governing DTC and DTC participants as in effect from
time to time.

     CEDEL is incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg as a professional
depository. CEDEL holds securities for its participating organizations ('CEDEL
Participants') and facilitates the clearance and settlement of securities
transactions between CEDEL Participants through electronic book-entry changes in
accounts of CEDEL Participants, thereby eliminating the need for physical
movement of certificates. Transactions may be settled in CEDEL in any of 28
currencies, including United States dollars. CEDEL provides to its CEDEL
Participants, among other things, services for safekeeping, administration,
clearance and settlement of internationally traded securities and securities
lending and borrowing. CEDEL interfaces with domestic markets in several
countries. As a professional depository, CEDEL is subject to regulation by the
Luxembourg Monetary Institute. CEDEL participants are recognized financial
institutions around the world, including underwriters, securities brokers and
dealers, banks, trust companies, clearing corporations and certain other
organizations. Indirect access to CEDEL is also available to others, such as
banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a
custodial relationship with a CEDEL Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     Euroclear was created in 1968 to hold securities for participants of
Euroclear ('Euroclear Participants') and to clear and settle transactions
between Euroclear Participants through simultaneous electronic book-entry
delivery against payment, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of
certificates and any risk from lack of simultaneous transfers of securities and
cash. Transactions may now be settled in any of 32 currencies, including United
States dollars. Euroclear includes various other services, including securities
lending and borrowing and interfaces with domestic markets in several countries
generally similar to the arrangements for cross-market transfers with DTC
described above. Euroclear is operated by the Brussels, Belgium office of Morgan
Guaranty Trust Company of New York (the 'Euroclear Operator'), under contract
with Euroclear Clearance Systems S.C., a Belgian cooperative corporation (the
'Cooperative'). All operations are conducted by the Euroclear Operator, and all
Euroclear securities clearance accounts and Euroclear cash accounts are accounts
with the Euroclear Operator, not the Cooperative. The Cooperative establishes
policy for Euroclear on behalf of Euroclear Participants. Euroclear Participants
include banks (including central banks), securities brokers and dealers and
other professional financial intermediaries. Indirect access to Euroclear is
also available to other firms that clear through or maintain a custodial
relationship with a Euroclear Participant, either directly or indirectly.

     The Euroclear Operator is the Belgian branch of a New York banking
corporation which is a member bank of the Federal Reserve System. As such, it is
regulated and examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
and the New York State Banking Department, as well as the Belgian Banking
Commission.

     Securities clearance accounts and cash accounts with the Euroclear Operator
are governed by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear and the
related Operating Procedures of the Euroclear System and applicable Belgian law
(collectively, the 'Terms and Conditions'). The Terms and Conditions govern
transfers of securities and cash within Euroclear, withdrawals of securities and
cash from Euroclear, and receipts of payments with respect to securities in
Euroclear. All securities in Euroclear are held on a fungible basis without
attribution of specific certificates to specific securities clearance accounts.
The Euroclear Operator acts under the

                                      S-38



<PAGE>

Terms and Conditions only on behalf of Euroclear Participants, and has no record
of or relationship with persons holding through Euroclear Participants.

     Distributions on the Book-Entry Certificates will be made on each
Distribution Date by the Trustee to DTC. DTC will be responsible for crediting
the amount of such payments to the accounts of the applicable DTC participants
in accordance with DTC's normal procedures. Each DTC participant will be
responsible for disbursing such payments to the beneficial owners of the
Book-Entry Certificates that it represents and to each Financial Intermediary
for which it acts as agent. Each such Financial Intermediary will be responsible
for disbursing funds to the beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates
that it represents.

     Under a book-entry format, beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates
may experience some delay in their receipt of payments, since such payments will
be forwarded by the Trustee to Cede. Distributions with respect to Offered
Certificates held through CEDEL or Euroclear will be credited to the cash
accounts of CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants in accordance with the
relevant system's rules and procedures, to the extent received by the Relevant
Depositary. Such distributions will be subject to tax reporting in accordance
with relevant United States tax laws and regulations. See 'Certain Federal
Income Tax Considerations -- Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors' and
' -- Miscellaneous Tax Aspects -- Backup Withholding' in the Prospectus. Because
DTC can only act on behalf of Financial Intermediaries, the ability of a
beneficial owner to pledge Book-Entry Certificates to persons or entities that
do not participate in the depository system, or otherwise take actions in
respect of such Book-Entry Certificates, may be limited due to the lack of
physical certificates for such Book-Entry Certificates. In addition, issuance of
the Book-Entry Certificates in book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such
Offered Certificates in the secondary market since certain potential investors
may be unwilling to purchase Offered Certificates for which they cannot obtain
physical certificates.

     Monthly and annual reports on the Trust Fund provided by the Master
Servicer to Cede, as nominee of DTC, may be made available to beneficial owners
upon request, in accordance with the rules, regulations and procedures creating
and affecting DTC or the Relevant Depositary, and to the Financial
Intermediaries to whose DTC accounts the Book-Entry Certificates of such
beneficial owners are credited.

     DTC has advised the Depositor and the Trustee that, unless and until
Definitive Certificates are issued, DTC will take any action permitted to be
taken by the holders of the Book-Entry Certificates under the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement only at the direction of one or more Financial
Intermediaries to whose DTC accounts the Book-Entry Certificates are credited,
to the extent that such actions are taken on behalf of Financial Intermediaries
whose holdings include such Book-Entry Certificates. CEDEL or the Euroclear
Operator, as the case may be, will take any other action permitted to be taken
by a holder of an Offered Certificate under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
on behalf of a CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant only in accordance
with its relevant rules and procedures and subject to the ability of the
Relevant Depositary to effect such actions on its behalf through DTC. DTC may
take actions, at the direction of the related Participants, with respect to some
Offered Certificates which conflict with actions taken with respect to other
Offered Certificates.

     Definitive Certificates will be issued to beneficial owners of the
Book-Entry Certificates, or their nominees, rather than to DTC, only if (a) DTC
or the Depositor advises the Trustee in writing that DTC is no longer willing,
qualified or able to discharge properly its responsibilities as nominee and
depositary with respect to the Book-Entry Certificates and the Depositor or the
Trustee is unable to locate a qualified successor, (b) the Depositor at its sole
option, elects to terminate a book-entry system through DTC or (c) after the
occurrence of an Event of Default (as defined herein), beneficial owners having
not less than 51% of the Voting Rights (as defined herein) evidenced by the
Offered Certificates advise the Trustee and DTC through the Financial
Intermediaries and the DTC participants in writing that the continuation of a
book-entry system through DTC (or a successor thereto) is no longer in the best
interests of beneficial owners of such Class.

     Upon the occurrence of any of the events described in the immediately
preceding paragraph, the Trustee will be required to notify all beneficial
owners of the occurrence of such event and the availability through DTC of
Definitive Certificates. Upon surrender by DTC of the global certificate or
certificates representing the Book-Entry Certificates and instructions for
re-registration, the Trustee will issue Definitive Certificates, and thereafter
the Trustee will recognize the holders of such Definitive Certificates as
holders of the Offered Certificates under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

                                      S-39



<PAGE>

     Although DTC, CEDEL and Euroclear have agreed to the foregoing procedures
in order to facilitate transfers of Certificates among participants of DTC,
CEDEL and Euroclear, they are under no obligation to perform or continue to
perform such procedures and such procedures may be discontinued at any time.

     None of the Master Servicer, the Depositor or the Trustee will have any
responsibilty for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made on
account of beneficial ownership interests in Book-Entry Certificates held by
Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC, or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any
records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.

     DTC has advised the Depositor that management of DTC is aware that some
computer applications, systems, and the like for processing data ('Systems')
that are dependent upon calendar dates, including dates before, on, and after
January 1, 2000, may encounter 'Year 2000 problems.' DTC has informed its
participants and other members of the financial community (the 'Industry') that
is has developed and is implementing a program so that its Systems, as the same
relate to the timely payment of distributions (including principal and income
payments) to securityholders, book-entry deliveries, and settlement of trades
within DTC ('Depositary Services'), continue to function appropriately. This
program includes a technical assessment and a remediation plan, each of which is
complete. Additionally, DTC's plan includes a testing phase, which is expected
to be completed within appropriate time frames.

     However, DTC's ability to perform properly its services is also dependent
upon other parties, including but not limited to issuers and their agents, as
well as DTC's direct and indirect participants and third party vendors from whom
DTC licenses software and hardware, and third party vendors on whom DTC relies
for information or the provision of services, including telecommunication and
electrical utility service providers, among others. DTC has informed the
Industry that it is contacting (and will continue to contact) third party
vendors from whom DTC acquires services to: (i) impress upon them the importance
of such services being Year 2000 compliant; and (ii) determine the extent of
their efforts for Year 2000 remediation (and, as appropriate, testing) of their
services. In addition, DTC is in the process of developing such contingency
plans as it deems appropriate.

     According to DTC, the foregoing information with respect to DTC has been
provided to the Industry for informational purposes only and is not intended to
serve as a representation, warranty, or contract modification of any kind.

DEPOSITS TO THE CERTIFICATE ACCOUNT

     The Master Servicer shall establish and initially maintain an account (the
'Certificate Account') for the benefit of the Trustee on behalf of the
Certificateholders. The Certificate Account must be either (i) maintained with a
depository institution the debt obligations of which (or in the case of a
depository institution that is the principal subsidiary of a holding company,
the obligations of which) are rated in one of the two highest rating categories
by the Rating Agencies, (ii) an account or accounts the deposits in which are
fully insured by either the Bank Insurance Fund (the 'BIF') of the FDIC or the
Savings Association Insurance Fund (as successor to the Federal Savings and Loan
Insurance Corporation ('SAIF')), (iii) an account or accounts the deposits in
which are insured by the BIF or SAIF (to the limits established by the FDIC),
and the uninsured deposits in which are otherwise secured such that, as
evidenced by an opinion of counsel, the Certificateholders have a claim with
respect to the funds in the Certificate Account or a perfected first priority
security interest against any collateral securing such funds that is superior to
the claims of any other depositors or general creditors of the depository
institution with which the Certificate Account is maintained, or (iv) an account
or accounts otherwise acceptable to each Rating Agency.

     On a daily basis within one Business Day after receipt, the Master Servicer
shall deposit or cause to be deposited into the Certificate Account the
following payments and collections received or made or to be applied by it on or
subsequent to the Cut-off Date (to the extent not applied in computing the
Cut-off Date Pool Principal Balance):

          (i) all payments on account of principal, including Principal
     Prepayments, on the Mortgage Loans;

          (ii) all payments on account of interest (other than interest accruing
     on the Mortgage Loans prior to the Cut-Off Date) on the Mortgage Loans, net
     of the related Servicing Fee;

                                      S-40



<PAGE>

          (iii) all proceeds of any insurance policies (to the extent such
     proceeds are not applied to the restoration of the property or released to
     the mortgagor in accordance with the Master Servicer's normal servicing
     procedures), other than proceeds that represent reimbursement of the Master
     Servicer's costs and expenses incurred in connection with presenting claims
     under the related insurance policies ('Insurance Proceeds'), all other net
     proceeds received in connection with the partial or complete liquidation of
     Mortgage Loans (whether through trustee's sale, foreclosure sale or
     otherwise) or in connection with any condemnation or partial release of a
     Mortgaged Property, together with the net proceeds received with respect to
     any Mortgaged Properties acquired by the Master Servicer by foreclosure or
     deed in lieu of foreclosure in connection with defaulted Mortgage Loans
     (other than the amount of such net proceeds representing any profit
     realized by the Master Servicer in connection with the disposition of any
     such properties) (together with Insurance Proceeds, 'Liquidation
     Proceeds');

          (iv) all payments made by the Master Servicer in respect of Prepayment
     Interest Shortfalls;

          (v) any amount required to be deposited by the Master Servicer in
     connection with any losses on investment of funds in the Certificate
     Account;

          (vi) any amounts required to be deposited by the Master Servicer with
     respect to any deductible clause in any blanket hazard insurance policy
     maintained by the Master Servicer in lieu of requiring each mortgagor to
     maintain a primary hazard insurance policy;

          (vii) all amounts required to be deposited in connection with
     shortfalls in the principal amount of Replacement Mortgage Loans; and

          (viii) all Advances.

WITHDRAWALS FROM THE CERTIFICATE ACCOUNT

     The Master Servicer may from time to time withdraw funds from the
Certificate Account prior to the related Distribution Account Deposit Date (as
defined below) for the following purposes:

          (i) to pay to the Master Servicer the Servicing Fee to the extent not
     previously paid to or withheld by the Master Servicer (subject to reduction
     as described above under 'Servicing of the Mortgage Loans -- Adjustment to
     Servicing Fee in Connection with Certain Prepaid Mortgage Loans') and, as
     additional servicing compensation, prepayment penalties, assumption fees,
     late payment charges, net earnings on or investment income with respect to
     funds in or credited to the Certificate Account and the amount of
     Prepayment Interest Excess for the related Prepayment Period;

          (ii) to reimburse the Master Servicer for Advances, such right of
     reimbursement with respect to any Mortgage Loan pursuant to this clause
     (ii) being limited to amounts received that represent late recoveries of
     payments of principal and/or interest on the related Mortgage Loan (or
     Insurance Proceeds or Liquidation Proceeds with respect thereto) with
     respect to which such Advance was made;

          (iii) to reimburse the Master Servicer for any Advances previously
     made that the Master Servicer has determined to be nonrecoverable;

          (iv) to reimburse the Master Servicer from Insurance Proceeds for
     expenses incurred by the Master Servicer and covered by the related
     insurance policies;

          (v) to pay the Master Servicer any unpaid Servicing Fees and to
     reimburse it for any unreimbursed ordinary and necessary out-of-pocket
     costs and expenses incurred by the Master Servicer in the performance of
     its master servicing obligations, such right of reimbursement pursuant to
     this clause (v) being limited to amounts received representing late
     recoveries of the payments of such costs and expenses (or Liquidation
     Proceeds, purchase proceeds or repurchase proceeds with respect thereto);

          (vi) to pay to the Seller or the Master Servicer, as applicable, with
     respect to each Mortgage Loan or Mortgaged Property acquired in respect
     thereof that has been purchased by the Seller or the Master Servicer from
     the Trust Fund pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, all amounts
     received thereon and not taken into account in determining the related
     Stated Principal Balance of such repurchased Mortgage Loan;

                                      S-41



<PAGE>

          (vii) to reimburse the Seller, the Master Servicer or the Depositor
     for fees and expenses incurred and reimbursable pursuant to the Pooling and
     Servicing Agreement (including in the case of the Master Servicer, the
     Extra Master Servicing Fee);

          (viii) to withdraw any amount deposited in the Certificate Account and
     not required to be deposited therein; and

          (ix) to clear and terminate the Certificate Account upon termination
     of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

     In addition, not later than 1:00 p.m. Pacific Time on the Business Day
immediately preceding each Distribution Date (the 'Distribution Account Deposit
Date'), the Master Servicer shall withdraw from the Certificate Account and
remit to the Trustee the amount of Interest Funds and Principal Funds for each
Loan Group, to the extent on deposit, and the Trustee shall deposit such amount
in the Distribution Account, as described below.

     The 'Interest Funds' with respect to each Loan Group are equal to the sum,
without duplication, of (i) all scheduled interest collected during the related
Due Period less the related Servicing Fee, (ii) all Advances relating to
interest, (iii) all Compensating Interest and (iv) Liquidation Proceeds (to the
extent such Liquidation Proceeds relate to interest) less all non-recoverable
Advances relating to interest and certain expenses reimbursed during the related
Due Period, in each case with respect to the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group.

     The 'Principal Funds' with respect to each Loan Group are equal to the sum,
without duplication, of (i) the scheduled principal collected during the related
Due Period or advanced on or before the related Master Servicer Advance Date,
(ii) prepayments collected in the related Prepayment Period, (iii) the Stated
Principal Balance of each Mortgage Loan that was repurchased by the Seller or
the Master Servicer, (iv) the amount, if any, by which the aggregate unpaid
principal balance of any Replacement Mortgage Loans is less than the aggregate
unpaid principal balance of any Deleted Mortgage Loans delivered by the Seller
in connection with a substitution of a Mortgage Loan and (v) all Liquidation
Proceeds collected during the related Due Period (to the extent such Liquidation
Proceeds related to principal) less all non-recoverable Advances relating to
principal reimbursed during the related Due Period, in each case with respect to
the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group.

     A 'Due Period' with respect to any Distribution Date is the period
beginning on the second day of the calendar month preceding the calendar month
in which such Distribution Date occurs (or, in the case of the first
Distribution Date, on the Cut-off Date) and ending on the Due Date in the month
in which such Distribution Date occurs.

DEPOSITS TO THE DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNT

     The Trustee shall establish and maintain a distribution account (the
'Distribution Account') on behalf of the Certificateholders. The Trustee shall,
promptly upon receipt, deposit in the Distribution Account and retain therein
(i) the aggregate amount remitted by the Master Servicer to the Trustee; and
(ii) any amount required to be deposited by the Master Servicer in connection
with any losses on investment of funds in the Distribution Account.

WITHDRAWALS FROM THE DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNT

     The Trustee shall withdraw funds from the Distribution Account for
distribution to the Certificateholders as described below under
' -- Distributions' and may from time to time make withdrawals from the
Distribution Account (i) to pay to the Master Servicer, as additional servicing
compensation, earnings on or investment income with respect to funds in or
credited to the Distribution Account; (ii) to withdraw any amount deposited in
the Distribution Account and not required to be deposited therein; and (iii) to
clear and terminate the Distribution Account upon the termination of the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.

DISTRIBUTIONS

     General. Distributions on the Certificates will be made by the Trustee on
the 25th day of each month, or if such day is not a Business Day, on the first
Business Day thereafter, commencing in August 1999 (each, a 'Distribution
Date'), to the persons in whose names such Certificates are registered at the
close of business on the last Business Day of the month preceding the month of
such Distribution Date (the 'Record Date').

                                      S-42



<PAGE>

     Distributions on each Distribution Date will be made by check mailed to the
address of the person entitled thereto as it appears on the Certificate Register
or, in the case of any Certificateholder that holds 100% of a Class of
Certificates or who holds a Class of Certificates with an aggregate initial
Certificate Principal Balance of $1,000,000 or more and that has so notified the
Trustee in writing in accordance with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, by
wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account of such
Certificateholder at a bank or other depository institution having appropriate
wire transfer facilities; provided, however, that the final distribution in
retirement of the Certificates will be made only upon presentation and surrender
of such Certificates at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee. On each
Distribution Date, a holder of a Certificate will receive such holder's
Percentage Interest of the amounts required to be distributed with respect to
the applicable Class of Certificates. The 'Percentage Interest' evidenced by a
Certificate will equal the percentage derived by dividing the denomination of
such Certificate by the aggregate denominations of all Certificates of the
applicable Class.

     Distributions of Interest. On each Distribution Date, the interest
distributable with respect to the Offered Fixed Rate Certificates is the
interest which has accrued thereon at the related Pass-Through Rate during the
calendar month immediately preceding the calendar month in which such
Distribution Date occurs; and the interest distributable with respect to the
Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates is the interest which has accrued thereon
at the then applicable related Pass-Through Rate from and including the
preceding Distribution Date (or from the Closing Date in the case of the first
Distribution Date) to and including the day prior to the current Distribution
Date. Each period referred to in the prior sentence relating to the accrual of
interest is the 'Accrual Period' for the related Class of Offered Certificates.

     All calculations of interest of the Offered Fixed Rate Certificates will be
made on the basis of a 360-day year assumed to consist of twelve 30-day months.
All calculations of interest on the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates will be
made on the basis of a 360-day year and the actual number of days elapsed in the
applicable Accrual Period.

     On each Distribution Date, the Interest Funds for such Distribution Date
with respect to each Loan Group are required to be distributed in the following
order of priority, until such Interest Funds have been fully distributed:

          (i) to each Class of the Class A Certificates of the Certificate Group
     related to such Loan Group, the Current Interest and any Interest Carry
     Forward Amount for such Class; provided, however, that if the Interest
     Funds for the Offered Fixed Rate Certificates are not sufficient to make a
     full distribution of the aggregate Current Interest and the aggregate
     Interest Carry Forward Amount, the Interest Funds for such Certificate
     Group will be distributed pro rata among each Class of the Class A Fixed
     Rate Certificates based upon the ratio of (x) the Current Interest and
     Interest Carry Forward Amount for such Class of the Class A Certificates of
     such Certificate Group to (y) the total amount of Current Interest and any
     Interest Carry Forward Amount for the Class A Certificates of such
     Certificate Group;

          (ii) to the Class M-1 Certificates of such Certificate Group, the
     Current Interest for such Class;

          (iii) to the Class M-2 Certificates of such Certificate Group, the
     Current Interest for such Class;

          (iv) to the Class B Certificates of such Certificate Group, the
     Current Interest for such Class; and

          (v) any remainder to be distributed as described below under
     ' -- Overcollateralization and Crosscollateralization Provisions.'

     'Current Interest,' with respect to each Class of the Offered Certificates
and each Distribution Date, is the interest accrued at the applicable
Pass-Through Rate for the applicable Accrual Period on the Certificate Principal
Balance of such Class plus any amount previously distributed with respect to
interest for such Class that is recovered as a voidable preference by a trustee
in bankruptcy.

     'Interest Carry Forward Amount,' with respect to each Class of the Offered
Certificates and each Distribution Date, is the sum of (i) the excess of
(A) Current Interest for such Class with respect to prior Distribution Dates
(excluding any Fixed Net Rate Carryover and Adjustable Rate Certificate
Carryover, as the case may be) over (B) the amount actually distributed to such
Class with respect to interest on such prior Distribution Dates and
(ii) interest on such excess (to the extent permitted by applicable law) at the
applicable Pass-Through Rate.

                                      S-43



<PAGE>

     The 'Pass-Through Rate' per annum for each Class of Offered Fixed Rate
Certificates is the respective per annum fixed rate as set forth and described
on the cover of this Prospectus Supplement. On any Distribution Date after the
Optional Termination Date for the Fixed Rate Loan Group the Pass-Through Rate
for the Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF Certificates
will increase by 0.50% per annum. On any Distribution Date (including after the
Optional Termination Date for the Fixed Rate Loan Group), the Pass-Through Rate
for the Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF
Certificates will be subject to an interest rate cap equal to the weighted
average Net Mortgage Rates on the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans in effect on the
related Due Date (such weighted average rate, the 'Fixed Net Rate Cap').

     The 'Pass-Through Rate' per annum for each Class of Offered Adjustable Rate
Certificates will be equal to the least of (i) the London interbank offered rate
for one month United States dollar deposits ('One-Month LIBOR') (calculated as
described below under ' -- Calculation of One-Month LIBOR') plus the
Pass-Through Margin (as defined below) for such Class, (ii) the weighted average
of the Maximum Mortgage Rates on the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans (adjusted to
an effective rate reflecting the accrual of interest calculated on the basis of
a 360-day year and the actual number of days elapsed) less the Servicing Fee,
and (iii) the Adjustable Rate Available Funds Cap for the Offered Adjustable
Rate Certificates. The 'Adjustable Rate Available Funds Cap' for the Offered
Adjustable Rate Certificates for any Distribution Date will be a per annum rate
equal to 12 times the quotient of (x) the total scheduled interest on the
Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans based on the Net Mortgage Rates in effect on the
related Due Date divided by (y) the Certificate Principal Balance of the Offered
Adjustable Rate Certificates (adjusted to an effective rate reflecting the
accrual of interest calculated on the basis of a 360-day year and the actual
number of days elapsed).

     The 'Pass-Through Margin' for each Class of Offered Adjustable Rate
Certificates is as follows: for any Distribution Date on or prior to the
Optional Termination Date for the Adjustable Rate Loan Group: Class AV-1, 0.36%;
Class MV-1, 0.65%; Class MV-2, 1.30%; and Class BV, 3.50%; and for any
Distribution Date after the Optional Termination Date for the Adjustable Rate
Loan Group: Class AV-1, 0.72%; Class MV-1, 0.975%; Class MV-2, 1.95%; and
Class BV, 5.25%.

     The 'Adjustable Rate Certificate Carryover' for a Class of Offered
Adjustable Rate Certificates on any Distribution Date on which the Pass-Through
Rate for such Class is based upon the Adjustable Rate Available Funds Cap is the
excess of (i) the amount of interest that such Class would have been entitled to
receive on such Distribution Date had the Pass-Through Rate for that Class not
been calculated based on the Adjustable Rate Available Funds Cap over (ii) the
amount of interest such Class received on such Distribution Date based on the
Adjustable Rate Available Funds Cap, up to but not exceeding the weighted
average of the maximum lifetime Mortgage Rates on the Mortgage Loans in the
Adjustable Rate Loan Group (adjusted to an effective rate reflecting the accrual
of interest calculated on the basis of a 360-day year and the actual number of
days elapsed), less the Servicing Fee, together with the unpaid portion of any
such excess from prior Distribution Dates (and interest accrued thereon at the
then applicable Pass-Through Rate, without giving effect to the Adjustable
Available Funds Cap).

     The 'Fixed Net Rate Carryover' for any Class of Offered Fixed Rate
Certificates on any Distribution Date on which the Pass-Through Rate for such
Class is based upon the Fixed Net Rate Cap is the excess of (i) the amount of
interest that such Class would have been entitled to receive on such
Distribution Date had the Pass-Through Rate for that Class not been calculated
based on the Fixed Net Rate Cap over (ii) the amount of interest such Class
received on such Distribution Date based on the Fixed Net Rate Cap, together
with the unpaid portion of any such excess from prior Distribution Dates (and
interest accrued thereon at the then applicable Pass-Through Rate, without
giving effect to the Fixed Net Rate Cap).

     Distributions of Principal. On each Distribution Date, the Principal
Distribution Amount for such Distribution Date with respect to each Loan Group
is required to be distributed as follows until such Principal Distribution
Amount has been fully distributed:

          (i) to the Class A Certificates of the Certificate Group related to
     such Loan Group, the related Class A Principal Distribution Amount in
     respect of such Certificate Group; provided that the Class A Principal
     Distribution Amount for the Class A Fixed Rate Certificates is required to
     be distributed as set forth below;

          (ii) to the Class M-1 Certificates of each Certificate Group, the
     Class M-1 Principal Distribution Amount for such Certificate Group;

                                      S-44



<PAGE>

          (iii) to the Class M-2 Certificates of each Certificate Group, the
     Class M-2 Principal Distribution Amount for such Certificate Group;

          (iv) to the Class B Certificates of each Certificate Group, the
     Class B Principal Distribution Amount for such Certificate Group; and

          (v) any remainder to be distributed as described under
     ' -- Overcollateralization and Crosscollateralization Provisions' below.

     The Class A Principal Distribution Amount for the Fixed Rate Loan Group is
required to be distributed to the Class A Fixed Rate Certificates in the
following order of priority:

          (i) to the Class AF-6 Certificates, the Class AF-6 Distribution
     Amount, until the Certificate Principal Balance thereof is reduced to zero;
     and

          (ii) sequentially, to the Class AF-1, Class AF-2, Class AF-3,
     Class AF-4, Class AF-5 and Class AF-6 Certificates, in that order, until
     the respective Certificate Principal Balances thereof are reduced to zero.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing order of priority, on any Distribution Date
on which the aggregate Certificate Principal Balances of all Class A Fixed Rate
Certificates are greater than the Stated Principal Balances of all Mortgage
Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group, the Class A Principal Distribution Amount
for the Fixed Rate Loan Group will be distributed pro rata and not sequentially.

     'Principal Distribution Amount,' with respect to each Distribution Date and
a Certificate Group, is the sum of (i) the Principal Funds for such Distribution
Date for such Certificate Group and (ii) any Extra Principal Distribution Amount
for such Distribution Date for the related Certificate Group.

     'Class A Principal Distribution Amount,' for a Loan Group is (i) with
respect to any Distribution Date prior to the related Stepdown Date (as defined
herein) or as to which a Trigger Event (as defined herein) exists, 100% of the
Principal Distribution Amount for the related Loan Group for such Distribution
Date and (ii) with respect to any Distribution Date on or after the Stepdown
Date and as to which a Trigger Event does not exist, the excess of (A) the
Certificate Principal Balance of the Class A Certificates for such Certificate
Group immediately prior to such Distribution Date over (B) the lesser of
(I) 69.50% for the Fixed Rate Loan Group and 60.50% for the Adjustable Rate Loan
Group, of the Stated Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group
on the preceding Due Date and (II) the Stated Principal Balances of the Mortgage
Loans in such Loan Group on the preceding Due Date less the OC Floor for the
related Loan Group.

     'Class AF-6 Distribution Amount,' for any Distribution Date, is the product
of (i) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Certificate Principal Balance
of the Class AF-6 Certificates and the denominator of which is the aggregate
Certificate Principal Balance of the Class A Certificates in the related
Certificate Group, in each case immediately prior to such Distribution Date,
(ii) the Class A Principal Distribution Amount with respect to the related
Certificate Group for such Distribution Date and (iii) the applicable percentage
for such Distribution Date set forth in the following table:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
    DISTRIBUTION DATE                                             PERCENTAGE
    -----------------                                             ----------
    <S>                                                           <C>
    August 1999 - July 2002.....................................       0%
    August 2002 - July 2004.....................................      45%
    August 2004 - July 2005.....................................      80%
    August 2005 - July 2006.....................................     100%
    August 2006 and thereafter..................................     300%
</TABLE>

     'Class M-1 Principal Distribution Amount,' for a Loan Group and with
respect to any Distribution Date on or after the related Stepdown Date is 100%
of the Principal Distribution Amount for the related Loan Group if the
Certificate Principal Balance of each Class of Class A Certificates for such
Certificate Group has been reduced to zero and a Trigger Event exists, or, if
the Class A Certificates for such Certificate Group are still outstanding, and
as long as a Trigger Event is not in effect for such Loan Group, is the excess
of (i) the sum for such Loan Group of (A) the Certificate Principal Balance of
the Class A Certificates (after taking into account distributions of the
Class A Principal Distribution Amount for such Distribution Date) and (B) the
Certificate Principal Balance of the Class M-1 Certificates immediately prior to
such Distribution Date over (ii) the lesser of (A) 80.00% for the Fixed Rate
Loan Group and 74.50% for the Adjustable Rate Loan Group of the Stated Principal
Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group on the preceding Due Date and
(B) the Stated

                                      S-45



<PAGE>

Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group on the preceding Due
Date less the OC Floor for the related Loan Group.

     'Class M-2 Principal Distribution Amount,' for a Loan Group and with
respect to any Distribution Date on or after the related Stepdown Date, is 100%
of the Principal Distribution Amount for the related Loan Group if the
Certificate Principal Balance of each of the Class A and Class M-1 Certificates
for such Certificate Group has been reduced to zero and a Trigger Event exists,
or, if the Class A and Class M-1 Certificates for such Certificate Group are
still outstanding and as long as a Trigger Event is not in effect for such Loan
Group, is the excess of (i) of the sum for such Loan Group of (A) the
Certificate Principal Balance of the Class A Certificates (after taking into
account distributions of the Class A Principal Distribution Amount for such
Distribution Date), (B) the Certificate Principal Balance of the Class M-1
Certificates (after taking into account distribution of the Class M-1 Principal
Distribution Amount for such Distribution Date) and (C) the Certificate
Principal Balance of the Class M-2 Certificates immediately prior to such
Distribution Date over (ii) the lesser of (A) 88.00% for the Fixed Rate Loan
Group and 83.50% for the Adjustable Rate Loan Group, of the aggregate Stated
Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group on the preceding Due
Date and (B) the Stated Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such Loan
Group on the preceding Due Date less the OC Floor for the related Loan Group.

     'Class B Principal Distribution Amount,' for a Loan Group and with respect
to any Distribution Date on or after the related Stepdown Date and as long as a
Trigger Event is not in effect for such Loan Group, is the excess of (i) of the
sum for such Loan Group of (A) the Certificate Principal Balance of the Class A
Certificates (after taking into account distributions of the Class A Principal
Distribution Amount for such Distribution Date), (B) the Certificate Principal
Balance of the Class M-1 Certificates (after taking into account distribution of
the Class M-1 Principal Distribution Amount for such Distribution Date),
(C) the Certificate Principal Balance of the Class M-2 Certificates (after
taking into account distributions of the Class M-2 Principal Distribution Amount
for such Distribution Date) and (D) the Certificate Principal Balance of the
Class B Certificates immediately prior to such Distribution Date over (ii) the
lesser of (A) 95.50% for the Fixed Rate Loan Group and 94.50% for the Adjustable
Rate Loan Group, of the Stated Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such
Loan Group on the preceding Due Date and (B) the Stated Principal Balances of
the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group on the preceding Due Date less the OC
Floor for the related Loan Group, provided, however, that after the Certificate
Principal Balances of the Class A, Class M-1 and Class M-2 Certificates for such
Certificate Group are reduced to zero, the Class B Principal Distribution Amount
for such Distribution Date will equal 100% of the Principal Distribution Amount
for the related Loan Group.

     'Extra Principal Distribution Amount,' for a Loan Group and with respect to
any Distribution Date, is the lesser of (i) the excess, if any, of the Specified
Overcollateralization Amount for such Loan Group and Distribution Date over the
Overcollateralization Amount (after giving effect to distributions of principal
on the related Certificate Group other than any Extra Principal Distribution
Amount) for such Loan Group and Distribution Date and (ii) the Excess Cashflow
for such Loan Group and Distribution Date and any Remainder Excess Cashflow from
the other Loan Group for such Distribution Date available therefor in the
priority set forth herein.

     'Excess Cashflow,' for a Loan Group and with respect to any Distribution
Date, is the excess, if any, of the Interest Funds and Principal Funds for such
Loan Group and Distribution Date over required distributions of interest and
principal (excluding any Extra Principal Distribution Amount) on the Offered
Certificates in the related Certificate Group on such Distribution Date.

     'OC Floor' for either Loan Group equals 0.50% of the Stated Principal
Balances of the Mortgage Loans included in the related Loan Group as of the
Cut-off Date.

     'Remainder Excess Cashflow,' for a Loan Group and with respect to any
Distribution Date, is the excess, if any, of the Excess Cashflow for such Loan
Group and Distribution Date over the portion thereof, if any, applied to the
Offered Certificates in the related Certificate Group pursuant to clauses (i)
through (vii) under the third paragraph under ' -- Overcollateralization and
Crosscollateralization Provisions' below.

     'Specified Overcollateralization Amount' means, with respect to each Loan
Group prior to the Stepdown Date for the related Certificate Group, an amount
equal to 2.25% for the Fixed Rate Loan Group and 2.75% for the Adjustable Rate
Loan Group of the Cut-off Date Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in the
related Loan Group, and with respect to each Loan Group on and after the
Stepdown Date for the related Certificate

                                      S-46



<PAGE>

Group, an amount equal to 4.50% for the Fixed Rate Loan Group and 5.50% for the
Adjustable Rate Loan Group of the Stated Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans
in such Loan Group as of the preceding Due Date, subject to a minimum amount
equal to the applicable OC Floor; provided, however, that, if on any
Distribution Date, a Trigger Event for a Certificate Group has occurred, the
Specified Overcollateralization Amount shall not be reduced to the applicable
percentage of the then current Stated Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans in
the related Loan Group until the Distribution Date on which a Trigger Event for
such Certificate Group no longer exists.

     'Overcollateralization Amount,' with respect to any Distribution Date and
Loan Group, is the excess, if any, of (a) the aggregate Stated Principal
Balances of the Mortgage Loans in such Loan Group immediately following such
Distribution Date over (b) the Class Certificate Balance of the Offered
Certificates in the related Certificate Group as of such date (after taking into
account the payment of principal on such Certificates on such Distribution
Date).

     'Stepdown Date,' with respect to each Certificate Group, is the later to
occur of (i) the Distribution Date in August 25, 2002 or (ii) the first
Distribution Date on which the Class A Certificate Principal Balance of such
Certificate Group is less than or equal to 69.50% for the Fixed Rate Loan Group
and 60.50% for the Adjustable Rate Loan Group, of the Stated Principal Balances
of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group.

     A 'Trigger Event,' with respect to each Certificate Group and a
Distribution Date after the Stepdown Date, exists if the product of (i) two
times for the Fixed Rate Loan Group and 2.5 times for the Adjustable Rate Loan
Group and (ii) the quotient (expressed as a percentage) of (A) the aggregate
Stated Principal Balance of all Mortgage Loans 60 or more days delinquent for
each Loan Group (including Mortgage Loans in foreclosure and REO Properties) and
(B) the Stated Principal Balance of that Loan Group as of the preceding Master
Servicer Advance Date equals or exceeds the Required Percentage. A 'Required
Percentage,' with respect to each Certificate Group and a Distribution Date
after the Stepdown Date is equal to the quotient (expressed as a percentage) of
(x) the excess of (I) the Stated Principal Balances of such Loan Group over
(II) the Certificate Principal Balance of the most senior Class of Certificates
of such Certificate Group outstanding as of the preceding Master Servicer
Advance Date and (y) the Stated Principal Balance of such Loan Group.

OVERCOLLATERALIZATION AND CROSSCOLLATERALIZATION PROVISIONS

     As set forth below, the Excess Cashflow for a Loan Group will be required
to be applied as an Extra Principal Distribution Amount with respect to the
related Certificate Group whenever the Overcollateralization Amount for such
Loan Group is less than the related Specified Overcollateralization Amount. In
addition, any Remainder Excess Cashflow with respect to a Loan Group will be
required to be applied as an Extra Principal Distribution Amount with respect to
the Certificate Group related to the other Loan Group whenever the
Overcollateralization Amount for such other Loan Group is less than the related
Specified Overcollateralization Amount. If on any Distribution Date, after
giving effect to any Extra Principal Distribution Amount, the aggregate
Certificate Principal Balances of the Offered Certificates with respect to a
Certificate Group exceed the Stated Principal Balances of the Mortgage Loans in
the related Loan Group, the Certificate Principal Balances of the Subordinated
Offered Certificates (but not the Class A Certificates) of such Certificate
Group will be reduced, in inverse order of seniority (beginning with the
Class B Certificates) by an amount equal to such excess. Any such reduction is
an 'Applied Realized Loss Amount.'

     If the Certificate Principal Balance of a Class of Subordinated Offered
Certificates is reduced, that Class thereafter will be entitled to distributions
of interest and principal only with respect to the Certificate Principal Balance
as so reduced. On subsequent Distribution Dates, however, as described below,
Excess Cashflow from the related Loan Group and Remainder Excess Cashflow from
the other Loan Group will be applied to reduce Unpaid Realized Loss Amounts
previously allocated to such Certificates in order of seniority.

     On each Distribution Date, the Excess Cashflow with respect to a Loan Group
will be required to be distributed as follows:

          (i) the Extra Principal Distribution Amount for such Loan Group;

          (ii) to the Class M-1 Certificates of such Certificate Group, any
     Interest Carry Forward Amount for such Class;

          (iii) to the Class M-1 Certificates of such Certificate Group, any
     Unpaid Realized Loss Amount for such Class;

                                      S-47



<PAGE>

          (iv) to the Class M-2 Certificates of such Certificate Group, any
     Interest Carry Forward Amount for such Class;

          (v) to the Class M-2 Certificates of such Certificate Group, any
     Unpaid Realized Loss Amount for such Class;

          (vi) to the Class B Certificates of such Certificate Group, any
     Interest Carry Forward Amount for such Class; and

          (vii) to the Class B Certificates of such Certificate Group, the
     Unpaid Realized Loss Amount for such Class.

     On each Distribution Date, the Remainder Excess Cashflow with respect to a
Loan Group will be required to be distributed as follows:

          (i) for distribution to the Certificates in the other Certificate
     Group to the extent that any of the amounts listed in clauses (i) through
     (vii) in the immediately preceding paragraph with respect to the other
     Certificate Group have not otherwise been funded in full for such
     Distribution Date in accordance with the priorities set forth above;

          (ii) in the case of the Fixed Rate Loan Group to the Offered Fixed
     Rate Certificates, on a pro rata basis, the Fixed Net Rate Carryover (to be
     treated as paid from and to the extent of funds on deposit in the Fixed
     Rate Carryover Reserve Fund, after giving effect to distributions pursuant
     to clause (iv) below);

          (iii) in the case of the Adjustable Rate Loan Group, to the Offered
     Adjustable Rate Certificates, on a pro rata basis, the Adjustable Rate
     Certificate Carryover (to be treated as paid from and to the extent of
     funds on deposit in the Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund, after
     giving effect to distributions pursuant to clause (iv) below);

          (iv) to the Class B-IO Certificates of such Certificate Group, first,
     (A) in the case of the Adjustable Rate Certificates, for deposit in the
     Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund (for distribution (if any) pursuant
     to clause (iii) above) in an amount equal to the Adjustable Rate Carryover
     Reserve Fund Deposit, and (B) in the case of the Fixed Rate Certificates,
     for deposit in the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund (for distribution (if
     any) pursuant to clause (ii) above) in an amount equal to the Fixed Rate
     Carryover Reserve Fund Deposit, and second for distribution to the Class
     B-IO Certificates of each Certificate Group, in each case as provided in
     the Pooling and Servicing Agreement;

          (v) to pay the Master Servicer an extra master servicing fee as
     provided in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the 'Extra Master
     Servicing Fee'); and

          (vi) to the Residual Certificates, any remaining amount.

     'Applied Realized Loss Amount,' with respect to any Class of the
Subordinated Offered Certificates and as to any Distribution Date, means the sum
of the Realized Losses with respect to Mortgage Loans which have been applied in
reduction of the Certificate Principal Balance of such Class.

     'Realized Loss' is the excess of the Stated Principal Balance of a
defaulted Mortgage Loan over the net liquidation proceeds with respect thereto
that are allocated to principal.

     'Unpaid Realized Loss Amount,' with respect to any Class of the
Subordinated Offered Certificates and as to any Distribution Date, is the excess
of (i) Applied Realized Loss Amounts with respect to such Class over (ii) the
sum of all distributions in reduction of the Applied Realized Loss Amounts on
all previous Distribution Dates. Any amounts distributed to a Class of
Subordinated Offered Certificates in respect of any Unpaid Realized Loss Amount
will not be applied to reduce the Certificate Principal Balance of such Class.

     In the event that a Specified Overcollateralization Amount is permitted to
decrease or 'step down' on a Distribution Date in the future, or in the event
that an Excess Overcollateralization Amount (as defined below) for a Certificate
Group otherwise exists, the Remainder Excess Cash Flow for the related Loan
Group will be distributed (to the extent not otherwise required to be applied to
the other Certificate Group) to the holders of the related Class B-IO
Certificates, to the Master Servicer as an Extra Master Servicing Fee and to the
holders of the Residual Certificates (in each case as provided in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement) on such Distribution Date until the applicable Excess
Overcollateralization Amount is reduced to zero. This has the effect of
decelerating the amortization of the Certificates in the related Certificate
Group relative to the amortization of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan
Group, and of reducing the related Overcollateralization Amount to the
applicable Specified Overcollateralization Amount. With respect to a Certificate
Group and any Distribution Date, the excess, if any, of (a) the
Overcollateralization Amount on such Distribution Date over (b) the Specified
Overcollateralization Amount is the 'Excess Overcollateralization Amount' with
respect to

                                      S-48



<PAGE>

such Distribution Date. If, on any Distribution Date, the Excess
Overcollateralization Amount is, or, after taking into account all other
distributions to be made on such Distribution Date, would be, greater than zero
(i.e., the related Overcollateralization Amount is or would be greater than the
related Specified Overcollateralization Amount), then any amounts relating to
principal which would otherwise be distributed to the holders of the
Certificates in the related Certificate Group on such Distribution Date will (to
the extent not otherwise required to be applied to the other Certificate Group)
instead be distributed to the holders of the related Class B-IO Certificates, to
the Master Servicer as an Extra Master Servicing Fee and to the holders of the
Residual Certificates (in each case as provided in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement).

CALCULATION OF ONE-MONTH LIBOR

     On the second LIBOR Business Day (as defined below) preceding the
commencement of each Accrual Period for the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates
(each such date, an 'Interest Determination Date'), the Trustee will determine
the London interbank offered rate for one-month United States dollar deposits
('One-Month LIBOR') for such Accrual Period on the basis of such rate as it
appears on Telerate Screen Page 3750, as of 11:00 a.m. (London time) on such
Interest Determination Date. If such rate does not appear on such page (or such
other page as may replace that page on that service, or if such service is no
longer offered, such other service for displaying LIBOR or comparable rates as
may be reasonably selected by the Trustee), One-Month LIBOR for the applicable
Accrual Period will be the Reference Bank Rate as defined herein. If no such
quotations can be obtained and no Reference Bank Rate is available, One-Month
LIBOR will be the One-Month LIBOR applicable to the preceding Accrual Period.
The 'Reference Bank Rate' with respect to any Accrual Period, means the
arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest whole multiple of
0.03125%) of the offered rates for United States dollar deposits for one month
that are quoted by the Reference Banks as of 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on
the related Interest Determination Date to prime banks in the London interbank
market for a period of one month in amounts approximately equal to the aggregate
Certificate Principal Balance of all Adjustable Rate Certificates for such
Accrual Period, provided that at least two such Reference Banks provide such
rate. If fewer than two offered rates appear, the Reference Bank Rate will be
the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest whole
multiple of 0.03125%) of the rates quoted by one or more major banks in New York
City, selected by the Trustee, as of 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on such
date for loans in U.S. dollars to leading European banks for a period of one
month in amounts approximately equal to the Certificate Principal Balance of all
Adjustable Rate Certificates for such Accrual Period. As used in this section,
'LIBOR Business Day' means a day on which banks are open for dealing in foreign
currency and exchange in London and New York City; and 'Reference Banks' means
leading banks selected by the Trustee and engaged in transactions in Eurodollar
deposits in the international Eurocurrency market (i) with an established place
of business in London, (ii) which have been designated as such by the Trustee
and (iii) which are not controlling, controlled by, or under common control
with, the Depositor, Countrywide or any successor Master Servicer.

     The establishment of One-Month LIBOR on each Interest Determination Date by
the Trustee and the Trustee's calculation of the rate of interest applicable to
the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates for the related Accrual Period for the
Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates shall (in the absence of manifest error) be
final and binding.

FIXED RATE CARRYOVER RESERVE FUND

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement establishes an account (the 'Fixed Rate
Carryover Reserve Fund'), which is held in trust by the Trustee on behalf of the
Offered Fixed Rate Certificateholders. The Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund
will not be an asset of any REMIC. Holders of the Offered Fixed Rate
Certificates will be entitled to receive payments from the Fixed Rate Carryover
Reserve Fund in an amount equal to any Fixed Net Rate Carryover for such Offered
Fixed Rate Certificates as described herein under ' -- Overcollateralization and
Crosscollateralization Provisions.' The amount required to be deposited in the
Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund on any Distribution Date (the 'Fixed Rate
Carryover Reserve Fund Deposit') will equal the greater of (x) any Fixed Net
Rate Carryover for such Distribution Date and (y) an amount such that when added
to other amounts already on deposit in the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund,
the aggregate amount on deposit therein is equal to $5,000 (such amount on
deposit therein being subject to increase or decrease under certain
circumstances, as provided in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement). Any
investment earnings on amounts on deposit in the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve
Fund will be paid to (and for the benefit of) the holders of the Class BF-IO
Certificates and will not be available to pay any Fixed Net Rate Carryover.

                                      S-49



<PAGE>

ADJUSTABLE RATE CARRYOVER RESERVE FUND

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement also establishes an account (the
'Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund'), which is held in trust by the Trustee
on behalf of the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificateholders. The Adjustable Rate
Carryover Reserve Fund will not be an asset of any REMIC. Holders of the Offered
Adjustable Rate Certificates will be entitled to receive payments from the
Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund in an amount equal to any Adjustable Rate
Certificate Carryover for such Certificates as described herein under
' -- Overcollateralization and Crosscollateralization Provisions.' The amount
required to be deposited in the Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund on any
Distribution Date (the 'Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund Deposit') will
equal the greater of (x) any Adjustable Rate Certificate Carryover for such
Distribution Date and (y) an amount such that when added to other amounts
already on deposit in the Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund, the aggregate
amount on deposit therein is equal to $5,000 (such amount on deposit therein
being subject to increase or decrease under certain circumstances, as provided
in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement). Any investment earnings on amounts on
deposit in the Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund will be paid to (and for
the benefit of) the holders of the Class BV-IO Certificates and will not be
available to pay any Adjustable Rate Certificate Carryover.

REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS

     On each Distribution Date, the Trustee will forward to each
Certificateholder, the Master Servicer and the Depositor a statement generally
setting forth, among other information:

          (i) the amount of the related distribution to holders of the Offered
     Certificates allocable to principal, separately identifying (A) the
     aggregate amount of any Principal Prepayments included therein, (B) the
     aggregate of all scheduled payments of principal included therein and
     (C) Extra Principal Distribution Amount;

          (ii) the amount of such distribution to holders of the Offered
     Certificates allocable to interest;

          (iii) the Interest Carry Forward Amounts for each Class of Offered
     Certificates (if any);

          (iv) the Certificate Principal Balance of the Offered Certificates
     after giving effect to the distribution of principal on such Distribution
     Date;

          (v) the Pool Stated Principal Balance for the following Distribution
     Date;

          (vi) the amount of the Servicing Fee paid to or retained by the Master
     Servicer for the related Due Period;

          (vii) the Pass-Through Rate for each Class of Offered Adjustable Rate
     Certificates for such Distribution Date;

          (viii) the amount of Advances included in the distribution on such
     Distribution Date;

          (ix) the number and aggregate principal amounts of the Mortgage Loans
     in each Loan Group (A) delinquent (exclusive of related Mortgage Loans in
     foreclosure) (1) 30-59 days, (2) 60-89 days and (3) 90 or more days, and
     (B) in foreclosure and delinquent (1) 30-59 days, (2) 60-89 days and
     (3) 90 or more days, in each case as of the close of business on the last
     day of the calendar month preceding such Distribution Date;

          (x) with respect to any Mortgage Loan in each Loan Group that became
     an REO Property during the preceding calendar month, the loan number and
     Stated Principal Balance of such Mortgage Loan as of the close of business
     on the Determination Date preceding such Distribution Date and the date of
     acquisition thereof;

          (xi) with respect to each Loan Group, whether a Trigger Event exists;

          (xii) the total number and principal balance of any REO Properties in
     each Loan Group as of the close of business on the Determination Date
     preceding such Distribution Date;

          (xiii) any Adjustable Rate Certificate Carryover paid and all
     remaining Adjustable Rate Certificate Carryover remaining on each Class of
     the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates on such Distribution Date; and

          (xiv) any Fixed Net Rate Carryover paid and all remaining Fixed Net
     Rate Carryover remaining on each Class of the Offered Fixed Rate
     Certificates on such Distribution Date.

     In addition, within a reasonable period of time after the end of each
calendar year, the Trustee will prepare and deliver to each Certificateholder of
record during the previous calendar year a statement containing

                                      S-50



<PAGE>

information necessary to enable Certificateholders to prepare their tax returns.
Such statements will not have been examined and reported upon by an independent
public accountant.

AMENDMENT

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement may be amended by the Depositor, the
Master Servicer, the Seller and the Trustee, without the consent of
Certificateholders, (i) to cure any ambiguity, (ii) to correct or supplement any
provision therein which may be defective or inconsistent with any other
provision therein, or (iii) to make any other revisions with respect to matters
or questions arising under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement which are not
inconsistent with the provisions thereof, provided that such action will not
adversely affect in any material respect the interests of any Certificateholder.
An amendment will be deemed not to adversely affect in any material respect the
interests of the Certificateholders if the person requesting such amendment
obtains a letter from each Rating Agency stating that such amendment will not
result in the downgrading or withdrawal of the respective ratings then assigned
to any class of Certificates. The Pooling and Servicing Agreement may also be
amended without the consent of any of the Certificateholders, to change the
manner in which the Certificate Account is maintained, provided that any such
change does not adversely affect the then current rating on any class of
Certificates. In addition, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement may be amended
without the consent of Certificateholders to modify, eliminate or add to any of
its provisions to such extent as may be necessary to maintain the Trust Fund's
REMIC elections, provided that the Trustee has received an opinion of counsel to
the effect that such action is necessary or helpful to maintain such
qualifications.

     In addition, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement may be amended by the
Depositor, the Master Servicer, the Seller and the Trustee and the holders of a
Majority in Interest of each Class of Certificates affected thereby for the
purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any
of the provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or of modifying in any
manner the rights of the Certificateholders; provided, however, that no such
amendment may (i) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay the timing of,
payments required to be distributed on any Certificate without the consent of
the holder of such Certificate; (ii) adversely affect in any material respect
the interests of the holders of any Class of Certificates in a manner other than
as described in clause (i) above, without the consent of the holders of
Certificates of such Class evidencing, as to such Class, Percentage Interests
aggregating 66%; or (iii) reduce the aforesaid percentage of aggregate
outstanding principal amounts of Certificates of each Class, the holders of
which are required to consent to any such amendment, without the consent of the
holders of all Certificates of such Class.

     The Trustee will not be entitled to consent to any amendment to the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement without having first received an opinion of counsel to
the effect that such amendment will not cause the Trust Fund's REMIC elections
to fail to qualify.

OPTIONAL TERMINATION

     The Master Servicer will have the right to repurchase all remaining
Mortgage Loans and REO Properties in each Loan Group and thereby effect early
retirement of all the Certificates of the related Certificate Group, subject to
the Stated Principal Balance of the Mortgage Loans and REO Properties in such
Loan Group at the time of repurchase being less than or equal to 10% of Cut-off
Date Principal Balance of such Loan Group (each, an 'Optional Termination
Date'). In the event such option is exercised by the Master Servicer, the
repurchase will be made at a price equal to the sum of (i) 100% of the Stated
Principal Balance of each Mortgage Loan in such Loan Group (other than in
respect of REO Property) plus accrued interest thereon at the applicable
Mortgage Rate, net of the Servicing Fee, (ii) the appraised value of any REO
Property (up to the Stated Principal Balance of the related Mortgage Loan) in
such Loan Group, and (iii) any unreimbursed out-of-pocket costs and expenses and
the principal portion of Advances for such Loan Group, in each case previously
incurred by the Master Servicer in the performance of its servicing obligations.
Proceeds from such repurchase will be distributed to the Certificateholders in
the related Certificate Group in the priority described above. The proceeds from
any such distribution may not be sufficient to distribute the full amount to
which each Class of Certificates on a Certificate Group is entitled if, with
respect to the related Loan Group, the purchase price is based in part on the
appraised value of any REO Property and such appraised value is less than the
Stated Principal Balance of the related Mortgage Loan. Any repurchase of the
Mortgage Loans and REO Properties of a Loan Group will result in an early
retirement of the Certificates in the related Certificate Group.

OPTIONAL PURCHASE OF DEFAULTED LOANS

     As to any Mortgage Loan which is delinquent in payment by 91 days or more,
the Master Servicer may, at its option, purchase such Mortgage Loan at a price
equal to 100% of the Stated Principal Balance thereof plus

                                      S-51



<PAGE>

accrued interest thereon at the applicable Mortgage Rate, from the date through
which interest was last paid by the related mortgagor or advanced to the first
day of the month in which such amount is to be distributed.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     Events of Default will consist of: (i) any failure by the Master Servicer
to deposit in the Certificate Account or the Distribution Account the required
amounts or remit to the Trustee any payment (including an Advance required to be
made under the terms of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) which continues
unremedied for five Business Days after written notice of such failure shall
have been given to the Master Servicer by the Trustee or the Depositor, or to
the Master Servicer and the Trustee by the holders of Certificates evidencing
not less than 25% of the Voting Rights evidenced by the Certificates; (ii) any
failure by the Master Servicer to make an Advance as required under the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement, unless cured as specified therein; (iii) any failure by
the Master Servicer to observe or perform in any material respect any other of
its covenants or agreements, or any breach of a representation or warranty made
by the Master Servicer, in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, which continues
unremedied for 60 days after the giving of written notice of such failure to the
Master Servicer by the Trustee or the Depositor, or to the Master Servicer and
the Trustee by the holders of Certificates evidencing not less than 25% of the
Voting Rights evidenced by the Certificates; or (iv) insolvency, readjustment of
debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings, and certain
actions by or on behalf of the Master Servicer indicating its insolvency or
inability to pay its obligations. As of any date of determination, (i) holders
of the Offered Certificates will be allocated 95% of all Voting Rights,
allocated among the Offered Certificates in proportion to their respective
outstanding Certificate Principal Balances and (ii) holders of the Class B-IO
Certificates and the Residual Certificates will be allocated all of the
remaining Voting Rights. Voting Rights will be allocated among the Certificates
of each such Class in accordance with their respective Percentage Interests.

RIGHTS UPON EVENT OF DEFAULT

     So long as an Event of Default under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
remains unremedied, the Trustee shall, but only upon the receipt of instructions
from the holders of Certificates having not less than 25% of the Voting Rights
evidenced by the Certificates, terminate all of the rights and obligations of
the Master Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and in and to the
Mortgage Loans, whereupon the Trustee will succeed to all of the
responsibilities and duties of the Master Servicer under the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, including the obligation to make Advances. In the event
that the Trustee is unwilling or unable to act, it may appoint, or petition a
court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of, a mortgage loan
servicing institution with a net worth of at least $10,000,000 to act as
successor to the Master Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. No
assurance can be given that termination of the rights and obligations of the
Master Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement would not adversely
affect the servicing of the Mortgage Loans, including the delinquency experience
of the Mortgage Loans.

     No Certificateholder, solely by virtue of such holder's status as a
Certificateholder, will have any right under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
to institute any proceeding with respect thereto, unless such holder previously
has given to the Trustee written notice of the continuation of an Event of
Default and unless the holders of Certificates having not less than 25% of the
Voting Rights evidenced by the Certificates have made written request to the
Trustee to institute such proceeding in its own name as Trustee thereunder and
have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity and the Trustee for 60 days has
neglected or refused to institute any such proceeding.

THE TRUSTEE

     The Bank of New York will be the Trustee under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. The Depositor and Countrywide may maintain other banking
relationships in the ordinary course of business with the Trustee. Offered
Certificates may be surrendered at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee
located at 101 Barclay Street, 12 E., New York, New York 10286, Attention:
Corporate Trust Window or at such other addresses as the Trustee may designate
from time to time.

                                      S-52







<PAGE>

                 YIELD, PREPAYMENT AND MATURITY CONSIDERATIONS

GENERAL

     The weighted average life of, and the yield to maturity on each Class of
the Offered Certificates generally will be directly related to the rate of
payment of principal (including prepayments) of the Mortgage Loans in the
related Loan Group. The actual rate of principal prepayments on pools of
mortgage loans is influenced by a variety of economic, tax, geographic,
demographic, social, legal and other factors and has fluctuated considerably in
recent years. In addition, the rate of principal prepayments may differ among
pools of mortgage loans at any time because of specific factors relating to the
mortgage loans in the particular pool, including, among other things, the age of
the mortgage loans, the geographic locations of the properties securing the
loans, the extent of the mortgagor's equity in such properties, and changes in
the mortgagors' housing needs, job transfers and employment status. Furthermore,
with respect to up to 50% of the Mortgage Loans (the 'Delay Delivery Mortgage
Loans'), the Depositor may deliver all or a portion of each related Mortgage
File to the Trustee not later than thirty days after the Closing Date. Should
the Seller fail to deliver all or a portion of any such Mortgage Files to the
Depositor or other designee of the Depostor or, at the Depostor's direction, to
the Trustee within such period, the Seller will be required to use its best
efforts to deliver a Substitute Mortgage Loan for the related Delay Delivery
Mortgage Loan or repurchase the related Delay Delivery Mortgage Loan. Any
repurchases pursuant to this provision would also have the effect of
accelerating the rate of prepayments on the Mortgage Loans. In addition,
approximately 4.97%, 8.98% and 68.39% of the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate
Loan Group and approximately 24.09%, 8.70% and 24.09% of the Mortgage Loans in
the Adjustable Rate Loan Group (by Cut-off Date Principal Balance) provide for
the payment by the borrower of a prepayment charge on full prepayments typically
made within two, three and five years, respectively, from the date of the
execution of the related Mortgage Note. These penalties, if enforced by the
Master Servicer, may affect the rate of prepayments on the Mortgage Loans.

     The timing of changes in the rate of prepayments may significantly affect
the actual yield to investors who purchase the Offered Certificates at prices
other than par, even if the average rate of principal prepayments is consistent
with the expectations of investors. In general, the earlier the payment of
principal of the Mortgage Loans the greater the effect on an investor's yield to
maturity. As a result, the effect on an investor's yield of principal
prepayments occurring at a rate higher (or lower) than the rate anticipated by
the investor during the period immediately following the issuance of the Offered
Certificates may not be offset by a subsequent like reduction (or increase) in
the rate of principal prepayments. Investors must make their own decisions as to
the appropriate prepayment assumptions to be used in deciding whether to
purchase any of the Offered Certificates. The Depositor does not make any
representations or warranties as to the rate of prepayment or the factors to be
considered in connection with such determinations.

     The weighted average life and yield to maturity of each Class of Offered
Certificates will also be influenced by the amount of Excess Cashflow generated
by the Mortgage Loans and applied in reduction of the Certificate Principal
Balances of such Certificates. The level of Excess Cashflow available on any
Distribution Date to be applied in reduction of the Certificate Principal
Balances of the Offered Certificates will be influenced by, among other factors,
(i) the overcollateralization level of the assets in the Loan Group at such time
(i.e., the extent to which interest on the Mortgage Loans is accruing on a
higher Stated Principal Balance than the Certificate Principal Balance of the
related Offered Certificates); (ii) the delinquency and default experience of
the Mortgage Loans, (iii) the level of One-Month LIBOR and the Mortgage Index
for the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans, and (iv) the provisions of the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement that permit any Remainder Excess Cashflow to be
distributed to the Class B-IO Certificates and the Residual Certificates and to
the Master Servicer as an Extra Master Servicing Fee (in each case as provided
in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) when required overcollateralization
levels have been met. To the extent that greater amounts of Excess Cashflow are
distributed in reduction of the Certificate Principal Balances of a Class of
Offered Certificates, the weighted average life thereof can be expected to
shorten. No assurance, however, can be given as to the amount of Excess Cashflow
distributed at any time or in the aggregate. See 'Description of the
Certificates -- Overcollateralization and Crosscollateralization Provisions'
herein.

     The Class AF-6 Certificates will not be entitled to distributions of
principal until the Distribution Date in August 25, 2002 (except as otherwise
described herein). Thereafter, the relative entitlement of the Class AF-6
Certificates to payments in respect of principal is subject to increase in
accordance with the calculation of the Class AF-6 Distribution Amount. See
'Description of the Certificates -- Distributions' herein.

                                      S-53



<PAGE>

PREPAYMENTS AND YIELDS FOR OFFERED CERTIFICATES

     The extent to which the yield to maturity of the Offered Certificates may
vary from the anticipated yield will depend upon the degree to which it is
purchased at a discount or premium and, correspondingly, the degree to which the
timing of payments thereon is sensitive to prepayments, liquidations and
purchases of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group. In particular, in the
case of an Offered Certificate purchased at a discount, an investor should
consider the risk that a slower than anticipated rate of principal payments,
liquidations and purchases of the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group could
result in an actual yield to such investor that is lower than the anticipated
yield and, in the case of an Offered Certificate purchased at a premium, the
risk that a faster than anticipated rate of principal payments, liquidations and
purchases of such Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group could result in an
actual yield to such investor that is lower than the anticipated yield.

     All of the Mortgage Loans in the Fixed Rate Loan Group are fixed rate
Mortgage Loans. In general, if prevailing interest rates fall significantly
below the interest rates on fixed rate mortgage loans, such mortgage loans are
likely to be subject to higher prepayment rates than if prevailing rates remain
at or above the interest rates on such mortgage loans. Conversely, if prevailing
interest rates rise appreciably above the interest rates on fixed rate mortgage
loans, such mortgage loans are likely to experience a lower prepayment rate than
if prevailing rates remain at or below the interest rates on such mortgage
loans.

     The effective yield to the holders of the Fixed Rate Certificates will be
lower than the yield otherwise produced by the applicable rate at which interest
is passed through to such holders and the purchase price of such Certificates
because monthly distributions will not be payable to such holders until the 25th
day (or, if such day is not a business day, the following business day) of the
month following the month in which interest accrues on the related Mortgage
Loans (without any additional distribution of interest or earnings thereon in
respect of such delay).

     Although amounts deposited in the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund will be
available to pay any Fixed Net Rate Carryover, there is no assurance that funds
will be available to pay such amount, the ratings assigned Offered Fixed Rate
Certificates do not address the likelihood of the payment of such amount.

     All of the Mortgage Loans in the Adjustable Rate Loan Group are adjustable
rate Mortgage Loans. As is the case with conventional fixed rate mortgage loans,
adjustable rate mortgage loans may be subject to a greater rate of principal
prepayments in a declining interest rate environment. For example, if prevailing
interest rates fall significantly, adjustable rate mortgage loans could be
subject to higher prepayment rates than if prevailing interest rates remain
constant because the availability of fixed rate mortgage loans at lower interest
rates may encourage mortgagors to refinance their adjustable rate mortgage loans
to a lower fixed interest rate. Nevertheless, no assurance can be given as to
the level of prepayment that the Mortgage Loans will experience.

     Although the Mortgage Rates on the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans are
subject to adjustment, such Mortgage Rates adjust less frequently than the
Pass-Through Rate on the related Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates and adjust
by reference to the Mortgage Index. Changes in One-Month LIBOR may not correlate
with changes in the Mortgage Index and also may not correlate with prevailing
interest rates. It is possible that an increased level of One-Month LIBOR could
occur simultaneously with a lower level of prevailing interest rates which would
be expected to result in faster prepayments, thereby reducing the weighted
average life of the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates. The Mortgage Rate
applicable to all or substantially all of the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans and
any Adjustment Date will be based on the Mortgage Index value most recently
announced generally as of a date 45 days prior to such Adjustment Date. Thus, if
the Mortgage Index value with respect to an Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loan rises,
the lag in time before the corresponding Mortgage Rate increases will, all other
things being equal, slow the upward adjustment of the Adjustable Rate Available
Funds Cap on the related Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates. In addition, a
substantial portion of the Mortgage Loans in Adjustable Rate Loan Group have
Mortgage Rates which will not adjust for a substantial period of time after
origination. See 'The Mortgage Pool' herein.

     Although amounts deposited in the Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund
will be available to pay any Adjustable Rate Carryover, there is no assurance
that funds will be available to pay such amount. The ratings assigned to the
Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates do not address the likelihood of the
payment of any such amount.

     The 'Last Scheduled Distribution Date' for each Class of the Offered
Certificates is the date on which the Certificate Principal Balance thereof
would be reduced to zero assuming, among other things, that no

                                      S-54



<PAGE>

prepayments are received on the Mortgage Loans in the related Loan Group and
that scheduled monthly payments of principal of and interest on each of such
Mortgage Loans are timely received and that Excess Cashflow and any Remainder
Excess Cashflow is not used to make accelerated payments of principal. The
actual final Distribution Date with respect to each Class of Offered
Certificates could occur significantly earlier than its Last Scheduled
Distribution Date because (i) prepayments are likely to occur which will be
applied to the payment of the Certificate Principal Balances thereof,
(ii) Excess Cashflow and any Remainder Excess Cashflow to the extent available
will be applied as an accelerated payment of principal on the Offered
Certificates as described herein and (iii) the Master Servicer may purchase all
the Mortgage Loans in a Loan Group when outstanding Stated Principal Balances
thereof has declined to 10% or less of the Cut-off Date Principal Balance of
such Loan Group.

     Prepayments on mortgage loans are commonly measured relative to a
prepayment standard or model. The models used in this Prospectus Supplement
(each, a 'Prepayment Model') are based on an assumed rate of prepayment each
month of the then unpaid principal balance of a pool of mortgage loans similar
to the Mortgage Loans in each Loan Group. For the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans, the
Prepayment Model used in this Prospectus Supplement is a prepayment assumption
which represents an assumed rate of prepayment each month relative to the then
outstanding principal balance of a pool of mortgage loans for the life of such
mortgage loans ('PPC'). 100% of PPC assumes prepayment rates of 5% per annum of
the then outstanding principal balance of the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans in the
first month of the life of such Mortgage Loans and an additional 1.8182% per
annum in each month thereafter up to and including the twelfth month. Beginning
in the twelfth month and in each month thereafter during the life of such Fixed
Rate Mortgage Loans, 100% PPC assumes a constant prepayment rate of 25% per
annum. For the Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans, the Prepayment Model used in this
Prospectus Supplement is a prepayment assumption which represents a constant
assumed rate of prepayment each month relative of the then outstanding principal
balance of a pool of mortgage loans for the life of such mortgage loans ('CPR').
27% CPR, assumes a constant prepayment rate of 27% per annum.

     As used in the following tables 100% PPC assumes that the Fixed Rate
Mortgage Loans will prepay at rates equal to 100% of PPC; 125% PPC assumes that
the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans will prepay at rates equal to 125% of PPC; 150%
PPC assumes that the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans will prepay at rates equal to
150% of PPC; and the other percentages of PPC identified therein assume that the
Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans will prepay at rates equal to such respective
percentages of PPC.

     There is no assurance, however, that prepayments on the Mortgage Loans will
conform to any level of the Prepayment Model, and no representation is made that
the Mortgage Loans will prepay at the prepayment rates shown or any other
prepayment rate. The rate of principal payments on pools of mortgage loans is
influenced by a variety of economic, geographic, social and other factors,
including the level of interest rates. Other factors affecting prepayment of
mortgage loans include changes in obligors' housing needs, job transfers and
unemployment. In the case of mortgage loans in general, if prevailing interest
rates fall significantly below the interest rates on such mortgage loans, the
mortgage loans are likely to be subject to higher prepayment rates than if
prevailing interest rates remain at or above the rates borne by such mortgage
loans. Conversely, if prevailing interest rates rise above the interest on such
mortgage loans, the rate of prepayment would be expected to decrease.

     The following tables have been prepared on the basis of the following
assumptions (collectively, the 'Modeling Assumptions'): (i) the Mortgage Loans
prepay at the indicated percentage of the Prepayment Model; (ii) distributions
on the Offered Certificates are received, in cash, on the 25th day of each
month, commencing in August 1999, in accordance with the payment priorities
defined herein; (iii) no defaults or delinquencies in, or modifications, waivers
or amendments respecting, the payment by the Mortgagors of principal and
interest on the Mortgage Loans occur; (iv) scheduled payments are assumed to be
received on the first day of each month commencing in August 1999, and
prepayments represent payment in full of individual Mortgage Loans and are
assumed to be received on the last day of each month, commencing in July 1999,
and include 30 days' interest thereon; (v) the level of the six-month LIBOR
Mortgage Index remains constant at 5.6250% per annum and the level of One-Month
LIBOR remains constant at 5.17625% per annum; (vi) the Pass-Through Margin for
the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates remains constant at the rates
applicable prior to the related Optional Termination Date and the Pass-Through
Margin for the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates is adjusted accordingly on
any Distribution Date following related the Optional Termination Date; (vii) the
Closing Date for

                                      S-55



<PAGE>

the Certificates is July 30, 1999; (viii) the Mortgage Rate for each Adjustable
Rate Mortgage Loan is adjusted on its next Mortgage Rate Adjustment Date (and on
subsequent Mortgage Rate Adjustment Dates, if necessary) to equal the sum of (a)
the assumed level of the Mortgage Index and (b) the respective Gross Margin
(such sum being subject to the applicable periodic adjustment caps and floors);
(ix) except as indicated with respect to the weighted average lives, no optional
termination is exercised with respect to either Loan Group on the respective
Optional Termination Date; and (x) each Loan Group consists of Mortgage Loans
having the approximate characteristics described below:

                             FIXED RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    ORIGINAL      REMAINING
                                                  AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION   REMAINING TERM
    CURRENT                            NET            TERM           TERM        TO MATURITY
    BALANCE       MORTGAGE RATE   MORTGAGE RATE   (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)     (IN MONTHS)
    -------       -------------   -------------   -----------    -----------     -----------
<S>               <C>             <C>             <C>            <C>            <C>
$  5,745,185.64       9.203%        8.703%            360            352            172
$    141,175.97      10.301%        9.801%            120            114            114
$ 10,032,864.41       9.782%        9.282%            180            175            175
$  2,637,428.36      10.485%        9.985%            240            234            234
$108,308,233.72       9.709%        9.209%            360            355            355
</TABLE>

                           ADJUSTABLE RATE LOAN GROUP

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                  NUMBER OF
                                          ORIGINAL      REMAINING                                                MONTHS UNTIL
                               NET      AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION                       INITIAL      RESET      NEXT RATE
    CURRENT       MORTGAGE   MORTGAGE       TERM           TERM       GROSS    PERIODIC   PERIODIC    CHANGE      ADJUSTMENT
    BALANCE         RATE       RATE     (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)    MARGIN     CAP        CAP      FREQUENCY       DATE
    -------         ----       ----     -----------    -----------    ------     ---        ---      ---------       ----
<S>               <C>        <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>      <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>
$144,455,070.92    9.920%     9.420%        360            355        6.223%    1.040%     6.525%        6            19
$  4,699,078.68    9.214%     8.714%        357            352        6.174%    1.308%     4.183%        6            30
$  1,447,219.44    8.697%     8.197%        360            356        5.867%    1.000%     6.438%        6            56
$ 20,988,725.01    8.924%     8.424%        358            353        5.906%    1.000%     1.017%        6             2
</TABLE>

                                      S-56



<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      CLASS AF-1                          CLASS AF-2
                                           ---------------------------------    ----------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)              0%  50%   75%   100%  125% 150%      0%  50%   75%   100%  125%  150%
                                           ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----    ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)         0%  15%   20%   27%   35%   40%      0%  15%   20%   27%   35%   40%
                                           ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----    ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                        <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>      <C>   <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>
Initial Percentage .....................   100   100   100   100   100   100     100   100   100   100   100   100
July 25, 2000 ..........................    92    64    50    36    23     9     100   100   100   100   100   100
July 25, 2001 ..........................    90    34     9     0     0     0     100   100   100    45     0     0
July 25, 2002 ..........................    87     8     0     0     0     0     100   100     6     0     0     0
July 25, 2003 ..........................    84     0     0     0     0     0     100    49     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2004 ..........................    81     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2005 ..........................    78     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2006 ..........................    74     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2007 ..........................    71     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2008 ..........................    67     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2009 ..........................    63     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2010 ..........................    59     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2011 ..........................    54     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2012 ..........................    48     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2013 ..........................    42     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2014 ..........................    28     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2015 ..........................    23     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2016 ..........................    17     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2017 ..........................    10     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2018 ..........................     3     0     0     0     0     0     100     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2019 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0      78     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2020 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0      44     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2021 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0      15     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2022 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2023 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2024 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2025 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2026 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2027 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2028 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2029 ..........................     0     0     0     0     0     0       0     0     0     0     0     0
Weighted Average Life (in years)(1) .... 11.23  1.58  1.10  0.85  0.70  0.60   20.90  4.02  2.67  2.00  1.59  1.31
Weighted Average Life (in years)(1)(2).. 11.23  1.58  1.10  0.85  0.70  0.60   20.90  4.02  2.67  2.00  1.59  1.31
</TABLE>

- -----------

(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued on next page.)

                                      S-57




<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            CLASS AF-3                          CLASS AF-4
                                                 -----------------------------   ------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)                    0%  50%  75%  100% 125% 150%   0%   50%  75%  100% 125% 150%
                                                 ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----   ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- -----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)               0%  15%  20%   27%  35%  40%   0%   15%  20%   27%  35%  40%
                                                 ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----   ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- -----
PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                              <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>    <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>
Initial Percentage ...........................    100  100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2000 ................................    100  100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2001 ................................    100  100  100  100   74   24   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2002 ................................    100  100  100   34    0    0   100   100  100  100   48    0
July 25, 2003 ................................    100  100   55    3    0    0   100   100  100  100   24    0
July 25, 2004 ................................    100   86   20    0    0    0   100   100  100   44    0    0
July 25, 2005 ................................    100   60    0    0    0    0   100   100   92    5    0    0
July 25, 2006 ................................    100   38    0    0    0    0   100   100   55    0    0    0
July 25, 2007 ................................    100   25    0    0    0    0   100   100   39    0    0    0
July 25, 2008 ................................    100   12    0    0    0    0   100   100   20    0    0    0
July 25, 2009 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100    98    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2010 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100    73    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2011 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100    50    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2012 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100    30    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2013 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100    11    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2014 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2015 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2016 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2017 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2018 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2019 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2020 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2021 ................................    100    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2022 ................................     91    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2023 ................................     70    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2024 ................................     47    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2025 ................................     21    0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2026 ................................      0    0    0    0    0    0    84     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2027 ................................      0    0    0    0    0    0    21     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2028 ................................      0    0    0    0    0    0     0     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2029 ................................      0    0    0    0    0    0     0     0    0    0    0    0
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1) ....  24.81 6.77 4.24 3.00 2.25 1.84 27.58 12.12 7.61 5.00 3.43 2.46
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1)(2)..  24.81 6.77 4.24 3.00 2.25 1.84 27.58 12.12 7.61 5.00 3.43 2.46
</TABLE>

- -----------

(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued from previous page and continued on next page.)

                                      S-58




<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          CLASS AF-5                          CLASS AF-5
                                               ---------------------------------    ----------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)                  0%  50%   75%   100%  125% 150%      0%  50%   75%   100%  125%  150%
                                               ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----    ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)             0%  15%   20%   27%   35%   40%      0%  15%   20%   27%   35%   40%
                                               ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----    ---- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                            <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>     <C>   <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>
Initial Percentage .........................    100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100
July 25, 2000................................   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100
July 25, 2001................................   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100   100
July 25, 2002................................   100   100   100   100   100    43   100   100   100   100   100   100
July 25, 2003................................   100   100   100   100   100    43    99    92    89    91    94   100
July 25, 2004................................   100   100   100   100    71    12    99    84    81    79    79    83
July 25, 2005................................   100   100   100   100    44     2    97    74    68    62    58    57
July 25, 2006................................   100   100   100    78    29     1    95    64    54    46    39    35
July 25, 2007................................   100   100   100    72    29     1    89    40    27    18    17    21
July 25, 2008................................   100   100   100    59    26     1    83    25    13     7     5    11
July 25, 2009................................   100   100   100    46    19     1    76    16     7     3     1     3
July 25, 2010................................   100   100    81    34    13     0    69    10     3     1     0     0
July 25, 2011................................   100   100    65    25     6     0    62     6     2     0     0     0
July 25, 2012................................   100   100    51    19     2     0    54     4     1     0     0     0
July 25, 2013................................   100   100    40    12     0     0    47     2     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2014................................   100    90    30     6     0     0    33     1     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2015................................   100    77    24     3     0     0    29     1     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2016................................   100    64    19     0     0     0    25     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2017................................   100    54    14     0     0     0    20     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2018................................   100    45     9     0     0     0    16     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2019................................   100    37     5     0     0     0    13     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2020................................   100    30     2     0     0     0    10     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2021................................   100    24     0     0     0     0     7     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2022................................   100    19     0     0     0     0     5     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2023................................   100    15     0     0     0     0     4     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2024................................   100     9     0     0     0     0     2     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2025................................   100     5     0     0     0     0     1     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2026................................   100     1     0     0     0     0     1     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2027................................   100     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2028................................    48     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0
July 25, 2029................................     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0     0
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1).... 28.99 19.23 13.92 10.10  6.96  3.80 13.87  7.69  6.95  6.57  6.45  6.60
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1)(2). 28.40 14.73 10.47  7.54  5.55  3.65 13.87  7.67  6.88  6.34  5.63  4.92
</TABLE>

- ------------
(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued from previous page and continued on next page.)

                                      S-59




<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      CLASS MF-1                          CLASS MF-2
                                               -------------------------------  ------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)                  0%  50%   75%  100% 125% 150%    0%  50%  75%  100% 125% 150%
                                               ---- ----- ---- ----- ---- ----  ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- -----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)             0%  15%   20%   27%  35%  40%    0%  15%  20%   27%  35%  40%
                                               ---- ----- ---- ----- ---- ----  ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- -----
PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                            <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>   <C>  <C>   <C>  <C>  <C>
Initial Percentage ..........................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2000................................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2001................................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2002................................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2003................................   100   100   86   63   45   46   100   100   86   63   45   31
July 25, 2004................................   100    99   69   47   31   19   100    99   69   47   31   19
July 25, 2005................................   100    85   55   35   21   12   100    85   55   35   21   12
July 25, 2006................................   100    73   44   25   14    7   100    73   44   25   14    6
July 25, 2007................................   100    63   35   19    9    4   100    63   35   19    9    0
July 25, 2008................................   100    54   28   14    6    0   100    54   28   14    3    0
July 25, 2009................................   100    46   22   10    3    0   100    46   22   10    0    0
July 25, 2010................................   100    39   18    7    0    0   100    39   18    6    0    0
July 25, 2011................................   100    33   14    5    0    0   100    33   14    1    0    0
July 25, 2012................................   100    28   11    2    0    0   100    28   11    0    0    0
July 25, 2013................................   100    24    9    0    0    0   100    24    9    0    0    0
July 25, 2014................................   100    19    6    0    0    0   100    19    3    0    0    0
July 25, 2015................................   100    16    5    0    0    0   100    16    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2016................................   100    14    2    0    0    0   100    14    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2017................................   100    11    0    0    0    0   100    11    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2018................................   100     9    0    0    0    0   100     9    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2019................................   100     8    0    0    0    0   100     7    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2020................................   100     6    0    0    0    0   100     3    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2021................................    94     5    0    0    0    0    94     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2022................................    85     2    0    0    0    0    85     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2023................................    76     0    0    0    0    0    76     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2024................................    65     0    0    0    0    0    65     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2025................................    53     0    0    0    0    0    53     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2026................................    40     0    0    0    0    0    40     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2027................................    26     0    0    0    0    0    26     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2028................................    10     0    0    0    0    0    10     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2029................................     0     0    0    0    0    0     0     0    0    0    0    0
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1).... 26.00 10.88 7.56 5.74 4.83 4.48 26.00 10.77 7.47 5.65 4.67 4.18
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1)(2). 25.88 10.01 6.92 5.23 4.43 4.16 25.88 10.01 6.92 5.21 4.33 3.90
</TABLE>

- ------------
(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued from previous page and continued on next page.)

                                      S-60




<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          CLASS BF-1
                                                -------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)                  0%    50%  75%  100% 125% 150%
                                                ----- ----- ---- ---- ---- ----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)             0%    15%  20%  27%  35%  40%
                                                ----- ----- ---- ---- ---- ----
PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                              <C>    <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>
Initial Percentage.............................   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2000..................................   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2001..................................   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2002..................................   100   100  100  100  100  100
July 25, 2003..................................   100   100   86   63   45   31
July 25, 2004..................................   100    99   69   47   31   18
July 25, 2005..................................   100    85   55   35   20    6
July 25, 2006..................................   100    73   44   25    9    0
July 25, 2007..................................   100    63   35   17    2    0
July 25, 2008..................................   100    54   28    9    0    0
July 25, 2009..................................   100    46   22    3    0    0
July 25, 2010..................................   100    39   15    0    0    0
July 25, 2011..................................   100    33    9    0    0    0
July 25, 2012..................................   100    28    4    0    0    0
July 25, 2013..................................   100    24    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2014..................................   100    17    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2015..................................   100    12    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2016..................................   100     8    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2017..................................   100     5    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2018..................................   100     2    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2019..................................   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2020..................................   100     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2021..................................    94     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2022..................................    85     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2023..................................    76     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2024..................................    65     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2025..................................    53     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2026..................................    40     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2027..................................    26     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2028..................................     3     0    0    0    0    0
July 25, 2029..................................     0     0    0    0    0    0
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1)...... 25.95 10.41 7.21 5.42 4.45 3.91
Weighted Average Life Years (in  years)(1)(2).. 25.88 10.01 6.92 5.19 4.27 3.77
</TABLE>

- ------------
(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued from previous page and continued on next page.)

                                      S-61




<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        CLASS AV-1                     CLASS MV-1
                                               ------------------------------ -------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)                  0%   50%  75%  100% 125% 150%  0%   50%   75%  100% 125% 150%
                                               ----- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----- ----- ---- ---- ----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)             0%   15%  20%  27%  35%  40%   0%   15%   20%  27%  35%  40%
                                               ----- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----- ----- ---- ---- ----
PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                            <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>  <C>  <C>
Initial Percentage...........................   100  100  100  100  100  100   100   100   100  100  100  100
July 25, 2000................................    96   78   72   64   54   48   100   100   100  100  100  100
July 25, 2001................................    95   62   52   40   27   19   100   100   100  100  100  100
July 25, 2002................................    95   49   37   22    9    2   100   100   100  100  100  100
July 25, 2003................................    94   38   29   20    9    2   100   100    80   56   82  100
July 25, 2004................................    93   31   23   15    8    2   100    86    64   40   23   59
July 25, 2005................................    92   27   18   11    5    2   100    73    51   29   15   27
July 25, 2006................................    91   22   15    8    3    2   100    61    40   21    9    7
July 25, 2007................................    90   19   12    6    2    1   100    52    32   15    6    2
July 25, 2008................................    89   16    9    4    1    1   100    43    25   11    4    0
July 25, 2009................................    88   13    7    3    1    0   100    36    20    8    0    0
July 25, 2010................................    86   11    6    2    0    0   100    31    16    6    0    0
July 25, 2011................................    84    9    4    1    0    0   100    26    12    4    0    0
July 25, 2012................................    82    8    4    1    0    0   100    21    10    1    0    0
July 25, 2013................................    80    6    3    1    0    0   100    18     8    0    0    0
July 25, 2014................................    78    5    2    0    0    0   100    15     6    0    0    0
July 25, 2015................................    75    4    2    0    0    0   100    12     5    0    0    0
July 25, 2016................................    72    4    1    0    0    0   100    10     3    0    0    0
July 25, 2017................................    68    3    1    0    0    0   100     8     1    0    0    0
July 25, 2018................................    64    2    1    0    0    0   100     7     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2019................................    60    2    0    0    0    0   100     5     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2020................................    55    2    0    0    0    0   100     4     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2021................................    49    1    0    0    0    0   100     2     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2022................................    43    1    0    0    0    0   100     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2023................................    36    1    0    0    0    0    99     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2024................................    31    0    0    0    0    0    85     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2025................................    26    0    0    0    0    0    70     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2026................................    19    0    0    0    0    0    53     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2027................................    13    0    0    0    0    0    34     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2028................................     5    0    0    0    0    0    13     0     0    0    0    0
July 25, 2029................................     0    0    0    0    0    0     0     0     0    0    0    0
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1).... 20.02 4.66 3.49 2.48 1.69 1.26 27.06  9.63  7.22 5.45 4.92 5.47
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1)(2). 19.99 4.33 3.21 2.27 1.54 1.19 26.98  8.79  6.52 4.94 4.54 4.47
</TABLE>

- ------------
(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued from previous page and continued on next page.)

                                      S-62




<PAGE>

           PERCENT OF THE INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE PRINCIPAL BALANCE
                      AT THE RESPECTIVE PERCENTAGES OF THE
                                PREPAYMENT MODEL

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         CLASS MV-2                      CLASS BV-1
                                               ------------------------------- -------------------------------
FIXED RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (PPC)                 0%    50%  75%  100% 125% 150%  0%    50%  75%  100% 125% 150%
                                               ----- ----- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----- ----- ---- ---- ---- ----
ADJUSTABLE RATE MORTGAGE LOANS (CPR)            0%    15%  20%  27%  35%  40%   0%    15%  20%  27%  35%  40%

PAYMENT DATE
- ------------
<S>                                            <C>   <C>   <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>   <C>   <C>  <C>  <C>  <C>
Initial Percentage...........................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100   100
July 25, 2000................................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100   100
July 25, 2001................................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100   100
July 25, 2002................................   100   100  100  100  100  100   100   100  100  100  100   100
July 25, 2003................................   100   100   80   56   35   46   100   100   80   56   35    25
July 25, 2004................................   100    86   64   40   23   15   100    86   64   40   23    14
July 25, 2005................................   100    73   51   29   15    9   100    73   51   29   13     4
July 25, 2006................................   100    61   40   21    9    4   100    61   40   21    5     0
July 25, 2007................................   100    52   32   15    6    0   100    52   32   14    0     0
July 25, 2008................................   100    43   25   11    0    0   100    43   25    7    0     0
July 25, 2009................................   100    36   20    8    0    0   100    36   20    3    0     0
July 25, 2010................................   100    31   16    5    0    0   100    31   14    0    0     0
July 25, 2011................................   100    26   12    1    0    0   100    26    9    0    0     0
July 25, 2012................................   100    21   10    0    0    0   100    21    5    0    0     0
July 25, 2013................................   100    18    8    0    0    0   100    18    2    0    0     0
July 25, 2014................................   100    15    6    0    0    0   100    13    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2015................................   100    12    2    0    0    0   100     9    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2016................................   100    10    0    0    0    0   100     6    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2017................................   100     8    0    0    0    0   100     3    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2018................................   100     7    0    0    0    0   100     1    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2019................................   100     4    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2020................................   100     1    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2021................................   100     0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2022................................   100     0    0    0    0    0   100     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2023................................    99     0    0    0    0    0    99     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2024................................    85     0    0    0    0    0    85     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2025................................    70     0    0    0    0    0    70     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2026................................    53     0    0    0    0    0    53     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2027................................    34     0    0    0    0    0    34     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2028................................    13     0    0    0    0    0    10     0    0    0    0     0
July 25, 2029................................     0     0    0    0    0    0     0     0    0    0    0     0
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1).... 27.06  9.56 7.15 5.32 4.46 4.34 27.04  9.31 6.94 5.12 4.16  3.88
Weighted Average Life Years (in years)(1)(2). 26.98  8.79 6.52 4.86 4.12 4.04 26.98  8.79 6.52 4.82 3.94  3.69
</TABLE>

- ------------
(1) THE WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IS DETERMINED BY (I)
    MULTIPLYING THE AMOUNT OF EACH PRINCIPAL PAYMENT BY THE NUMBER OF YEARS FROM
    THE DATE OF ISSUANCE TO THE RELATED DISTRIBUTION DATE, (II) ADDING THE
    RESULTS, AND (III) DIVIDING THE SUM BY THE INITIAL RESPECTIVE CERTIFICATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCE FOR SUCH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES.

(2) TO THE RESPECTIVE OPTIONAL TERMINATION DATE.

(Table continued from previous page.)

                                      S-63





<PAGE>

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

     The Depositor intends to file certain additional yield tables and other
computational materials with respect to the Class A Certificates with the
Securities and Exchange Commission in a report on Form 8-K. Such tables and
materials were prepared by the Underwriters at the request of certain
prospective investors, based on assumptions provided by, and satisfying the
special requirements of, such prospective investors. Such tables and assumptions
may be based on assumptions that differ from the Structuring Assumptions.
Accordingly, such tables and other materials may not be relevant to or
appropriate for investors other than those specifically requesting them.

                                USE OF PROCEEDS

     The Depositor will apply the net proceeds of the sale of the Offered
Certificates against the purchase price of the Mortgage Loans.

                        FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement provides that the Trust Fund, exclusive
of the assets held in the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund and Adjustable Rate
Carryover Reserve Fund, will comprise several Lower Tier REMICs (as defined in
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) and an Upper Tier REMIC (as defined in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement) organized in a tiered REMIC structure. Each
Lower Tier REMIC will issue uncertificated regular interests and those interests
will be held entirely by the REMIC immediately above it in the tiered structure.
Each of the Lower Tier REMICs and the Upper Tier REMIC will designate a single
class of interests as the residual interest in that REMIC. The Residual
Certificate will represent ownership of the residual interests in each of the
REMICs. Elections will be made to treat each Lower Tier REMIC and the Upper Tier
REMIC as a REMIC for federal income tax purposes.

     Each class of Offered Certificates and the Class B-IO Certificates will
represent beneficial ownership of regular interests issued by the Upper Tier
REMIC. In addition, each of the Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates will
represent a beneficial interest in the right to receive payments from the
Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve Fund pursuant to contract rights delineated in
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the 'Interest Rate Cap Agreement'). Any
interest paid to the holders of the Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6,
Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF Certificates in excess of the weighted
average net mortgage rate of the Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans will be treated as
representing beneficial interests in contractual rights that would either be
treated for United States federal income tax purposes as an interest rate cap
agreement treated as a notional principal contract or as an interest in an
entity taxable as a partnership for federal income tax purposes.

     Upon the issuance of the Offered Certificates, Brown & Wood LLP ('Tax
Counsel'), will deliver its opinion concluding, assuming compliance with the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, for federal income tax purposes, each Lower
Tier REMIC and the Upper Tier REMIC will qualify as a REMIC within the meaning
of Section 860D of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the 'Code')
and the Offered Certificates represent regular interests in a REMIC. In
addition, Tax Counsel will deliver an opinion concluding that the Adjustable
Rate Carryover Reserve Fund is an 'outside reserve fund' that is beneficially
owned by the holders of the Class BV-IO Certificates. Moreover, Tax Counsel will
deliver an opinion concluding that the rights of the holders of the Offered
Adjustable Rate Certificates to receive payments from the Adjustable Rate
Carryover Reserve Fund pursuant to the Interest Rate Cap Agreement represents,
for federal income tax purposes, interests in an interest rate cap agreement.

TAXATION OF REGULAR INTERESTS

     A holder of an Offered Certificate of any Class of Offered Certificates
will be treated for federal income tax purposes as owning an interest in regular
interests in the Upper Tier REMIC. The Offered Adjustable Rate Certificates will
also represent beneficial ownership of an interest in a limited recourse
interest rate cap agreement. Any interest paid to the holders of the
Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF
Certificates in excess of the Fixed Net Rate Cap is unclear for federal income
tax purposes. The rights of such Certificates to interest in excess of the Fixed
Net Rate Cap may be treated as representing beneficial interests in the right to
receive payments from the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund pursuant to an
Interest Rate Cap Agreement. Alternatively, the rights of such Certificates to
interest in excess of the Fixed Net Rate Cap may be treated as representing the
beneficial interests in an entity taxable as a partnership for federal income
tax purposes with the Class BF-IO Certificates in respect of each Class BF-IO
Certificates' entitlement to interest, which may result in different tax timing
consequences to Certificateholders and in withholding on

                                      S-64



<PAGE>

such amounts to Certificateholders who are non-U.S. Persons. Prospective
investors in the Offered Fixed Rate Certificates should consult their tax
advisors regarding the tax treatment of the rights of such Certificates to
interest in excess of the Fixed Net Rate Cap.

     A holder of an Offered Certificate must allocate its purchase price for
such Offered Certificate between its two components -- the REMIC regular
interest component and the Interest Rate Cap Agreement component or the
partnership interest component, as applicable. For information reporting
purposes, the Trustee will assume that, with respect to any Offered Certificate,
the Interest Rate Cap Agreement component or the partnership interest component,
as applicable, will have only nominal value relative to the value of the regular
interest component. The IRS could, however, argue that the Interest Rate Cap
Agreement component or the partnership interest component, as applicable, has
significant value, and if that argument were to be sustained, the regular
interest component could be viewed as having been issued with an additional
amount of original issue discount ('OID') (which could cause the total amount of
discount to exceed a statutorily defined de minimis amount). See 'Certain
Federal Income Tax Considerations -- Taxation of the REMIC and its Holders' in
the Prospectus.

     Upon the sale, exchange, or other disposition of an Offered Certificate the
holder must allocate the amount realized between the two components of the
Offered Certificate based on the relative fair market values of those components
at the time of sale. Assuming that an Offered Certificate is held as a 'capital
asset' within the meaning of section 1221 of the Code, gain or loss on the
disposition of an interest in the Interest Rate Cap Agreement component or the
partnership interest component, as applicable, should be capital gain or loss,
and, gain or loss on the disposition of the regular interest component should,
subject to the limitation described below, be capital gain or loss. Gain
attributable to the regular interest component of an Offered Certificate will be
treated as ordinary income, however, to the extent such gain does not exceed the
excess, if any, of (i) the amount that would have been includable in the
holder's gross income with respect to the regular interest component had income
thereon accrued at a rate equal to 110% of the applicable federal rate as
defined in section 1274(d) of the Code determined as of the date of purchase of
the Offered Certficate over (ii) the amount actually included in such holder's
income.

     Interest on a regular interest must be included in income by a holder under
the accrual method of accounting, regardless of the holder's regular method of
accounting. In addition, a Regular interest could be considered to have been
issued with OID. See 'Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations -- Taxation of
the REMIC and its Holders' in the Prospectus. The prepayment assumption that
will be used in determining the accrual of any OID, market discount, or bond
premium, if any, will be a rate equal to 100% of the applicable Prepayment Model
as described above. No representation is made that the Mortgage Loans will
prepay at such a rate or at any other rate. OID must be included in income as it
accrues on a constant yield method, regardless of whether the holder receives
currently the cash attributable to such OID.

STATUS OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES

     The Regular Interest component of the Offered Certificates will be treated
as assets described in Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code, and as 'real estate
assets' under Section 856(c)(5)(B) of the Code, generally, in the same
proportion that the assets of the Trust Fund, exclusive of the Adjustable Rate
Carryover Reserve Fund, or the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund, as applicable,
would be so treated. In addition, to the extent a regular interest represents
real estate assets under section 856(c)(5)(B) of the Code, the interest derived
from that component would be interest on obligations secured by interests in
real property for purposes of section 856(c)(3) of the Code. The Interest Rate
Cap Agreement or partnership interest component of an Offered Certificate will
not, however, qualify as an asset described in Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the
Code or as a real estate asset under Section 856(c)(5)(B) of the Code.

THE FIXED RATE CARRYOVER RESERVE FUND AND ADJUSTABLE RATE CARRYOVER RESERVE FUND

     As indicated above, a portion of the purchase price paid by a holder to
acquire an Offered Adjustable Rate Certificate will be attributable to the
Interest Rate Cap Agreement component of the Offered Certificate. The portion of
the overall purchase price attributable to the Interest Rate Cap Agreement
component must be amortized over the life of the such Offered Certificate,
taking into account the declining balance of the related Regular Interest
component. Treasury regulations concerning notional principal contracts provide
alternative methods for amortizing the purchase price of an interest rate cap
contract. Under one method -- the level yield constant interest method -- the
price paid for an interest rate cap agreement is amortized over the life of the
cap as though it were the principal amount of a loan bearing interest at a
reasonable rate. Holders are urged to

                                      S-65



<PAGE>

consult their tax advisors concerning the methods that can be employed to
amortize the portion of the purchase price paid for the Interest Rate Cap
Agreement component of an Offered Adjustable Rate Certificate.

     Any payments made to a holder of an Offered Adjustable Rate Certificate
from the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund or the Adjustable Rate Carryover
Reserve Fund, as the case may be, will be treated as periodic payments on an
interest rate cap agreement. To the extent the sum of such periodic payments for
any year exceed that year's amortized cost of the Interest Rate Cap Agreement
component, such excess is ordinary income. If for any year the amount of that
year's amortized cost exceeds the sum of the periodic payments, such excess is
allowable as an ordinary deduction. The foregoing discussion will describe the
treatment of the Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund with respect to the Class
AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1, Class MF-2 and Class BF Certificates
in the event that the latter is treated as an Interest Rate Cap Agreement
(rather than an interest in a partnership) for federal income tax purposes.
Prospective investors in the Class AF-4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class MF-1,
Class MF-2 and Class BF Certificates should consult their tax advisors regarding
the tax treatment of the rights of such Certificates to interest in excess of
the Fixed Net Rate Cap.

PROHIBITED TRANSACTIONS TAX AND OTHER TAXES

     The Code imposes a tax on REMICs equal to 100% of the net income derived
from 'prohibited transactions' (the 'Prohibited Transactions Tax'). In general,
subject to certain specified exceptions, a prohibited transaction means the
disposition of a Mortgage Loan, the receipt of income from a source other than a
Mortgage Loan or certain other permitted investments, the receipt of
compensation for services, or gain from the disposition of an asset purchased
with the payments on the Mortgage Loans for temporary investment pending
distribution on the Certificates. It is not anticipated that the Trust Fund will
engage in any prohibited transactions in which it would recognize a material
amount of net income.

     In addition, certain contributions to a trust fund that elects to be
treated as a REMIC made after the day on which such trust fund issues all of its
interests could result in the imposition of a tax on the trust fund equal to
100% of the value of the contributed property (the 'Contributions Tax'). The
Trust Fund will not accept contributions that would subject it to such tax.

     In addition, a trust fund that elects to be treated as a REMIC may also be
subject to federal income tax at the highest corporate rate on 'net income from
foreclosure property,' determined by reference to the rules applicable to real
estate investment trusts. 'Net income from foreclosure property' generally means
gain from the sale of a foreclosure property other than qualifying rents and
other qualifying income for a real estate investment trust. It is not
anticipated that the Trust Fund will recognize net income from foreclosure
property subject to federal income tax.

     Where any Prohibited Transactions Tax, Contributions Tax, tax on net income
from foreclosure property or state or local income or franchise tax that may be
imposed on the REMIC arises out of a breach of the Master Servicer's or the
Trustee's obligations, as the case may be, under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and in respect of compliance with then applicable law, such tax will
be borne by the Master Servicer or Trustee in either case out of its own funds.
In the event that either the Master Servicer or the Trustee, as the case may be,
fails to pay or is not required to pay any such tax as provided above, such tax
will be paid by the Trust Fund first with amounts otherwise distributable to the
holders of Certificates in the manner provided in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. It is not anticipated that any material state or local income or
franchise tax will be imposed on the Trust Fund.

     For further information regarding the federal income tax consequences of
investing in the Class Certificates, see 'Certain Federal Income Tax
Considerations -- Taxation of the REMIC and its Holders' in the Prospectus.

                                  STATE TAXES

     The Depositor makes no representations regarding the tax consequences of
purchase, ownership or disposition of the Offered Certificates under the tax
laws of any state. Investors considering an investment in the Offered
Certificates should consult their own tax advisors regarding such tax
consequences.

     All investors should consult their own tax advisors regarding the federal,
state, local or foreign income tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and
disposition of the Offered Certificates.

                                      S-66



<PAGE>

                              ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     Section 406 of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
amended ('ERISA'), prohibits 'parties in interest' with respect to an employee
benefit plan subject to ERISA from engaging in certain transactions involving
such Plan and its assets unless a statutory, regulatory or administrative
exemption applies to the transaction. Section 4975 of the Code imposes certain
excise taxes on prohibited transactions involving 'disqualified persons' and
employee benefit plans or other arrangements (including, but not limited to,
individual retirement accounts) described under that Section (collectively with
employee benefit plans subject to ERISA, 'Plans'); ERISA authorizes the
imposition of civil penalties for prohibited transactions involving Plans not
covered under Section 4975 of the Code. Any Plan fiduciary which proposes to
cause a Plan to acquire the Offered Certificates should consult with its counsel
with respect to the potential consequences under ERISA and the Code of the
Plan's acquisition and ownership of such Certificates. See 'ERISA
Considerations' in the Prospectus.

     Certain employee benefit plans, including governmental plans and certain
church plans, are not subject to ERISA's requirements. Accordingly, assets of
such plans may be invested in the Offered Certificates without regard to the
ERISA considerations described herein and in the Prospectus, subject to the
provisions of other applicable federal and state law. Any such plan which is
qualified and exempt from taxation under Sections 401(a) and 501(a) of the Code
may nonetheless be subject to the prohibited transaction rules set forth in
Section 503 of the Code.

     Except as noted above, investments by Plans are subject to ERISA's general
fiduciary requirements, including the requirement of investment prudence and
diversification and the requirement that a Plan's investments be made in
accordance with the documents governing the Plan. A fiduciary which decides to
invest the assets of a Plan in the Class A Certificates should consider, among
other factors, the extreme sensitivity of the investments to the rate of
principal payments (including prepayments) on the Mortgage Loans.

     The U.S. Department of Labor has granted to Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. an
administrative exemption (Prohibited Transaction Exemption 90-30; Exemption
Application No. D-8207, 55 Fed. Reg. 21461 (1990)) (the 'Exemption') from
certain of the prohibited transaction rules of ERISA and the related excise tax
provisions of Section 4975 of the Code with respect to the initial purchase, the
holding and the subsequent resale by Plans of certificates in pass-through
trusts that consist of certain receivables, loans and other obligations that
meet the conditions and requirements of the Exemption. The Exemption applies to
mortgage loans such as the Mortgage Loans in the Trust Fund.

     Among the conditions that must be satisfied for the Exemption to apply are
the following:

          (1) the acquisition of the certificates by a Plan is on terms
     (including the price for the certificates) that are at least as favorable
     to the Plan as they would be in an arm's length transaction with an
     unrelated party;

          (2) the rights and interests evidenced by the certificates acquired by
     the Plan are not subordinated to the rights and interests evidenced by
     other certificates of the trust fund;

          (3) the certificates acquired by the Plan have received a rating at
     the time of such acquisition that is one of the three highest generic
     rating categories from Standard & Poor's, a Division of The McGraw-Hill
     Companies, Inc. ('S&P'), Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ('Moody's'), Duff
     & Phelps Credit Rating Co. ('DCR') or Fitch IBCA, Inc. ('Fitch');

          (4) the trustee must not be an affiliate of any other member of the
     Restricted Group (as defined below);

          (5) the sum of all payments made to and retained by the underwriters
     in connection with the distribution of the certificates represents not more
     than reasonable compensation for underwriting the certificates; the sum of
     all payments made to and retained by the seller pursuant to the assignment
     of the loans to the trust fund represents not more than the fair market
     value of such loans; the sum of all payments made to and retained by the
     servicer and any other servicer represents not more than reasonable
     compensation for such person's services under the agreement pursuant to
     which the loans are pooled and reimbursements of such person's reasonable
     expenses in connection therewith; and

          (6) the Plan investing in the certificates is an 'accredited investor'
     as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of the Securities and Exchange
     Commission under the Securities Act of 1933.

                                      S-67



<PAGE>

     The trust fund must also meet the following requirements:

          (i) the corpus of the trust fund must consist solely of assets of the
     type that have been included in other investment pools;

          (ii) certificates in such other investment pools must have been rated
     in one of the three highest rating categories of S&P, Moody's, Fitch or DCR
     for at least one year prior to the Plan's acquisition of certificates; and

          (iii) certificates evidencing interests in such other investment pools
     must have been purchased by investors other than Plans for at least one
     year prior to any Plan's acquisition of certificates.

     Moreover, the Exemption provides relief from certain self-dealing/conflict
of interest prohibited transactions that may occur when a Plan fiduciary causes
a Plan to acquire certificates in a trust holding receivables as to which the
fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor, provided that, among other
requirements, (i) in the case of an acquisition in connection with the initial
issuance of certificates, at least fifty percent (50%) of each class of
certificates in which Plans have invested is acquired by persons independent of
the Restricted Group; (ii) such fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor with
respect to five percent (5%) or less of the fair market value of the obligations
contained in the trust; (iii) a Plan's investment in certificates of any class
does not exceed twenty-five percent (25%) of all of the certificates of that
class outstanding at the time of the acquisition; and (iv) immediately after the
acquisition, no more than twenty-five percent (25%) of the assets of any Plan
with respect to which such person is a fiduciary are invested in certificates
representing an interest in one or more trusts containing assets sold or
serviced by the same entity. The Exemption does not apply to Plans sponsored by
an Underwriter, the Trustee, the Master Servicer, any other servicer, any
obligor with respect to Mortgage Loans included in the Trust Fund constituting
more than five percent of the aggregate unamortized principal balance of the
assets in the Trust Fund, any insurer or any affiliate of such parties (the
'Restricted Group').

     It is expected that the Exemption will apply to the acquisition and holding
of the Class A Certificates by Plans and that all conditions of the Exemption
other than those within the control of the investors will be met. In addition,
as of the date hereof, there is no single Mortgagor that is the obligor on five
percent (5%) of the Mortgage Loans included in the Trust Fund by aggregate
unamortized principal balance of the assets of the Trust Fund.

     The Exemption does not apply to the initial purchase, the holding or the
subsequent resale of the Subordinated Offered Certificates because the
Subordinated Offered Certificates are subordinate to certain other Classes of
Certificates. Consequently, transfers of the Subordinated Offered Certificates
will not be registered by the Trustee unless the Trustee receives: (i) a
representation from the transferee of such Certificate, acceptable to and in
form and substance satisfactory to the Trustee, to the effect that such
transferee is not an employee benefit plan subject to Section 406 of ERISA or a
plan or arrangement subject to Section 4975 of the Code, nor a person acting on
behalf of any such plan or arrangement or using the assets of any such plan or
arrangement to effect such transfer; (ii) if the purchaser is an insurance
company, a representation that the purchaser is an insurance company which is
purchasing such Certificates with funds contained in an 'insurance company
general account' (as such term is defined in Section V(e) of Prohibited
Transaction Class Exemption 95-60 ('PTCE 95-60')) and that the purchase and
holding of such Certificates are covered under Sections I and III of PTCE 95-60;
or (iii) an opinion of counsel satisfactory to the Trustee that the purchase and
holding of such Certificate by a Plan, any person acting on behalf of a Plan or
using such Plan's assets, will not result in the assets of the Trust Fund being
deemed to be 'plan assets' and subject to the prohibited transaction
requirements of ERISA and the Code and will not subject the Trustee to any
obligation in addition to those undertaken in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. Such representation as described above shall be deemed to have been
made to the Trustee by the transferee's acceptance of a Subordinated Offered
Certificate. In the event that such representation is violated, or any attempt
to transfer to a Plan or person acting on behalf of a Plan or using such Plan's
assets is attempted without such opinion of counsel, such attempted transfer or
acquisition shall be void and of no effect.

     Prospective Plan investors should consult with their legal advisors
concerning the impact of ERISA and the Exemption or any other exemption, and the
potential consequences in their specific circumstances, prior to making an
investment in the Offered Certificates. Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should
determine whether under the general fiduciary standards of investment prudence
and diversification, an investment in the Offered

                                      S-68



<PAGE>

Certificates is appropriate for the Plan, taking into account the overall
investment policy of the Plan and the composition of the Plan's investment
portfolio.

                             METHOD OF DISTRIBUTION

     Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Underwriting Agreement
among the Depositor, Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. and Countrywide Securities
Corporation (an affiliate of the Depositor, the Seller and the Master Servicer)
(collectively, the 'Underwriters'), the Depositor has agreed to sell the Offered
Certificates to the Underwriters, and the Underwriters have respectively agreed
to purchase from the Depositor the initial Certificate Principal Balance of each
Class of the Offered Certificates from the Depositor set forth below. It is
expected that the proceeds to the Depositor from the sale of the Offered
Certificates will be approximately $298,096,416.06, plus accrued interest,
before deducting issuance expenses payable by the Depositor, estimated to be
approximately $746,135.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           COUNTRYWIDE
                                                           BEAR, STEARNS    SECURITIES
CLASS                                                       & CO. INC.     CORPORATION
- -----                                                       ----------     -----------
<S>                                                        <C>             <C>
AF-1.....................................................  $ 24,903,000    $ 24,903,000
AF-2.....................................................     6,367,000       6,367,000
AF-3.....................................................     9,901,500       9,901,500
AF-4.....................................................     4,975,000       4,975,000
AF-5.....................................................     4,599,500       4,599,500
AF-6.....................................................     4,440,000       4,440,000
MF-1.....................................................     3,330,000       3,330,000
MF-2.....................................................     2,537,500       2,537,500
BF.......................................................     2,378,500       2,378,500
AV-1.....................................................    71,210,000      71,210,000
MV-1.....................................................     6,005,500       6,005,500
MV-2.....................................................     3,861,000       3,861,000
BV.......................................................     4,718,500       4,718,500
                                                           ------------    ------------
          Total..........................................  $149,227,000    $149,227,000
                                                           ------------    ------------
                                                           ------------    ------------
</TABLE>

     The Depositor has been advised that the Underwriters propose initially to
offer the Offered Certificates to certain dealers at such price less a selling
concession not to exceed the percentage of the Certificate denomination set
forth below, and that the Underwriters may allow and such dealers may reallow a
reallowance discount not to exceed the percentage of the Certificate
denomination set forth below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               SELLING     REALLOWANCE
CLASS OF CERTIFICATE                                          CONCESSION    DISCOUNT
- --------------------                                          ----------    --------
<S>                                                           <C>          <C>
Class AF-1 Certificates.....................................   0.720%        0.050%
Class AF-2 Certificates.....................................   0.105%        0.075%
Class AF-3 Certificates.....................................   0.135%        0.100%
Class AF-4 Certificates.....................................   0.150%        0.100%
Class AF-5 Certificates.....................................   0.225%        0.150%
Class AF-6 Certificates.....................................   0.195%        0.150%
Class MF-1 Certificates.....................................   0.300%        0.200%
Class MF-2 Certificates.....................................   0.390%        0.250%
Class BF Certificates.......................................   0.450%        0.250%
Class AV-1 Certificates.....................................   0.105%        0.075%
Class MV-1 Certificates.....................................   0.300%        0.200%
Class MV-2 Certificates.....................................   0.375%        0.250%
Class BV Certificates.......................................   0.450%        0.250%
</TABLE>

     After the initial public offering, the public offering price, such
concessions and such discounts may be changed.

     The Depositor has been advised by each Underwriter that it intends to make
a market in the Offered Certificates, but neither of the Underwriters has any
obligation to do so. There can be no assurance that a

                                      S-69



<PAGE>

secondary market for the Offered Certificates (or any particular Class thereof)
will develop or, if it does develop, that it will continue or that such market
will provide sufficient liquidity to Certificateholders.

     Until the distribution of the Offered Certificates is completed, rules of
the Securities and Exchange Commission may limit the ability of the Underwriters
and certain selling group members to bid for and purchase the Offered
Certificates. As an exception to these rules, the Underwriters are permitted to
engage in certain transactions that stabilize the price of the Offered
Certificates. Such transactions consist of bids or purchases for the purpose of
pegging, fixing or maintaining the price of the Offered Certificates.

     In general, purchases of a security for the purpose of stabilization or to
reduce a short position could cause the price of the security to be higher than
it might be in the absence of such purchases.

     Neither the Depositor nor either of the Underwriters makes any
representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that
the transactions described above may have on the prices of the Offered
Certificates. In addition, neither the Depositor nor either of the Underwriters
makes any representation that the Underwriters will engage in such transactions
or that such transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without
notice.

     The Depositor has agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against, or make
contributions to the Underwriters with respect to, certain liabilities,
including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

                                 LEGAL MATTERS

     The validity of the Certificates, including certain federal income tax
consequences with respect thereto, will be passed upon for the Depositor by
Brown & Wood LLP, New York, New York. Brown & Wood LLP, New York, New York, will
also pass upon certain legal matters on behalf of the Seller, the Master
Servicer and the Underwriters.

                                    RATINGS

     It is a condition of the issuance of the Offered Certificates that each
Class of Offered Certificates be assigned the ratings designated below by
Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ('Moody's') and Fitch IBCA, Inc. ('Fitch' and
together with Moody's, the 'Rating Agencies').

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
CLASS           MOODY'S RATING   FITCH RATING
- -----           --------------   ------------
<S>             <C>              <C>
AF-1                  Aaa             AAA
AF-2                  Aaa             AAA
AF-3                  Aaa             AAA
AF-4                  Aaa             AAA
AF-5                  Aaa             AAA
AF-6                  Aaa             AAA
AV-1                  Aaa             AAA
MF-1                  Aa2             AA
MV-1                  Aa2             AA
MF-2                  A2               A
MV-2                  A2               A
 BF                  Baa3             BBB-
 BV                  Baa2             BBB-
</TABLE>

     The security ratings assigned to the Offered Certificates should be
evaluated independently from similar ratings on other types of securities. A
security rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities and may
be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the Rating Agencies. The
ratings on the Offered Certificates do not, however, constitute statements
regarding the likelihood or frequency of prepayments on the Mortgage Loans, the
payment of the Fixed Net Rate Carryover or Adjustable Rate Certificate Carryover
(as the case may be) or the anticipated yields in light of prepayments.

     The Depositor has not requested a rating of the Offered Certificates by any
rating agency other than Moody's and Fitch. However, there can be no assurance
as to whether any other rating agency will rate the Offered Certificates or, if
it does, what ratings would be assigned by such other rating agency. The ratings
assigned by such other rating agency to the Offered Certificates could be lower
than the respective ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies.

                                      S-70






<PAGE>

             INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       PAGE
                                       ----
<S>                                 <C>
2/28 Mortgage Loans.                      S-18
3/27 Mortgage Loans.                      S-18
5/25 Mortgage Loans...............        S-18
accredited investor...............        S-67
Accrual Period....................        S-43
Adjustable Rate Available Funds
  Cap.............................        S-44
Adjustable Rate Certificate
  Carryover.......................        S-44
Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve
  Fund............................        S-49
Adjustable Rate Carryover Reserve
  Fund Deposit....................        S-50
Adjustable Rate Certificates......        S-36
Adjustable Rate Loan Group........        S-17
Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans....        S-17
Adjustment Date...................        S-18
Advance...........................        S-34
Amresco...........................  S-17, S-27
Applied Realized Loss Amount......  S-47, S-48
B&C...............................        S-17
Bankruptcy Rate...................        S-31
beneficial owner..................        S-37
BIF...............................        S-40
Book-Entry Certificates...........        S-36
capital asset.....................        S-65
CEDEL.............................        S-36
CEDEL Participants................        S-38
Certificates......................        S-36
Certificate Account...............        S-40
Certificate Group.................        S-36
Certificate Owners................        S-36
Class A Adjustable Rate
  Certificates....................        S-36
Class A Certificates..............        S-36
Class A Fixed Rate Certificates...        S-36
Class A Principal Distribution
  Amount..........................        S-45
Class AF-6 Distribution Amount....        S-45
Class B Certificates..............        S-36
Class B Principal Distribution
  Amount..........................        S-45
Class B-IO Certificates...........        S-36
Class BF Certificates.............        S-36
Class BF-IO Certificates..........        S-36
Class BV Certificates.............        S-36
Class BV-IO Certificates..........        S-36
Class M-1 Certificates............        S-36
Class M-1 Principal Distribution
  Amount..........................        S-45
Class M-2 Certificates............        S-36
Class M-2 Principal Distribution
  Amount..........................        S-45
Class MF-1 Certificates...........        S-36
Class MF-2 Certificates...........        S-36
Class MV-1 Certificates...........        S-36
Class MV-2 Certificates...........        S-36
Code..............................        S-64
Collateral Value..................        S-19
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio......        S-19
Compensating Interest.............        S-32
Contributions Tax.................        S-66
Cooperative.......................        S-38
Countrywide.......................        S-29
CPR...............................        S-55
Current Interest..................        S-43
Cut-off Date......................        S-17
Cut-off Date Pool Principal
  Balance.........................        S-17
Cut-off Date Principal Balance....        S-17
DCR...............................        S-67
Definitive Certificate............        S-37
Delay Delivery Mortgage Loans.....        S-53
Deleted Mortgage Loan.............        S-27
Depositor.........................        S-17
Depositary Services...............        S-40
disqualified persons..............        S-67
Distribution Account..............        S-42
Distribution Account Deposit
  Date............................        S-42
Distribution Date.................        S-42
DTC...............................   S-36, A-1
Due Dates.........................        S-32
Due Period........................        S-42
ERISA.............................        S-67
Euroclear.........................        S-36
Euroclear Operator................        S-38
Euroclear Participants............        S-38
European Depositaries.............        S-36
Excess Cashflow...................        S-46
Excess Overcollateralization
  Amount..........................        S-48
Exemption.........................        S-67
Extra Principal Distribution
  Amount..........................        S-46
Extra Master Servicing Fee........        S-48
FHLMC.............................        S-28
Financial Intermediary............        S-37
Fitch.............................  S-67, S-70
Fixed Net Rate Cap................        S-44
Fixed Net Rate Carryover..........        S-44
Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve
  Fund............................        S-49
Fixed Rate Carryover Reserve Fund
  Deposit.........................        S-49
Fixed Rate Certificates...........        S-36
Fixed Rate Loan Group.............        S-17
Fixed Rate Mortgage Loans.........        S-17
FNMA..............................        S-28
Foreclosure Rate..................        S-31
Full Documentation................        S-28
Global Securities.................         A-1
Gross Margin......................        S-18
Indirect Participants.............        S-37
</TABLE>

                       S-71



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       PAGE
                                       ----
<S>                                 <C>
Industry..........................        S-40
Insurance Proceeds................        S-41
Interest Carry Forward Amount.....        S-43
Interest Determination Date.......        S-49
Interest Funds....................        S-42
Interest Rate Cap Agreement.......        S-64
Last Scheduled Distribution
  Date............................        S-54
LIBOR Business Day................        S-49
Liquidation Proceeds..............        S-41
Limited Documentation.............        S-28
Loan Group........................        S-17
Loan-to-Value Ratio...............        S-19
Master Servicer...................        S-29
Master Servicer Advance Date......        S-32
Maximum Mortgage Rate.............        S-18
Mezzanine Adjustable Rate
  Certificates....................        S-36
Mezzanine Certificates............        S-36
Mezzanine Fixed Rate
  Certificates....................        S-36
Minimum Mortgage Rate.............        S-27
Modeling Assumptions..............        S-55
Moody's...........................  S-67, S-70
Mortgage Capital..................  S-17, S-27
Mortgage Index....................        S-18
Mortgage Loans....................        S-17
Mortgage Notes....................        S-17
Mortgage Pool.....................        S-17
Mortgaged Properties..............        S-17
net income from foreclosure
  property........................        S-66
Net Mortgage Rate.................        S-27
OC Floor..........................        S-46
Offered Adjustable Rate
  Certificates....................        S-36
Offered Certificates..............        S-36
Offered Fixed Rate Certificates...        S-36
OID...............................        S-65
One-Month LIBOR...................  S-44, S-49
Optional Termination Date.........        S-51
Originator........................        S-27
Originators.......................        S-27
outside reserve fund..............        S-64
Overcollateralization Amount......        S-47
Participants......................        S-37
parties in interest...............        S-67
Pass-Through Margin...............        S-44
Pass-Through Rate.................        S-44
Percentage Interest...............        S-43
Periodic Rate Cap.................        S-18
Plans.............................        S-67
plan assets.......................        S-68
Pooling and Servicing Agreement...        S-26
PPC...............................        S-55
Prepayment Interest Excess........        S-32
Prepayment Interest Shortfall.....        S-32
Prepayment Model..................        S-55
Prepayment Period.................        S-32
Principal Distribution Amount.....        S-45
Principal Funds...................        S-42
prohibited transactions...........        S-66
Prohibited Transactions Tax.......        S-66
Provident.........................  S-17, S-27
PTCE 95-60........................        S-68
Purchase Price....................        S-26
Rating Agencies...................        S-70
real estate assets................        S-65
Realized Loss.....................        S-48
Record Date.......................        S-42
Reference Banks...................        S-49
Reference Bank Rate...............        S-49
Relevant Depositary...............        S-36
Remainder Excess Cashflow.........        S-46
REO Property......................        S-32
Replacement Mortgage Loan.........        S-27
Required Percentage...............        S-47
Reserve Interest Rate.............
Residual Certificates.............        S-36
Restricted Group..................        S-68
Rules.............................        S-37
SAIF..............................        S-40
Scheduled Payments................        S-17
Seller............................        S-26
Servicing Fee.....................        S-32
Servicing Fee Rate................        S-32
S&P...............................        S-67
Specified
  Overcollateralization Amount....        S-46
Stated Income Documentation.......        S-28
Stepdown Date.....................        S-47
Subordinated Offered
  Certificates....................        S-36
Subordinated Offered Adjustable
  Rate Certificates...............        S-36
Subordinated Offered Fixed Rate
  Certificates....................        S-36
Systems...........................        S-40
Tax Counsel.......................        S-64
Terms and Conditions..............        S-38
Trigger Event.....................        S-47
Trustee...........................        S-26
Trustee's Mortgage File...........        S-26
Trust Fund........................        S-17
Underwriters......................        S-69
Underwriting Guidelines...........        S-27
Unpaid Realized Loss Amount.......        S-48
U.S. Person.......................         A-3
Year 2000 problems................        S-40
</TABLE>

                       S-72







<PAGE>

                                                                         ANNEX I

         GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES

     Except in certain limited circumstances, the globally offered Bear Stearns
Asset Backed Securities, Inc. Asset-Backed Certificates, Series 1999-1 (the
'Global Securities') will be available only in book-entry form. Investors in the
Global Securities may hold such Global Securities through any of The Depository
Trust Company ('DTC'), CEDEL or Euroclear. The Global Securities will be
tradeable as home market instruments in both the European and U.S. domestic
markets. Initial settlement and all secondary trades will settle in same-day
funds.

     Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
through CEDEL and Euroclear will be conducted in the ordinary way in accordance
with their normal rules and operating procedures and in accordance with
conventional Eurobond practice (i.e., seven calendar day settlement).

     Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
through DTC will be conducted according to the rules and procedures applicable
to U.S. corporate debt obligations and prior mortgage pass-through certificate
issues.

     Secondary cross-market trading between CEDEL or Euroclear and DTC
Participants holding Certificates will be effected on a delivery-against-payment
basis through the respective Depositaries of CEDEL and Euroclear (in such
capacity) and as DTC Participants.

     Non-U.S. holders (as described below) of Global Securities will be subject
to U.S. withholding taxes unless such holders meet certain requirements and
deliver appropriate U.S. tax documents to the securities clearing organizations
or their participants.

INITIAL SETTLEMENT

     All Global Securities will be held in book-entry form by DTC in the name of
Cede & Co. as nominee of DTC. Investors' interests in the Global Securities will
be represented through financial institutions acting on their behalf as direct
and indirect Participants in DTC. As a result, CEDEL and Euroclear will hold
positions on behalf of their participants through their respective Depositaries,
which in turn will hold such positions in accounts as DTC Participants.

     Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through DTC will follow
the settlement practices applicable to prior mortgage pass-through certificate
issues. Investor securities custody accounts will be credited with their
holdings against payment in same-day funds on the settlement date.

     Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through CEDEL or
Euroclear accounts will follow the settlement procedures applicable to
conventional Eurobonds, except that there will be no temporary global security
and no 'lock-up' or restricted period. Global Securities will be credited to the
securities custody accounts on the settlement date against payment in same-day
funds.

SECONDARY MARKET TRADING

     Since the purchaser determines the place of delivery, it is important to
establish at the time of the trade where both the purchaser's and seller's
accounts are located to ensure that settlement can be made on the desired value
date.

     Trading between DTC Participants. Secondary market trading between DTC
Participants will be settled using the procedures applicable to prior mortgage
pass-through certificate issues in same-day funds.

     Trading between CEDEL and/or Euroclear Participants. Secondary market
trading between CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants will be settled
using the procedures applicable to conventional Eurobonds in same-day funds.

     Trading between DTC Seller and CEDEL or Euroclear Purchaser. When Global
Securities are to be transferred from the account of a DTC Participant to the
account of a CEDEL Participant or a Euroclear Participant, the purchaser will
send instructions to CEDEL or Euroclear through a CEDEL Participant or Euroclear
Participant at least one business day prior to settlement. CEDEL or Euroclear
will instruct the respective Depositary, as the case may be, to receive the
Global Securities against payment. Payment will

                                      A-1



<PAGE>

include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and including the last
coupon payment date to and excluding the settlement date, on the basis of either
the actual number of days in such accrual period and a year assumed to consist
of 360 days or a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months, as applicable to the
related Class of Global Securities. For transactions settling on the 31st of the
month, payment will include interest accrued to and excluding the first day of
the following month. Payment will then be made by the respective Depositary of
the DTC Participant's account against delivery of the Global Securities. After
settlement has been completed, the Global Securities will be credited to the
respective clearing system and by the clearing system, in accordance with its
usual procedures, to the CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account.
The securities credit will appear the next day (European time) and the cash debt
will be back-valued to, and the interest on the Global Securities will accrue
from, the value date (which would be the preceding day when settlement occurred
in New York). If settlement is not completed on the intended value date (i.e.,
the trade fails), the CEDEL or Euroclear cash debt will be valued instead as of
the actual settlement date.

     CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants will need to make available
to the respective clearing systems the funds necessary to process same-day funds
settlement. The most direct means of doing so is to preposition funds for
settlement, either from cash on hand or existing lines of credit, as they would
for any settlement occurring within CEDEL or Euroclear. Under this approach,
they may take on credit exposure to CEDEL or Euroclear until the Global
Securities are credited to their accounts one day later.

     As an alternative, if CEDEL or Euroclear has extended a line of credit to
them, CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants can elect not to preposition
funds and allow that credit line to be drawn upon the finance settlement. Under
this procedure, CEDEL Participants or Euroclear Participants purchasing Global
Securities would incur overdraft charges for one day, assuming they cleared the
overdraft when the Global Securities were credited to their accounts. However,
interest on the Global Securities would accrue from the value date. Therefore,
in many cases the investment income on the Global Securities earned during that
one-day period may substantially reduce or offset the amount of such overdraft
charges, although this result will depend on each CEDEL Participant's or
Euroclear Participant's particular cost of funds.

     Since the settlement is taking place during New York business hours, DTC
Participants can employ their usual procedures for sending Global Securities to
the respective European Depositary for the benefit of CEDEL Participants or
Euroclear Participants. The sale proceeds will be available to the DTC seller on
the settlement date. Thus, to the DTC Participants a cross-market transaction
will settle no differently than a trade between two DTC Participants.

     Trading between CEDEL or Euroclear Seller and DTC Purchaser. Due to time
zone differences in their favor, CEDEL Participants and Euroclear Participants
may employ their customary procedures for transactions in which Global
Securities are to be transferred by the respective clearing system, through the
respective Depositary, to a DTC Participant. The seller will send instructions
to CEDEL or Euroclear through a CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant at
least one business day prior to settlement. In these cases CEDEL or Euroclear
will instruct the respective Depositary, as appropriate, to deliver the Global
Securities to the DTC Participant's account against payment. Payment will
include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and including the last
coupon payment to and excluding the settlement date on the basis of either the
actual number of days in such accrual period and a year assumed to consist of
360 days or a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months, as applicable to the related
Class of Global Securities. For transactions settling on the 31st of the month,
payment will include interest accrued to and excluding the first day of the
following month. The payment will then be reflected in the account of the CEDEL
Participant or Euroclear Participant the following day, and receipt of the cash
proceeds in the CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account would be
back-valued to the value date (which would be the preceding day, when settlement
occurred in New York). Should the CEDEL Participant or Euroclear Participant
have a line of credit with its respective clearing system and elect to be in
debt in anticipation of receipt of the sale proceeds in its account, the
back-valuation will extinguish any overdraft incurred over that one-day period.
If settlement is not completed on the intended value date (i.e., the trade
fails), receipt of the cash proceeds in the CEDEL Participant's or Euroclear
Participant's account would instead be valued as of the actual settlement date.

     Finally, day traders that use CEDEL or Euroclear and that purchase Global
Securities from DTC Participants for delivery to CEDEL Participants or Euroclear
Participants should note that these trades would automatically fail on the sale
side unless affirmative action were taken. At least three techniques should be
readily available to eliminate this potential problem:

                                      A-2



<PAGE>

          (a) borrowing through CEDEL or Euroclear for one day (until the
     purchase side of the day trade is reflected in their CEDEL or Euroclear
     accounts) in accordance with the clearing system's customary procedures;

          (b) borrowing the Global Securities in the U.S. from a DTC Participant
     no later than one day prior to settlement, which would give the Global
     Securities sufficient time to be reflected in their CEDEL or Euroclear
     account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or

          (c) staggering the value dates for the buy and sell sides of the trade
     so that the value date for the purchase from the DTC Participant is at
     least one day prior to the value date for the sale to the CEDEL Participant
     or Euroclear Participant.

CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS

     A beneficial owner of Global Securities holding securities through CEDEL or
Euroclear (or through DTC if the holder has an address outside the U.S.) will be
subject to the 30% U.S. withholding tax that generally applies to payments of
interest (including original issue discount) on registered debt issued by U.S.
Persons, unless (i) each clearing system, bank or other financial institution
that holds customers' securities in the ordinary course of its trade or business
in the chain of intermediaries between such beneficial owner and the U.S. entity
required to withhold tax complies with applicable certification requirements and
(ii) such beneficial owner takes one of the following steps to obtain an
exemption or reduced tax rate:

     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons (Form W-8). Beneficial owners of Global
Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption from the
withholding tax by filing a signed Form W-8 (Certificate of Foreign Status). If
the information shown on Form W-8 changes, a new Form W-8 must be filed within
30 days of such change.

     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons with Effectively Connected Income (Form
4224). A non-U.S. Person, including a non-U.S. corporation or bank with a U.S.
branch, for which the interest income is effectively connected with its conduct
of a trade or business in the United States, can obtain an exemption from the
withholding tax by filing Form 4224 (Exemption from Withholding of Tax on Income
Effectively Connected with the Conduct of a Trade or Business in the United
States).

     Exemption or Reduced Rate for non-U.S. Persons Resident in Treaty Countries
(Form 1001). Non-U.S. Persons that are Certificate Owners residing in a country
that has a tax treaty with the United States can obtain an exemption or reduced
tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by filing Form 1001 (Ownership,
Exemption or Reduced Rate Certificate). If the treaty provides only for a
reduced rate, withholding tax will be imposed at that rate unless the filer
alternatively files Form W-8. Form 1001 may be filed by the Certificate Owners
or his agent.

     Exemption for U.S. Persons (Form W-9). U.S. Persons can obtain a complete
exemption from the withholding tax by filing Form W-9 (Payer's Request for
Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).

     U.S. Federal Income Tax Reporting Procedure. The Certificate Owner of a
Global Security or, in the case of a Form 1001 or a Form 4224 filer, his agent,
files by submitting the appropriate form to the person through whom it holds
(the clearing agency, in the case of persons holding directly on the books of
the clearing agency). Form W-8 and Form 1001 are effective for three calendar
years and Form 4224 is effective for one calendar year.

     The term 'U.S. Person' means (i) a citizen or resident of the United
States, (ii) a corporation or partnership organized in or under the laws of the
United States, any State thereof or the District of Columbia, (iii) an estate
the income of which is includible in gross income for United States tax
purposes, regardless of its source, or (iv) a trust if a court within the United
States is able to exercise primary supervision of the administration of the
trust and one or more United States persons have the authority to control all
substantial decisions of the trust. This summary does not deal with all aspects
of U.S. Federal income tax withholding that may be relevant to foreign holders
of the Global Securities or with the application of Treasury regulations
relating to tax documentation requirements that are generally effective with
respect to payments after December 31, 2000. Investors are advised to consult
their own tax advisors for specific tax advice concerning their holding and
disposing of the Global Securities.

                                      A-3



<PAGE>









                      [THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]











<PAGE>

PROSPECTUS

                   BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES, INC.
                                  (Depositor)

     Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc. (the 'Depositor') may offer from
time to time under this Prospectus and related Prospectus Supplements the
Asset-Backed Notes (the 'Notes') and the Asset-Backed Certificates (the
'Certificates' and, together with the Notes, the 'Securities') which may be sold
from time to time in one or more series (each, a 'Series').

     As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Certificates of a
Series will evidence undivided interests in certain assets deposited into a
trust (each, a 'Trust Fund') by the Depositor pursuant to a Pooling and
Servicing Agreement or a Trust Agreement, as described herein. As specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Notes of a Series will be issued and
secured pursuant to an Indenture and will represent indebtedness of the related
Trust Fund. The Trust Fund for a Series of Securities will include assets
purchased from the seller or sellers specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement (the 'Seller') composed of (a) Primary Assets, which may include one
or more pools of (i) closed-end home equity loans (the 'Mortgage Loans'),
secured by mortgages on one- to four-family residential or mixed-use properties,
(ii) home improvement installment sales contracts and installment loan
agreements (the 'Home Improvement Contracts') which are either unsecured or
secured by mortgages on one- to four-family residential or mixed-use properties,
or by purchase money security interests in the home improvements financed
thereby (the 'Home Improvements') and (iii) securities backed or secured by
Mortgage Loans and/or Home Improvement Contracts, (b) all monies due thereunder
net, if and as provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, of certain amounts
payable to the servicer of the Mortgage Loans and/or Home Improvement Contracts
(collectively, the 'Loans'), which servicer may also be the Seller, specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement (the 'Servicer'), (c) if specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, funds on deposit in one or more pre-funding
amounts and/or capitalized interest accounts and (d) reserve funds, letters of
credit, surety bonds, insurance policies or other forms of credit support as
described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement. The amount initially
deposited in a pre-funding account for a Series of Securities will not exceed
fifty percent of the aggregate principal amount of such series of Securities.

                                                  (cover continued on next page)

                         ------------------------------

     NOTES OF A GIVEN SERIES REPRESENT OBLIGATIONS OF, AND CERTIFICATES OF A
SERIES EVIDENCE BENEFICIAL INTERESTS IN, THE RELATED TRUST FUND ONLY AND ARE NOT
GUARANTEED BY ANY GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY OR BY THE DEPOSITOR, THE SELLER, THE
TRUSTEE, THE SERVICER OR BY ANY OF THEIR RESPECTIVE AFFILIATES OR, UNLESS
OTHERWISE SPECIFIED IN THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT, BY ANY OTHER PERSON OR
ENTITY. THE DEPOSITOR'S ONLY OBLIGATIONS WITH RESPECT TO ANY SERIES OF
SECURITIES WILL BE PURSUANT TO CERTAIN REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES SET FORTH
IN THE RELATED AGREEMENT AS DESCRIBED HEREIN OR IN THE RELATED PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT.
                         -----------------------------------

     SEE 'RISK FACTORS' ON PAGE 15 FOR CERTAIN FACTORS TO BE CONSIDERED IN
PURCHASING THE SECURITIES.

                         -----------------------------------

   THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
    AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION
        PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS OR THE
          PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY
                            IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

                         ------------------------------

     The Securities offered by this Prospectus and by the related Prospectus
Supplement are offered by Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. and the other underwriters
set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, if any, subject to prior sale,
to withdrawal, cancellation or modification of the offer without notice, to
delivery to and acceptance by Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. and the other
underwriters, if any, and certain further conditions. Retain this Prospectus for
future reference. This Prospectus may not be used to consummate sales of the
Securities offered hereby unless accompanied by a Prospectus Supplement.

                            BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.

                                 July 23, 1999



<PAGE>

(continued from previous page)

     Each Series of Securities will be issued in one or more classes (each, a
'Class'). Interest on and principal of the Securities of a Series will be
payable on each Distribution Date specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, at the times, at the rates, in the amounts and in the order of
priority set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If a Series includes multiple Classes, such Classes may vary with respect
to the amount, percentage and timing of distributions of principal, interest or
both and one or more Classes may be subordinated to other Classes with respect
to distributions of principal, interest or both as described herein and in the
related Prospectus Supplement. If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Primary Assets and other assets comprising the Trust Fund may be
divided into one or more Asset Groups and each Class of the related Series will
evidence beneficial ownership of the corresponding Asset Group, as applicable.

     The rate of reduction of the aggregate principal balance of each Class of a
Series may depend principally upon the rate of payment (including prepayments)
with respect to the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private
Securities, as applicable. A rate of prepayment lower or higher than anticipated
will affect the yield on the Securities of a Series in the manner described
herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement. Under certain limited
circumstances described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement, a
Series of Securities may be subject to termination or redemption under the
circumstances described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, an election may be made
to treat certain assets comprising the Trust Fund for a Series as a 'real estate
mortgage investment conduit' (a 'REMIC') for federal income tax purposes. See
'CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS' herein.

                                       2







<PAGE>

                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT

     The Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities to be offered
hereunder will, among other things, set forth with respect to such Series of
Securities: (i) the aggregate principal amount, interest rate, and authorized
denominations of each Class of such Securities; (ii) certain information
concerning the Primary Assets, the Seller and any Servicer; (iii) the terms of
any Enhancement with respect to such Series; (iv) the terms of any insurance
related to the Primary Assets; (v) information concerning any other assets in
the related Trust Fund, including any Reserve Fund; (vi) the Final Scheduled
Distribution Date of each Class of such Securities; (vii) the method to be used
to calculate the amount of principal required to be applied to the Securities of
each Class of such Series on each Distribution Date, the timing of the
application of principal and the order of priority of the application of such
principal to the respective Classes and the allocation of principal to be so
applied; (viii) the Distribution Dates and any Assumed Reinvestment Rate (as
defined herein); (ix) additional information with respect to the plan of
distribution of such Securities; and (x) whether a REMIC election will be made
with respect to some or all of the Trust Fund for such Series.

                               REPORTS TO HOLDERS

     Periodic and annual reports concerning the related Trust Fund for a Series
of Securities are required under the related Agreement to be forwarded to
Holders. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, such
reports will not be examined and reported on by an independent public
accountant. If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of
Securities, such Series or one or more Classes of such Series will be issued in
book-entry form. In such event, (i) owners of beneficial interests in such
Securities will not be considered 'Holders' under the Agreements and will not
receive such reports directly from the related Trust Fund; rather, such reports
will be furnished to such owners through the participants and indirect
participants of the applicable book-entry system and (ii) references herein to
the rights of 'Holders' shall refer to the rights of such owners as they may be
exercised indirectly through such participants. See 'THE AGREEMENTS -- Reports
to Holders' herein.

                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION

     The Depositor has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission a
Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, with
respect to the Securities. This Prospectus, which forms a part of the
Registration Statement, and the Prospectus Supplement relating to each Series of
Securities contain summaries of the material terms of the documents referred to
herein and therein, but do not contain all of the information set forth in the
Registration Statement pursuant to the Rules and Regulations of the Commission.
For further information, reference is made to such Registration Statement and
the exhibits thereto. Such Registration Statement and exhibits can be inspected
and copied at prescribed rates at the public reference facilities maintained by
the Commission at its Public Reference Section, 450 Fifth Street, N.W.,
Washington, D.C. 20549, and at its Regional Office located as follows, Midwest
Regional Office, 500 West Madison Street, Chicago, Illinois 60661; and Northeast
Regional Office, Seven World Trade Center, New York, New York 10048.

     Each Trust Fund will be required to file certain reports with the
Commission pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as amended. The Depositor intends to cause each Trust Fund to suspend filing
such reports if and when such reports are no longer required under said Act.

     No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representation other than those contained in this Prospectus and any Prospectus
Supplement with respect hereto and, if given or made, such information or
representations must not be relied upon. This Prospectus and any Prospectus
Supplement with respect hereto do not constitute an offer to sell or a
solicitation of an offer to buy any securities other than the Securities offered
hereby and thereby nor an offer of the Securities to any person in any state or
other jurisdiction in which such offer would be unlawful. The delivery of this
Prospectus at any time does not imply that information herein is correct as of
any time subsequent to its date.

                                       3



<PAGE>

                INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

     All documents subsequently filed by or on behalf of the Trust Fund referred
to in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement with the Commission pursuant to
Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended (the 'Exchange Act'), after the date of this Prospectus and prior to the
termination of any offering of the Securities issued by such Trust Fund shall be
deemed to be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus and to be a part of
this Prospectus from the date of the filing of such documents. Any statement
contained in a document incorporated or deemed to be incorporated by reference
herein shall be deemed to be modified or superseded for all purposes of this
Prospectus to the extent that a statement contained herein (or in the
accompanying Prospectus Supplement) or in any other subsequently filed document
which also is or is deemed to be incorporated by reference modifies or replaces
such statement. Any such statement so modified or superseded shall not be
deemed, except as so modified or superseded, to constitute a part of this
Prospectus.

     The Depositor on behalf of any Trust Fund will provide without charge to
each person to whom this Prospectus is delivered, on the written or oral request
of such person, a copy of any or all of the documents referred to above that
have been or may be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus (not including
exhibits to the information that is incorporated by reference unless such
exhibits are specifically incorporated by reference into the information that
this Prospectus incorporates). Such requests should be directed to the Depositor
at 245 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10167.

                                       4






<PAGE>

                                SUMMARY OF TERMS

     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the
detailed information appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and by reference to
the information with respect to each Series of Securities contained in the
Prospectus Supplement to be prepared and delivered in connection with the
offering of Securities of such Series. Capitalized terms used and not otherwise
defined herein or in the related Prospectus Supplement shall have the meanings
set forth in the 'GLOSSARY OF TERMS' herein.

<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
Securities Offered........................  Asset-Backed Certificates (the 'Certificates') and
                                            Asset-Backed Notes (the 'Notes'). Certificates are
                                            issuable from time to time in Series pursuant to a
                                            Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement. Each
                                            Certificate of a Series will evidence an interest in the
                                            Trust Fund for such Series, or in an Asset Group
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. Notes
                                            are issuable from time to time in Series pursuant to an
                                            Indenture. Each Series of Securities will consist of one
                                            or more Classes, one or more of which may be Classes of
                                            Compound Interest Securities, Planned Amortization Class
                                            ('PAC') Securities, Variable Interest Securities, Zero
                                            Coupon Securities, Principal Only Securities, Interest
                                            Only Securities, Participating Securities, Senior
                                            Securities or Subordinate Securities. Each Class may
                                            differ in, among other things, the amounts allocated to
                                            and the priority of principal and interest payments,
                                            Final Scheduled Distribution Dates, Distribution Dates
                                            and interest rates. The Securities of each Class will be
                                            issued in fully registered form in the denominations
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. If so
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
                                            Securities or certain Classes of such Securities offered
                                            thereby may be available in book-entry form only.

Depositor.................................  Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc. (the
                                            'Depositor') was incorporated in the State of Delaware
                                            in June 1995, and is a wholly-owned, special purpose
                                            subsidiary of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc. None of
                                            The Bear Stearns Companies Inc. nor any other affiliate
                                            of the Depositor, the Servicer, the Trustee or the
                                            Seller has guaranteed or is otherwise obligated with
                                            respect to the Securities of any Series. See 'THE
                                            DEPOSITOR.'

Interest Payments.........................  Interest payments on the Securities of a Series entitled
                                            by their terms to receive interest will be made on each
                                            Distribution Date, to the extent set forth in, and at
                                            the applicable rate specified in (or determined in the
                                            manner set forth in), the related Prospectus Supplement.
                                            The interest rate on Securities of a Series may be
                                            variable or change with changes in the rates of interest
                                            on the related Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the
                                            Private Securities, as applicable and/or as prepayments
                                            occur with respect to such Loans or Underlying Loans, as
                                            applicable. Interest Only Securities may be assigned a
                                            'Notional Amount' set forth in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement which is used solely for convenience in
                                            expressing the calculation of interest and for certain
                                            other purposes and does not represent the right to
                                            receive any distributions allocable to principal.
                                            Principal Only Securities may not be entitled to receive
                                            any interest payments or may be entitled to receive only
                                            nominal interest payments. Interest payable on the
                                            Securities of a Series on a Distribution Date will
                                            include all interest accrued during
</TABLE>

                                       5



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            the period specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES --
                                            Payments of Interest.'

Principal Payments........................  All payments of principal of a Series of Securities will
                                            be made in an aggregate amount determined as set forth
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement and will be paid at
                                            the times and will be allocated among the Classes of
                                            such Series in the order and amounts, and will be
                                            applied either on a pro rata or a random lot basis among
                                            all Securities of any such Class, all as specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement.

Final Scheduled Distribution Date of the
  Securities..............................  The Final Scheduled Distribution Date with respect to
                                            each Class of Notes is the date no later than which
                                            principal thereof will be fully paid and with respect to
                                            each Class of Certificates is the date after which no
                                            Certificates of such Class are expected to remain
                                            outstanding, in each case calculated on the basis of the
                                            assumptions applicable to such Series described in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement. The Final Scheduled
                                            Distribution Date of a Class may equal the maturity date
                                            of the Primary Asset in the related Trust Fund which has
                                            the latest stated maturity or will be determined as
                                            described herein and in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement.

                                            The actual final Distribution Date of the Securities of
                                            a Series will depend primarily upon the rate of payment
                                            (including prepayments, liquidations due to default, the
                                            receipt of proceeds from casualty insurance policies and
                                            repurchases) of the Loans or Underlying Loans relating
                                            to the Private Securities, as applicable, in the related
                                            Trust Fund. Unless otherwise specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement, the actual final Distribution
                                            Date of any Security is likely to occur earlier and may
                                            occur substantially earlier or may occur later than its
                                            Final Scheduled Distribution Date as a result of the
                                            application of prepayments to the reduction of the
                                            principal balances of the Securities and as a result of
                                            defaults on the Primary Assets. The rate of payments on
                                            the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private
                                            Securities, as applicable, in the Trust Fund for a
                                            Series will depend on a variety of factors, including
                                            certain characteristics of such Loans or Underlying
                                            Loans, as applicable, and the prevailing level of
                                            interest rates from time to time, as well as on a
                                            variety of economic, demographic, tax, legal, social and
                                            other factors. No assurance can be given as to the
                                            actual prepayment experience with respect to a Series.
                                            See 'RISK FACTORS -- Yield May Vary' and 'DESCRIPTION OF
                                            THE SECURITIES -- Weighted Average Life of the
                                            Securities' herein.

Optional Termination......................  One or more Classes of Securities of any Series may be
                                            redeemed or repurchased in whole or in part, at the
                                            Depositor's or the Servicer's option, at such time and
                                            under the circumstances specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement, at the price set forth therein.
                                            If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for
                                            a Series of Securities, the Depositor, the Servicer, or
                                            such other entity that is specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement, may, at its option, cause an
                                            early termination of the related Trust Fund by
                                            repurchasing all of the Primary Assets remaining in the
                                            Trust Fund on or after a specified date, or on or after
                                            such time as the aggregate
</TABLE>

                                       6



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            principal balance of the Securities of the Series or the
                                            Primary Assets relating to such Series, as specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement, is less than the
                                            amount or percentage specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES -- Optional
                                            Redemption, Purchase or Termination.'

                                            In addition, the Prospectus Supplement may provide other
                                            circumstances under which Holders of Securities of a
                                            Series could be fully paid significantly earlier than
                                            would otherwise be the case if payments or distributions
                                            were solely based on the activity of the related Primary
                                            Assets.

The Trust Fund............................  The Trust Fund for a Series of Securities will consist
                                            of one or more of the assets described below, as
                                            described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

A. Primary Assets.........................  The Primary Assets for a Series may consist of any
                                            combination of the following assets, to the extent and
                                            as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The
                                            Primary Assets will be purchased from the Seller or may
                                            be purchased by the Depositor in the open market or in
                                            privately negotiated transactions, including
                                            transactions with entities affiliated with the
                                            Depositor.

  (1) Loans...............................  Primary Assets for a Series will consist, in whole or in
                                            part, of Loans. Some Loans may be delinquent or
                                            non-performing as specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. Loans may be originated by or acquired from
                                            an affiliate of the Depositor and an affiliate of the
                                            Depositor may be an obligor with respect to any such
                                            Loan. The Loans will be conventional contracts or
                                            contracts insured by the Federal Housing Administration
                                            ('FHA') or partially guaranteed by the Veterans
                                            Administration ('VA'). See 'The Trust Funds -- The
                                            Loans' for a discussion of such guarantees. To the
                                            extent provided in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            additional Loans may be periodically added to the Trust
                                            Fund, or may be removed from time to time if certain
                                            asset value tests are met, as described in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement.

                                            The 'Loans' for a Series will consist of (i) closed-end
                                            home equity loans (the 'Mortgage Loans') and (ii) home
                                            improvement installment sales contracts and installment
                                            loan agreements (the 'Home Improvement Contracts'). The
                                            Mortgage Loans and the Home Improvement Contracts are
                                            collectively referred to herein as the 'Loans.' Loans
                                            may, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            have various payment characteristics, including balloon
                                            or other irregular payment features, and may accrue
                                            interest at a fixed rate or an adjustable rate. As
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
                                            Mortgage Loans will and the Home Improvement Contracts
                                            may be secured by mortgages and deeds of trust or other
                                            similar security instruments creating a lien on a
                                            Mortgaged Property, which may be subordinated to one or
                                            more senior liens on the Mortgaged Property, as
                                            described in the related Prospectus Supplement. As
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Home
                                            Improvement Contracts may be unsecured or secured by
                                            purchase money security interests in the Home
                                            Improvements financed thereby. The Mortgaged Properties
                                            and the Home Improvements are collectively referred to
                                            herein as the
</TABLE>

                                       7



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            'Properties.' The related Prospectus Supplement will
                                            describe certain characteristics of the Loans for a
                                            Series, including, without limitation, and to the extent
                                            relevant: (a) the aggregate unpaid principal balance of
                                            the Loans (or the aggregate unpaid principal balance
                                            included in the Trust Fund for the related Series);
                                            (b) the range and weighted average Loan Rate on the
                                            Loans and in the case of adjustable rate Loans, the
                                            range and weighted average of the Current Loan Rates and
                                            the Lifetime Rate Caps, if any; (c) the range and the
                                            average outstanding principal balance of the Loans;
                                            (d) the weighted average original and remaining
                                            term-to-stated maturity of the Loans and the range of
                                            original and remaining terms-to-stated maturity, if
                                            applicable; (e) the range and Combined Loan-to-Value
                                            Ratios or Loan-to-Value Ratios, as applicable, of the
                                            Loans, computed in the manner described in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement; (f) the percentage (by principal
                                            balance as of the Cut-off Date) of Loans that accrue
                                            interest at adjustable or fixed interest rates; (g) any
                                            enhancement relating to the Loans; (h) the percentage
                                            (by principal balance as of the Cut-off Date) of Loans
                                            that are secured by Mortgaged Properties, Home
                                            Improvements or are unsecured; (i) the geographic
                                            distribution of any Mortgaged Properties securing the
                                            Loans; (j) the use and type of each Mortgaged Property
                                            securing a Loan; (k) the lien priority of the Loans; and
                                            (l) the delinquency status and year of origination of
                                            the Loans.

  (2) Private Securities..................  Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in whole or in
                                            part, of Private Securities which include (a)
                                            pass-through certificates representing beneficial
                                            interests in loans of the type that would otherwise be
                                            eligible to be Loans (the 'Underlying Loans') or
                                            (b) collateralized obligations secured by Underlying
                                            Loans. Such pass-through certificates or collateralized
                                            obligations will have previously been (a) offered and
                                            distributed to the public pursuant to an effective
                                            registration statement or (b) purchased in a transaction
                                            not involving any public offering from a person who is
                                            not an affiliate of the issuer of such securities at the
                                            time of sale (nor an affiliate thereof at any time
                                            during the three preceding months); provided a period of
                                            three years has elapsed since the later of the date the
                                            securities were acquired from the issuer or an affiliate
                                            thereof. Although individual Underlying Loans may be
                                            insured or guaranteed by the United States or an agency
                                            or instrumentality thereof, they need not be, and the
                                            Private Securities themselves will not be so insured or
                                            guaranteed. See 'The Trust Funds -- Private Securities.'
                                            Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement
                                            relating to a Series of Securities, payments on the
                                            Private Securities will be distributed directly to the
                                            Trustee as registered owner of such Private Securities.
                                            The related Prospectus Supplement for a Series will
                                            specify (such disclosure may be on an approximate basis,
                                            as described above and will be as of the date specified
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement) to the extent
                                            relevant and to the extent such information is
                                            reasonably available to the Depositor and the Depositor
                                            reasonably believes such information to be reliable:
                                            (i) the aggregate approximate principal amount and type
                                            of any Private Securities to be included in the
</TABLE>

                                       8



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Trust Fund for such Series; (ii) certain characteristics
                                            of the Underlying Loans including (A) the payment
                                            features of such Underlying Loans (i.e., whether they
                                            are fixed rate or adjustable rate and whether they
                                            provide for fixed level payments, negative amortization
                                            or other payment features), (B) the approximate
                                            aggregate principal amount of such Underlying Loans
                                            which are insured or guaranteed by a governmental
                                            entity, (C) the servicing fee or range of servicing fees
                                            with respect to such Underlying Loans, (D) the minimum
                                            and maximum stated maturities of such Underlying Loans
                                            at origination, (E) the lien priority of such Underlying
                                            Loans, and (F) the delinquency status and year of
                                            origination of such Underlying Loans; (iii) the maximum
                                            original term-to-stated maturity of the Private
                                            Securities; (iv) the weighted average term-to-stated
                                            maturity of the Private Securities; (v) the
                                            pass-through or certificate rate or ranges thereof for
                                            the Private Securities; (vi) the sponsor or depositor of
                                            the Private Securities (the 'PS Sponsor'), the servicer
                                            of the Private Securities (the 'PS Servicer') and the
                                            trustee of the Private Securities (the 'PS Trustee');
                                            (vii) certain characteristics of enhancement, if any,
                                            such as reserve funds, insurance policies, letters of
                                            credit or guarantees, relating to the Loans underlying
                                            the Private Securities, or to such Private Securities
                                            themselves; (viii) the terms on which the Underlying
                                            Loans may, or are required to, be repurchased prior to
                                            stated maturity; and (ix) the terms on which substitute
                                            Underlying Loans may be delivered to replace those
                                            initially deposited with the PS Trustee. See 'THE TRUST
                                            FUNDS -- The Loans -- Additional Information' herein.

B. Collection and Distribution Accounts...  Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement, all payments on or with respect to the
                                            Primary Assets for a Series will be remitted directly to
                                            an account (the 'Collection Account') to be established
                                            for such Series with the Trustee or the Servicer, in the
                                            name of the Trustee. Unless otherwise provided in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee shall be
                                            required to apply a portion of the amount in the
                                            Collection Account, together with reinvestment earnings
                                            from eligible investments specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement, to the payment of certain amounts
                                            payable to the Servicer under the related Agreement and
                                            any other person specified in the Prospectus Supplement,
                                            and to deposit a portion of the amount in the Collection
                                            Account into a separate account (the 'Distribution
                                            Account') to be established for such Series, each in the
                                            manner and at the times established in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement. All amounts deposited in such
                                            Distribution Account will be available, unless otherwise
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, for
                                            (i) application to the payment of principal of and
                                            interest on such Series of Securities on the next
                                            Distribution Date, (ii) the making of adequate provision
                                            for future payments on certain Classes of Securities and
                                            (iii) any other purpose specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement. After applying the funds in the
                                            Collection Account as described above, any funds
                                            remaining in the Collection Account may be paid over to
                                            the Servicer, the Depositor, any provider of Enhancement
                                            with
</TABLE>

                                       9



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            respect to such Series (an 'Enhancer') or any other
                                            person entitled thereto in the manner and at the times
                                            established in the related Prospectus Supplement.

C. Pre-Funding and Capitalized
   Interest Accounts......................  If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a
                                            Trust Fund will include one or more segregated trust
                                            accounts (each, a 'Pre-Funding Account') established and
                                            maintained with the Trustee for the related Series. If
                                            so specified, on the closing date for such Series, a
                                            portion of the proceeds of the sale of the Securities of
                                            such Series (such amount, the 'Pre-Funded Amount') will
                                            be deposited in the Pre-Funding Account and may be used
                                            to purchase additional Primary Assets during the period
                                            of time, not to exceed three months, specified in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement (the 'Pre-Funding
                                            Period'). The Primary Assets to be so purchased will be
                                            required to have certain characteristics specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement. If any Pre-Funded
                                            Amount remains on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account at
                                            the end of the Pre-Funding Period, such amount will be
                                            applied in the manner specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement to prepay the Notes and/or the
                                            Certificates of the applicable Series. The amount
                                            initially deposited in a pre-funding account for a
                                            Series of Securities will not exceed twenty-five percent
                                            of the aggregate principal amount of such Series of
                                            Securities.

                                            If a Pre-Funding Account is established, one or more
                                            segregated trust accounts (each, a 'Capitalized Interest
                                            Account') may be established and maintained with the
                                            Trustee for the related Series. On the closing date for
                                            such Series, a portion of the proceeds of the sale of
                                            the Securities of such Series will be deposited in the
                                            Capitalized Interest Account and used to fund the
                                            excess, if any, of (x) the sum of (i) the amount of
                                            interest accrued on the Securities of such Series and
                                            (ii) if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            certain fees or expenses during the Pre-Funding Period
                                            such as trustee fees and credit enhancement fees, over
                                            (y) the amount of interest available therefor from the
                                            Primary Assets in the Trust Fund. Any amounts on deposit
                                            in the Capitalized Interest Account at the end of the
                                            Pre-Funding Period that are not necessary for such
                                            purposes will be distributed to the person specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement.

Enhancement...............................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a
                                            Series, the Depositor will obtain an irrevocable letter
                                            of credit, surety bond, certificate insurance policy,
                                            insurance policy or other form of credit support
                                            (collectively, 'Enhancement') in favor of the Trustee on
                                            behalf of the Holders of such Series and any other
                                            person specified in such Prospectus Supplement from an
                                            institution acceptable to the rating agency or agencies
                                            identified in the related Prospectus Supplement as
                                            rating such Series of Securities (collectively, the
                                            'Rating Agency') for the purposes specified in such
                                            Prospectus Supplement. The Enhancement will support the
                                            payments on the Securities and may be used for other
                                            purposes, to the extent and under the conditions
                                            specified in such Prospectus Supplement. See 'Enhancement.'
                                            Enhancement for a Series may include one or
</TABLE>

                                       10



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            more of the following types of Enhancement, or such
                                            other type of Enhancement specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement.

A. Subordinate Securities.................  If stated in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            Enhancement for a Series may consist of one or more
                                            Classes of Subordinate Securities.

                                            The rights of Holders of such Subordinate Securities to
                                            receive distributions on any Distribution Date will be
                                            subordinate in right and priority to the rights of
                                            holders of Senior Securities of the Series, but only to
                                            the extent described in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement.

B. Insurance..............................  If stated in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            Enhancement for a Series may consist of special hazard
                                            insurance policies, bankruptcy bonds and other types of
                                            insurance supporting payments on the Securities.

C. Reserve Funds..........................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor
                                            may deposit cash, a letter or letters of credit,
                                            short-term investments, or other instruments acceptable
                                            to the Rating Agency in one or more reserve funds to be
                                            established in the name of the Trustee (each a 'Reserve
                                            Fund'), which will be used, as specified in such
                                            Prospectus Supplement, by the Trustee to make required
                                            payments of principal of or interest on the Securities
                                            of such Series, to make adequate provision for future
                                            payments on such Securities or for any other purpose
                                            specified in the Agreement, with respect to such Series,
                                            to the extent that funds are not otherwise available. In
                                            the alternative or in addition to such deposit, a
                                            Reserve Fund for a Series may be funded through
                                            application of all or a portion of the excess cash flow
                                            from the Primary Assets for such Series, to the extent
                                            described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

D. Minimum Principal Payment Agreement....  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a
                                            Series of Securities, the Depositor will enter into a
                                            minimum principal payment agreement (the 'Minimum
                                            Principal Payment Agreement') with an entity meeting the
                                            criteria of the Rating Agency, pursuant to which such
                                            entity will provide funds in the event that aggregate
                                            principal payments on the Primary Assets for such Series
                                            are not sufficient to make certain payments, as provided
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement. See 'ENHANCEMENT --
                                            Minimum Principal Payment Agreement.'

E. Deposit Agreement......................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor
                                            and the Trustee will enter into a guaranteed investment
                                            contract or an investment agreement (the 'Deposit
                                            Agreement') pursuant to which all or a portion of
                                            amounts held in the Collection Account, the Distribution
                                            Account or in any Reserve Fund will be invested with the
                                            entity specified in such Prospectus Supplement. The
                                            Trustee will be entitled to withdraw amounts so
                                            invested, plus interest at a rate equal to the Assumed
                                            Reinvestment Rate, in the manner specified in the
                                            Prospectus Supplement. See 'ENHANCEMENT -- Deposit
                                            Agreement.'

Servicing.................................  The Servicer will be responsible for servicing, managing
                                            and making collections on the Loans for a Series. In
                                            addition, the
</TABLE>

                                       11



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Servicer, if so specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement, will act as custodian and will be
                                            responsible for maintaining custody of the Loans and
                                            related documentation on behalf of the Trustee. Advances
                                            with respect to delinquent payments of principal or
                                            interest on a Loan will be made by the Servicer only to
                                            the extent described in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. Such advances will be intended to provide
                                            liquidity only and, unless otherwise specified in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement, reimbursable to the
                                            Servicer from scheduled payments of principal and
                                            interest, late collections, or from the proceeds of
                                            liquidation of the related Loans or from other
                                            recoveries relating to such Loans (including any
                                            insurance proceeds or payments from other credit
                                            support). In performing these functions, the Servicer
                                            will exercise the same degree of skill and care that it
                                            customarily exercises with respect to similar
                                            receivables or Loans owned or serviced by it. Under
                                            certain limited circumstances, the Servicer may resign
                                            or be removed, in which event either the Trustee or a
                                            third-party servicer will be appointed as successor
                                            servicer. The Servicer will receive a periodic fee as
                                            servicing compensation (the 'Servicing Fee') and may, as
                                            specified herein and in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement, receive certain additional compensation. See
                                            'SERVICING OF LOANS -- Servicing Compensation and
                                            Payment of Expenses' herein.

Federal Income Tax Considerations

A. Debt Securities and REMIC Residual
   Securities.............................  If (i) an election is made to treat all or a portion of
                                            a Trust Fund for a Series as a 'real estate mortgage
                                            investment conduit' (a 'REMIC') or (ii) so provided in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement, a Series of
                                            Securities will include one or more Classes of taxable
                                            debt obligations under the Internal Revenue Code of
                                            1986, as amended (the 'Code'). Stated interest with
                                            respect to such Classes of Securities will be reported
                                            by a Holder in accordance with the Holder's method of
                                            accounting except that, in the case of Securities
                                            constituting 'regular interests' in a REMIC ('Regular
                                            Interests'), such interest will be required to be
                                            reported on the accrual method regardless of a Holder's
                                            usual method of accounting. Securities that are Compound
                                            Interest Securities, Zero Coupon Securities or Interest
                                            Only Securities will, and certain other Classes of
                                            Securities may, be issued with original issue discount
                                            that is not de minimis. In such cases, the Holder will
                                            be required to include original issue discount in gross
                                            income as it accrues, which may be prior to the receipt
                                            of cash attributable to such income. If a Security is
                                            issued at a premium, the Holder may be entitled to make
                                            an election to amortize such premium on a constant yield
                                            method.

                                            In the case of a REMIC election, a Class of Securities
                                            may be treated as REMIC 'residual interests' ('Residual
                                            Interest'). A Holder of a Residual Interest will be
                                            required to include in its income its pro rata share of
                                            the taxable income of the REMIC. In certain
                                            circumstances, the Holder of a Residual Interest may
                                            have REMIC taxable income or tax liability attributable
                                            to REMIC taxable income for a particular period in
                                            excess of cash distributions for such period or have an
                                            after-tax return that is less than the after-tax return
                                            on comparable debt instruments. In addition, a portion
</TABLE>

                                       12



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            (or, in some cases, all) of the income from a Residual
                                            Interest (i) may not be subject to offset by losses from
                                            other activities or investments, (ii) for a Holder that
                                            is subject to tax under the Code on unrelated business
                                            taxable income, may be treated as unrelated business
                                            taxable income and (iii) for a foreign holder, may not
                                            qualify for exemption from or reduction of withholding.
                                            In addition, (i) Residual Interests are subject to
                                            transfer restrictions and (ii) certain transfers of
                                            Residual Interests will not be recognized for federal
                                            income tax purposes. Further, individual holders are
                                            subject to limitations on the deductibility of expenses
                                            of the REMIC. See 'CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX
                                            CONSIDERATIONS.'

B. Non-REMIC Pass-Through Securities......  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            the Trust Fund for a Series will be treated as a grantor
                                            trust and will not be classified as an association
                                            taxable as a corporation for federal income tax purposes
                                            and Holders of Securities of such Series ('Pass-Through
                                            Securities') will be treated as owning directly rights
                                            to receive certain payments of interest or principal, or
                                            both on the Primary Assets held in the Trust Fund for
                                            such Series. All income with respect to a Stripped
                                            Security (as defined herein) will be accounted for as
                                            original issue discount and, unless otherwise specified
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement, will be reported
                                            by the Trustee on an accrual basis, which may be prior
                                            to the receipt of cash associated with such income.

C. Owner Trust Securities.................  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the Trust
                                            Fund will be treated as a partnership for purposes of
                                            federal and state income tax. Each Noteholder, by the
                                            acceptance of a Note of a given Series, will agree to
                                            treat such Note as indebtedness, and each
                                            Certificateholder, by the acceptance of a Certificate of
                                            a given Series, will agree to treat the related Trust as
                                            a partnership in which such Certificateholder is a
                                            partner for federal income and state tax purposes.
                                            Alternative characterizations of such Trust and such
                                            Certificates are possible, but would not result in
                                            materially adverse tax consequences to
                                            Certificateholders. See 'CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX
                                            CONSIDERATIONS.'

ERISA Considerations......................  A fiduciary of any employee benefit plan or other
                                            retirement arrangement subject to the Employee
                                            Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
                                            ('ERISA'), or Section 4975 of the Code should carefully
                                            review with its own legal advisors whether the purchase
                                            or holding of Securities will constitute a prohibited
                                            transaction or cause the assets of the Trust Fund to be
                                            considered 'plan assets,' thereby subjecting operation
                                            of the Trust Fund to the prohibited transaction rules
                                            and fiduciary investment standards of ERISA, unless some
                                            exception or exemption is applicable. See 'ERISA
                                            CONSIDERATIONS.'

Legal Investment..........................  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement, Securities of each Series offered by this
                                            Prospectus and the related Prospectus Supplement will
                                            not constitute 'mortgage related securities' under the
                                            Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of 1984
                                            ('SMMEA'). Investors whose investment authority is
                                            subject to legal restrictions should consult their own
                                            legal advisors
</TABLE>

                                       13



<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            to determine whether and to what extent the Securities
                                            constitute legal investments for them. See 'LEGAL
                                            INVESTMENT.'

Use of Proceeds...........................  The Depositor will use the net proceeds from the sale of
                                            each Series for one or more of the following purposes:
                                            (i) to purchase the related Primary Assets, (ii) to
                                            repay indebtedness which has been incurred to obtain
                                            funds to acquire such Primary Assets, (iii) to
                                            establish any Reserve Funds described in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement and (iv) to pay costs of
                                            structuring and issuing such Securities, including the
                                            costs of obtaining Enhancement, if any. If so specified
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement, the purchase of
                                            the Primary Assets for a Series will be effected by an
                                            exchange of Securities with the Seller of such Primary
                                            Assets. See 'USE OF PROCEEDS.'

Ratings...................................  It will be a requirement for issuance of any Series that
                                            the Securities offered by this Prospectus and the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement be rated by at least one
                                            Rating Agency in one of its four highest applicable
                                            rating categories. The rating or ratings applicable to
                                            Securities of each Series offered hereby and by the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement will be as set forth in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement. A securities rating
                                            should be evaluated independently of similar ratings on
                                            different types of securities. A securities rating is
                                            not a recommendation to buy, hold or sell securities and
                                            does not address the effect that the rate of prepayments
                                            on Loans or Underlying Loans relating to Private
                                            Securities, as applicable, for a Series may have on the
                                            yield to investors in the Securities of such Series. See
                                            'RISK FACTORS -- Ratings Are Not Recommendations.'
</TABLE>

                                       14








<PAGE>

                                  RISK FACTORS

     Investors should consider, among other things, the following factors in
connection with the purchase of the Securities.

NO SECONDARY MARKET

     There will be no market for the Securities of any Series prior to the
issuance thereof, and there can be no assurance that a secondary market will
develop or, if it does develop, that it will provide Holders with liquidity of
investment or will continue for the life of the Securities of such Series. The
Underwriter(s) specified in the related Prospectus Supplement expects to make a
secondary market in the Securities, but has no obligation to do so.

PRIMARY ASSETS ARE ONLY SOURCE OF REPAYMENT

     The Depositor does not have, nor is it expected to have, any significant
assets. The Securities of a Series will be payable solely from the assets of the
Trust Fund for such Securities. There will be no recourse to the Depositor or
any other person for any default on the Notes or any failure to receive
distributions on the Certificates. Further, unless otherwise stated in the
related Prospectus Supplement, at the times set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement, certain Primary Assets and/or any balance remaining in the
Collection Account or Distribution Account immediately after making all payments
due on the Securities of such Series and other payments specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, may be promptly released or remitted to the Depositor,
the Servicer, the Enhancer or any other person entitled thereto and will no
longer be available for making payments to Holders. Consequently, Holders of
Securities of each Series must rely solely upon payments with respect to the
Primary Assets and the other assets constituting the Trust Fund for a Series of
Securities, including, if applicable, any amounts available pursuant to any
Enhancement for such Series, for the payment of principal of and interest on the
Securities of such Series.

     Holders of Notes will be required under the Indenture to proceed only
against the Primary Assets and other assets constituting the related Trust Fund
in the case of a default with respect to such Notes and may not proceed against
any assets of the Depositor. There is no assurance that the market value of the
Primary Assets or any other assets for a Series will at any time be equal to or
greater than the aggregate principal amount of the Securities of such Series
then outstanding, plus accrued interest thereon. Moreover, upon an event of
default under the Indenture for a Series of Notes and a sale of the assets in
the Trust Fund or upon a sale of the assets of a Trust Fund for a Series of
Certificates, the Trustee, the Servicer, if any, the Enhancer and any other
service provider specified in the related Prospectus Supplement generally will
be entitled to receive the proceeds of any such sale to the extent of unpaid
fees and other amounts owing to such persons under the related Agreement prior
to distributions to Holders of Securities. Upon any such sale, the proceeds
thereof may be insufficient to pay in full the principal of and interest on the
Securities of such Series.

     The only obligations, if any, of the Depositor with respect to the
Securities of any Series will be pursuant to certain representations and
warranties. See 'THE AGREEMENTS -- Assignment of Primary Assets' herein. The
Depositor does not have, and is not expected in the future to have, any
significant assets with which to meet any obligation to repurchase Primary
Assets with respect to which there has been a breach of any representation or
warranty. If, for example, the Depositor were required to repurchase a Primary
Asset, its only sources of funds to make such repurchase would be from funds
obtained from the enforcement of a corresponding obligation, if any, on the part
of the originator of the Primary Assets, the Servicer or the Seller, as the case
may be, or from a Reserve Fund established to provide funds for such
repurchases.

LIMITED PROTECTION AGAINST LOSSES

     Although any Enhancement is intended to reduce the risk of delinquent
payments or losses to holders of Securities entitled to the benefit thereof, the
amount of such Enhancement will be limited, as set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement, and will decline and could be depleted under certain
circumstances prior to the payment in full of the related Series of Securities,
and as a result Holders may suffer losses. See 'ENHANCEMENT.'

                                       15



<PAGE>

YIELD MAY VARY

     The yield to maturity experienced by a Holder of Securities may be affected
by the rate of payment of principal of the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to
the Private Securities, as applicable. The timing of principal payments of the
Securities of a Series will be affected by a number of factors, including the
following: (i) the extent of prepayments of the Loans or Underlying Loans
relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, which prepayments may be
influenced by a variety of factors; (ii) the manner of allocating principal
payments among the Classes of Securities of a Series as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement; and (iii) the exercise by the party entitled thereto of
any right of optional termination. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES --
Weighted Average Life of the Securities.' Prepayments may also result from
repurchases of Loans or Underlying Loans, as applicable, due to material
breaches of the Seller's or the Depositor's warranties.

     Interest payable on the Securities of a Series on a Distribution Date will
include all interest accrued during the period specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. In the event interest accrues during the calendar month
prior to a Distribution Date, the effective yield to Holders will be reduced
from the yield that would otherwise be obtainable if interest payable on the
Security were to accrue through the day immediately preceding each Distribution
Date, and the effective yield (at par) to Holders will be less than the
indicated coupon rate. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES -- Payments of
Interest.'

PROPERTY VALUES MAY BE INSUFFICIENT

     If the Mortgages in a Trust Fund are primarily junior liens subordinate to
the rights of the mortgagee under the related senior mortgage or mortgages, the
proceeds from any liquidation, insurance or condemnation proceedings will be
available to satisfy the outstanding balance of such junior mortgage only to the
extent that the claims of such senior mortgagees have been satisfied in full,
including any related foreclosure costs. In addition, a junior mortgagee may not
foreclose on the Property securing a junior mortgage unless it forecloses
subject to the senior mortgages, in which case it must either pay the entire
amount due on the senior mortgages to the senior mortgagees at or prior to the
foreclosure sale or undertake the obligation to make payments on the senior
mortgages in the event the mortgagor is in default thereunder. The Trust Fund
will not have any source of funds to satisfy the senior mortgages or make
payments due to the senior mortgagees.

     There are several factors that could adversely affect the value of
Properties such that the outstanding balance of the related Loan, together with
any senior financing on the Properties, would equal or exceed the value of the
Properties. Among the factors that could adversely affect the value of the
Properties are an overall decline in the residential real estate market in the
areas in which the Properties are located or a decline in the general condition
of the Properties as a result of failure of borrowers to maintain adequately the
Properties or of natural disasters that are not necessarily covered by
insurance, such as earthquakes and floods. Any such decline could extinguish the
value of a junior interest in a Property before having any effect on the related
senior interest therein. If such a decline occurs, the actual rates of
delinquencies, foreclosure and losses on the junior Loans could be higher than
those currently experienced in the mortgage lending industry in general.

PRE-FUNDING MAY ADVERSELY AFFECT INVESTMENT

     If a Trust Fund includes a Pre-Funding Account and the principal balance of
additional Loans delivered to the Trust Fund during the Pre-Funding Period is
less than the original Pre-Funded Amount, the Holders of the Securities of the
related Series will receive a prepayment of principal as and to the extent
described in the related Prospectus Supplement. Any such principal prepayment
may adversely affect the yield to maturity of the applicable Securities. Since
prevailing interest rates are subject to fluctuation, there can be no assurance
that investors will be able to reinvest such a prepayment at yields equaling or
exceeding the yields on the related Securities. It is possible that the yield on
any such reinvestment will be lower, and may be significantly lower, than the
yield on the related Securities.

     The ability of a Trust Fund to invest in subsequent Loans during the
related Pre-Funding Period will be dependant on the ability of the Seller to
originate or acquire Loans that satisfy the requirements for transfer to the
Trust Fund. The ability of the Seller to originate or acquire such Loans will be
affected by a variety of social and economic factors, including the prevailing
level of market interest rates, unemployment levels and consumer perceptions of
general economic conditions.

                                       16



<PAGE>

     Although subsequent Loans must satisfy the characteristics described in the
related Prospectus Supplement, such Loans may have been originated more recently
than the Loans originally transferred to the Trust Fund and may be of a lesser
credit quality. As a result, the addition of subsequent Loans may adversely
affect the performance of the related Securities.

POTENTIAL LIABILITY FOR ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS

     Real property pledged as security to a lender may be subject to certain
environmental risks. Under the laws of certain states, contamination of a
property may give rise to a lien on the property to assure the costs of
clean-up. In several states, such a lien has priority over the lien of an
existing mortgage or owner's interest against such property. In addition, under
the laws of some states and under the federal Comprehensive Environmental
Response, Compensation, and Liability Act of 1980 ('CERCLA'), a lender may be
liable, as an 'owner' or 'operator,' for costs of addressing releases or
threatened releases of hazardous substances that require remedy at a property,
if agents or employees of the lender have become sufficiently involved in the
operations of the borrower, regardless of whether or not the environmental
damage or threat was caused by a prior owner. A lender also risks such liability
on foreclosure of the Mortgaged Property.

CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS MAY AFFECT LOANS

     Applicable state laws generally regulate interest rates and other charges
and require certain disclosures. In addition, other state laws, public policy
and general principles of equity relating to the protection of consumers, unfair
and deceptive practices and debt collection practices may apply to the
origination, servicing and collection of the Loans. Depending on the provisions
of the applicable law and the specific facts and circumstances involved,
violations of these laws, policies and principles may limit the ability of the
Servicer to collect all or part of the principal of or interest on the Loans,
may entitle the borrower to a refund of amounts previously paid and, in
addition, could subject the owner of the Loan to damages and administrative
enforcement.

     The Loans are also subject to Federal laws, including:

          (i) the Federal Truth in Lending Act and Regulation Z promulgated
     thereunder, which require certain disclosures to the borrowers regarding
     the terms of the Loans;

          (ii) the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and Regulation B promulgated
     thereunder, which prohibit discrimination on the basis of age, race, color,
     sex, religion, marital status, national origin, receipt of public
     assistance or the exercise of any right under the Consumer Credit
     Protection Act, in the extension of credit; and

          (iii) the Fair Credit Reporting Act, which regulates the use and
     reporting of information related to the borrower's credit experience.

     The Home Improvement Contracts are also subject to the Preservation of
Consumers' Claims and Defenses regulations of the Federal Trade Commission and
other similar federal and state statutes and regulations (collectively, the
'Holder in Due Course Rules'), which protect the homeowner from defective
craftsmanship or incomplete work by a contractor. These laws permit the obligor
to withhold payment if the work does not meet the quality and durability
standards agreed to by the homeowner and the contractor. The Holder in Due
Course Rules have the effect of subjecting any assignee of the seller in a
consumer credit transaction to all claims and defenses which the obligor in the
credit sale transaction could assert against the seller of the goods.

     Violations of certain provisions of these Federal laws may limit the
ability of the Servicer to collect all or part of the principal of or interest
on the Loans and in addition could subject the Trust Fund to damages and
administrative enforcement. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS.'

CONTRACTS WILL NOT BE STAMPED

     In order to give notice of the right, title and interest of Securityholders
to the Home Improvement Contracts, the Depositor will cause a UCC-1 financing
statement to be executed by the Depositor or the Seller identifying the Trustee
as the secured party and identifying all Home Improvement Contracts as
collateral. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Home Improvement Contracts will not be stamped or otherwise marked to reflect
their assignment to the Trust Fund. Therefore, if, through negligence,

                                       17



<PAGE>

fraud or otherwise, a subsequent purchaser were able to take physical possession
of the Home Improvement Contracts without notice of such assignment, the
interest of Securityholders in the Home Improvement Contracts could be defeated.
See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS -- The Home Improvement Contracts.'

RATINGS ARE NOT RECOMMENDATIONS

     It will be a condition to the issuance of a Series of Securities that they
be rated in one of the four highest rating categories by the Rating Agency
identified in the related Prospectus Supplement. Any such rating would be based
on, among other things, the adequacy of the value of the Primary Assets and any
Enhancement with respect to such Series. Such rating should not be deemed a
recommendation to purchase, hold or sell Securities, inasmuch as it does not
address market price or suitability for a particular investor. There is also no
assurance that any such rating will remain in effect for any given period of
time or may not be lowered or withdrawn entirely by the Rating Agency if in its
judgment circumstances in the future so warrant. In addition to being lowered or
withdrawn due to any erosion in the adequacy of the value of the Primary Assets,
such rating might also be lowered or withdrawn, among other reasons, because of
an adverse change in the financial or other condition of an Enhancer or a change
in the rating of such Enhancer's long term debt.

                         DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES

GENERAL

     Each Series of Notes will be issued pursuant to an indenture (the
'Indenture') between the related Trust Fund and the entity named in the related
Prospectus Supplement as trustee (the 'Trustee') with respect to such Series. A
form of Indenture has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus forms a part. The Certificates will also be issued in
Series pursuant to separate agreements (each, a 'Pooling and Servicing
Agreement' or a 'Trust Agreement') among the Depositor, the Servicer, if the
Series relates to Loans, and the Trustee. A form of Pooling and Servicing
Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which
this Prospectus forms a part. A Series may consist of both Notes and
Certificates.

     The Seller may agree to reimburse the Depositor for certain fees and
expenses of the Depositor incurred in connection with the offering of the
Securities.

     The following summaries describe certain provisions in the Agreements
common to each Series of Securities. The summaries do not purport to be complete
and are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety by reference to, the
provisions of the Agreements and the Prospectus Supplement relating to each
Series of Securities. Where particular provisions or terms used in the
Agreements are referred to, the actual provisions (including definitions of
terms) are incorporated herein by reference as part of such summaries.

     Each Series of Securities will consist of one or more Classes of
Securities, one or more of which may be Compound Interest Securities, Variable
Interest Securities, PAC Securities, Zero Coupon Securities, Principal Only
Securities, Interest Only Securities or Participating Securities. A Series may
also include one or more Classes of Subordinate Securities. The Securities of
each Series will be issued only in fully registered form, without coupons, in
the authorized denominations for each Class specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement. Upon satisfaction of the conditions, if any, applicable to a Class
of a Series, as described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the transfer of
the Securities may be registered and the Securities may be exchanged at the
office of the Trustee specified in the Prospectus Supplement without the payment
of any service charge other than any tax or governmental charge payable in
connection with such registration of transfer or exchange. If specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, one or more Classes of a Series may be available
in book-entry form only.

     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, payments of
principal of and interest on a Series of Securities will be made on the
Distribution Dates specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to such
Series by check mailed to Holders of such Series, registered as such at the
close of business on the record date specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement applicable to such Distribution Dates at their addresses appearing on
the security register, except that (a) payments may be made by wire transfer (at
the expense of the Holder requesting payment by wire transfer) in certain
circumstances described in the related Prospectus Supplement and (b) final
payments of principal in retirement of each Security will be made only upon

                                       18



<PAGE>

presentation and surrender of such Security at the office of the Trustee
specified in the Prospectus Supplement. Notice of the final payment on a
Security will be mailed to the Holder of such Security before the Distribution
Date on which the final principal payment on any Security is expected to be made
to the holder of such Security.

     Payments of principal of and interest on the Securities will be made by the
Trustee, or a paying agent on behalf of the Trustee, as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, all payments with respect to the Primary Assets for a Series,
together with reinvestment income thereon, amounts withdrawn from any Reserve
Fund, and amounts available pursuant to any other Enhancement will be deposited
directly into the Collection Account. If provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, such amounts may be net of certain amounts payable to the related
Servicer and any other person specified in the Prospectus Supplement. Such
amounts thereafter will be deposited into the Distribution Account and will be
available to make payments on the Securities of such Series on the next
Distribution Date. See 'THE TRUST FUNDS -- Collection and Distribution
Accounts.'

VALUATION OF THE PRIMARY ASSETS

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Notes,
each Primary Asset included in the related Trust Fund for a Series will be
assigned an initial 'Asset Value.' Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, at any time the Asset Value of the Primary Assets will be
equal to the product of the Asset Value Percentage as set forth in the Indenture
and the lesser of (a) the stream of remaining regularly scheduled payments on
the Primary Assets, net, unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, of certain amounts payable as expenses, together with income earned
on each such scheduled payment received through the day preceding the next
Distribution Date at the Assumed Reinvestment Rate, if any, discounted to
present value at the highest interest rate on the Notes of such Series over
periods equal to the interval between payments on the Notes, and (b) the then
principal balance of the Primary Assets. Unless otherwise specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the initial Asset Value of the Primary Assets
will be at least equal to the principal amount of the Notes of the related
Series at the date of issuance thereof.

     The 'Assumed Reinvestment Rate,' if any, for a Series will be the highest
rate permitted by the Rating Agency or a rate insured by means of a surety bond,
guaranteed investment contract, Deposit Agreement or other arrangement
satisfactory to the Rating Agency. If the Assumed Reinvestment Rate is so
insured, the related Prospectus Supplement will set forth the terms of such
arrangement.

PAYMENTS OF INTEREST

     The Securities of each Class by their terms entitled to receive interest
will bear interest (calculated, unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, on the basis of a 360 day year of twelve 30-day months)
from the date and at the rate per annum specified, or calculated in the method
described, in the related Prospectus Supplement. Interest on such Securities of
a Series will be payable on the Distribution Date specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. The rate of interest on Securities of a Series may be
variable or may change with changes in the annual percentage rates of the Loans
or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable included
in the related Trust Fund and/or as prepayments occur with respect to such Loans
or Underlying Loans, as applicable. Principal Only Securities may not be
entitled to receive any interest distributions or may be entitled to receive
only nominal interest distributions. Any interest on Zero Coupon Securities that
is not paid on the related Distribution Date will accrue and be added to the
principal thereof on such Distribution Date.

     Interest payable on the Securities on a Distribution Date will include all
interest accrued during the period specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement. In the event interest accrues during the calendar month preceding a
Distribution Date, the effective yield to Holders will be reduced from the yield
that would otherwise be obtainable if interest payable on the Securities were to
accrue through the day immediately preceding such Distribution Date.

PAYMENTS OF PRINCIPAL

     On each Distribution Date for a Series, principal payments will be made to
the Holders of the Securities of such Series on which principal is then payable,
to the extent set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement. Such payments will
be made in an aggregate amount determined as specified in the related Prospectus

                                       19



<PAGE>

Supplement and will be allocated among the respective Classes of a Series in the
manner, at the times and in the priority (which may, in certain cases, include
allocation by random lot) set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

FINAL SCHEDULED DISTRIBUTION DATE

     The Final Scheduled Distribution Date with respect to each Class of Notes
is the date no later than which the principal thereof will be fully paid and
with respect to each Class of a Series of Certificates will be the date on which
the entire aggregate principal balance of such Class is expected to be reduced
to zero, in each case calculated on the basis of the assumptions applicable to
such Series described in the related Prospectus Supplement. The Final Scheduled
Distribution Date for each Class of a Series will be specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. Since payments on the Primary Assets will be used to make
distributions in reduction of the outstanding principal amount of the
Securities, it is likely that the actual final Distribution Date of any such
Class will occur earlier, and may occur substantially earlier, than its Final
Scheduled Distribution Date.

     Furthermore, with respect to a Series of Certificates, unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, as a result of delinquencies,
defaults and liquidations of the Primary Assets in the Trust Fund, the actual
final Distribution Date of any Certificate may occur later than its Final
Scheduled Distribution Date. No assurance can be given as to the actual
prepayment experience with respect to a Series. See 'Weighted Average Life of
the Securities' below.

SPECIAL REDEMPTION

     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of
Securities having other than monthly Distribution Dates, one or more Classes of
Securities of such Series may be subject to special redemption, in whole or in
part, on the day specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (a 'Special
Redemption Date') if, as a consequence of prepayments on the Loans or Underlying
Loans, as applicable, relating to such Securities or low yields then available
for reinvestment the entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
determines, based on assumptions specified in the applicable Agreement that the
amount available for the payment of interest that will have accrued on such
Securities (the 'Available Interest Amount') through the designated interest
accrual date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement is less than the
amount of interest that will have accrued on such Securities to such date. In
such event and as further described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Trustee will redeem a principal amount of outstanding Securities of such Series
as will cause the Available Interest Amount to equal the amount of interest that
will have accrued through such designated interest accrual date for such Series
of Securities outstanding immediately after such redemption.

OPTIONAL REDEMPTION, PURCHASE OR TERMINATION

     The Depositor or the Servicer may, at its option, redeem, in whole or in
part, one or more Classes of Notes or purchase one or more Classes of
Certificates of any Series, on any Distribution Date under the circumstances, if
any, specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to such Series.
Alternatively, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series
of Certificates, the Depositor, the Servicer, or another entity designated in
the related Prospectus Supplement may, at its option, cause an early termination
of a Trust Fund by repurchasing all of the Primary Assets from such Trust Fund
on or after a date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, or on or
after such time as the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the
Certificates or Primary Assets, as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement is less than the amount or percentage specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. Notice of such redemption, purchase or termination must
be given by the Depositor or the Trustee prior to the related date. The
redemption, purchase or repurchase price will be set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement. If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in the
event that a REMIC election has been made, the Trustee shall receive a
satisfactory opinion of counsel that the optional redemption, purchase or
termination will be conducted so as to constitute a 'qualified liquidation'
under Section 860F of the Code.

     In addition, the Prospectus Supplement may provide other circumstances
under which Holders of Securities of a Series could be fully paid significantly
earlier than would otherwise be the case if payments or distributions were
solely based on the activity of the related Primary Assets.

                                       20



<PAGE>

WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE SECURITIES

     Weighted average life refers to the average amount of time that will elapse
from the date of issue of a security until each dollar of principal of such
security will be repaid to the investor. Unless otherwise specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the weighted average life of the Securities of a
Class will be influenced by the rate at which the amount financed under the
Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable,
included in the Trust Fund for a Series is paid, which may be in the form of
scheduled amortization or prepayments.

     Prepayments on loans and other receivables can be measured relative to a
prepayment standard or model. The Prospectus Supplement for a Series of
Securities will describe the prepayment standard or model, if any, used and may
contain tables setting forth the projected weighted average life of each Class
of Securities of such Series and the percentage of the original principal amount
of each Class of Securities of such Series that would be outstanding on
specified Distribution Dates for such Series based on the assumptions stated in
such Prospectus Supplement, including assumptions that prepayments on the Loans
or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, included
in the related Trust Fund are made at rates corresponding to various percentages
of the prepayment standard or model specified in such Prospectus Supplement.

     There is, however, no assurance that prepayment of the Loans or Underlying
Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, included in the related
Trust Fund will conform to any level of any prepayment standard or model
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The rate of principal
prepayments on pools of loans may be influenced by a variety of factors,
including job related factors such as transfers, layoffs or promotions and
personal factors such as divorce, disability or prolonged illness. Economic
conditions, either generally or within a particular geographic area or industry,
also may affect the rate of principal prepayments. Demographic and social
factors may influence the rate of principal prepayments in that some borrowers
have greater financial flexibility to move or refinance than do other borrowers.
The deductibility of mortgage interest payments, servicing decisions and other
factors also affect the rate of principal prepayments. As a result, there can be
no assurance as to the rate or timing of principal prepayments of the Loans or
Underlying Loans either from time to time or over the lives of such Loans or
Underlying Loans.

     The rate of prepayments of conventional housing loans and other receivables
has fluctuated significantly in recent years. In general, however, if prevailing
interest rates fall significantly below the interest rates on the Loans or
Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, for a
Series, such loans are likely to prepay at rates higher than if prevailing
interest rates remain at or above the interest rates borne by such loans. In
this regard, it should be noted that the Loans or Underlying Loans, as
applicable, for a Series may have different interest rates. In addition, the
weighted average life of the Securities may be affected by the varying
maturities of the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities,
as applicable. If any Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private
Securities, as applicable, for a Series have actual terms-to-stated maturity of
less than those assumed in calculating the Final Scheduled Distribution Date of
the related Securities, one or more Classes of the Series may be fully paid
prior to their respective Final Scheduled Distribution Date, even in the absence
of prepayments and a reinvestment return higher than the Assumed Reinvestment
Rate.

                                THE TRUST FUNDS

GENERAL

     The Notes of each Series will be secured by the pledge of the assets of the
related Trust Fund, and the Certificates of each Series will represent interests
in the assets of the related Trust Fund. The Trust Fund of each Series will
include assets purchased from the Seller composed of (i) the Primary Assets,
(ii) amounts available from the reinvestment of payments on such Primary Assets
at the Assumed Reinvestment Rate, if any, specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, (iii) any Enhancement, (iv) any Property that secured a Loan but
which is acquired by foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure or repossession
and (v) the amount, if any, initially deposited in the Collection Account or
Distribution Account for a Series as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     The Securities will be non-recourse obligations of the related Trust Fund.
The assets of the Trust Fund specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for
a Series of Securities, unless otherwise specified in the

                                       21



<PAGE>

related Prospectus Supplement, will serve as collateral only for that Series of
Securities. Holders of a Series of Notes may only proceed against such
collateral securing such Series of Notes in the case of a default with respect
to such Series of Notes and may not proceed against any assets of the Depositor
or the related Trust Fund not pledged to secure such Notes.

     The Primary Assets for a Series will be sold by the Seller to the Depositor
or purchased by the Depositor in the open market or in privately negotiated
transactions, which may include transactions with affiliates and will be
transferred by the Depositor to the Trust Fund. Loans relating to a Series will
be serviced by the Servicer, which may be the Seller, specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement, with
respect to a Series of Certificates or a servicing agreement (each, a 'Servicing
Agreement') between the Trust Fund and Servicer, with respect to a Series of
Notes.

     As used herein, 'Agreement' means, with respect to a Series of
Certificates, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement, and with
respect to a Series of Notes, the Indenture and the Servicing Agreement, as the
context requires.

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund relating
to a Series of Securities may be a business trust formed under the laws of the
state specified in the related Prospectus Supplement pursuant to a trust
agreement (each, a 'Trust Agreement') between the Depositor and the trustee of
such Trust Fund specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     With respect to each Trust Fund, prior to the initial offering of the
related Series of Securities, the Trust Fund will have no assets or liabilities.
No Trust Fund is expected to engage in any activities other than acquiring,
managing and holding the related Primary Assets and other assets contemplated
herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement and the proceeds thereof,
issuing Securities and making payments and distributions thereon and certain
related activities. No Trust Fund is expected to have any source of capital
other than its assets and any related Enhancement.

     Primary Assets included in the Trust Fund for a Series may consist of any
combination of Loans and Private Securities, to the extent and as specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.

THE LOANS

     Mortgage Loans. The Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in whole or in
part, of closed-end home equity loans (the 'Mortgage Loans') secured by
mortgages primarily on Single Family Properties which may be subordinated to
other mortgages on the same Mortgaged Property. The Mortgage Loans may have
fixed interest rates or adjustable interest rates and may provide for other
payment characteristics as described below and in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     Unless otherwise described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the full
principal amount of a Mortgage Loan is advanced at origination of the loan and
generally is repayable in equal (or substantially equal) installments of an
amount sufficient to fully amortize such loan at its stated maturity. As more
fully described in the related Prospectus Supplement, interest on each Mortgage
Loan is calculated on the basis of the outstanding principal balance of such
loan multiplied by the Loan Rate thereon and further multiplied by a fraction,
the numerator of which is the number of days in the period elapsed since the
preceding payment of interest was made and the denominator is the number of days
in the annual period for which interest accrues on such loan. Unless otherwise
described in the related Prospectus Supplement the original terms to stated
maturity of Mortgage Loans will not exceed 360 months.

     The Mortgaged Properties will include Single Family Property (i.e., one- to
four-family residential housing, including Condominium Units and Cooperative
Dwellings) and mixed-use property. Mixed-use properties will consist of
structures of no more than three stories, which include one to four residential
dwelling units and space used for retail, professional or other commercial uses.
Such uses, which will not involve more than 50% of the space in the structure,
may include doctor, dentist or law offices, real estate agencies, boutiques,
newsstands, convenience stores or other similar types of uses intended to cater
to individual customers as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The
properties may be located in suburban or metropolitan districts. Any such
non-residential use will be in compliance with local zoning laws and
regulations. The Mortgaged Properties may consist of detached individual
dwellings, individual condominiums, townhouses, duplexes, row houses, individual
units in planned unit developments and other attached dwelling units. Each
Single Family Property will be located on land owned in fee simple by the
borrower or on land leased by the borrower for a term at

                                       22



<PAGE>

least ten years (unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement)
greater than the term of the related Loan. Attached dwellings may include
owner-occupied structures where each borrower owns the land upon which the unit
is built, with the remaining adjacent land owned in common or dwelling units
subject to a proprietary lease or occupancy agreement in a cooperatively owned
apartment building.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Mortgages
on Cooperative Dwellings consist of a lien on the shares issued by such
Cooperative Dwelling and the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement relating
to such Cooperative Dwelling.

     The aggregate principal balance of Mortgage Loans secured by Mortgaged
Properties that are owner-occupied will be disclosed in the related Prospectus
Supplement. Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the sole
basis for a representation that a given percentage of the Mortgage Loans are
secured by Single Family Property that is owner-occupied will be either (i) the
making of a representation by the Mortgagor at origination of the Mortgage Loan
either that the underlying Mortgaged Property will be used by the Mortgagor for
a period of at least six months every year or that the Mortgagor intends to use
the Mortgaged Property as a primary residence, or (ii) a finding that the
address of the underlying Mortgaged Property is the Mortgagor's mailing address
as reflected in the Servicer's records. To the extent specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Mortgaged Properties may include non-owner occupied
investment properties and vacation and second homes.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
initial Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of a Loan is computed in the manner
described in the related Prospectus Supplement, taking into account the amounts
of any related senior mortgage loans.

     Home Improvement Contracts. The Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in
whole or part, of home improvement installment sales contracts and installment
loan agreements (the 'Home Improvement Contracts') originated by a home
improvement contractor in the ordinary course of business. As specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the Home Improvement Contracts will either be
unsecured or secured by the Mortgages primarily on Single Family Properties
which are generally subordinate to other mortgages on the same Mortgaged
Property or by purchase money security interests in the Home Improvements
financed thereby. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable Prospectus
Supplement, the Home Improvement Contracts will be fully amortizing and may have
fixed interest rates or adjustable interest rates and may provide for other
payment characteristics as described below and in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the home
improvements (the 'Home Improvements') securing the Home Improvement Contracts
include, but are not limited to, replacement windows, house siding, new roofs,
swimming pools, satellite dishes, kitchen and bathroom remodeling goods and
solar heating panels. The initial Loan-to-Value Ratio of a Home Improvement
Contract will be computed in the manner described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     Additional Information. The selection criteria which will apply with
respect to the Loans, including, but not limited to, the Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratios or Loan-to-Value Ratios, as applicable, original terms to maturity and
delinquency information, will be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     The Loans for a Series may include Loans that do not amortize their entire
principal balance by their stated maturity in accordance with their terms and
require a balloon payment of the remaining principal balance at maturity, as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. As further described in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the Loans for a Series may include Loans that do
not have a specified stated maturity.

     The Loans will be conventional contracts or contracts insured by the
Federal Housing Administration ('FHA') or partially guaranteed by the Veterans
Administration ('VA'). Loans designated in the related Prospectus Supplement as
insured by the FHA will be insured by the FHA as authorized under the United
States Housing Act of 1937, as amended. Such Loans will be insured under various
FHA programs. These programs generally limit the principal amount and interest
rates of the mortgage loans insured. Loans insured by the FHA generally require
a minimum down payment of approximately 5% of the original principal amount of
the loan. No FHA-insured Loans relating to a Series may have an interest rate or
original principal amount exceeding the applicable FHA limits at the time of
origination of such loan.

     The insurance premiums for Loans insured by the FHA are collected by
lenders approved by the Department of Housing and Urban Development ('HUD') and
are paid to the FHA. The regulations governing FHA single-family mortgage
insurance programs provide that insurance benefits are payable either upon

                                       23



<PAGE>

foreclosure (or other acquisition of possession) and conveyance of the mortgaged
premises to HUD or upon assignment of the defaulted Loan to HUD. With respect to
a defaulted FHA-insured Loan, the Servicer is limited in its ability to initiate
foreclosure proceedings. When it is determined, either by the Servicer or HUD,
that default was caused by circumstances beyond the mortgagor's control, the
Servicer is expected to make an effort to avoid foreclosure by entering, if
feasible, into one of a number of available forms of forbearance plans with the
mortgagor. Such plans may involve the reduction or suspension of regular
mortgage payments for a specified period, with such payments to be made upon or
before the maturity date of the mortgage, or the recasting of payments due under
the mortgage up to or beyond the maturity date. In addition, when a default
caused by such circumstances is accompanied by certain other criteria, HUD may
provide relief by making payments to the Servicer in partial or full
satisfaction of amounts due under the Loan (which payments are to be repaid by
the mortgagor to HUD) or by accepting assignment of the loan from the Servicer.
With certain exceptions, at least three full monthly installments must be due
and unpaid under the Loan and HUD must have rejected any request for relief from
the mortgagor before the Servicer may initiate foreclosure proceedings.

     HUD has the option, in most cases, to pay insurance claims in cash or in
debentures issued by HUD. Currently, claims are being paid in cash, and claims
have not been paid in debentures since 1965. HUD debentures issued in
satisfaction of FHA insurance claims bear interest at the applicable HUD
debenture interest rate. The Servicer of each FHA-insured Loan will be obligated
to purchase any such debenture issued in satisfaction of such Loan upon default
for an amount equal to the principal amount of any such debenture.

     The amount of insurance benefits generally paid by the FHA is equal to the
entire unpaid principal amount of the defaulted Loan adjusted to reimburse the
Servicer for certain costs and expenses and to deduct certain amounts received
or retained by the Servicer after default. When entitlement to insurance
benefits results from foreclosure (or other acquisition of possession) and
conveyance to HUD, the Servicer is compensated for no more than two-thirds of
its foreclosure costs, and is compensated for interest accrued and unpaid prior
to such date but in general only to the extent it was allowed pursuant to a
forbearance plan approved by HUD. When entitlement to insurance benefits results
from assignment of the Loan to HUD, the insurance payment includes full
compensation for interest accrued and unpaid to the assignment date. The
insurance payment itself, upon foreclosure of an FHA-insured Loan, bears
interest from a date 30 days after the mortgagor's first uncorrected failure to
perform any obligation to make any payment due under the Loan and, upon
assignment, from the date of assignment to the date of payment of the claim, in
each case at the same interest rate as the applicable HUD debenture interest
rate as described above.

     Loans designated in the related Prospectus Supplement as guaranteed by the
VA will be partially guaranteed by the VA under the Serviceman's Readjustment
Act of 1944, as amended (a 'VA Guaranty'). The Serviceman's Readjustment Act of
1944, as amended, permits a veteran (or in certain instances the spouse of a
veteran) to obtain a mortgage loan guaranty by the VA covering mortgage
financing of the purchase of a one- to four-family dwelling unit at interest
rates permitted by the VA. The program has no mortgage loan limits, requires no
down payment from the purchaser and permits the guarantee of mortgage loans of
up to 30 years' duration.

     The maximum guaranty that may be issued by the VA under a VA guaranteed
mortgage loan depends upon the original principal amount of the mortgage loan,
as further described in 38 United States Code Section 1803(a), as amended. The
liability on the guaranty is reduced or increased pro rata with any reduction or
increase in the amount of indebtedness, but in no event will the amount payable
on the guaranty exceed the amount of the original guaranty. The VA may, at its
option and without regard to the guaranty, make full payment to a mortgage
holder of unsatisfied indebtedness on a mortgage upon its assignment to the VA.

     With respect to a defaulted VA guaranteed Loan, the Servicer is, absent
exceptional circumstances, authorized to announce its intention to foreclose
only when the default has continued for three months. Generally, a claim for the
guaranty is submitted after liquidation of the Mortgaged Property.

     The amount payable under the guaranty will be the percentage of the
VA-insured Loan originally guaranteed applied to indebtedness outstanding as of
the applicable date of computation specified in the VA regulations. Payments
under the guaranty will be equal to the unpaid principal amount of the loan,
interest accrued on the unpaid balance of the loan to the appropriate date of
computation and limited expenses of the mortgagee, but in each case only to the
extent that such amounts have not been recovered through liquidation of the
Mortgaged Property. The amount payable under the guaranty may in no event exceed
the amount of the original guaranty.

                                       24



<PAGE>

     The related Prospectus Supplement for each Series will provide information
with respect to the Loans that are Primary Assets as of the Cut-off Date,
including, among other things, and to the extent relevant: (a) the aggregate
unpaid principal balance of the Loans; (b) the range and weighted average Loan
Rate on the Loans, and, in the case of adjustable rate Loans, the range and
weighted average of the current Loan Rates and the Lifetime Rate Caps, if any;
(c) the range and average outstanding principal balance of the Loans; (d) the
weighted average original and remaining term-to-stated maturity of the Loans and
the range of original and remaining terms-to-stated maturity, if applicable; (e)
the range and weighted average of Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios or Loan-to-Value
Ratios for the Loans, as applicable; (f) the percentage (by outstanding
principal balance as of the Cut-off Date) of Loans that accrue interest at
adjustable or fixed interest rates; (g) any special hazard insurance policy or
bankruptcy bond or other enhancement relating to the Loans; (h) the percentage
(by principal balance as of the Cut-off Date) of Loans that are secured by
Mortgaged Properties, Home Improvements or are unsecured; (i) the geographic
distribution of any Mortgaged Properties securing the Loans; (j) the percentage
of Loans (by principal balance as of the Cut-off Date) that are secured by
Single Family Properties, shares relating to Cooperative Dwellings, Condominium
Units, investment property and vacation or second homes; (k) the lien priority
of the Loans; and (l) the delinquency status and year of origination of the
Loans. The related Prospectus Supplement will also specify any other limitations
on the types or characteristics of Loans for a Series.

     If information of the nature described above respecting the Loans is not
known to the Depositor at the time the Securities are initially offered,
approximate or more general information of the nature described above will be
provided in the Prospectus Supplement and additional information will be set
forth in a Current Report on Form 8-K to be available to investors on the date
of issuance of the related Series and to be filed with the Commission within 15
days after the initial issuance of such Securities.

PRIVATE SECURITIES

     General. Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in whole or in part, of
Private Securities which include pass-through certificates representing
beneficial interests in loans of the type that would otherwise be eligible to be
Loans (the 'Underlying Loans') or (b) collateralized obligations secured by
Underlying Loans. Such pass-through certificates or collateralized obligations
will have previously been (a) offered and distributed to the public pursuant to
an effective registration statement or (b) purchased in a transaction not
involving any public offering from a person who is not an affiliate of the
issuer of such securities at the time of sale (nor an affiliate thereof at any
time during the three preceding months); provided a period of three years
elapsed since the later of the date the securities were acquired from the issuer
or an affiliate thereof. Although individual Underlying Loans may be insured or
guaranteed by the United States or an agency or instrumentality thereof, they
need not be, and Private Securities themselves will not be so insured or
guaranteed.

     Private Securities will have been issued pursuant to a pooling and
servicing agreement, a trust agreement or similar agreement (a 'PS Agreement').
The seller/servicer of the Underlying Loans will have entered into the PS
Agreement with the trustee under such PS Agreement (the 'PS Trustee'). The PS
Trustee or its agent, or a custodian, will possess the Underlying Loans.
Underlying Loans will be serviced by a servicer (the 'PS Servicer') directly or
by one or more sub-servicers who may be subject to the supervision of the PS
Servicer.

     The sponsor of the Private Securities (the 'PS Sponsor') will be a
financial institution or other entity engaged generally in the business of
lending; a public agency or instrumentality of a state, local or federal
government; or a limited purpose corporation organized for the purpose of, among
other things, establishing trusts and acquiring and selling loans to such
trusts, and selling beneficial interests in such trusts. If so specified in the
Prospectus Supplement, the PS Sponsor may be an affiliate of the Depositor. The
obligations of the PS Sponsor will generally be limited to certain
representations and warranties with respect to the assets conveyed by it to the
related trust. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
the PS Sponsor will not have guaranteed any of the assets conveyed to the
related trust or any of the Private Securities issued under the PS Agreement.
Additionally, although the Underlying Loans may be guaranteed by an agency or
instrumentality of the United States, the Private Securities themselves will not
be so guaranteed.

     Distributions of principal and interest will be made on the Private
Securities on the dates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The
Private Securities may be entitled to receive nominal or no principal
distributions or nominal or no interest distributions. Principal and interest
distributions will be made on the Private Securities by the PS Trustee or the PS
Servicer. The PS Sponsor or the PS Servicer may have the right to

                                       25



<PAGE>

repurchase the Underlying Loans after a certain date or under other
circumstances specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     The Underlying Loans may be fixed rate, level payment, fully amortizing
loans or adjustable rate loans or loans having balloon or other irregular
payment features. Such Underlying Loans will be secured by mortgages on
Mortgaged Properties.

     Credit Support Relating to Private Securities. Credit support in the form
of Reserve Funds, subordination of other private securities issued under the PS
Agreement, guarantees, letters of credit, cash collateral accounts, insurance
policies or other types of credit support may be provided with respect to the
Underlying Loans or with respect to the Private Securities themselves. The type,
characteristics and amount of credit support will be a function of certain
characteristics of the Underlying Loans and other factors and will have been
established for the Private Securities on the basis of requirements of the
nationally recognized statistical rating organization that rated the Private
Securities.

     Additional Information. The Prospectus Supplement for a Series for which
the Primary Assets include Private Securities will specify (such disclosure may
be on an approximate basis and will be as of the date specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement), to the extent relevant and to the extent such
information is reasonably available to the Depositor and the Depositor
reasonably believes such information to be reliable: (i) the aggregate
approximate principal amount and type of the Private Securities to be included
in the Trust Fund for such Series; (ii) certain characteristics of the
Underlying Loans including (A) the payment features of such Underlying Loans
(i.e., whether they are fixed rate or adjustable rate and whether they provide
for fixed level payments or other payment features), (B) the approximate
aggregate principal balance, if known, of such Underlying Loans insured or
guaranteed by a governmental entity, (C) the servicing fee or range of servicing
fees with respect to the Underlying Loans, (D) the minimum and maximum stated
maturities of such Underlying Loans at origination, (E) the lien priority of
such Underlying Loans, and (F) the delinquency status and year of origination of
such Underlying Loans; (iii) the maximum original term-to-stated maturity of the
Private Securities; (iv) the weighted average term-to-stated maturity of the
Private Securities; (v) the pass-through or certificate rate or ranges thereof
for the Private Securities; (vi) the PS Sponsor, the PS Servicer (if other than
the PS Sponsor) and the PS Trustee for such Private Securities; (vii) certain
characteristics of credit support if any, such as Reserve Funds, insurance
policies, letters of credit or guarantees relating to such Loans underlying the
Private Securities or to such Private Securities themselves; (viii) the terms on
which Underlying Loans may, or are required to, be purchased prior to their
stated maturity or the stated maturity of the Private Securities; and (ix) the
terms on which Underlying Loans may be substituted for those originally
underlying the Private Securities.

     If information of the nature described above representing the Private
Securities is not known to the Depositor at the time the Securities are
initially offered, approximate or more general information of the nature
described above will be provided in the Prospectus Supplement and the additional
information, if available, will be set forth in a Current Report on Form 8-K to
be available to investors on the date of issuance of the related Series and to
be filed with the Commission within 15 days of the initial issuance of such
Securities.

COLLECTION AND DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNTS

     A separate Collection Account will be established by the Trustee or the
Servicer, in the name of the Trustee, for each Series of Securities for receipt
of the amount of cash, if any, specified in the related Prospectus Supplement to
be initially deposited therein by the Depositor, all amounts received on or with
respect to the Primary Assets and, unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, income earned thereon. Certain amounts on deposit in such
Collection Account and certain amounts available pursuant to any Enhancement, as
provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, will be deposited in a related
Distribution Account, which will also be established by the Trustee for each
such Series of Securities, for distribution to the related Holders. Unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee will
invest the funds in the Collection and Distribution Accounts in Eligible
Investments maturing, with certain exceptions, not later, in the case of funds
in the Collection Account, than the day preceding the date such funds are due to
be deposited in the Distribution Account or otherwise distributed and, in the
case of funds in the Distribution Account, than the day preceding the next
Distribution Date for the related Series of Securities. Eligible Investments
include, among other investments, obligations of the United States and certain
agencies thereof, federal funds, certificates of deposit, commercial paper,
demand and time deposits and banker's acceptances,

                                       26



<PAGE>

certain repurchase agreements of United States government securities and certain
guaranteed investment contracts, in each case, acceptable to the Rating Agency.

     Notwithstanding any of the foregoing, amounts may be deposited and
withdrawn pursuant to any Deposit Agreement or Minimum Principal Payment
Agreement as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund will
include one or more segregated trust accounts (each, a 'Pre-Funding Account')
established and maintained with the Trustee for the related Series. If so
specified, on the closing date for such Series, a portion of the proceeds of the
sale of the Securities of such Series (such amount, the 'Pre-Funded Amount')
will be deposited in the Pre-Funding Account and may be used to purchase
additional Primary Assets during the period of time specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement (the 'Pre-Funding Period'). The Primary Assets to be so
purchased will be required to have certain characteristics specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement. If any Pre-Funded Amount remains on deposit in
the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the Pre-Funding Period, such amount will
be applied in the manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement to
prepay the Notes and/or the Certificates of the applicable Series.

     If a Pre-Funding Account is established, one or more segregated trust
accounts (each, a 'Capitalized Interest Account') may be established and
maintained with the Trustee for the related Series. On the closing date for such
Series, a portion of the proceeds of the sale of the Securities of such Series
will be deposited in the Capitalized Interest Account and used to fund the
excess, if any, of the sum of (i) the amount of interest accrued on the
Securities of such Series and (ii) if specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, certain fees or expenses during the Pre-Funding Period, over the
amount of interest available therefor from the Primary Assets in the Trust Fund.
Any amounts on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account at the end of the
Pre-Funding Period that are not necessary for such purposes will be distributed
to the person specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

                                  ENHANCEMENT

     If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities,
simultaneously with the Depositor's assignment of the Primary Assets to the
Trustee, the Depositor will obtain an irrevocable letter of credit, surety bond
or insurance policy, issue Subordinate Securities or obtain any other form of
enhancement or combination thereof (collectively, 'Enhancement') in favor of the
Trustee on behalf of the Holders of the related Series or designated Classes of
such Series from an institution or by other means acceptable to the Rating
Agency. The Enhancement will support the payment of principal and interest on
the Securities, and may be applied for certain other purposes to the extent and
under the conditions set forth in such Prospectus Supplement. Enhancement for a
Series may include one or more of the following forms, or such other form as may
be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. If so specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, any of such Enhancement may be structured so as
to protect against losses relating to more than one Trust Fund, in the manner
described therein.

SUBORDINATE SECURITIES

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Enhancement for a Series
may consist of one or more Classes of Subordinate Securities. The rights of
holders of such Subordinate Securities to receive distributions on any
Distribution Date will be subordinate in right and priority to the rights of
Holders of Senior Securities of the Series, but only to the extent described in
the related Prospectus Supplement.

INSURANCE

     If stated in the related Prospectus Supplement, Enhancement for a Series
may consist of special hazard insurance policies, bankruptcy bonds and other
types of insurance relating to the Primary Assets, as described below and in the
related Prospectus Supplement.

     Pool Insurance Policy. If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement
relating to a Series of Securities, the Depositor will obtain a pool insurance
policy for the Loans in the related Trust Fund. The pool insurance policy will
cover any loss (subject to the limitations described in a related Prospectus
Supplement) by reason of default, but will not cover the portion of the
principal balance of any Loan that is required to be covered by any primary

                                       27



<PAGE>

mortgage insurance policy. The amount and terms of any such coverage will be set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Special Hazard Insurance Policy. Although the terms of such policies vary
to some degree, a special hazard insurance policy typically provides that, where
there has been damage to Property securing a defaulted or foreclosed Loan (title
to which has been acquired by the insured) and to the extent such damage is not
covered by the standard hazard insurance policy or any flood insurance policy,
if applicable, required to be maintained with respect to such Property, or in
connection with partial loss resulting from the application of the coinsurance
clause in a standard hazard insurance policy, the special hazard insurer will
pay the lesser of (i) the cost of repair or replacement of such Property or
(ii) upon transfer of such Property to the special hazard insurer, the unpaid
principal balance of such Loan at the time of acquisition of such Property by
foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure, plus accrued interest to the date of
claim settlement and certain expenses incurred by the Servicer with respect to
such Property. If the unpaid principal balance plus accrued interest and certain
expenses is paid by the special hazard insurer, the amount of further coverage
under the special hazard insurance policy will be reduced by such amount less
any net proceeds from the sale of such Property. Any amount paid as the cost of
repair of such Property will reduce coverage by such amount. Special hazard
insurance policies typically do not cover losses occasioned by war, civil
insurrection, certain governmental actions, errors in design, faulty workmanship
or materials (except under certain circumstances), nuclear reaction, flood (if
the mortgaged property is in a federally designated flood area), chemical
contamination and certain other risks.

     Restoration of the Property with the proceeds described under (i) above is
expected to satisfy the condition under any pool insurance policy that such
Property be restored before a claim under such pool insurance policy may be
validly presented with respect to the defaulted Loan secured by such Property.
The payment described under (ii) above will render unnecessary presentation of a
claim in respect of such Loan under any pool insurance policy. Therefore, so
long as such pool insurance policy remains in effect, the payment by the special
hazard insurer of the cost of repair or of the unpaid principal balance of the
related Loan plus accrued interest and certain expenses will not affect the
total insurance proceeds paid to Holders of the Securities, but will affect the
relative amounts of coverage remaining under the special hazard insurance policy
and pool insurance policy.

     Bankruptcy Bond. In the event of a bankruptcy of a borrower, the bankruptcy
court may establish the value of the Property securing the related Loan at an
amount less than the then-outstanding principal balance of such Loan. The amount
of the secured debt could be reduced to such value, and the holder of such Loan
thus would become an unsecured creditor to the extent the outstanding principal
balance of such Loan exceeds the value so assigned to the Property by the
bankruptcy court. In addition, certain other modifications of the terms of a
Loan can result from a bankruptcy proceeding. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF
LOANS.' If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor or
other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement will obtain a
bankruptcy bond or similar insurance contract (the 'bankruptcy bond') covering
losses resulting from proceedings with respect to borrowers under the Bankruptcy
Code. The bankruptcy bond will cover certain losses resulting from a reduction
by a bankruptcy court of scheduled payments of principal of and interest on a
Loan or a reduction by such court of the principal amount of a Loan and will
cover certain unpaid interest on the amount of such a principal reduction from
the date of the filing of a bankruptcy petition.

     The bankruptcy bond will provide coverage in the aggregate amount specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement for all Loans in the Trust Fund for such
Series. Such amount will be reduced by payments made under such bankruptcy bond
in respect of such Loans, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, and will not be restored.

RESERVE FUNDS

     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of
Securities, the Depositor will deposit into one or more funds to be established
with the Trustee as part of the Trust Fund for such Series or for the benefit of
any Enhancer with respect to such Series (the 'Reserve Funds') cash, a letter or
letters of credit, cash collateral accounts, Eligible Investments, or other
instruments meeting the criteria of the Rating Agency rating any Series of the
Securities in the amount specified in such Prospectus Supplement. In the
alternative or in addition to such deposit, a Reserve Fund for a Series may be
funded over time through application of all or a portion of the excess cash flow
from the Primary Assets for such Series, to the extent described in the related
Prospectus Supplement. If applicable, the initial amount of the Reserve Fund and
the Reserve Fund maintenance requirements for a Series of Securities will be
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

                                       28



<PAGE>

     Amounts withdrawn from any Reserve Fund will be applied by the Trustee to
make payments on the Securities of a Series, to pay expenses, to reimburse any
Enhancer or for any other purpose, in the manner and to the extent specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Amounts deposited in a Reserve Fund will be invested by the Trustee, in
Eligible Investments maturing no later than the day specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.

MINIMUM PRINCIPAL PAYMENT AGREEMENT

     If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities,
the Depositor will enter into a Minimum Principal Payment Agreement with an
entity meeting the criteria of the Rating Agency pursuant to which such entity
will provide certain payments on the Securities of such Series in the event that
aggregate scheduled principal payments and/or prepayments on the Primary Assets
for such Series are not sufficient to make certain payments on the Securities of
such Series, as provided in the Prospectus Supplement.

DEPOSIT AGREEMENT

     If specified in a Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor and the Trustee for
such Series of Securities will enter into a Deposit Agreement with the entity
specified in such Prospectus Supplement on or before the sale of such Series of
Securities. The purpose of a Deposit Agreement would be to accumulate available
cash for investment so that such cash, together with income thereon, can be
applied to future distributions on one or more Classes of Securities. The
Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities pursuant to which a Deposit
Agreement is used will contain a description of the terms of such Deposit
Agreement.

                               SERVICING OF LOANS

GENERAL

     Customary servicing functions with respect to Loans comprising the Primary
Assets in the Trust Fund will be provided by the Servicer directly pursuant to
the related Servicing Agreement or Pooling and Servicing Agreement, as the case
may be, with respect to a Series of Securities.

COLLECTION PROCEDURES; ESCROW ACCOUNTS

     The Servicer will make reasonable efforts to collect all payments required
to be made under the Loans and will, consistent with the terms of the related
Agreement for a Series and any applicable Enhancement, follow such collection
procedures as it follows with respect to comparable loans held in its own
portfolio. Consistent with the above, the Servicer may, in its discretion,
(i) waive any assumption fee, late payment charge, or other charge in connection
with a Loan and (ii) to the extent provided in the related Agreement arrange
with an obligor a schedule for the liquidation of delinquencies by extending the
Due Dates for Scheduled Payments on such Loan.

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer, to the
extent permitted by law, will establish and maintain escrow or impound accounts
('Escrow Accounts') with respect to Loans in which payments by obligors to pay
taxes, assessments, mortgage and hazard insurance premiums, and other comparable
items will be deposited. Loans may not require such payments under the loan
related documents, in which case the Servicer would not be required to establish
any Escrow Account with respect to such Loans. Withdrawals from the Escrow
Accounts are to be made to effect timely payment of taxes, assessments and
mortgage and hazard insurance, to refund to obligors amounts determined to be
overages, to pay interest to obligors on balances in the Escrow Account to the
extent required by law, to repair or otherwise protect the property securing the
related Loan and to clear and terminate such Escrow Account. The Servicer will
be responsible for the administration of the Escrow Accounts and generally will
make advances to such accounts when a deficiency exists therein.

DEPOSITS TO AND WITHDRAWALS FROM THE COLLECTION ACCOUNT

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Trustee or the Servicer will establish a separate account (the 'Collection
Account') in the name of the Trustee. Unless otherwise indicated in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Collection Account will be an account maintained
(i) at a depository

                                       29



<PAGE>

institution, the long-term unsecured debt obligations of which at the time of
any deposit therein are rated by each Rating Agency rating the Securities of
such Series at levels satisfactory to each Rating Agency or (ii) in an account
or accounts the deposits in which are insured to the maximum extent available by
the FDIC or which are secured in a manner meeting requirements established by
each Rating Agency.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the funds
held in the Collection Account may be invested, pending remittance to the
Trustee, in Eligible Investments. If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Servicer will be entitled to receive as additional compensation
any interest or other income earned on funds in the Collection Account.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer, the Depositor, the Trustee or the Seller, as appropriate, will deposit
into the Collection Account for each Series on the Business Day following the
Closing Date any amounts representing Scheduled Payments due after the related
Cut-off Date but received by the Servicer on or before the Closing Date, and
thereafter, within two business days after the date of receipt thereof, the
following payments and collections received or made by it (other than, unless
otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, in respect of principal
of and interest on the related Primary Assets due on or before such Cut-off
Date):

          (i) All payments on account of principal, including prepayments, on
     such Primary Assets;

          (ii) All payments on account of interest on such Primary Assets after
     deducting therefrom, at the discretion of the Servicer but only to the
     extent of the amount permitted to be withdrawn or withheld from the
     Collection Account in accordance with the related Agreement, the Servicing
     Fee in respect of such Primary Assets;

          (iii) All amounts received by the Servicer in connection with the
     liquidation of Primary Assets or property acquired in respect thereof,
     whether through foreclosure, sale, repossession or otherwise, including
     payments in connection with such Primary Assets received from the obligor,
     other than amounts required to be paid or refunded to the obligor pursuant
     to the terms of the applicable loan documents or otherwise pursuant to law
     ('Liquidation Proceeds'), exclusive of, in the discretion of the Servicer,
     but only to the extent of the amount permitted to be withdrawn from the
     Collection Account in accordance with the related Agreement, the Servicing
     Fee, if any, in respect of the related Primary Asset;

          (iv) All proceeds under any title insurance, hazard insurance or other
     insurance policy covering any such Primary Asset, other than proceeds to be
     applied to the restoration or repair of the related Property or released to
     the obligor in accordance with the related Agreement;

          (v) All amounts required to be deposited therein from any applicable
     Reserve Fund for such Series pursuant to the related Agreement;

          (vi) All Advances made by the Servicer required pursuant to the
     related Agreement; and (vii) All repurchase prices of any such Primary
     Assets repurchased by the Depositor, the Servicer or the Seller pursuant to
     the related Agreement.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer is permitted, from time to time, to make withdrawals from the
Collection Account for each Series for the following purposes:

          (i) to reimburse itself for Advances for such Series made by it
     pursuant to the related Agreement; the Servicer's right to reimburse itself
     is limited to amounts received on or in respect of particular Loans
     (including, for this purpose, Liquidation Proceeds and amounts representing
     proceeds of insurance policies covering the related Property) which
     represent late recoveries of Scheduled Payments respecting which any such
     Advance was made;

          (ii) to the extent provided in the related Agreement, to reimburse
     itself for any Advances for such Series that the Servicer determines in
     good faith it will be unable to recover from amounts representing late
     recoveries of Scheduled Payments respecting which such Advance was made or
     from Liquidation Proceeds or the proceeds of insurance policies;

          (iii) to reimburse itself from Liquidation Proceeds for liquidation
     expenses and for amounts expended by it in good faith in connection with
     the restoration of damaged Property and, in the event deposited in the
     Collection Account and not previously withheld, and to the extent that
     Liquidation Proceeds after such reimbursement exceed the outstanding
     principal balance of the related Loan, together with accrued and unpaid
     interest thereon to the Due Date for such Loan next succeeding the date of
     its receipt of such

                                       30



<PAGE>

     Liquidation Proceeds, to pay to itself out of such excess the amount of any
     unpaid Servicing Fee and any assumption fees, late payment charges, or
     other charges on the related Loan;

          (iv) in the event it has elected not to pay itself the Servicing Fee
     out of the interest component of any Scheduled Payment, late payment or
     other recovery with respect to a particular Loan prior to the deposit of
     such Scheduled Payment, late payment or recovery into the Collection
     Account, to pay to itself the Servicing Fee, as adjusted pursuant to the
     related Agreement, from any such Scheduled Payment, late payment or such
     other recovery, to the extent permitted by the related Agreement;

          (v) to reimburse itself for expenses incurred by and recoverable by or
     reimbursable to it pursuant to the related Agreement;

          (vi) to pay to the applicable person with respect to each Primary
     Asset or REO Property acquired in respect thereof that has been repurchased
     or removed from the Trust Fund by the Depositor, the Servicer or the Seller
     pursuant to the related Agreement, all amounts received thereon and not
     distributed as of the date on which the related repurchase price was
     determined;

          (vii) to make payments to the Trustee of such Series for deposit into
     the Distribution Account, if any, or for remittance to the Holders of such
     Series in the amounts and in the manner provided for in the related
     Agreement; and

          (viii) to clear and terminate the Collection Account pursuant to the
     related Agreement.

     In addition, if the Servicer deposits in the Collection Account for a
Series any amount not required to be deposited therein, it may, at any time,
withdraw such amount from such Collection Account.

ADVANCES AND LIMITATIONS THEREON

     The related Prospectus Supplement will describe the circumstances, if any,
under which the Servicer will make Advances with respect to delinquent payments
on Loans. If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will
be obligated to make Advances, and such obligation may be limited in amount, or
may not be activated until a certain portion of a specified Reserve Fund is
depleted. Advances are intended to provide liquidity and, except to the extent
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, not to guarantee or insure
against losses. Accordingly, any funds advanced are recoverable by the Servicer
out of amounts received on particular Loans which represent late recoveries of
principal or interest, proceeds of insurance policies or Liquidation Proceeds
respecting which any such Advance was made. If an Advance is made and
subsequently determined to be nonrecoverable from late collections, proceeds of
insurance policies, or Liquidation Proceeds from the related Loan, the Servicer
may be entitled to reimbursement from other funds in the Collection Account or
Distribution Account, as the case may be, or from a specified Reserve Fund as
applicable, to the extent specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

MAINTENANCE OF INSURANCE POLICIES AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES

     Standard Hazard Insurance; Flood Insurance. Except as otherwise specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will be required to maintain
or to cause the obligor on each Loan to maintain a standard hazard insurance
policy providing coverage of the standard form of fire insurance with extended
coverage for certain other hazards as is customary in the state in which the
related Property is located. The standard hazard insurance policies will provide
for coverage at least equal to the applicable state standard form of fire
insurance policy with extended coverage for property of the type securing the
related Loans. In general, the standard form of fire and extended coverage
policy will cover physical damage to or destruction of, the related Property
caused by fire, lightning, explosion, smoke, windstorm, hail, riot, strike and
civil commotion, subject to the conditions and exclusions particularized in each
policy. Because the standard hazard insurance policies relating to the Loans
will be underwritten by different hazard insurers and will cover Properties
located in various states, such policies will not contain identical terms and
conditions. The basic terms, however, generally will be determined by state law
and generally will be similar. Most such policies typically will not cover any
physical damage resulting from war, revolution, governmental actions, floods and
other water-related causes, earth movement (including earthquakes, landslides
and mudflows), nuclear reaction, wet or dry rot, vermin, rodents, insects or
domestic animals, theft and, in certain cases, vandalism. The foregoing list is
merely indicative of certain kinds of uninsured risks and is not intended to be
all inclusive. Uninsured risks not covered

                                       31



<PAGE>

by a special hazard insurance policy or other form of Enhancement will adversely
affect distributions to Holders. When a Property securing a Loan is located in a
flood area identified by HUD pursuant to the Flood Disaster Protection Act of
1973, as amended, the Servicer will be required to cause flood insurance to be
maintained with respect to such Property, to the extent available.

     The standard hazard insurance policies covering Properties securing Loans
typically will contain a 'coinsurance' clause which, in effect, will require the
insured at all times to carry hazard insurance of a specified percentage
(generally 80% to 90%) of the full replacement value of the Property, including
the improvements on any Property, in order to recover the full amount of any
partial loss. If the insured's coverage falls below this specified percentage,
such clause will provide that the hazard insurer's liability in the event of
partial loss will not exceed the greater of (i) the actual cash value (the
replacement cost less physical depreciation) of the Property, including the
improvements, if any, damaged or destroyed or (ii) such proportion of the loss,
without deduction for depreciation, as the amount of insurance carried bears to
the specified percentage of the full replacement cost of such Property and
improvements. Since the amount of hazard insurance to be maintained on the
improvements securing the Loans declines as the principal balances owing thereon
decrease, and since the value of the Properties will fluctuate in value over
time, the effect of this requirement in the event of partial loss may be that
hazard insurance proceeds will be insufficient to restore fully the damage to
the affected Property.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, coverage
will be in an amount at least equal to the greater of (i) the amount necessary
to avoid the enforcement of any co-insurance clause contained in the policy or
(ii) the outstanding principal balance of the related Loan. Unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will also maintain
on REO Property that secured a defaulted Loan and that has been acquired upon
foreclosure, deed in lieu of foreclosure, or repossession, a standard hazard
insurance policy in an amount that is at least equal to the maximum insurable
value of such REO Property. No earthquake or other additional insurance will be
required of any obligor or will be maintained on REO Property acquired in
respect of a defaulted Loan, other than pursuant to such applicable laws and
regulations as shall at any time be in force and shall require such additional
insurance.

     Any amounts collected by the Servicer under any such policies of insurance
(other than amounts to be applied to the restoration or repair of the Property,
released to the obligor in accordance with normal servicing procedures or used
to reimburse the Servicer for amounts to which it is entitled to reimbursement)
will be deposited in the Collection Account. In the event that the Servicer
obtains and maintains a blanket policy insuring against hazard losses on all of
the Loans, written by an insurer then acceptable to each Rating Agency which
assigns a rating to such Series, it will conclusively be deemed to have
satisfied its obligations to cause to be maintained a standard hazard insurance
policy for each Loan or related REO Property. This blanket policy may contain a
deductible clause, in which case the Servicer will be required, in the event
that there has been a loss that would have been covered by such policy absent
such deductible clause, to deposit in the Collection Account the amount not
otherwise payable under the blanket policy because of the application of such
deductible clause.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED LOANS

     The Servicer will use its reasonable best efforts to foreclose upon,
repossess or otherwise comparably convert the ownership of the Properties
securing the related Loans as come into and continue in default and as to which
no satisfactory arrangements can be made for collection of delinquent payments.
In connection with such foreclosure or other conversion, the Servicer will
follow such practices and procedures as it deems necessary or advisable and as
are normal and usual in its servicing activities with respect to comparable
loans serviced by it. However, the Servicer will not be required to expend its
own funds in connection with any foreclosure or towards the restoration of the
Property unless it determines that (i) such restoration or foreclosure will
increase the Liquidation Proceeds in respect of the related Loan available to
the Holders after reimbursement to itself for such expenses and (ii) such
expenses will be recoverable by it either through Liquidation Proceeds or the
proceeds of insurance. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, in the
case of a Trust Fund for which a REMIC election has been made, the Servicer will
be required to liquidate any Property acquired through foreclosure within two
years after the acquisition of the beneficial ownership of such Property. While
the holder of a Property acquired through foreclosure can often maximize its
recovery by providing financing to a new

                                       32



<PAGE>

purchaser, the Trust Fund, if applicable, will have no ability to do so and
neither the Servicer nor the Depositor will be required to do so.

     The Servicer may arrange with the obligor on a defaulted Loan a
modification of such Loan (a 'Modification') to the extent provided in the
related Prospectus Supplement. Such Modifications may only be entered into if
they meet the underwriting policies and procedures employed by the Servicer in
servicing receivables for its own account and meet the other conditions set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

ENFORCEMENT OF DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a
Series, when any Property is about to be conveyed by the obligor, the Servicer
will, to the extent it has knowledge of such prospective conveyance and prior to
the time of the consummation of such conveyance, exercise its rights to
accelerate the maturity of the related Loan under the applicable 'due-on-sale'
clause, if any, unless it reasonably believes that such clause is not
enforceable under applicable law or if the enforcement of such clause would
result in loss of coverage under any primary mortgage insurance policy. In such
event, the Servicer is authorized to accept from or enter into an assumption
agreement with the person to whom such property has been or is about to be
conveyed, pursuant to which such person becomes liable under the Loan and
pursuant to which the original obligor is released from liability and such
person is substituted as the obligor and becomes liable under the Loan. Any fee
collected in connection with an assumption will be retained by the Servicer as
additional servicing compensation. The terms of a Loan may not be changed in
connection with an assumption.

SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

     Except as otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer will be entitled to a periodic fee as servicing compensation (the
'Servicing Fee') in an amount to be determined as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. The Servicing Fee may be fixed or variable, as specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement. In addition, unless otherwise specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will be entitled to servicing
compensation in the form of assumption fees, late payment charges and similar
items, or excess proceeds following disposition of Property in connection with
defaulted Loans.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer will pay certain expenses incurred in connection with the servicing of
the Loans, including, without limitation, the payment of the fees and expenses
of the Trustee and independent accountants, payment of insurance policy premiums
and the cost of credit support, if any, and payment of expenses incurred in
preparation of reports to Holders.

     When an obligor makes a principal prepayment in full between Due Dates on
the related Loan, the obligor will generally be required to pay interest on the
amount prepaid only to the date of prepayment. If and to the extent provided in
the related Prospectus Supplement in order that one or more Classes of the
Holders of a Series will not be adversely affected by any resulting shortfall in
interest, the amount of the Servicing Fee may be reduced to the extent necessary
to include in the Servicer's remittance to the Trustee for deposit into the
Distribution Account an amount equal to one month's interest on the related Loan
(less the Servicing Fee). If the aggregate amount of such shortfalls in a month
exceeds the Servicing Fee for such month, a shortfall to Holders may occur.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement for certain expenses incurred by it
in connection with the liquidation of defaulted Loans. The related Holders will
suffer no loss by reason of such expenses to the extent expenses are covered
under related insurance policies or from excess Liquidation Proceeds. If claims
are either not made or paid under the applicable insurance policies or if
coverage thereunder has been exhausted, the related Holders will suffer a loss
to the extent that Liquidation Proceeds, after reimbursement of the Servicer's
expenses, are less than the outstanding principal balance of and unpaid interest
on the related Loan which would be distributable to Holders. In addition, the
Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement of expenditures incurred by it in
connection with the restoration of property securing a defaulted Loan, such
right of reimbursement being prior to the rights of the Holders to receive any
related proceeds of insurance policies, Liquidation Proceeds or amounts derived
from other Enhancement. The Servicer is generally also entitled to reimbursement
from the Collection Account for Advances.

                                       33



<PAGE>

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the rights
of the Servicer to receive funds from the Collection Account for a Series,
whether as the Servicing Fee or other compensation, or for the reimbursement of
Advances, expenses or otherwise, are not subordinate to the rights of Holders of
such Series.

EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the applicable
Agreement for each Series will provide that each year, a firm of independent
public accountants will furnish a statement to the Trustee to the effect that
such firm has examined certain documents and records relating to the servicing
of the Loans by the Servicer and that, on the basis of such examination, such
firm is of the opinion that the servicing has been conducted in compliance with
such Agreement, except for (i) such exceptions as such firm believes to be
immaterial and (ii) such other exceptions as are set forth in such statement.

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the applicable
Agreement for each Series will also provide for delivery to the Trustee for such
Series of an annual statement signed by an officer of the Servicer to the effect
that the Servicer has fulfilled its obligations under such Agreement throughout
the preceding calendar year.

CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE SERVICER

     The Servicer for each Series will be identified in the related Prospectus
Supplement. The Servicer may be an affiliate of the Depositor and may have other
business relationships with the Depositor and its affiliates.

     If an Event of Default occurs under either a Servicing Agreement or a
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Servicer may be replaced by the Trustee or
a successor Servicer. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, such Events of Default and the rights of the Trustee upon such a
default under the Agreement for the related Series will be substantially similar
to those described under 'THE AGREEMENTS -- Events of Default; Rights Upon Event
of Default -- Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Servicing Agreement' herein.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer does not have the right to assign its rights and delegate its duties
and obligations under the related Agreement for each Series unless the successor
Servicer accepting such assignment or delegation (i) services similar loans in
the ordinary course of its business, (ii) is reasonably satisfactory to the
Trustee for the related Series, (iii) has a net worth of not less than the
amount specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, (iv) would not cause any
Rating Agency's rating of the Securities for such Series in effect immediately
prior to such assignment, sale or transfer to be qualified, downgraded or
withdrawn as a result of such assignment, sale or transfer and (v) executes and
delivers to the Trustee an agreement, in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to the Trustee, which contains an assumption by such Servicer of
the due and punctual performance and observance of each covenant and condition
to be performed or observed by the Servicer under the related Agreement from and
after the date of such agreement. No such assignment will become effective until
the Trustee or a successor Servicer has assumed the servicer's obligations and
duties under the related Agreement. To the extent that the Servicer transfers
its obligations to a wholly-owned subsidiary or affiliate, such subsidiary or
affiliate need not satisfy the criteria set forth above; however, in such
instance, the assigning Servicer will remain liable for the servicing
obligations under the related Agreement. Any entity into which the Servicer is
merged or consolidated or any successor corporation resulting from any merger,
conversion or consolidation will succeed to the Servicer's obligations under the
related Agreement provided that such successor or surviving entity meets the
requirements for a successor Servicer set forth above.

     Except to the extent otherwise provided therein, each Agreement will
provide that neither the Servicer, nor any director, officer, employee or agent
of the Servicer, will be under any liability to the related Trust Fund, the
Depositor or the Holders for any action taken or for failing to take any action
in good faith pursuant to the related Agreement, or for errors in judgment;
provided, however, that neither the Servicer nor any such person will be
protected against any breach of warranty or representations made under such
Agreement or the failure to perform its obligations in compliance with any
standard of care set forth in such Agreement, or liability which would otherwise
be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or negligence in the
performance of their duties or by reason of reckless disregard of their
obligations and duties thereunder. Each Agreement will further provide that the
Servicer and any director, officer, employee or agent of the Servicer is
entitled to

                                       34



<PAGE>

indemnification from the related Trust Fund and will be held harmless against
any loss, liability or expense incurred in connection with any legal action
relating to the Agreement or the Securities, other than any loss, liability or
expense incurred by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or negligence in
the performance of duties thereunder or by reason of reckless disregard of
obligations and duties thereunder. In addition, the related Agreement will
provide that the Servicer is not under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or
defend any legal action which is not incidental to its servicing
responsibilities under such Agreement which, in its opinion, may involve it in
any expense or liability. The Servicer may, in its discretion, undertake any
such action which it may deem necessary or desirable with respect to the related
Agreement and the rights and duties of the parties thereto and the interests of
the Holders thereunder. In such event the legal expenses and costs of such
action and any liability resulting therefrom may be expenses, costs, and
liabilities of the Trust Fund and the Servicer may be entitled to be reimbursed
therefor out of the Collection Account.

                                 THE AGREEMENTS

     The following summaries describe certain provisions of the Agreements. The
summaries do not purport to be complete and are subject to, and qualified in
their entirety by reference to, the provisions of the Agreements. Where
particular provisions or terms used in the Agreements are referred to, such
provisions or terms are as specified in the related Agreements.

ASSIGNMENT OF PRIMARY ASSETS

     General. At the time of issuance of the Securities of a Series, the
Depositor will transfer, convey and assign to the Trust Fund all right, title
and interest of the Depositor in the Primary Assets and other property to be
transferred to the Trust Fund for a Series. Such assignment will include all
principal and interest due on or with respect to the Primary Assets after the
Cut-off Date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (except for any
Retained Interests). The Trustee will, concurrently with such assignment,
execute and deliver the Securities.

     Assignment of Loans. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Depositor will, as to each Loan, deliver or cause to be
delivered to the Trustee, or, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
a custodian on behalf of the Trustee (the 'Custodian'), the Mortgage Note
endorsed without recourse to the order of the Trustee or in blank, the original
Mortgage with evidence of recording indicated thereon (except for any Mortgage
not returned from the public recording office, in which case a copy of such
Mortgage will be delivered, together with a certificate that the original of
such Mortgage was delivered to such recording office) and an assignment of the
Mortgage in recordable form. The Trustee, or, if so specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Custodian, will hold such documents in trust for the
benefit of the Holders.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Depositor will as to each Home Improvement Contract deliver or cause to be
delivered to the Trustee (or the Custodian) the original Home Improvement
Contract and copies of documents and instruments related to each Home
Improvement Contract and, other than in the case of unsecured Home Improvement
Contracts, the security interest in the property securing such Home Improvement
Contract. In order to give notice of the right, title and interest of
Securityholders to the Home Improvement Contracts, the Depositor will cause a
UCC-1 financing statement to be executed by the Depositor or the Seller
identifying the Trustee as the secured party and identifying all Home
Improvement Contracts as collateral. Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Home Improvement Contracts will not be stamped or
otherwise marked to reflect their assignment to the Trust. Therefore, if,
through negligence, fraud or otherwise, a subsequent purchaser were able to take
physical possession of the Home Improvement Contracts without notice of such
assignment, the interest of Securityholders in the Home Improvement Contracts
could be defeated. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS -- The Home Improvement
Contracts.'

     With respect to Loans secured by Mortgages, if so specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor will, at the time of issuance of the
Securities, cause assignments to the Trustee of the Mortgages relating to the
Loans for a Series to be recorded in the appropriate public office for real
property records, except in states where, in the opinion of counsel acceptable
to the Trustee, such recording is not required to protect the Trustee's interest
in the related Loans. If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Depositor will cause such assignments to be so recorded within the time after
issuance of the Securities as is specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
in which event, the Agreement may, as specified in the related Prospectus

                                       35



<PAGE>

Supplement, require the Depositor to repurchase from the Trustee any Loan the
related Mortgage of which is not recorded within such time, at the price
described below with respect to repurchases by reason of defective
documentation. Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement,
the enforcement of the repurchase obligation would constitute the sole remedy
available to the Holders or the Trustee for the failure of a Mortgage to be
recorded.

     Each Loan will be identified in a schedule appearing as an exhibit to the
related Agreement (the 'Loan Schedule'). Such Loan Schedule will specify with
respect to each Loan: the original principal amount and unpaid principal balance
as of the Cut-off Date; the current interest rate; the current Scheduled Payment
of principal and interest; the maturity date, if any, of the related Mortgage
Note; if the Loan is an adjustable rate Loan, the Lifetime Rate Cap, if any, and
the current index.

     Assignment of Private Securities. The Depositor will cause Private
Securities to be registered in the name of the Trustee (or its nominee or
correspondent). The Trustee (or its nominee or correspondent) will have
possession of any certificated Private Securities. Unless otherwise specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee will not be in possession of or
be assignee of record of any underlying assets for a Private Security. See 'THE
TRUST FUNDS -- Private Securities' herein. Each Private Security will be
identified in a schedule appearing as an exhibit to the related Agreement (the
'Certificate Schedule'), which will specify the original principal amount,
outstanding principal balance as of the Cut-off Date, annual pass-through rate
or interest rate and maturity date for each Private Security conveyed to the
Trust Fund. In the Agreement, the Depositor will represent and warrant to the
Trustee regarding the Private Securities: (i) that the information contained in
the Certificate Schedule is true and correct in all material respects; (ii)
that, immediately prior to the conveyance of the Private Securities, the
Depositor had good title thereto, and was the sole owner thereof (subject to any
Retained Interest); (iii) that there has been no other sale by it of such
Private Securities; and (iv) that there is no existing lien, charge, security
interest or other encumbrance (other than any Retained Interest) on such Private
Securities.

     Repurchase and Substitution of Non-Conforming Primary Assets. Unless
otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, if any document in the
file relating to the Primary Assets delivered by the Depositor to the Trustee
(or Custodian) is found by the Trustee within 90 days of the execution of the
related Agreement (or promptly after the Trustee's receipt of any document
permitted to be delivered after the Closing Date) to be defective in any
material respect and the Depositor or Seller does not cure such defect within 90
days, or within such other period specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Depositor or Seller will, not later than 90 days or within such
other period specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, after the Trustee's
notice to the Depositor or the Seller, as the case may be, of the defect,
repurchase the related Primary Asset or any property acquired in respect thereof
from the Trustee at a price equal to, unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, (a) the lesser of (i) the outstanding principal balance
of such Primary Asset and (ii) the Trust Fund's federal income tax basis in the
Primary Asset and (b) accrued and unpaid interest to the date of the next
scheduled payment on such Primary Asset at the rate set forth in the related
Agreement, provided, however, the purchase price shall not be limited in (i)
above to the Trust Fund's federal income tax basis if the repurchase at a price
equal to the outstanding principal balance of such Primary Asset will not result
in any prohibited transaction tax under Section 860F(a) of the Code.

     If provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor or Seller,
as the case may be, may, rather than repurchase the Primary Asset as described
above, remove such Primary Asset from the Trust Fund (the 'Deleted Primary
Asset') and substitute in its place one or more other Primary Assets (each, a
'Qualifying Substitute Primary Asset') provided, however, that (i) with respect
to a Trust Fund for which no REMIC election is made, such substitution must be
effected within 120 days of the date of initial issuance of the Securities and
(ii) with respect to a Trust Fund for which a REMIC election is made, after a
specified time period, the Trustee must have received a satisfactory opinion of
counsel that such substitution will not cause the Trust Fund to lose its status
as a REMIC or otherwise subject the Trust Fund to a prohibited transaction tax.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
Qualifying Substitute Primary Asset will have, on the date of substitution, (i)
an outstanding principal balance, after deduction of all Scheduled Payments due
in the month of substitution, not in excess of the outstanding principal balance
of the Deleted Primary Asset (the amount of any shortfall to be deposited to the
Collection Account in the month of substitution for distribution to Holders),
(ii) an interest rate not less than (and not more than 2% greater than) the
interest rate of the Deleted Primary Asset, (iii) a remaining term-to-stated
maturity not greater than (and not

                                       36



<PAGE>

more than two years less than) that of the Deleted Primary Asset, and will
comply with all of the representations and warranties set forth in the
applicable Agreement as of the date of substitution.

     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
above-described cure, repurchase or substitution obligations constitute the sole
remedies available to the Holders or the Trustee for a material defect in a
document for a Primary Asset.

     The Depositor or another entity will make representations and warranties
with respect to Primary Assets for a Series. If the Depositor or such entity
cannot cure a breach of any such representations and warranties in all material
respects within the time period specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
after notification by the Trustee of such breach, and if such breach is of a
nature that materially and adversely affects the value of such Primary Asset,
the Depositor or such entity is obligated to repurchase the affected Primary
Asset or, if provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, provide a Qualifying
Substitute Primary Asset therefor, subject to the same conditions and
limitations on purchases and substitutions as described above.

     The Depositor's only source of funds to effect any cure, repurchase or
substitution will be through the enforcement of the corresponding obligations,
if any, of the responsible originator or Seller of such Primary Assets. See
'RISK FACTORS -- Primary Assets Are Only Source of Repayment.'

     No Holder of Securities of a Series, solely by virtue of such Holder's
status as a Holder, will have any right under the applicable Agreement for such
Series to institute any proceeding with respect to such Agreement, unless such
Holder previously has given to the Trustee for such Series written notice of
default and unless the Holders of Securities evidencing not less than 51% of the
aggregate voting rights of the Securities for such Series have made written
request upon the Trustee to institute such proceeding in its own name as Trustee
thereunder and have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity, and the Trustee
for 60 days has neglected or refused to institute any such proceeding.

REPORTS TO HOLDERS

     The Trustee or other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
will prepare and forward to each Holder on each Distribution Date, or as soon
thereafter as is practicable, a statement setting forth, to the extent
applicable to any Series, among other things:

          (i) the amount of principal distributed to Holders of the related
     Securities and the outstanding principal balance of such Securities
     following such distribution;

          (ii) the amount of interest distributed to Holders of the related
     Securities and the current interest on such Securities;

          (iii) the amounts of (a) any overdue accrued interest included in such
     distribution, (b) any remaining overdue accrued interest with respect to
     such Securities or (c) any current shortfall in amounts to be distributed
     as accrued interest to Holders of such Securities;

          (iv) the amounts of (a) any overdue payments of scheduled principal
     included in such distribution, (b) any remaining overdue principal amounts
     with respect to such Securities, (c) any current shortfall in receipt of
     scheduled principal payments on the related Primary Assets or (d) any
     realized losses or Liquidation Proceeds to be allocated as reductions in
     the outstanding principal balances of such Securities;

          (v) the amount received under any related Enhancement, and the
     remaining amount available under such Enhancement;

          (vi) the amount of any delinquencies with respect to payments on the
     related Primary Assets;

          (vii) the book value of any REO Property acquired by the related Trust
     Fund; and

          (viii) such other information as specified in the related Agreement.

     In addition, within a reasonable period of time after the end of each
calendar year the Trustee, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, will furnish to each Holder of record at any time during such
calendar year (a) the aggregate of amounts reported pursuant to (i), (ii), and
(iv)(d) above for such calendar year and (b) such information specified in the
related Agreement to enable Holders to prepare their tax returns including,
without limitation, the amount of original issue discount accrued on the
Securities, if applicable. Information in the Distribution Date and annual
statements provided to the Holders will not have been examined and reported upon
by an independent public accountant. However, the Servicer will provide to

                                       37



<PAGE>

the Trustee a report by independent public accountants with respect to the
Servicer's servicing of the Loans. See 'SERVICING OF LOANS -- Evidence as to
Compliance' herein.

     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities,
such Series or one or more Classes of such Series will be issued in book-entry
form. In such event, owners of beneficial interests in such Securities will not
be considered Holders and will not receive such reports directly from the
Trustee. The Trustee will forward such reports only to the entity or its nominee
which is the registered holder of the global certificate which evidences such
book-entry securities. Beneficial owners will receive such reports from the
participants and indirect participants of the applicable book-entry system in
accordance with the practices and procedures of such entities.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT; RIGHTS UPON EVENT OF DEFAULT

     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Servicing Agreement. Unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Events of Default under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement for each Series of Certificates relating to
Loans include (i) any failure by the Servicer to deposit amounts in the
Collection Account and Distribution Account to enable the Trustee to distribute
to Holders of such Series any required payment, which failure continues
unremedied for the number of days specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
after the giving of written notice of such failure to the Servicer by the
Trustee for such Series, or to the Servicer and the Trustee by the Holders of
such Series evidencing not less than 25% of the aggregate voting rights of the
Securities for such Series, (ii) any failure by the Servicer duly to observe or
perform in any material respect any other of its covenants or agreements in the
applicable Agreement which continues unremedied for the number of days specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement after the giving of written notice of such
failure to the Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Servicer and the Trustee by
the Holders of such Series evidencing not less than 25% of the aggregate voting
rights of the Securities for such Series, and (iii) certain events of
insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or
similar proceedings and certain actions by the Servicer indicating its
insolvency, reorganization or inability to pay its obligations.

     So long as an Event of Default remains unremedied under the applicable
Agreement for a Series of Securities relating to the servicing of Loans, unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee for such
Series or Holders of Securities of such Series evidencing not less than 51% of
the aggregate voting rights of the Securities for such Series may terminate all
of the rights and obligations of the Servicer as servicer under the applicable
Agreement (other than its right to recovery of other expenses and amounts
advanced pursuant to the terms of such Agreement which rights the Servicer will
retain under all circumstances), whereupon the Trustee will succeed to all the
responsibilities, duties and liabilities of the Servicer under such Agreement
and will be entitled to reasonable servicing compensation not to exceed the
applicable servicing fee, together with other servicing compensation in the form
of assumption fees, late payment charges or otherwise as provided in such
Agreement.

     In the event that the Trustee is unwilling or unable so to act, it may
select, or petition a court of competent jurisdiction to appoint, a finance
institution, bank or loan servicing institution with a net worth specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement to act as successor Servicer under the
provisions of the applicable Agreement. The successor Servicer would be entitled
to reasonable servicing compensation in an amount not to exceed the Servicing
Fee as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, together with the other
servicing compensation in the form of assumption fees, late payment charges or
otherwise, as provided in such Agreement.

     During the continuance of any Event of Default of a Servicer under an
Agreement for a Series of Securities, the Trustee for such Series will have the
right to take action to enforce its rights and remedies and to protect and
enforce the rights and remedies of the Holders of such Series, and, unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Holders of Securities
evidencing not less than 51% of the aggregate voting rights of the Securities
for such Series may direct the time, method and place of conducting any
proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or
power conferred upon that Trustee. However, the Trustee will not be under any
obligation to pursue any such remedy or to exercise any of such trusts or powers
unless such Holders have offered the Trustee reasonable security or indemnity
against the cost, expenses and liabilities which may be incurred by the Trustee
therein or thereby. The Trustee may decline to follow any such direction if the
Trustee determines that the action or proceeding so directed may not lawfully be
taken or would involve it in personal liability or be unjustly prejudicial to
the nonassenting Holders.

                                       38



<PAGE>

     Indenture. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
Events of Default under the Indenture for each Series of Notes include: (i) a
default for thirty (30) days or more in the payment of any principal of or
interest on any Note of such Series; (ii) failure to perform any other covenant
of the Depositor or the Trust Fund in the Indenture which continues for a period
of sixty (60) days after notice thereof is given in accordance with the
procedures described in the related Prospectus Supplement; (iii) any
representation or warranty made by the Depositor or the Trust Fund in the
Indenture or in any certificate or other writing delivered pursuant thereto or
in connection therewith with respect to or affecting such Series having been
incorrect in a material respect as of the time made, and such breach is not
cured within sixty (60) days after notice thereof is given in accordance with
the procedures described in the related Prospectus Supplement; (iv) certain
events of bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or liquidation of the Depositor
or the Trust Fund; or (v) any other Event of Default provided with respect to
Notes of that Series.

     If an Event of Default with respect to the Notes of any Series at the time
outstanding occurs and is continuing, either the Trustee or the Holders of a
majority of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series
may declare the principal amount (or, if the Notes of that Series are Zero
Coupon Securities, such portion of the principal amount as may be specified in
the terms of that Series, as provided in the related Prospectus Supplement) of
all the Notes of such Series to be due and payable immediately. Such declaration
may, under certain circumstances, be rescinded and annulled by the Holders of a
majority in aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series.

     If, following an Event of Default with respect to any Series of Notes, the
Notes of such Series have been declared to be due and payable, the Trustee may,
in its discretion, notwithstanding such acceleration, elect to maintain
possession of the collateral securing the Notes of such Series and to continue
to apply distributions on such collateral as if there had been no declaration of
acceleration if such collateral continues to provide sufficient funds for the
payment of principal of and interest on the Notes of such Series as they would
have become due if there had not been such a declaration. In addition, the
Trustee may not sell or otherwise liquidate the collateral securing the Notes of
a Series following an Event of Default other than a default in the payment of
any principal or interest on any Note of such Series for thirty (30) days or
more, unless (a) the Holders of 100% of the then aggregate outstanding amount of
the Notes of such Series consent to such sale, (b) the proceeds of such sale or
liquidation are sufficient to pay in full the principal of and accrued interest
due and unpaid on the outstanding Notes of such Series at the date of such sale
or (c) the Trustee determines that such collateral would not be sufficient on an
ongoing basis to make all payments on such Notes as such payments would have
become due if such Notes had not been declared due and payable, and the Trustee
obtains the consent of the Holders of 66 2/3% of the then aggregate outstanding
amount of the Notes of such Series.

     In the event that the Trustee liquidates the collateral in connection with
an Event of Default involving a default for thirty (30) days or more in the
payment of principal of or interest on the Notes of a Series, the Indenture
provides that the Trustee will have a prior lien on the proceeds of any such
liquidation for unpaid fees and expenses. As a result, upon the occurrence of
such an Event of Default, the amount available for distribution to the
Noteholders may be less than would otherwise be the case. However, the Trustee
may not institute a proceeding for the enforcement of its lien except in
connection with a proceeding for the enforcement of the lien of the Indenture
for the benefit of the Noteholders after the occurrence of such an Event of
Default.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in the
event the principal of the Notes of a Series is declared due and payable, as
described above, the Holders of any such Notes issued at a discount from par may
be entitled to receive no more than an amount equal to the unpaid principal
amount thereof less the amount of such discount which is unamortized.

     Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in case an Event of Default shall occur and be continuing with respect
to a Series of Notes, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of
the rights or powers under the Indenture at the request or direction of any of
the Holders of Notes of such Series, unless such Holders offered to the Trustee
security or indemnity satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses and
liabilities which might be incurred by it in complying with such request or
direction. Subject to such provisions for indemnification and certain
limitations contained in the Indenture, the Holders of a majority of the then
aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series shall have the right to
direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy
available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the
Trustee with respect to the Notes of such Series, and the Holders of a majority
of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series may, in
certain cases, waive any default

                                       39



<PAGE>

with respect thereto, except a default in the payment of principal or interest
or a default in respect of a covenant or provision of the Indenture that cannot
be modified without the waiver or consent of all the Holders of the outstanding
Notes of such Series affected thereby.

THE TRUSTEE

     The identity of the commercial bank, savings and loan association or trust
company named as the Trustee for each Series of Securities will be set forth in
the related Prospectus Supplement. The entity serving as Trustee may have normal
banking relationships with the Depositor or the Servicer. In addition, for the
purpose of meeting the legal requirements of certain local jurisdictions, the
Trustee will have the power to appoint co-trustees or separate trustees of all
or any part of the Trust Fund relating to a Series of Securities. In the event
of such appointment, all rights, powers, duties and obligations conferred or
imposed upon the Trustee by the Agreement relating to such Series will be
conferred or imposed upon the Trustee and each such separate trustee or
co-trustee jointly, or, in any jurisdiction in which the Trustee shall be
incompetent or unqualified to perform certain acts, singly upon such separate
trustee or co-trustee who will exercise and perform such rights, powers, duties
and obligations solely at the direction of the Trustee. The Trustee may also
appoint agents to perform any of the responsibilities of the Trustee, which
agents will have any or all of the rights, powers, duties and obligations of the
Trustee conferred on them by such appointment; provided that the Trustee will
continue to be responsible for its duties and obligations under the Agreement.

DUTIES OF THE TRUSTEE

     The Trustee will not make any representations as to the validity or
sufficiency of the Agreement, the Securities or of any Primary Asset or related
documents. If no Event of Default (as defined in the related Agreement) has
occurred, the Trustee is required to perform only those duties specifically
required of it under the Agreement. Upon receipt of the various certificates,
statements, reports or other instruments required to be furnished to it, the
Trustee is required to examine them to determine whether they are in the form
required by the related Agreement. However, the Trustee will not be responsible
for the accuracy or content of any such documents furnished to it by the Holders
or the Servicer under the Agreement.

     The Trustee may be held liable for its own negligent action or failure to
act, or for its own misconduct; provided, however, that the Trustee will not be
personally liable with respect to any action taken, suffered or omitted to be
taken by it in good faith in accordance with the direction of the Holders in an
Event of Default. The Trustee is not required to expend or risk its own funds or
otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of any of its duties
under the Agreement, or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers, if it
has reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate
indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it.

RESIGNATION OF TRUSTEE

     The Trustee may, upon written notice to the Depositor, resign at any time,
in which event the Depositor will be obligated to use its best efforts to
appoint a successor Trustee. If no successor Trustee has been appointed and has
accepted the appointment within 30 days after the giving of such notice of
resignation, the resigning Trustee may petition any court of competent
jurisdiction for appointment of a successor Trustee. The Trustee may also be
removed at any time (i) if the Trustee ceases to be eligible to continue as such
under the Agreement, (ii) if the Trustee becomes insolvent or (iii) by the
Holders of Securities evidencing over 50% of the aggregate voting rights of the
Securities in the Trust Fund upon written notice to the Trustee and to the
Depositor. Any resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a
successor Trustee will not become effective until acceptance of the appointment
by the successor Trustee.

AMENDMENT OF AGREEMENT

     Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the Agreement for
each Series of Securities may be amended by the Depositor, the Servicer (with
respect to a Series relating to Loans), and the Trustee with respect to such
Series, without notice to or consent of the Holders (i) to cure any ambiguity,
(ii) to correct any defective provisions or to correct or supplement any
provision therein, (iii) to add to the duties of the Depositor, the Trust Fund
or Servicer, (iv) to add any other provisions with respect to matters or
questions arising under

                                       40



<PAGE>

such Agreement or related Enhancement, (v) to add or amend any provisions of
such Agreement as required by a Rating Agency in order to maintain or improve
the rating of the Securities (it being understood that none of the Depositor,
the Seller, the Servicer or Trustee is obligated to maintain or improve such
rating), or (vi) to comply with any requirements imposed by the Code; provided
that any such amendment except pursuant to clause (vi) above will not adversely
affect in any material respect the interests of any Holders of such Series, as
evidenced by an opinion of counsel. Any such amendment except pursuant to clause
(vi) of the preceding sentence shall be deemed not to adversely affect in any
material respect the interests of any Holder if the Trustee receives written
confirmation from each Rating Agency rating such Securities that such amendment
will not cause such Rating Agency to reduce the then current rating thereof.
Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the Agreement for each
Series may also be amended by the Trustee, the Servicer, if applicable, and the
Depositor with respect to such Series with the consent of the Holders possessing
not less than 66 2/3% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the
Securities of such Series or, if only certain Classes of such Series are
affected by such amendment, 66 2/3% of the aggregate outstanding principal
amount of the Securities of each Class of such Series affected thereby, for the
purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any
of the provisions of such Agreement or modifying in any manner the rights of
Holders of such Series; provided, however, that no such amendment may
(a) reduce the amount or delay the timing of payments on any Security without
the consent of the Holder of such Security; or (b) reduce the aforesaid
percentage of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of Securities of each
Class, the Holders of which are required to consent to any such amendment
without the consent of the Holders of 100% of the aggregate outstanding
principal amount of each Class of Securities affected thereby.

VOTING RIGHTS

     The related Prospectus Supplement will set forth the method of determining
allocation of voting rights with respect to a Series.

LIST OF HOLDERS

     Upon written request of three or more Holders of record of a Series for
purposes of communicating with other Holders with respect to their rights under
the Agreement, which request is accompanied by a copy of the communication which
such Holders propose to transmit, the Trustee will afford such Holders access
during business hours to the most recent list of Holders of that Series held by
the Trustee.

     No Agreement will provide for the holding of any annual or other meeting of
Holders.

BOOK-ENTRY SECURITIES

     If specified in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities, such
Series or one or more Classes of such Series may be issued in book-entry form.
In such event, beneficial owners of such Securities will not be considered
'Holders' under the Agreements and may exercise the rights of Holders only
indirectly through the participants in the applicable book-entry system.

REMIC ADMINISTRATOR

     For any Series with respect to which a REMIC election is made, preparation
of certain reports and certain other administrative duties with respect to the
Trust Fund may be performed by a REMIC administrator, who may be an affiliate of
the Depositor.

TERMINATION

     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Trust Agreement. The obligations created
by the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement for a Series will
terminate upon the distribution to Holders of all amounts distributable to them
pursuant to such Agreement after the earlier of (i) the later of (a) the final
payment or other liquidation of the last Primary Asset remaining in the Trust
Fund for such Series and (b) the disposition of all property acquired upon
foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure or repossession in respect of any
Primary Asset or (ii) the repurchase, as described below, by the Servicer or
other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement from the Trustee for
such Series of all Primary Assets and other property at that time

                                       41



<PAGE>

subject to such Agreement. The Agreement for each Series permits, but does not
require, the Servicer or other entity specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement to purchase from the Trust Fund for such Series all remaining Primary
Assets at a price equal to, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, 100% of the aggregate Principal Balance of such Primary Assets plus,
with respect to any property acquired in respect of a Primary Asset, if any, the
outstanding Principal Balance of the related Primary Asset at the time of
foreclosure, less, in either case, related unreimbursed Advances (in the case of
the Primary Assets, only to the extent not already reflected in the computation
of the aggregate Principal Balance of such Primary Assets) and unreimbursed
expenses (that are reimbursable pursuant to the terms of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement) plus, in either case, accrued interest thereon at the
weighted average rate on the related Primary Assets through the last day of the
Due Period in which such repurchase occurs; provided, however, that if an
election is made for treatment as a REMIC under the Code, the repurchase price
may equal the greater of (a) 100% of the aggregate Principal Balance of such
Primary Assets, plus accrued interest thereon at the applicable net rates on the
Primary Assets through the last day of the month of such repurchase and (b) the
aggregate fair market value of such Primary Assets plus the fair market value of
any property acquired in respect of a Primary Asset and remaining in the Trust
Fund. The exercise of such right will effect early retirement of the Securities
of such Series, but such entity's right to so purchase is subject to the
aggregate Principal Balance of the Primary Assets at the time of repurchase
being less than a fixed percentage, to be set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement, of the aggregate Principal Balance of the Primary Assets as of the
Cut-off Date. In no event, however, will the trust created by the Agreement
continue beyond the expiration of 21 years from the death of the last survivor
of certain persons identified therein. For each Series, the Servicer or the
Trustee, as applicable, will give written notice of termination of the Agreement
to each Holder, and the final distribution will be made only upon surrender and
cancellation of the Securities at an office or agency specified in the notice of
termination. If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series,
the Depositor or another entity may effect an optional termination of the Trust
Fund under the circumstances described in such Prospectus Supplement. See
'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES -- Optional Redemption, Purchase or Termination'
herein.

     Indenture. The Indenture will be discharged with respect to a Series of
Notes (except with respect to certain continuing rights specified in the
Indenture) upon the delivery to the Trustee for cancellation of all the Notes of
such Series or, with certain limitations, upon deposit with the Trustee of funds
sufficient for the payment in full of all of the Notes of such Series.

     In addition to such discharge with certain limitations, the Indenture will
provide that, if so specified with respect to the Notes of any Series, the
related Trust Fund will be discharged from any and all obligations in respect of
the Notes of such Series (except for certain obligations relating to temporary
Notes and exchange of Notes, to register the transfer of or exchange Notes of
such Series, to replace stolen, lost or mutilated Notes of such Series, to
maintain paying agencies and to hold monies for payment in trust) upon the
deposit with the Trustee, in trust, of money and/or direct obligations of or
obligations guaranteed by the United States of America which, through the
payment of interest and principal in respect thereof in accordance with their
terms, will provide money in an amount sufficient to pay the principal of and
each installment of interest on the Notes of such Series on the Final Scheduled
Distribution Date for such Notes and any installment of interest on such Notes
in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Notes of such Series. In
the event of any such defeasance and discharge of Notes of such Series, holders
of Notes of such Series would be able to look only to such money and/or direct
obligations for payment of principal and interest, if any, on their Notes until
maturity.

                         CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS

     The following discussion contains summaries of certain legal aspects of
mortgage loans, home improvement installment sales contracts and home
improvement installment loan agreements which are general in nature. Because
certain of such legal aspects are governed by applicable state law (which laws
may differ substantially), the summaries do not purport to be complete nor
reflect the laws of any particular state, nor encompass the laws of all states
in which the properties securing the Loans are situated.

MORTGAGES

     The Loans for a Series will, and certain Home Improvement Contracts for a
Series may, be secured by either mortgages or deeds of trust or deeds to secure
debt (such Mortgage Loans and Home Improvement Contracts are hereinafter
referred to in this section as 'mortgage loans'), depending upon the prevailing
practice

                                       42



<PAGE>

in the state in which the property subject to a mortgage loan is located. The
filing of a mortgage, deed of trust or deed to secure debt creates a lien or
title interest upon the real property covered by such instrument and represents
the security for the repayment of an obligation that is customarily evidenced by
a promissory note. It is not prior to the lien for real estate taxes and
assessments or other charges imposed under governmental police powers and may
also be subject to other liens pursuant to the laws of the jurisdiction in which
the Mortgaged Property is located. Priority with respect to such instruments
depends on their terms, the knowledge of the parties to the mortgage and
generally on the order of recording with the applicable state, county or
municipal office. There are two parties to a mortgage, the mortgagor, who is the
borrower/property owner or the land trustee (as described below), and the
mortgagee, who is the lender. Under the mortgage instrument, the mortgagor
delivers to the mortgagee a note or bond and the mortgage. In the case of a land
trust, there are three parties because title to the property is held by a land
trustee under a land trust agreement of which the borrower/property owner is the
beneficiary; at origination of a mortgage loan, the borrower executes a separate
undertaking to make payments on the mortgage note. A deed of trust transaction
normally has three parties: the trustor, who is the borrower/property owner; the
beneficiary, who is the lender; and the trustee, a third-party grantee. Under a
deed of trust, the trustor grants the property, irrevocably until the debt is
paid, in trust, generally with a power of sale, to the trustee to secure payment
of the obligation. The mortgagee's authority under a mortgage and the trustee's
authority under a deed of trust are governed by the law of the state in which
the real property is located, the express provisions of the mortgage or deed of
trust, and, in some cases, in deed of trust transactions, the directions of the
beneficiary.

FORECLOSURE ON MORTGAGES

     Foreclosure of a mortgage is generally accomplished by judicial action.
Generally, the action is initiated by the service of legal pleadings upon all
parties having an interest of record in the real property. Delays in completion
of the foreclosure occasionally may result from difficulties in locating
necessary parties defendant. When the mortgagee's right to foreclosure is
contested, the legal proceedings necessary to resolve the issue can be
time-consuming and expensive. After the completion of a judicial foreclosure
proceeding, the court may issue a judgment of foreclosure and appoint a receiver
or other officer to conduct the sale of the property. In some states, mortgages
may also be foreclosed by advertisement, pursuant to a power of sale provided in
the mortgage. Foreclosure of a mortgage by advertisement is essentially similar
to foreclosure of a deed of trust by nonjudicial power of sale.

     Foreclosure of a deed of trust is generally accomplished by a nonjudicial
trustee's sale under a specific provision in the deed of trust which authorizes
the trustee to sell the property upon any default by the borrower under the
terms of the note or deed of trust. In certain states, such foreclosure also may
be accomplished by judicial action in the manner provided for foreclosure of
mortgages. In some states, the trustee must record a notice of default and send
a copy to the borrower-trustor and to any person who has recorded a request for
a copy of a notice of default and notice of sale. In addition, the trustee in
some states must provide notice to any other individual having an interest in
the real property, including any junior lienholders. If the deed of trust is not
reinstated within any applicable cure period, a notice of sale must be posted in
a public place and, in most states, published for a specified period of time in
one or more newspapers. In addition, some state laws require that a copy of the
notice of sale be posted on the property and sent to all parties having an
interest of record in the property. The trustor, borrower, or any person having
a junior encumbrance on the real estate, may, during a reinstatement period,
cure the default by paying the entire amount in arrears plus the costs and
expenses incurred in enforcing the obligation. Generally, state law controls the
amount of foreclosure expenses and costs, including attorney's fees, which may
be recovered by a lender. If the deed of trust is not reinstated, a notice of
sale must be posted in a public place and, in most states, published for a
specified period of time in one or more newspapers. In addition, some state laws
require that a copy of the notice of sale be posted on the property, recorded
and sent to all parties having an interest in the real property.

     An action to foreclose a mortgage is an action to recover the mortgage debt
by enforcing the mortgagee's rights under the mortgage. It is regulated by
statutes and rules and subject throughout to the court's equitable powers.
Generally, a mortgagor is bound by the terms of the related mortgage note and
the mortgage as made and cannot be relieved from his default if the mortgagee
has exercised his rights in a commercially reasonable manner. However, since a
foreclosure action historically was equitable in nature, the court may exercise
equitable powers to relieve a mortgagor of a default and deny the mortgagee
foreclosure on proof that either the

                                       43



<PAGE>

mortgagor's default was neither willful nor in bad faith or the mortgagee's
action established a waiver, fraud, bad faith, or oppressive or unconscionable
conduct such as to warrant a court of equity to refuse affirmative relief to the
mortgagee. Under certain circumstances a court of equity may relieve the
mortgagor from an entirely technical default where such default was not willful.

     A foreclosure action is subject to most of the delays and expenses of other
lawsuits if defenses or counterclaims are interposed, sometimes requiring up to
several years to complete. Moreover, a non-collusive, regularly conducted
foreclosure sale may be challenged as a fraudulent conveyance, regardless of the
parties' intent, if a court determines that the sale was for less than fair
consideration and such sale occurred while the mortgagor was insolvent and
within one year (or within the state statute of limitations if the trustee in
bankruptcy elects to proceed under state fraudulent conveyance law) of the
filing of bankruptcy. Similarly, a suit against the debtor on the related
mortgage note may take several years and, generally, is a remedy alternative to
foreclosure, the mortgagee being precluded from pursuing both at the same time.

     In the case of foreclosure under either a mortgage or a deed of trust, the
sale by the referee or other designated officer or by the trustee is a public
sale. However, because of the difficulty potential third party purchasers at the
sale have in determining the exact status of title and because the physical
condition of the property may have deteriorated during the foreclosure
proceedings, it is uncommon for a third party to purchase the property at a
foreclosure sale. Rather, it is common for the lender to purchase the property
from the trustee or referee for an amount which may be equal to the unpaid
principal amount of the mortgage note secured by the mortgage or deed of trust
plus accrued and unpaid interest and the expenses of foreclosure, in which event
the mortgagor's debt will be extinguished or the lender may purchase for a
lesser amount in order to preserve its right against a borrower to seek a
deficiency judgment in states where such a judgment is available. Thereafter,
subject to the right of the borrower in some states to remain in possession
during the redemption period, the lender will assume the burdens of ownership,
including obtaining hazard insurance, paying taxes and making such repairs at
its own expense as are necessary to render the property suitable for sale. The
lender will commonly obtain the services of a real estate broker and pay the
broker's commission in connection with the sale of the property. Depending upon
market conditions, the ultimate proceeds of the sale of the property may not
equal the lender's investment in the property. Any loss may be reduced by the
receipt of any mortgage guaranty insurance proceeds.

RIGHTS OF REDEMPTION

     In some states, after sale pursuant to a deed of trust or foreclosure of a
mortgage, the trustor or mortgagor and foreclosed junior lienors are given a
statutory period in which to redeem the property from the foreclosure sale. The
right of redemption should be distinguished from the equity of redemption, which
is a non-statutory right that must be exercised prior to the foreclosure sale.
In some states, redemption may occur only upon payment of the entire principal
balance of the loan, accrued interest and expenses of foreclosure. In other
states, redemption may be authorized if the former borrower pays only a portion
of the sums due. The effect of a statutory right of redemption is to diminish
the ability of the lender to sell the foreclosed property. The exercise of a
right of redemption would defeat the title of any purchaser at a foreclosure
sale, or of any purchaser from the lender subsequent to foreclosure or sale
under a deed of trust. Consequently the practical effect of a right of
redemption is to force the lender to retain the property and pay the expenses of
ownership until the redemption period has run. In some states, there is no right
to redeem property after a trustee's sale under a deed of trust.

JUNIOR MORTGAGES; RIGHTS OF SENIOR MORTGAGES

     The mortgage loans comprising or underlying the Primary Assets included in
the Trust Fund for a Series will be secured by mortgages or deeds of trust which
may be second or more junior mortgages to other mortgages held by other lenders
or institutional investors. The rights of the Trust Fund (and therefore the
Holders), as mortgagee under a junior mortgage, are subordinate to those of the
mortgagee under the senior mortgage, including the prior rights of the senior
mortgagee to receive hazard insurance and condemnation proceeds and to cause the
property securing the mortgage loan to be sold upon default of the mortgagor,
thereby extinguishing the junior mortgagee's lien unless the junior mortgagee
asserts its subordinate interest in the property in foreclosure litigation and,
possibly, satisfies the defaulted senior mortgage. A junior mortgagee may
satisfy a defaulted senior loan in full and, in some states, may cure such
default and bring the senior loan current, in either event adding the amounts
expended to the balance due on the junior loan. In most states,

                                       44



<PAGE>

absent a provision in the mortgage or deed of trust, no notice of default is
required to be given to a junior mortgagee.

     The standard form of the mortgage used by most institutional lenders
confers on the mortgagee the right both to receive all proceeds collected under
any hazard insurance policy and all awards made in connection with condemnation
proceedings, and to apply such proceeds and awards to any indebtedness secured
by the mortgage, in such order as the mortgagee may determine. Thus, in the
event improvements on the property are damaged or destroyed by fire or other
casualty, or in the event the property is taken by condemnation, the mortgagee
or beneficiary under underlying senior mortgages will have the prior right to
collect any insurance proceeds payable under a hazard insurance policy and any
award of damages in connection with the condemnation and to apply the same to
the indebtedness secured by the senior mortgages. Proceeds in excess of the
amount of senior mortgage indebtedness, in most cases, may be applied to the
indebtedness of a junior mortgage.

     Another provision sometimes found in the form of the mortgage or deed of
trust used by institutional lenders obligates the mortgagor to pay before
delinquency all taxes and assessments on the property and, when due, all
encumbrances, charges and liens on the property which appear prior to the
mortgage or deed of trust, to provide and maintain fire insurance on the
property, to maintain and repair the property and not to commit or permit any
waste thereof, and to appear in and defend any action or proceeding purporting
to affect the property or the rights of the mortgagee under the mortgage. Upon a
failure of the mortgagor to perform any of these obligations, the mortgagee is
given the right under certain mortgages to perform the obligation itself, at its
election, with the mortgagor agreeing to reimburse the mortgagee for any sums
expended by the mortgagee on behalf of the mortgagor. All sums so expended by
the mortgagee become part of the indebtedness secured by the mortgage.

ANTI-DEFICIENCY LEGISLATION AND OTHER LIMITATIONS ON LENDERS

     Certain states have imposed statutory prohibitions which limit the remedies
of a beneficiary under a deed of trust or a mortgagee under a mortgage. In some
states, statutes limit the right of the beneficiary or mortgagee to obtain a
deficiency judgment against the borrower following foreclosure or sale under a
deed of trust. A deficiency judgment is a personal judgment against the former
borrower equal in most cases to the difference between the net amount realized
upon the public sale of the real property and the amount due to the lender.
Other statutes require the beneficiary or mortgagee to exhaust the security
afforded under a deed of trust or mortgage by foreclosure in an attempt to
satisfy the full debt before bringing a personal action against the borrower. In
certain other states, the lender has the option of bringing a personal action
against the borrower on the debt without first exhausting such security;
however, in some of these states, the lender, following judgment on such
personal action, may be deemed to have elected a remedy and may be precluded
from exercising remedies with respect to the security. Consequently, the
practical effect of the election requirement, when applicable, is that lenders
will usually proceed first against the security rather than bringing a personal
action against the borrower. Finally, other statutory provisions limit any
deficiency judgment against the former borrower following a foreclosure sale to
the excess of the outstanding debt over the fair market value of the property at
the time of the public sale. The purpose of these statutes is generally to
prevent a beneficiary or a mortgagee from obtaining a large deficiency judgment
against the former borrower as a result of low or no bids at the foreclosure
sale.

     In addition to laws limiting or prohibiting deficiency judgments, numerous
other statutory provisions, including the federal bankruptcy laws, the Federal
Soldiers' and Sailors' Relief Act and state laws affording relief to debtors,
may interfere with or affect the ability of the secured lender to realize upon
collateral and/or enforce a deficiency judgment. For example, with respect to
federal bankruptcy law, the filing of a petition acts as a stay against the
enforcement of remedies for collection of a debt. Moreover, a court with federal
bankruptcy jurisdiction may permit a debtor through a Chapter 13 Bankruptcy Code
rehabilitative plan to cure a monetary default with respect to a loan on a
debtor's residence by paying arrearages within a reasonable time period and
reinstating the original loan payment schedule even though the lender
accelerated the loan and the lender has taken all steps to realize upon his
security (provided no sale of the property has yet occurred) prior to the filing
of the debtor's Chapter 13 petition. Some courts with federal bankruptcy
jurisdiction have approved plans, based on the particular facts of the
reorganization case, that effected the curing of a loan default by permitting
the obligor to pay arrearages over a number of years.

                                       45



<PAGE>

     Courts with federal bankruptcy jurisdiction have also indicated that the
terms of a mortgage loan may be modified if the borrower has filed a petition
under Chapter 13. These courts have suggested that such modifications may
include reducing the amount of each monthly payment, changing the rate of
interest, altering the repayment schedule and reducing the lender's security
interest to the value of the residence, thus leaving the lender a general
unsecured creditor for the difference between the value of the residence and the
outstanding balance of the loan. Federal bankruptcy law and limited case law
indicate that the foregoing modifications could not be applied to the terms of a
loan secured by property that is the principal residence of the debtor. In all
cases, the secured creditor is entitled to the value of its security plus
post-petition interest, attorney's fees and costs to the extent the value of the
security exceeds the debt.

     In a Chapter 11 case under the Bankruptcy Code, the lender is precluded
from foreclosing without authorization from the bankruptcy court. The lender's
lien may be transferred to other collateral and/or be limited in amount to the
value of the lender's interest in the collateral as of the date of the
bankruptcy. The loan term may be extended, the interest rate may be adjusted to
market rates and the priority of the loan may be subordinated to bankruptcy
court-approved financing. The bankruptcy court can, in effect, invalidate
due-on-sale clauses through confirmed Chapter 11 plans of reorganization.

     The Bankruptcy Code provides priority to certain tax liens over the
lender's security. This may delay or interfere with the enforcement of rights in
respect of a defaulted Loan. In addition, substantive requirements are imposed
upon lenders in connection with the origination and the servicing of mortgage
loans by numerous federal and some state consumer protection laws. The laws
include the federal Truth-in-Lending Act, Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act,
Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Fair Credit Billing Act, Fair Credit Reporting Act
and related statutes and regulations. These federal laws impose specific
statutory liabilities upon lenders who originate loans and who fail to comply
with the provisions of the law. In some cases, this liability may affect
assignees of the loans.

DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES IN MORTGAGE LOANS

     Due-on-sale clauses permit the lender to accelerate the maturity of the
loan if the borrower sells or transfers, whether voluntarily or involuntarily,
all or part of the real property securing the loan without the lender's prior
written consent. The enforceability of these clauses has been the subject of
legislation or litigation in many states, and in some cases, typically involving
single family residential mortgage transactions, their enforceability has been
limited or denied. In any event, the Garn-St Germain Depository Institutions Act
of 1982 (the 'Garn-St Germain Act') preempts state constitutional, statutory and
case law that prohibits the enforcement of due-on-sale clauses and permits
lenders to enforce these clauses in accordance with their terms, subject to
certain exceptions. As a result, due-on-sale clauses have become generally
enforceable except in those states whose legislatures exercised their authority
to regulate the enforceability of such clauses with respect to mortgage loans
that were (i) originated or assumed during the 'window period' under the Garn-St
Germain Act which ended in all cases not later than October 15, 1982, and
(ii) originated by lenders other than national banks, federal savings
institutions and federal credit unions. FHLMC has taken the position in its
published mortgage servicing standards that, out of a total of eleven 'window
period states,' five states (Arizona, Michigan, Minnesota, New Mexico and Utah)
have enacted statutes extending, on various terms and for varying periods, the
prohibition on enforcement of due-on-sale clauses with respect to certain
categories of window period loans. Also, the Garn-St Germain Act does
'encourage' lenders to permit assumption of loans at the original rate of
interest or at some other rate less than the average of the original rate and
the market rate.

     In addition, under federal bankruptcy law, due-on-sale clauses may not be
enforceable in bankruptcy proceedings and may, under certain circumstances, be
eliminated in any modified mortgage resulting from such bankruptcy proceeding.

ENFORCEABILITY OF PREPAYMENT AND LATE PAYMENT FEES

     Forms of notes, mortgages and deeds of trust used by lenders may contain
provisions obligating the borrower to pay a late charge if payments are not
timely made, and in some circumstances may provide for prepayment fees or
penalties if the obligation is paid prior to maturity. In certain states, there
are or may be specific limitations, upon the late charges which a lender may
collect from a borrower for delinquent payments. Certain states also limit the
amounts that a lender may collect from a borrower as an additional charge if the

                                       46



<PAGE>

loan is prepaid. Late charges and prepayment fees are typically retained by
servicers as additional servicing compensation.

EQUITABLE LIMITATIONS ON REMEDIES

     In connection with lenders' attempts to realize upon their security, courts
have invoked general equitable principles. The equitable principles are
generally designed to relieve the borrower from the legal effect of his defaults
under the loan documents. Examples of judicial remedies that have been fashioned
include judicial requirements that the lender undertake affirmative and
expensive actions to determine the causes of the borrower's default and the
likelihood that the borrower will be able to reinstate the loan. In some cases,
courts have substituted their judgment for the lender's judgment and have
required that lenders reinstate loans or recast payment schedules in order to
accommodate borrowers who are suffering from temporary financial disability. In
other cases, courts have limited the right of a lender to realize upon his
security if the default under the security agreement is not monetary, such as
the borrower's failure to adequately maintain the property or the borrower's
execution of secondary financing affecting the property. Finally, some courts
have been faced with the issue of whether or not federal or state constitutional
provisions reflecting due process concerns for adequate notice require that
borrowers under security agreements receive notices in addition to the
statutorily-prescribed minimums. For the most part, these cases have upheld the
notice provisions as being reasonable or have found that, in cases involving the
sale by a trustee under a deed of trust or by a mortgagee under a mortgage
having a power of sale, there is insufficient state action to afford
constitutional protections to the borrower.

     Most conventional single-family mortgage loans may be prepaid in full or in
part without penalty. The regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision (the
'OTS') prohibit the imposition of a prepayment penalty or equivalent fee for or
in connection with the acceleration of a loan by exercise of a due-on-sale
clause. A mortgagee to whom a prepayment in full has been tendered may be
compelled to give either a release of the mortgage or an instrument assigning
the existing mortgage. The absence of a restraint on prepayment, particularly
with respect to mortgage loans having higher mortgage rates, may increase the
likelihood of refinancing or other early retirements of such mortgage loans.

APPLICABILITY OF USURY LAWS

     Title V of the Depository Institutions Deregulation and Monetary Control
Act of 1980, enacted in March 1980 ('Title V'), provides that state usury
limitations shall not apply to certain types of residential first mortgage loans
originated by certain lenders after March 31, 1980. Similar federal statutes
were in effect with respect to mortgage loans made during the first three months
of 1980. The OTS, as successor to the Federal Home Loan Bank Board, is
authorized to issue rules and regulations and to publish interpretations
governing implementation of Title V. Title V authorizes any state to reimpose
interest rate limits by adopting, before April 1, 1983, a state law, or by
certifying that the voters of such state have voted in favor of any provision,
constitutional or otherwise, which expressly rejects an application of the
federal law. Fifteen states adopted such a law prior to the April 1, 1983
deadline. In addition, even where Title V is not so rejected, any state is
authorized by the law to adopt a provision limiting discount points or other
charges on mortgage loans covered by Title V.

THE HOME IMPROVEMENT CONTRACTS

     General. The Home Improvement Contracts, other than those Home Improvement
Contracts that are unsecured or secured by mortgages on real estate (such Home
Improvement Contracts are hereinafter referred to in this section as
'contracts') generally are 'chattel paper' or constitute 'purchase money
security interests' each as defined in the Uniform Commercial Code (the 'UCC').
Pursuant to the UCC, the sale of chattel paper is treated in a manner similar to
perfection of a security interest in chattel paper. Under the related Agreement,
the Depositor will transfer physical possession of the contracts to the Trustee
or a designated custodian or may retain possession of the contracts as custodian
for the Trustee. In addition, the Depositor will make an appropriate filing of a
UCC-1 financing statement in the appropriate states to give notice of the
Trustee's ownership of the contracts. Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the contracts will not be stamped or otherwise marked to
reflect their assignment from the Depositor to the Trustee. Therefore, if

                                       47



<PAGE>

through negligence, fraud or otherwise, a subsequent purchaser were able to take
physical possession of the contracts without notice of such assignment, the
Trustee's interest in the contracts could be defeated.

     Security Interests in Home Improvements. The contracts that are secured by
the Home Improvements financed thereby grant to the originator of such contracts
a purchase money security interest in such Home Improvements to secure all or
part of the purchase price of such Home Improvements and related services. A
financing statement generally is not required to be filed to perfect a purchase
money security interest in consumer goods. Such purchase money security
interests are assignable. In general, a purchase money security interest grants
to the holder a security interest that has priority over a conflicting security
interest in the same collateral and the proceeds of such collateral. However, to
the extent that the collateral subject to a purchase money security interest
becomes a fixture, in order for the related purchase money security interest to
take priority over a conflicting interest in the fixture, the holder's interest
in such Home Improvement must generally be perfected by a timely fixture filing.
In general, under the UCC, a security interest does not exist under the UCC in
ordinary building material incorporated into an improvement on land. Home
Improvement Contracts that finance lumber, bricks, other types of ordinary
building material or other goods that are deemed to lose such characterization,
upon incorporation of such materials into the related property, will not be
secured by a purchase money security interest in the Home Improvement being
financed.

     Enforcement of Security Interest in Home Improvements. So long as the Home
Improvement has not become subject to the real estate law, a creditor can
repossess a Home Improvement securing a contract by voluntary surrender, by
'self-help' repossession that is 'peaceful' (i.e., without breach of the peace)
or, in the absence of voluntary surrender and the ability to repossess without
breach of the peace, by judicial process. The holder of a contract must give the
debtor a number of days' notice, which varies from 10 to 30 days depending on
the state, prior to commencement of any repossession. The UCC and consumer
protection laws in most states place restrictions on repossession sales,
including requiring prior notice to the debtor and commercial reasonableness in
effecting such a sale. The law in most states also requires that the debtor be
given notice of any sale prior to resale of the unit that the debtor may redeem
it at or before such resale.

     Under the laws applicable in most states, a creditor is entitled to obtain
a deficiency judgement from a debtor for any deficiency on repossession and
resale of the property securing the debtor's loan. However, some states impose
prohibitions or limitations on deficiency judgements, and in many cases the
defaulting borrower would have no assets with which to pay a judgement.

     Certain other statutory provisions, including federal and state bankruptcy
and insolvency laws and general equitable principles, may limit or delay the
ability of a lender to repossess and resell collateral or enforce a deficiency
judgement.

     Consumer Protection Laws. The so-called 'Holder-in-Due-Course' rule of the
Federal Trade Commission is intended to defeat the ability of the transferor of
a consumer credit contract which is the seller of goods which gave rise to the
transaction (and certain related lenders and assignees) to transfer such
contract free of notice of claims by the debtor thereunder. The effect of this
rule is to subject the assignee of such a contract to all claims and defenses
which the debtor could assert against the seller of goods. Liability under this
rule is limited to amounts paid under a contract; however, the obligor also may
be able to assert the rule to set off remaining amounts due as a defense against
a claim brought by the Trustee against such obligor. Numerous other federal and
state consumer protection laws impose requirements applicable to the origination
and lending pursuant to the contracts, including the Truth in Lending Act, the
Federal Trade Commission Act, the Fair Credit Billing Act, the Fair Credit
Reporting Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Debt Collection
Practices Act and the Uniform Consumer Credit Code. In the case of some of these
laws, the failure to comply with their provisions may affect the enforceability
of the related contract.

     Applicability of Usury Laws. Title V provides that, subject to the
following conditions, state usury limitations shall not apply to any contract
which is secured by a first lien on certain kinds of consumer goods. The
contracts would be covered if they satisfy certain conditions, among other
things, governing the terms of any prepayments, late charges and deferral fees
and requiring a 30-day notice period prior to instituting any action leading to
repossession of the related unit.

     Title V authorized any state to reimpose limitations on interest rates and
finance charges by adopting before April 1, 1983 a law or constitutional
provision which expressly rejects application of the federal law. Fifteen states
adopted such a law prior to the April 1, 1983 deadline. In addition, even where
Title V was not so

                                       48



<PAGE>

rejected, any state is authorized by the law to adopt a provision limiting
discount points or other charges on loans covered by Title V.

INSTALLMENT SALES CONTRACTS

     The Loans may also consist of installment sales contracts. Under an
installment sales contract ('Installment Sales Contract') the seller
(hereinafter referred to in this section as the 'lender') retains legal title to
the property and enters into an agreement with the purchaser (hereinafter
referred to in this section as the 'borrower') for the payment of the purchase
price, plus interest, over the term of such contract. Only after full
performance by the borrower of the contract is the lender obligated to convey
title to the property to the purchaser. As with mortgage or deed of trust
financing, during the effective period of the Installment Sales Contract, the
borrower is generally responsible for maintaining the property in good condition
and for paying real estate taxes, assessments and hazard insurance premiums
associated with the property.

     The method of enforcing the rights of the lender under an Installment Sales
Contract varies on a state-by-state basis depending upon the extent to which
state courts are willing, or able pursuant to state statute, to enforce the
contract strictly according to the terms. The terms of Installment Sales
Contracts generally provide that upon a default by the borrower, the borrower
loses his or her right to occupy the property, the entire indebtedness is
accelerated, and the buyer's equitable interest in the property is forfeited.
The lender in such a situation does not have to foreclose in order to obtain
title to the property, although in some cases a quiet title action is in order
if the borrower has filed the Installment Sales Contract in local land records
and an ejectment action may be necessary to recover possession. In a few states,
particularly in cases of borrower default during the early years of an
Installment Sales Contract, the courts will permit ejectment of the buyer and a
forfeiture of his or her interest in the property. However, most state
legislatures have enacted provisions by analogy to mortgage law protecting
borrowers under Installment Sales Contracts from the harsh consequences of
forfeiture. Under such statutes, a judicial or nonjudicial foreclosure may be
required, the lender may be required to give notice of default and the borrower
may be granted some grace period during which the Installment Sales Contract may
be reinstated upon full payment of the default amount and the borrower may have
a post-foreclosure statutory redemption right. In other states, courts in equity
may permit a borrower with significant investment in the property under an
Installment Sales Contract for the sale of real estate to share in the proceeds
of sale of the property after the indebtedness is repaid or may otherwise refuse
to enforce the forfeiture clause. Nevertheless, generally speaking, the lender's
procedures for obtaining possession and clear title under an Installment Sales
Contract in a given state are simpler and less time-consuming and costly than
are the procedures for foreclosing and obtaining clear title to a property
subject to one or more liens.

SOLDIERS' AND SAILORS' CIVIL RELIEF ACT OF 1940

     Under the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940, members of all
branches of the military on active duty, including draftees and reservists in
military service, (i) are entitled to have interest rates reduced and capped at
6% per annum, on obligations (including Loans) incurred prior to the
commencement of military service for the duration of military service, (ii) may
be entitled to a stay of proceedings on any kind of foreclosure or repossession
action in the case of defaults on such obligations entered into prior to
military service for the duration of military service and (iii) may have the
maturity of such obligations incurred prior to military service extended, the
payments lowered and the payment schedule readjusted for a period of time after
the completion of military service. However, the benefits of (i), (ii), or (iii)
above are subject to challenge by creditors and if, in the opinion of the court,
the ability of a person to comply with such obligations is not materially
impaired by military service, the court may apply equitable principles
accordingly. If a borrower's obligation to repay amounts otherwise due on a Loan
included in a Trust Fund for a Series is relieved pursuant to the Soldiers' and
Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940, none of the Trust Fund, the Servicer, the
Depositor nor the Trustee will be required to advance such amounts, and any loss
in respect thereof may reduce the amounts available to be paid to the Holders of
the Securities of such Series. Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, any shortfalls in interest collections on Loans or
Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, included in
a Trust Fund for a Series resulting from application of the Soldiers' and
Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940 will be allocated to each Class of Securities
of such Series that is entitled to receive interest in respect of such Loans or
Underlying Loans in proportion to the interest that each such Class of
Securities would have otherwise been entitled to receive in respect of such
Loans or Underlying Loans had such interest shortfall not occurred.

                                       49







<PAGE>

                                 THE DEPOSITOR

GENERAL

     The Depositor was incorporated in the State of Delaware in June 1995, and
is a wholly-owned subsidiary of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc. The Depositor's
principal executive offices are located at 245 Park Avenue, New York, New York
10167. Its telephone number is (212) 272-4095.

     The Depositor will not engage in any activities other than to authorize,
issue, sell, deliver, purchase and invest in (and enter into agreements in
connection with), and/or to engage in the establishment of one or more trusts
which will issue and sell, bonds, notes, debt or equity securities, obligations
and other securities and instruments ('Depositor Securities') collateralized or
otherwise secured or backed by, or otherwise representing an interest in, among
other things, receivables or pass-through certificates, or participations or
certificates of participation or beneficial ownership in one or more pools of
receivables, and the proceeds of the foregoing, that arise in connection with
loans secured by certain first or junior mortgages on real estate or
manufactured housing and any and all other commercial transactions and
commercial, sovereign, student or consumer loans or indebtedness and, in
connection therewith or otherwise, purchasing, acquiring, owning, holding,
transferring, conveying, servicing, selling, pledging, assigning, financing and
otherwise dealing with such receivables, pass-through certificates, or
participations or certificates of participation or beneficial ownership. Article
Third of the Depositor's Certificate of Incorporation limits the Depositor's
activities to the above activities and certain related activities, such as
credit enhancement with respect to such Depositor Securities, and to any
activities incidental to and necessary or convenient for the accomplishment of
such purposes.

                                USE OF PROCEEDS

     The Depositor will apply all or substantially all of the net proceeds from
the sale of each Series of Securities for one or more of the following purposes:
(i) to purchase the related Primary Assets, (ii) to repay indebtedness which has
been incurred to obtain funds to acquire such Primary Assets, (iii) to establish
any Reserve Funds described in the related Prospectus Supplement and (iv) to pay
costs of structuring and issuing such Securities, including the costs of
obtaining Enhancement, if any. If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the purchase of the Primary Assets for a Series may be effected by
an exchange of Securities with the Seller of such Primary Assets.

                   CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

GENERAL

     The following summary is based on the opinion of Brown & Wood LLP, special
counsel to the Depositor ('Federal Tax Counsel') as to the anticipated material
federal income tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of
Securities. The summary does not purport to deal with all aspects of federal
income taxation that may affect particular investors in light of their
individual circumstances, nor with certain types of investors subject to special
treatment under the federal income tax laws. This summary focuses primarily upon
investors who will hold Securities as 'capital assets' (generally, property held
for investment) within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code, but much of the
discussion is applicable to other investors as well. Prospective investors are
advised to consult their own tax advisers concerning the federal, state, local
and any other tax consequences to them of the purchase, ownership and
disposition of the Securities.

     The summary is based upon the provisions of the Code, the regulations
promulgated thereunder, including, where applicable, proposed regulations, and
the judicial and administrative rulings and decisions now in effect, all of
which are subject to change or possible differing interpretations. The statutory
provisions, regulations, and interpretations on which this interpretation is
based are subject to change, and such a change could apply retroactively.

     The federal income tax consequences to Holders will vary depending on
whether (i) the Securities of a Series are classified as indebtedness; (ii) an
election is made to treat the Trust Fund relating to a particular Series of
Securities as a real estate mortgage investment conduit ('REMIC') under the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the 'Code'); (iii) the Securities
represent an ownership interest in some or all of the assets included in the
Trust Fund for a Series; or (iv) an election is made to treat the Trust Fund
relating to a particular Series of Certificates as a partnership or a division
of a single holder of all of the equity Securities of a Series.

                                       50



<PAGE>

     The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities will specify how
the Securities will be treated for federal income tax purposes and will discuss
whether a REMIC election, if any, will be made with respect to such Series.

TAXATION OF DEBT SECURITIES

     Status of Regular Interest Securities as Real Property Loans. The regular
interests in a REMIC ('Regular Interest Securities') will be 'real estate
assets' for purposes of Section 856(c)(4)(A) of the Code and assets described in
Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code (assets qualifying under one or both of those
sections, applying each section separately, 'qualifying assets') to the extent
that the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets. For purposes of this rule, if at
least 95 percent of the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets, then 100 percent
of the Regular Interest Securities will be qualifying assets. Similarly, income
on the Regular Interest Securities will be treated as 'interest on obligations
secured by mortgages on real property' within the meaning of Section
856(c)(3)(B) of the Code, subject to the limitations of the preceding two
sentences. In addition to Loans, the REMIC's assets will include payments on
Loans held pending distribution to holders of Regular Interest Securities,
amounts in reserve accounts (if any), other credit enhancements (if any) and
possibly buydown funds ('Buydown Funds'). The Loans generally will be qualifying
assets under both of the foregoing sections of the Code. However, Loans that are
not secured by residential real property or real property used primarily for
church purposes may not constitute qualifying assets under Section
7701(a)(19)(c)(v) of the Code. In addition, to the extent that the principal
amount of a Loan exceeds the value of the property securing the Loan, it is
unclear and Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine whether the Loans will be
qualifying assets. The regulations under Sections 860A through 860G of the Code
(the 'REMIC Regulations') treat credit enhancements as part of the mortgage or
pool of mortgages to which they relate, and therefore credit enhancements
generally should be qualifying assets. Regulations issued in conjunction with
the REMIC Regulations provide that amounts paid on Loans and held pending
distribution to holders of Regular Interest Securities ('cash flow investments')
will be treated as qualifying assets. It is unclear whether reserve funds or
Buydown Funds would also constitute qualifying assets under any of those
provisions.

     Interest and Acquisition Discount. Securities representing Regular Interest
Securities are generally taxable to Holders in the same manner as evidences of
indebtedness issued by the REMIC. Stated interest on the Regular Interest
Securities will be taxable as ordinary income and taken into account using the
accrual method of accounting, regardless of the Holder's normal accounting
method. Interest (other than original issue discount) on Securities (other than
Regular Interest Securities) that are characterized as indebtedness for federal
income tax purposes will be includible in income by Holders thereof in
accordance with their usual methods of accounting. Securities characterized as
debt for federal income tax purposes and Regular Interest Securities will be
referred to hereinafter collectively as 'Debt Securities.'

     Debt Securities that are Compound Interest Securities will, and certain of
the other Debt Securities may, be issued with 'original issue discount' ('OID').
The following discussion is based in part on the rules governing OID which are
set forth in Sections 1271-1275 of the Code and the Treasury regulations issued
thereunder on February 2, 1994, as amended June 11, 1996 (the 'OID
Regulations'). A Holder should be aware, however, that the OID Regulations do
not adequately address certain issues relevant to prepayable securities, such as
the Debt Securities.

     In general, OID, if any, will equal the difference between the stated
redemption price at maturity of a Debt Security and its issue price. A Holder of
a Debt Security must include such OID in gross income as ordinary interest
income as it accrues under a method taking into account an economic accrual of
the discount. In general, OID must be included in income in advance of the
receipt of the cash representing that income. The amount of OID on a Debt
Security will be considered to be zero if it is less than a de minimis amount
determined under the Code.

     The issue price of a Debt Security is the first price at which a
substantial amount of Debt Securities of that class are sold to the public
(excluding bond houses, brokers, underwriters or wholesalers). If less than a
substantial amount of a particular class of Debt Securities is sold for cash on
or prior to the Closing Date, the issue price for such class will be treated as
the fair market value of such class on the Closing Date. The issue price of a
Debt Security also includes the amount paid by an initial Debt Security Holder
for accrued interest that relates to a period prior to the issue date of the
Debt Security. The stated redemption price at maturity of a

                                       51



<PAGE>

Debt Security includes the original principal amount of the Debt Security, but
generally will not include distributions of interest if such distributions
constitute 'qualified stated interest.'

     Under the OID Regulations, interest payments will not qualify as qualified
stated interest unless the interest payments are 'unconditionally payable.' The
OID Regulations state that interest is unconditionally payable if reasonable
legal remedies exist to compel timely payment, or the debt instrument otherwise
provides terms and conditions that make the likelihood of late payment (other
than a late payment that occurs within a reasonable grace period) or nonpayment
of interest a remote contingency, as defined in the OID Regulations. It is
unclear whether the terms and conditions of the Loans underlying the Debt
Securities or the terms and conditions of the Debt Securities are considered
when determining whether the likelihood of late payment or nonpayment of
interest is a remote contingency. Any terms or conditions that do not reflect
arm's length dealing or that the holder does not intend to enforce are not
considered.

     Certain Debt Securities will provide for distributions of interest based on
a period that is the same length as the interval between Distribution Dates but
ends prior to each Distribution Date. Any interest that accrues prior to the
Closing Date may be treated under the OID Regulations either (i) as part of the
issue price and the stated redemption price at maturity of the Debt Securities
or (ii) as not included in the issue price or stated redemption price. The OID
Regulations provide a special application of the de minimis rule for debt
instruments with long first accrual periods where the interest payable for the
first period is at a rate which is effectively less than that which applies in
all other periods. In such cases, for the sole purpose of determining whether
original issue discount is de minimis, the OID Regulations provide that the
stated redemption price is equal to the instrument's issue price plus the
greater of the amount of foregone interest or the excess (if any) of the
instrument's stated principal amount over its issue price.

     Under the de minimis rule, OID on a Debt Security will be considered to be
zero if such OID is less than 0.25% of the stated redemption price at maturity
of the Debt Security multiplied by the weighted average maturity of the Debt
Security. For this purpose, the weighted average maturity of the Debt Security
is computed as the sum of the amounts determined by multiplying the number of
full years (i.e., rounding down partial years) from the issue date until each
distribution in reduction of stated redemption price at maturity is scheduled to
be made by a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount of each distribution
included in the stated redemption price at maturity of the Debt Security and the
denominator of which is the stated redemption price at maturity of the Debt
Security. Holders generally must report de minimis OID pro rata as principal
payments are received, and such income will be capital gain if the Debt Security
is held as a capital asset. However, accrual method Holders may elect to accrue
all de minimis OID as well as market discount under a constant interest method.

     The Holder of a Debt Security issued with OID must include in gross income,
for all days during its taxable year on which it holds such Debt Security, the
sum of the 'daily portions' of such original issue discount. The amount of OID
includible in income by a Holder will be computed by allocating to each day
during a taxable year a pro rata portion of the original issue discount that
accrued during the relevant accrual period. In the case of a Debt Security that
is not a Regular Interest Security and the principal payments on which are not
subject to acceleration resulting from prepayments on the Loans, the amount of
OID includible in income of a Holder for an accrual period (generally the period
over which interest accrues on the debt instrument) will equal the product of
the yield to maturity of the Debt Security and the adjusted issue price of the
Debt Security, reduced by any payments of qualified stated interest. The
adjusted issue price is the sum of its issue price plus prior accruals of OID,
reduced by the total payments made with respect to such Debt Security in all
prior periods, other than qualified stated interest payments.

     The amount of OID to be included in income by a Holder of a debt
instrument, such as certain Classes of the Debt Securities, that is subject to
acceleration due to prepayments on other debt obligations securing such
instruments (a 'Pay-Through Security'), is computed by taking into account the
anticipated rate of prepayments assumed in pricing the debt instrument (the
'Prepayment Assumption'). The amount of OID that will accrue during an accrual
period on a Pay-Through Security is the excess (if any) of the sum of (a) the
present value of all payments remaining to be made on the Pay-Through Security
as of the close of the accrual period and (b) the payments during the accrual
period of amounts included in the stated redemption price of the Pay-Through
Security, over the adjusted issue price of the Pay-Through Security at the
beginning of the accrual period. The present value of the remaining payments is
to be determined on the basis of three factors: (i) the original yield to
maturity of the Pay-Through Security (determined on the basis of compounding at
the end of each accrual period and properly adjusted for the length of the
accrual period), (ii) events which have occurred before the end

                                       52



<PAGE>

of the accrual period and (iii) the assumption that the remaining payments will
be made in accordance with the original Prepayment Assumption. The effect of
this method is to increase the portions of OID required to be included in income
by a Holder to take into account prepayments with respect to the Loans at a rate
that exceeds the Prepayment Assumption, and to decrease (but not below zero for
any period) the portions of OID required to be included in income by a Holder of
a Pay-Through Security to take into account prepayments with respect to the
Loans at a rate that is slower than the Prepayment Assumption. Although OID will
be reported to Holders of Pay-Through Securities based on the Prepayment
Assumption, no representation is made to Holders that Loans will be prepaid at
that rate or at any other rate.

     The Depositor may adjust the accrual of OID on a Class of Regular Interest
Securities (or other regular interests in a REMIC) in a manner that it believes
to be appropriate, to take account of realized losses on the Loans, although the
OID Regulations do not provide for such adjustments. If the Internal Revenue
Service were to require that OID be accrued without such adjustments, the rate
of accrual of OID for a Class of Regular Interest Securities could increase.

     Certain classes of Regular Interest Securities may represent more than one
class of REMIC regular interests. Unless the applicable Prospectus Supplement
specifies otherwise, the Trustee intends, based on the OID Regulations, to
calculate OID on such Securities as if, solely for the purposes of computing
OID, the separate regular interests were a single debt instrument.

     A subsequent Holder of a Debt Security will also be required to include OID
in gross income, but such a Holder who purchases such Debt Security for an
amount that exceeds its adjusted issue price will be entitled (as will an
initial Holder who pays more than a Debt Security's issue price) to offset such
OID by comparable economic accruals of portions of such excess.

     Effects of Defaults and Delinquencies. Holders will be required to report
income with respect to the related Securities under an accrual method without
giving effect to delays and reductions in distributions attributable to a
default or delinquency on the Loans, except possibly to the extent that it can
be established that such amounts are uncollectible. As a result, the amount of
income (including OID) reported by a Holder of such a Security in any period
could significantly exceed the amount of cash distributed to such Holder in that
period. The Holder will eventually be allowed a loss (or will be allowed to
report a lesser amount of income) to the extent that the aggregate amount of
distributions on the Securities is reduced as a result of a Loan default.
However, the timing and character of such losses or reductions in income are
uncertain and, accordingly, Holders of Securities should consult their own tax
advisors on this point.

     Interest-Only Debt Securities. The Trust Fund intends to report income from
interest-only classes of Debt Securities to the Internal Revenue Service and to
holders of interest-only Debt Securities based on the assumption that the stated
redemption price at maturity is equal to the sum of all payments determined
under the applicable prepayment assumption. As a result, such interest-only Debt
Securities Certificates will be treated as having original issue discount.

     Variable Rate Debt Securities. Under the OID Regulations, Debt Securities
paying interest at a variable rate (a 'Variable Rate Debt Security') are subject
to special rules. A Variable Rate Debt Security will qualify as a 'variable rate
debt instrument' if (i) its issue price does not exceed the total noncontingent
principal payments due under the Variable Rate Debt Security by more than a
specified de minimis amount, (ii) it provides for stated interest, paid or
compounded at least annually, at (a) one or more qualified floating rates, (b) a
single fixed rate and one or more qualified floating rates, (c) a single
objective rate or (d) a single fixed rate and a single objective rate that is a
qualified inverse floating rate and (iii) it does not provide for any principal
payments that are contingent, as defined in the OID Regulations, except as
provided in (i), above. Because the OID Regulations relating to contingent
payment debt instruments do not apply to REMIC regular interests, principal
payments on the REMIC Regular Certificates should not be considered contingent
for this purpose.

     A 'qualified floating rate' is any variable rate where variations in the
value of such rate can reasonably be expected to measure contemporaneous
variations in the cost of newly borrowed funds in the currency in which the
Variable Rate Debt Security is denominated. A multiple of a qualified floating
rate will generally not itself constitute a qualified floating rate for purposes
of the OID Regulations. However, a variable rate equal to (i) the product of a
qualified floating rate and a fixed multiple that is greater than 0.65 but not
more than 1.35 or (ii) the product of a qualified floating rate and a fixed
multiple that is greater than 0.65 but not more than 1.35, increased or
decreased by a fixed rate will constitute a qualified floating rate for purposes
of the OID

                                       53



<PAGE>

Regulations. In addition, under the OID Regulations, two or more qualified
floating rates that can reasonably be expected to have approximately the same
values throughout the term of the Variable Rate Debt Security will be treated as
a single qualified floating rate (a 'Presumed Single Qualified Floating Rate').
Two or more qualified floating rates with values within 25 basis points of each
other as determined on the Variable Rate Debt Security's issue date will be
conclusively presumed to be a Presumed Single Qualified Floating Rate.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, a variable rate that would otherwise constitute a
qualified floating rate but which is subject to one or more restrictions such as
a cap or floor, will not be a qualified floating rate for purposes of the OID
Regulations unless the restriction is fixed throughout the term of the Variable
Rate Debt Security or the restriction will not significantly affect the yield of
the Variable Rate Debt Security.

     An 'objective rate' is a rate that is not itself a qualified floating rate
but which is determined using a single fixed formula and which is based upon
objective financial or economic information. The OID Regulations also provide
that other variable rates may be treated as objective rates if so designated by
the Internal Revenue Service in the future. An interest rate on a REMIC Regular
Certificate that is the weighted average of the interest rates on some or all of
the qualified mortgages held by the REMIC should constitute an objective rate.
Despite the foregoing, a variable rate of interest on a Variable Rate Debt
Security will not constitute an objective rate if it is reasonably expected that
the average value of such rate during the first half of the Variable Rate Debt
Security's term will be either significantly less than or significantly greater
than the average value of the rate during the final half of the Variable Rate
Debt Security's term. Further, an objective rate does not include a rate that is
based on information that is within the control of the issuer (or a party
related to the issuer) or that is unique to the circumstances of the issuer (or
a party related to the issuer). An objective rate will qualify as a 'qualified
inverse floating rate' if such rate is equal to a fixed rate minus a qualified
floating rate and variations in the rate can reasonably be expected to inversely
reflect contemporaneous variations in the qualified floating rate. The OID
Regulations also provide that if a Variable Rate Debt Security provides for
stated interest at a fixed rate for an initial period of less than one year
followed by a variable rate that is either a qualified floating rate or an
objective rate and if the variable rate on the Variable Rate Debt Security's
issue date is intended to approximate the fixed rate, then the fixed rate and
the variable rate together will constitute either a single qualified floating
rate or objective rate, as the case may be (a 'Presumed Single Variable Rate').
If the value of the variable rate and the initial fixed rate are within 25 basis
points of each other as determined on the Variable Rate Debt Security's issue
date, the variable rate will be conclusively presumed to approximate the fixed
rate.

     For Variable Rate Debt Securities that qualify as a 'variable rate debt
instrument' under the OID Regulations and provide for interest at either a
single qualified floating rate, a single objective rate, a Presumed Single
Qualified Floating Rate or a Presumed Single Variable Rate throughout the term
(a 'Single Variable Rate Debt Security'), original issue discount is computed as
described above based on the following: (i) stated interest on the Single
Variable Rate Debt Security which is unconditionally payable in cash or property
(other than debt instruments of the issuer) at least annually will constitute
qualified stated interest, (ii) by assuming that the variable rate on the Single
Variable Debt Security is a fixed rate equal to: (a) in the case of a Single
Variable Rate Debt Security with a qualified floating rate or a qualified
inverse floating rate, the value of, as of the issue date, of the qualified
floating rate or the qualified inverse floating rate or (b) in the case of a
Single Variable Rate Debt Security with an objective rate (other than a
qualified inverse floating rate), a fixed rate which reflects the reasonably
expected yield for such Single Variable Debt Security and (iii) the qualified
stated interest allocable to an accrual period is increased (or decreased) if
the interest actually paid during an accrual period exceeds (or is less than)
the interest assumed to be paid under the assumed fixed rate described in (ii),
above.

     In general, any Variable Rate Debt Security other than a Single Variable
Rate Debt Security (a 'Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security') that qualifies as
a 'variable rate debt instrument' will be converted into an 'equivalent' fixed
rate debt instrument for purposes of determining the amount and accrual of
original issue discount and qualified stated interest on the Multiple Variable
Rate Debt Security. The OID Regulations generally require that such a Multiple
Variable Rate Debt Security be converted into an 'equivalent' fixed rate debt
instrument by substituting any qualified floating rate or qualified inverse
floating rate provided for under the terms of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt
Security with a fixed rate equal to the value of the qualified floating rate or
qualified inverse floating rate, as the case may be, as of the Multiple Variable
Rate Debt Security's issue date. Any objective rate (other than a qualified
inverse floating rate) provided for under the terms of the Multiple Variable
Rate Debt Security is converted into a fixed rate that reflects the yield that
is reasonably expected for the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security. In the case
of a Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security that qualifies as a 'variable rate
debt instrument' and provides for stated interest at a fixed rate in addition to
either one or more

                                       54



<PAGE>

qualified floating rates or a qualified inverse floating rate, the fixed rate is
initially converted into a qualified floating rate (or a qualified inverse
floating rate, if the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security provides for a
qualified inverse floating rate). Under such circumstances, the qualified
floating rate or qualified inverse floating rate that replaces the fixed rate
must be such that the fair market value of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt
Security as of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security's issue date is
approximately the same as the fair market value of an otherwise identical debt
instrument that provides for either the qualified floating rate or qualified
inverse floating rate rather than the fixed rate. Subsequent to converting the
fixed rate into either a qualified floating rate or a qualified inverse floating
rate, the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security is then converted into an
'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument in the manner described above.

     Once the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security is converted into an
'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument pursuant to the foregoing rules, the
amount of original issue discount and qualified stated interest, if any, are
determined for the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument by applying the
original issue discount rules to the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument in
the manner described above. A Holder of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security
will account for such original issue discount and qualified stated interest as
if the Holder held the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument. Each accrual
period appropriate adjustments will be made to the amount of qualified stated
interest or original issue discount assumed to have been accrued or paid with
respect to the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument in the event that such
amounts differ from the accrual amount of interest accrued or paid on the
Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security during the accrual period.

     If a Variable Rate Debt Security does not qualify as a 'variable rate debt
instrument' under the OID Regulations, then the Variable Rate Debt Security
would be treated as a contingent payment debt obligation. It is not clear under
current law how a Variable Rate Debt Security would be taxed if such Debt
Security were treated as a contingent payment debt obligation since the OID
Regulations relating to contingent payment debt obligations do not apply to
REMIC regular interests.

     Market Discount. A purchaser of a Security may be subject to the market
discount rules of Sections 1276-1278 of the Code. A Holder that acquires a Debt
Security with more than a prescribed de minimis amount of 'market discount'
(generally, the excess of the principal amount of the Debt Security over the
purchaser's purchase price) will be required to include accrued market discount
in income as ordinary income in each month, but limited to an amount not
exceeding the principal payments on the Debt Security received in that month
and, if the Securities are sold, the gain realized. Such market discount would
accrue in a manner to be provided in Treasury regulations but, until such
regulations are issued, such market discount would in general accrue either (i)
on the basis of a constant yield (in the case of a Pay-Through Security, taking
into account a prepayment assumption) or (ii) in the ratio of (a) in the case of
Securities (or in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as set forth below, the
Loans underlying such Security) not originally issued with original issue
discount, stated interest payable in the relevant period to total stated
interest remaining to be paid at the beginning of the period or (b) in the case
of Securities (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below,
the Loans underlying such Security) originally issued at a discount, OID in the
relevant period to total OID remaining to be paid.

     Section 1277 of the Code provides that, regardless of the origination date
of the Debt Security (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, the Loans),
the excess of interest paid or accrued to purchase or carry a Security (or, in
the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below, the underlying Loans)
with market discount over interest received on such Security is allowed as a
current deduction only to the extent such excess is greater than the market
discount that accrued during the taxable year in which such interest expense was
incurred. In general, the deferred portion of any interest expense will be
deductible when such market discount is included in income, including upon the
sale, disposition, or repayment of the Security (or in the case of a
Pass-Through Security, an underlying Loan). A Holder may elect to include market
discount in income currently as it accrues, on all market discount obligations
acquired by such Holder during the taxable year such election is made and
thereafter, in which case the interest deferral rule will not apply.

     Premium. A Holder who purchases a Debt Security (other than an Interest
Weighted Security to the extent described above) at a cost greater than its
stated redemption price at maturity, generally will be considered to have
purchased the Security at a premium, which it may elect to amortize as an offset
to interest income on such Security (and not as a separate deduction item) on a
constant yield method. Although no regulations addressing the computation of
premium accrual on securities similar to the Securities have been issued, the
legislative history of the 1986 Act indicates that premium is to be accrued in
the same manner as market discount.

                                       55



<PAGE>

     Accordingly, it appears that the accrual of premium on a Class of
Pay-Through Securities will be calculated using the prepayment assumption used
in pricing such Class. If a Holder makes an election to amortize premium on a
Debt Security, such election will apply to all taxable debt instruments
(including all REMIC regular interests and all pass-through certificates
representing ownership interests in a trust holding debt obligations) held by
the Holder at the beginning of the taxable year in which the election is made,
and to all taxable debt instruments acquired thereafter by such Holder, and will
be irrevocable without the consent of the Internal Revenue Service. Purchasers
who pay a premium for the Securities should consult their tax advisers regarding
the election to amortize premium and the method to be employed.

     Election to Treat all Interest as Original Issue Discount. The OID
Regulations permit a Holder of a Debt Security to elect to accrue all interest,
discount (including de minimis market or original issue discount) and premium in
income as interest, based on a constant yield method for Debt Securities
acquired on or after April 4, 1994. If such an election were to be made with
respect to a Debt Security with market discount, the Holder of the Debt Security
would be deemed to have made an election to include in income currently market
discount with respect to all other debt instruments having market discount that
such Holder of the Debt Security acquires during the year of the election or
thereafter. Similarly, a Holder of a Debt Security that makes this election for
a Debt Security that is acquired at a premium will be deemed to have made an
election to amortize bond premium with respect to all debt instruments having
amortizable bond premium that such Holder owns or acquires. The election to
accrue interest, discount and premium on a constant yield method with respect to
a Debt Security is irrevocable.

TAXATION OF THE REMIC AND ITS HOLDERS

     General. In the opinion of Federal Tax Counsel, if a REMIC election is made
with respect to a Series of Securities, then the arrangement by which the
Securities of that Series are issued will be treated as a REMIC as long as all
of the provisions of the applicable Agreement are complied with and the
statutory and regulatory requirements are satisfied. Securities will be
designated as 'Regular Interests' or 'Residual Interests' in a REMIC, as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Except to the extent specified otherwise in a Prospectus Supplement, if a
REMIC election is made with respect to a Series of Securities, (i) Securities
held by a domestic building and loan association will constitute 'a regular or a
residual interest in a REMIC' within the meaning of Code Section
7701(a)(19)(C)(xi) (assuming that at least 95% of the REMIC's assets consist of
cash, government saturates, 'loans secured by an interest in real property,' and
other types of assets described in Code Section 7701(a)(19)(C)); and (ii)
Securities held by a real estate investment trust will constitute 'real estate
assets' within the meaning of Code Section 856(c)(5)(B), and income with respect
to the Securities will be considered 'interest on obligations secured by
mortgages on real property or on interests in real property' within the meaning
of Code Section 856(c)(3)(B) (assuming, for both purposes, that at least 95% of
the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets). If less than 95% of the REMIC's
assets consist of assets described in (i) or (ii) above, then a Security will
qualify for the tax treatment described in (i) or (ii) in the proportion that
such REMIC assets are qualifying assets.

REMIC EXPENSES; SINGLE CLASS REMICS

     As a general rule, all of the expenses of a REMIC will be taken into
account by Holders of the Residual Interest Securities. In the case of a 'single
class REMIC,' however, the expenses will be allocated, under Treasury
regulations, among the Holders of the Regular Interest Securities and the
Holders of the Residual Interest Securities on a daily basis in proportion to
the relative amounts of income accruing to each Holder on that day. In the case
of a Holder of a Regular Interest Security who is an individual or a
'pass-through interest holder' (including certain pass-through entities but not
including real estate investment trusts), such expenses will be deductible only
to the extent that such expenses, plus other 'miscellaneous itemized deductions'
of the Holder, exceed 2% of such Holder's adjusted gross income. In addition,
for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1990, the amount of itemized
deductions otherwise allowable for the taxable year for an individual whose
adjusted gross income exceeds the applicable amount (which amount will be
adjusted for inflation for taxable years beginning after 1990) will be reduced
by the lesser of (i) 3% of the excess of adjusted gross income over the
applicable amount, or (ii) 80% of the amount of itemized deductions otherwise
allowable for such taxable year. For taxable years beginning after December 31,
1997, in the case of a partnership that has 100 or more partners and elects to
be treated as an 'electing large partnership,' 70 percent of such partnership's

                                       56



<PAGE>

miscellaneous itemized deductions will be disallowed, although the remaining
deductions will generally be allowed at the partnership level and will not be
subject to the 2 percent floor that would otherwise be applicable to individual
partners. The reduction or disallowance of this deduction may have a significant
impact on the yield of the Regular Interest Security to such a Holder. In
general terms, a single class REMIC is one that either (i) would qualify, under
existing Treasury regulations, as a grantor trust if it were not a REMIC
(treating all interests as ownership interests, even if they would be classified
as debt for federal income tax purposes) or (ii) is similar to such a trust and
which is structured with the principal purpose of avoiding the single class
REMIC rules. Unless otherwise stated in the applicable Prospectus Supplement,
the expenses of the REMIC will be allocated to Holders of the related Residual
Interest Securities.

TAXATION OF THE REMIC

     General. Although a REMIC is a separate entity for federal income tax
purposes, a REMIC is not generally subject to entity-level tax. Rather, the
taxable income or net loss of a REMIC is taken into account by the holders of
residual interests. As described above, the regular interests are generally
taxable as debt of the REMIC.

     Tiered REMIC Structures. For certain Series of Securities, two or more
separate elections may be held to treat designated portions of the related Trust
Fund as REMICs ('Tiered REMICs') for federal income tax purposes. Upon the
issuance of any such Series of Securities, Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its
opinion generally to the effect that, assuming compliance with all provisions of
the related Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Tiered REMICs will each qualify
as a REMIC and the REMIC Certificates issued by the Tiered REMICs, respectively,
will be considered to evidence ownership of Regular Certificates or Residual
Certificates in the related REMIC within the meaning of the REMIC Provisions.

     Solely for purposes of determining whether the REMIC Certificates will be
'real estate assets' within the meaning of Section 856(c)(4)(A) of the Code, and
'loans secured by an interest in real property' under Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of
the Code, and whether the income on such Certificates is interest described in
Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code, the Tiered REMICs will be treated as one
REMIC.

     Calculation of REMIC Income. The taxable income or net loss of a REMIC is
determined under an accrual method of accounting and in the same manner as in
the case of an individual, with certain adjustments. In general, the taxable
income or net loss will be the difference between (i) the gross income produced
by the REMIC's assets, including stated interest and any original issue discount
or market discount on loans and other assets, and (ii) deductions, including
stated interest and original issue discount accrued on Regular Interest
Securities, amortization of any premium with respect to Loans, and servicing
fees and other expenses of the REMIC. A Holder of a Residual Interest Security
that is an individual or a 'pass-through interest holder' (including certain
pass-through entities, but not including real estate investment trusts) will be
unable to deduct servicing fees payable on the Loans or other administrative
expenses of the REMIC for a given taxable year, to the extent that such
expenses, when aggregated with such Holder's other miscellaneous itemized
deductions for that year, do not exceed two percent of such Holder's adjusted
gross income. For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1997, in the case
of a partnership that has 100 or more partners and elects to be treated as an
'electing large partnership,' 70 percent of such partnership's miscellaneous
itemized deductions will be disallowed, although the remaining deductions will
generally be allowed at the partnership level and will not be subject to the 2
percent floor that would otherwise be applicable to individual partners.

     For purposes of computing its taxable income or net loss, the REMIC should
have an initial aggregate tax basis in its assets equal to the aggregate fair
market value of the regular interests and the residual interests on the Startup
Day (generally, the day that the interests are issued). Such aggregate basis
will be allocated among the assets of the REMIC in proportion to their
respective fair market values.

     The OID provisions of the Code apply to loans of individuals originated on
or after March 2, 1984, and the market discount provisions apply to loans
originated after July 18, 1984. Subject to possible application of the de
minimis rules, the method of accrual by the REMIC of OID income on such loans
will be equivalent to the method under which Holders of Pay-Through Securities
accrue original issue discount (i.e., under the constant yield method taking
into account the Prepayment Assumption). The REMIC will deduct OID on the
Regular Interest Securities in the same manner that the Holders of the Regular
Interest Securities include such discount in income, but without regard to the
de minimis rules. See 'Taxation of Debt Securities' above. However, a

                                       57



<PAGE>

REMIC that acquires loans at a market discount must include such market discount
in income currently, as it accrues, on a constant interest basis.

     To the extent that the REMIC's basis allocable to loans that it holds
exceeds their principal amounts, the resulting premium, if attributable to
mortgages originated after September 27, 1985, will be amortized over the life
of the loans (taking into account the Prepayment Assumption) on a constant yield
method. Although the law is somewhat unclear regarding recovery of premium
attributable to loans originated on or before such date, it is possible that
such premium may be recovered in proportion to payments of loan principal.

     Prohibited Transactions and Contributions Tax. The REMIC will be subject to
a 100% tax on any net income derived from a 'prohibited transaction.' For this
purpose, net income will be calculated without taking into account any losses
from prohibited transactions or any deductions attributable to any prohibited
transaction that resulted in a loss. In general, prohibited transactions
include: (i) subject to limited exceptions, the sale or other disposition of any
qualified mortgage transferred to the REMIC; (ii) subject to a limited
exception, the sale or other disposition of a cash flow investment; (iii) the
receipt of any income from assets not permitted to be held by the REMIC pursuant
to the Code; or (iv) the receipt of any fees or other compensation for services
rendered by the REMIC. It is anticipated that a REMIC will not engage in any
prohibited transactions in which it would recognize a material amount of net
income. In addition, subject to a number of exceptions, a tax is imposed at the
rate of 100% on amounts contributed to a REMIC after the close of the
three-month period beginning on the Startup Day. The Holders of Residual
Interest Securities will generally be responsible for the payment of any such
taxes imposed on the REMIC. To the extent not paid by such Holders or otherwise,
however, such taxes will be paid out of the Trust Fund and will be allocated pro
rata to all outstanding Classes of Securities of such REMIC.

TAXATION OF HOLDERS OF RESIDUAL INTEREST SECURITIES

     The Holder of a Security representing a residual interest (a 'Residual
Interest Security') will take into account the 'daily portion' of the taxable
income or net loss of the REMIC for each day during the taxable year on which
such Holder held the Residual Interest Security. The daily portion is determined
by allocating to each day in any calendar quarter its ratable portion of the
taxable income or net loss of the REMIC for such quarter, and by allocating that
amount among the Holders (on such day) of the Residual Interest Securities in
proportion to their respective holdings on such day.

     The Holder of a Residual Interest Security must report its proportionate
share of the taxable income of the REMIC whether or not it receives cash
distributions from the REMIC attributable to such income or loss. The reporting
of taxable income without corresponding distributions could occur, for example,
in certain REMIC issues in which the loans held by the REMIC were issued or
acquired at a discount, since mortgage prepayments cause recognition of discount
income, while the corresponding portion of the prepayment could be used in whole
or in part to make principal payments on REMIC Regular Interests issued without
any discount or at an insubstantial discount. (If this occurs, it is likely that
cash distributions will exceed taxable income in later years.) Taxable income
may also be greater in earlier years of certain REMIC issues as a result of the
fact that interest expense deductions, as a percentage of outstanding principal
on REMIC Regular Interest Securities, will typically increase over time as lower
yielding Securities are paid, whereas interest income with respect to loans will
generally remain constant over time as a percentage of loan principal.

     In any event, because the holder of a residual interest is taxed on the net
income of the REMIC, the taxable income derived from a Residual Interest
Security in a given taxable year will not be equal to the taxable income
associated with investment in a corporate bond or stripped instrument having
similar cash flow characteristics and pretax yield. Therefore, the after-tax
yield on the Residual Interest Security may be less than that of such a bond or
instrument.

     Limitation on Losses. The amount of the REMIC's net loss that a Holder may
take into account currently is limited to the Holder's adjusted basis at the end
of the calendar quarter in which such loss arises. A Holder's basis in a
Residual Interest Security will initially equal such Holder's purchase price,
and will subsequently be increased by the amount of the REMIC's taxable income
allocated to the Holder, and decreased (but not below zero) by the amount of
distributions made and the amount of the REMIC's net loss allocated to the
Holder. Any disallowed loss may be carried forward indefinitely, but may be used
only to offset income of the REMIC

                                       58



<PAGE>

generated by the same REMIC. The ability of Holders of Residual Interest
Securities to deduct net losses may be subject to additional limitations under
the Code, as to which such Holders should consult their tax advisers.

     Distributions. Distributions on a Residual Interest Security (whether at
their scheduled times or as a result of prepayments) will generally not result
in any additional taxable income or loss to a Holder of a Residual Interest
Security. If the amount of such payment exceeds a holder's adjusted basis in the
Residual Interest Security, however, the Holder will recognize gain (treated as
gain from the sale of the Residual Interest Security) to the extent of such
excess.

     Sale or Exchange. A Holder of a Residual Interest Security will recognize
gain or loss on the sale or exchange of a Residual Interest Security equal to
the difference, if any, between the amount realized and such Holder's adjusted
basis in the Residual Interest Security at the time of such sale or exchange.
Except to the extent provided in regulations, which have not yet been issued,
any loss upon disposition of a Residual Interest Security will be disallowed if
the selling Holder acquires any residual interest in a REMIC or similar mortgage
pool within six months before or after such disposition.

     Excess Inclusions. The portion of the REMIC taxable income of a Holder of a
Residual Interest Security consisting of 'excess inclusion' income may not be
offset by other deductions or losses, including net operating losses, on such
Holder's federal income tax return. Further, if the Holder of a Residual
Interest Security is an organization subject to the tax on unrelated business
income imposed by Code Section 511, such Holder's excess inclusion income will
be treated as unrelated business taxable income of such Holder. In addition,
under Treasury regulations yet to be issued, if a real estate investment trust,
a regulated investment company, a common trust fund, or certain cooperatives
were to own a Residual Interest Security, a portion of dividends (or other
distributions) paid by the real estate investment trust (or other entity) would
be treated as excess inclusion income. If a Residual Security is owned by a
foreign person, excess inclusion income is subject to tax at a rate of 30% which
may not be reduced by treaty, is not eligible for treatment as 'portfolio
interest' and is subject to certain additional limitations. See 'Tax Treatment
of Foreign Investors.'

     The excess inclusion portion of a REMIC's income is generally equal to the
excess, if any, of REMIC taxable income for the quarterly period allocable to a
Residual Interest Security, over the daily accruals for such quarterly period of
(i) 120% of the long term applicable federal rate on the Startup Date multiplied
by (ii) the adjusted issue price of such Residual Interest Security at the
beginning of such quarterly period. The adjusted issue price of a Residual
Interest Security at the beginning of each calendar quarter will equal its issue
price (calculated in a manner analogous to the determination of the issue price
of a Regular Interest Security), increased by the aggregate of the daily
accruals for prior calendar quarters, and decreased (but not below zero) by the
amount of loss allocated to a Holder and the amount of distributions made on the
Residual Interest Security before the beginning of the quarter. The long-term
federal rate, which is announced monthly by the Treasury Department, is an
interest rate that is based on the average market yield of outstanding
marketable obligations of the United States government having remaining
maturities in excess of nine years.

     Provisions governing the relationship between excess inclusions and the
alternative minimum tax provide that (i) the alternative minimum taxable income
of a taxpayer is based on the taxpayer's regular taxable income computed without
regard to the rule that taxable income cannot be less than the amount of excess
inclusions, (ii) the alternative minimum taxable income of a taxpayer for a
taxable year cannot be less than the amount of excess inclusions for that year,
and (iii) the amount of any alternative minimum tax net operating loss is
computed without regard to any excess inclusions. While these provisions are
generally effective for tax years beginning after December 31, 1986, a taxpayer
may elect to have these provisions apply only with respect to tax years
beginning after August 20, 1996.

     The Code provides that to the extent provided in regulations, as an
exception to the general rule described above, the entire amount of income
accruing on a Residual Interest Security will be treated as an excess inclusion
if the Residual Interest Securities in the aggregate are considered not to have
'significant value.' The Treasury Department has not yet provided regulations in
this respect.

     Under the REMIC Regulations, in certain circumstances, transfers of
Residual Interest Securities may be disregarded. See ' -- Restrictions on
Ownership and Transfer of Residual Interest Securities' and ' -- Tax Treatment
of Foreign Investors' below.

     Restrictions on Ownership and Transfer of Residual Interest Securities. As
a condition to qualification as a REMIC, reasonable arrangements must be made to
prevent the ownership of a REMIC residual interest by any

                                       59



<PAGE>

'Disqualified Organization.' Disqualified Organizations include the United
States, any State or political subdivision thereof, any foreign government, any
international organization, or any agency or instrumentality of any of the
foregoing, a rural electric or telephone cooperative described in Section
1381(a)(2)(C) of the Code, or any entity exempt from the tax imposed by Sections
1399 of the Code, if such entity is not subject to tax on its unrelated business
income. Accordingly, the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement will
prohibit Disqualified Organizations from owning a Residual Interest Security. In
addition, no transfer of a Residual Interest Security will be permitted unless
the proposed transferee shall have furnished to the Trustee an affidavit
representing and warranting that it is neither a Disqualified Organization nor
an agent or nominee acing on behalf of a Disqualified Organization.

     If a Residual Interest Security is transferred to a Disqualified
Organization after March 31, 1988 (in violation of the restrictions set forth
above), a substantial tax will be imposed on the transferor of such Residual
Interest Security at the time of the transfer. In addition, if a Disqualified
Organization holds an interest in a pass-through entity after March 31, 1988
(including, among others, a partnership, trust, real estate investment trust,
regulated investment company, or any person holding as nominee), that owns a
Residual Interest Security, the pass-through entity will be required to pay an
annual tax on its allocable share of the excess inclusion income of the REMIC.
For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1997, all partners of certain
electing partnerships having 100 or more partners ('electing large
partnerships') will be treated as disqualified organizations for purposes of the
tax imposed on pass-through entities if such electing large partnerships hold
residual interests in a REMIC. However, the electing large partnership would be
entitled to exclude the excess inclusion income from gross income for purposes
of determining the taxable income of the partners.

     Under the REMIC Regulations, if a Residual Interest Security is a
'noneconomic residual interest,' as described below, a transfer of a Residual
Interest Security to a United States person will be disregarded for all federal
tax purposes unless no significant purpose of the transfer was to impede the
assessment or collection of tax. A Residual Interest Security is a 'noneconomic
residual interest' unless, at the time of the transfer (i) the present value of
the expected future distributions on the Residual Interest Security at least
equals the product of the present value of the anticipated excess inclusions and
the highest rate of tax for the year in which the transfer occurs, and (ii) the
transferor reasonably expects that the transferee will receive distributions
from the REMIC at or after the time at which the taxes accrue on the anticipated
excess inclusions in an amount sufficient to satisfy the accrued taxes. If a
transfer of a Residual Interest Security is disregarded, the transferor would be
liable for any federal income tax imposed upon taxable income derived by the
transferee from the REMIC. The REMIC Regulations provide no guidance as to how
to determine if a significant purpose of a transfer is to impede the assessment
or collection of tax. A similar type of limitation exists with respect to
certain transfers of residual interests by foreign persons to United States
persons. See ' -- Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors.'

     Mark to Market Rules. Prospective purchasers of a Residual Interest
Security should be aware of Internal Revenue Service regulations (the 'Mark to
Market Regulations') relating to the requirement that a securities dealer
mark-to-market securities held for sale to customers. This mark-to-market
requirement applies to all securities of a dealer, except to the extent that the
dealer has specifically identified a security as held for investment. The Mark
to Market Regulations provide that for purposes of this mark-to-market
requirement, a 'negative value' Residual Interest Security is not treated as a
security and thus may not be marked to market. In addition, a dealer is not
required to identify such Residual Interest Security as held for investment. In
general, a Residual Interest Security has negative value if, as of the date a
taxpayer acquires the Residual Interest Security, the present value of the tax
liabilities associated with holding the Residual Interest Security exceeds the
sum of (i) the present value of the expected future distributions on the
Residual Interest Security, and (ii) the present value of the anticipated tax
savings associated with holding the Residual Interest Security as the REMIC
generates losses. The amounts and present values of the anticipated tax
liabilities, expected future distributions and anticipated tax savings are all
to be determined using (i) the prepayment and reinvestment assumptions adopted
under Section 1272(a)(6), or that would have been adopted had the REMIC's
regular interests been issued with OID, (ii) any required or permitted clean up
calls, or required qualified liquidation provided for in the REMIC's
organizational documents and (iii) a discount rate equal to the 'applicable
Federal rate' (as specified in Section 1274(d)(1)) that would apply to a debt
instrument issued on the date of acquisition of the Residual Interest Security.
Furthermore, the Temporary Mark to Market Regulations provide the IRS with the
authority to treat any Residual Interest Security having substantially the same
economic effect as a 'negative value' residual interest as a 'negative value'
residual interest.

                                       60



<PAGE>

     The Mark-to-Market Regulations provide that any REMIC Residual Interest
acquired after January 3, 1995 cannot be marked to market, regardless of the
value of such REMIC residual interest. However, holders of positive value REMIC
Residual Interests acquired on or prior to January 3, 1995 may continue to mark
such residual interests to market for the entire economic life of such
interests.

ADMINISTRATIVE MATTERS

     The REMIC's books must be maintained on a calendar year basis and the REMIC
must file an annual federal income tax return. The REMIC will also be subject to
the procedural and administrative rules of the Code applicable to partnerships,
including the determination of any adjustments to, among other things, items of
REMIC income, gain, loss, deduction, or credit, by the IRS in a unified
administrative proceeding.

TAX STATUS AS A GRANTOR TRUST

     General. As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement if a REMIC or
partnership election is not made and the Trust Fund is not treated as a division
of a sole owner in the opinion of Federal Tax Counsel, the Trust Fund relating
to a Series of Securities will be classified for federal income tax purposes as
a grantor trust under Subpart E, Part 1 of Subchapter J of Chapter 1 of Subtitle
A of the Code and not as an association taxable as a corporation (the Securities
of such Series, 'Pass-Through Securities'). In some Series there will be no
separation of the principal and interest payments on the Loans. In such
circumstances, a Holder will be considered to have purchased a pro rata
undivided interest in each of the Loans. In other cases ('Stripped Securities'),
sale of the Securities will produce a separation in the ownership of all or a
portion of the principal payments from all or a portion of the interest payments
on the Loans.

     Each Holder must report on its federal income tax return its share of the
gross income derived from the Loans (not reduced by the amount payable as fees
to the Trustee and the Servicer and similar fees (collectively, the 'Servicing
Fees')), at the same time and in the same manner as such items would have been
reported under the Holder's tax accounting method had it held its interest in
the Loans directly, received directly its share of the amounts received with
respect to the Loans, and paid directly its share of the Servicing Fees. In the
case of Pass-Through Securities other than Stripped Securities, such income will
consist of a pro rata share of all of the income derived from all of the Loans
and, in the case of Stripped Securities, such income will consist of a pro rata
share of the income derived from each stripped bond or stripped coupon in which
the Holder owns an interest. The Holder of a Security will generally be entitled
to deduct such Servicing Fees under Section 162 or Section 212 of the Code to
the extent that such Servicing Fees represent 'reasonable' compensation for the
services rendered by the Trustee and the Servicer (or third parties that are
compensated for the performance of services). In the case of a noncorporate
Holder, however, Servicing Fees (to the extent not otherwise disallowed, e.g.,
because they exceed reasonable compensation) will be deductible in computing
such Holder's regular tax liability only to the extent that such fees, when
added to other miscellaneous itemized deductions, exceed 2% of adjusted gross
income and may not be deducible to any extent in computing such Holder's
alternative minimum tax liability. In addition, for taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1990, the amount of itemized deductions otherwise allowable
for the taxable year for an individual whose adjusted gross income exceeds the
applicable amount (which amount will be adjusted for inflation in taxable years
beginning after 1990) will be reduced by the lesser of (i) 3% of the excess of
adjusted gross income over the applicable amount or (ii) 80% of the amount of
itemized deductions otherwise allowable for such taxable year. For taxable years
beginning after December 31, 1997, in the case of a partnership that has 100 or
more partners and elects to be treated as an 'electing large partnership,' 70
percent of such partnership's miscellaneous itemized deductions will be
disallowed, although the remaining deductions will generally be allowed at the
partnership level and will not be subject to the 2 percent floor that would
otherwise be applicable to individual partners.

     Discount or Premium on Pass-Through Securities. The Holder's purchase price
of a Pass-Through Security is to be allocated among the Loans in proportion to
their fair market values, determined as of the time of purchase of the
Securities. In the typical case, the Trustee (to the extent necessary to fulfill
its reporting obligations) will treat each Loan as having a fair market value
proportional to the share of the aggregate principal balances of all of the
Loans that it represents, since the Securities, unless otherwise specified in
the applicable Prospectus Supplement, will have a relatively uniform interest
rate and other common characteristics. To the extent that the portion of the
purchase price of a Pass-Through Security allocated to a Loan (other than to a
right to receive any accrued interest thereon and any undistributed principal
payments) is less than or greater

                                       61



<PAGE>

than the portion of the principal balance of the Loan allocable to the Security,
the interest in the Loan allocable to the Pass-Through Security will be deemed
to have been acquired at a discount or premium, respectively.

     The treatment of any discount will depend on whether the discount
represents OID or market discount. In the case of a Loan with OID in excess of a
prescribed de minimis amount or a Stripped Security, a Holder of a Security will
be required to report as interest income in each taxable year its share of the
amount of OID that accrues during that year in the manner described above. OID
with respect to a Loan could arise, for example, by virtue of the financing of
points by the originator of the Loan, or by virtue of the charging of points by
the originator of the Loan in an amount greater than a statutory de minimis
exception, in circumstances under which the points are not currently deductible
pursuant to applicable Code provisions. Any market discount or premium on a Loan
will be includible in income, generally in the manner described above, except
that in the case of Pass-Through Securities, market discount is calculated with
respect to the Loans underlying the Security, rather than with respect to the
Security. A Holder that acquires an interest in a Loan originated after July 18,
1984 with more than a de minimis amount of market discount (generally, the
excess of the principal amount of the Loan over the purchaser's allocable
purchase price) will be required to include accrued market discount in income in
the manner set forth above. See ' -- Taxation of Debt Securities; Market
Discount' and ' -- Premium' above.

     In the case of market discount on a Pass-Through Security attributable to
Loans originated on or before July 18, 1984, the Holder generally will be
required to allocate the portion of such discount that is allocable to a Loan
among the principal payments on the Loan and to include the discount allocable
to each principal payment in ordinary income at the time such principal payment
is made. Such treatment would generally result in discount being included in
income at a slower rate than discount would be required to be included in income
using the method described in the preceding paragraph.

     Stripped Securities. A Stripped Security may represent a right to receive
only a portion of the interest payments on the Loans, a right to receive only
principal payments on the Loans, or a right to receive certain payments of both
interest and principal. Certain Stripped Securities ('Ratio Strip Securities')
may represent a right to receive differing percentages of both the interest and
principal on each Loan. Pursuant to Section 1286 of the Code, the separation of
ownership of the right to receive some or all of the interest payments on an
obligation from ownership of the right to receive some or all of the principal
payments results in the creation of 'stripped bonds' with respect to principal
payments and 'stripped coupons' with respect to interest payments. Section 1286
of the Code applies the OID rules to stripped bonds and stripped coupons. For
purposes of computing original issue discount, a stripped bond or a stripped
coupon is treated as a debt instrument issued on he date that such stripped
interest is purchased with an issue price equal to its purchase price or, if
more than one stripped interest is purchased, the ratable share of the purchase
price allocable to such stripped interest.

     Servicing Fees in excess of reasonable servicing fees ('excess servicing')
will be treated under the stripped bond rules. If the excess servicing fee is
less than 100 basis points (i.e. 1% interest on the Loan principal balance) or
the Securities are initially sold with a de minimis discount (assuming no
prepayment assumption is required), any non-de minimis discount arising from a
subsequent transfer of the Securities should be treated as market discount. The
IRS appears to require that reasonable servicing fees be calculated on a Loan by
Loan basis, which could result in some Loans being treated as having more than
100 basis points of interest stripped off.

     The Code, OID Regulations and judicial decisions provide no direct guidance
as to how the interest and original issue discount rules are to apply to
Stripped Securities and other Pass-Through Securities. Under the method
described above for Pay-Through Securities (the 'Cash Flow Bond Method'), a
prepayment assumption is used and periodic recalculations are made which take
into account with respect to each accrual period the effect of prepayments
during such period. However, the 1986 Act does not, absent Treasury regulations,
appear specifically to cover instruments such as the Stripped Securities which
technically represent ownership interests in the underlying Loans, rather than
being debt instruments 'secured by' those Loans. Nevertheless, it is believed
that the Cash Flow Bond Method is a reasonable method of reporting income for
such Securities, and it is expected that OID will be reported on that basis
unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. In applying the
calculation to Pass-Through Securities, the Trustee will treat all payments to
be received by a Holder with respect to the underlying Loans as payments on a
single installment obligation. The IRS could, however, assert that original
issue discount must be calculated separately for each Loan underlying a
Security.

                                       62



<PAGE>

     Under certain circumstances, if the Loans prepay at a rate faster than the
Prepayment Assumption, the use of the Cash Flow Bond Method may accelerate a
Holder's recognition of income. If, however, the Loans prepay at a rate slower
than the Prepayment Assumption, in some circumstances the use of this method may
decelerate a Holder's recognition of income.

     Possible Alternative Characterizations. The characterizations of the
Stripped Securities described above are not the only possible interpretations of
the applicable Code provisions. Among other possibilities, the Internal Revenue
Service could contend that (i) in certain Series, each Security is composed of
an unstripped undivided ownership interest in Loans and an installment
obligation consisting of stripped principal payments; (ii) the Securities are
subject to the contingent payment provisions of the Proposed Regulations; or
(iii) each Stripped Security the payments on which consist primarily or solely
of a specified portion of the interest payments on Loans is composed of an
unstripped undivided ownership interest in Loans and an installment obligation
consisting of stripped interest payments.

     Given the variety of alternatives for treatment of the Stripped Securities
and the different federal income tax consequences that result from each
alternative, potential purchasers are urged to consult their own tax advisers
regarding the proper treatment of the Securities for federal income tax
purposes.

     Character as Qualifying Loans. In the case of Stripped Securities there is
no specific legal authority existing regarding whether the character of the
Securities, for federal income tax purposes, will be the same as the Loans. The
IRS could take the position that the Loans' character is not carried over to the
Securities in such circumstances. To the extent the Trust Fund's assets are
qualifying assets, Pass-Through Securities will be, and, although the matter is
not free from doubt, Stripped Securities should be considered to represent 'real
estate assets' within the meaning of Section 856(c)(5)(B) of the Code, and
'loans secured by an interest in real property' within the meaning of Section
7701(a)(19)(C)(v) of the Code; and interest income attributable to the
Securities should be considered to represent 'interest on obligations secured by
mortgages on real property or on interests in real property' with the meaning of
Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code. Reserves or funds underlying the Securities
may cause a proportionate reduction in the above-described qualifying status
categories of Securities.

SALE OR EXCHANGE

     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as to which a
partnership election is made, a Holder's tax basis in its Security is the price
such Holder pays for a Security, plus amounts of original issue or market
discount included in income and reduced by any payments received (other than
qualified stated interest payments) and any amortized premium. Gain or loss
recognized on a sale, exchange, or redemption of a Security, measured by the
difference between the amount realized and the Security's basis as so adjusted,
will generally be capital gain or loss, assuming that the Security is held as a
capital asset. In the case of a Security held by a bank, thrift, or similar
institution described in Section 582 of the Code, however, gain or loss realized
on the sale or exchange of a Regular Interest Security will be taxable as
ordinary income or loss. In addition, gain from the disposition of a Regular
Interest Security that might otherwise be capital gain will be treated as
ordinary income to the extent of the excess, if any, of (i) the amount that
would have been includible in the Holder's income if the yield on such Regular
Interest Security had equaled 110% of the applicable federal rate as of the
beginning of such Holder's holding period, over the amount of ordinary income
actually recognized by the Holder with respect to such Regular Interest
Security.

MISCELLANEOUS TAX ASPECTS

     Backup Withholding. Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust
Funds as to which a partnership election is made, a Holder, other than a Holder
of a Residual Interest Security, may, under certain circumstances, be subject to
'backup withholding' at a rate of 31% with respect to distributions or the
proceeds of a sale of certificates to or through brokers that represent interest
or original issue discount on the Securities. This withholding generally applies
if the Holder of a Security (i) fails to furnish the Trustee with its taxpayer
identification number ('TIN'); (ii) furnishes the Trustee an incorrect TIN;
(iii) fails to report properly interest, dividends or other 'reportable
payments' as defined in the Code; or (iv) under certain circumstances, fails to
provide the Trustee or such Holder's securities broker with a certified
statement, signed under penalty of perjury, that the TIN provided is its correct
number and that the Holder is not subject to backup withholding. Backup

                                       63



<PAGE>

withholding will not apply, however, with respect to certain payments made to
Holders, including payments to certain exempt recipients (such as exempt
organizations) and to certain Nonresidents (as defined below). Holders should
consult their tax advisers as to their qualification for exemption from backup
withholding and the procedure for obtaining the exemption.

     The Trustee will report to the Holders and to the Servicer for each
calendar year the amount of any 'reportable payments' during such year and the
amount of tax withheld, if any, with respect to payments on the Securities.

TAX TREATMENT OF FOREIGN INVESTORS

     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as to which a
partnership election is made, under the Code, unless interest (including OID)
paid on a Security (other than a Residual Interest Security) is considered to be
'effectively connected' with a trade or business conducted in the United States
by a Holder who is not a United States person, as defined below,
('Nonresidents'), such interest will normally qualify as portfolio interest
(except where (i) the recipient is a holder, directly or by attribution, of 10%
or more of the capital or profits interest in the issuer, or (ii) the recipient
is a controlled foreign corporation to which the issuer is a related person) and
will be exempt from federal income tax. Upon receipt of appropriate ownership
statements, the issuer normally will be relieved of obligations to withhold tax
from such interest payments. These provisions supersede the generally applicable
provisions of United States law that would otherwise require the issuer to
withhold at a 30% rate (unless such rate were reduced or eliminated by an
applicable tax treaty) on, among other things, interest and other fixed or
determinable, annual or periodic income paid to Nonresidents. Holders of
Pass-Through Securities and Stripped Securities, including Ratio Strip
Securities, however, may be subject to withholding to the extent that the Loans
were originated on or before July 18, 1984. For these purposes, the term 'United
States person' means (i) a citizen or resident of the United States, (ii) a
corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the
laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof, (iii) an estate
whose income is includable in gross income for United States federal income
taxation regardless of its source, and (iv) a trust for which one or more United
States fiduciaries have the authority to control all substantial decisions and
for which a court of the United States can exercise primary supervision over the
trust's administration. For years beginning before January 1, 1997, the term
'United States person' shall include a trust whose income in includible in gross
income for United States federal income taxation regardless of source, in lieu
of trusts described in (iv) above, unless the trust elects to have its United
States status determined under the criteria set forth in (iv) above for tax year
ending after August 20, 1996. Recently issued Treasury regulations (the 'Final
Withholding Regulations'), which are generally effective with respect to
payments made after December 31, 2000, consolidate and modify the current
certification requirements and means by which a Holder may claim exemption from
United States federal income tax withholding and provide certain presumptions
regarding the status of Holders when payments to the Holders cannot be reliably
associated with appropriate documentation provided to the payor. All Holders
should consult their tax advisers regarding the application of the Final
Withholding Regulations.

     Interest and OID of Holders who are Nonresidents are not subject to
withholding if they are effectively connected with a United States business
conducted by the Holder. They will, however, generally be subject to the regular
United States income tax.

     Payments to Holders of Residual Interest Securities who are Nonresidents
will generally be treated as interest for purposes of the 30% (or lower treaty
rate) United States withholding tax. Nonresidents should assume that such income
does not qualify for exemption from United States withholding tax as 'portfolio
interest.' It is clear that, to the extent that a payment represents a portion
of REMIC taxable income that constitutes excess inclusion income, a Holder of a
Residual Interest Security will not be entitled to an exemption from or
reduction of the 30% (or lower treaty rate) withholding tax rule. If the
payments are subject to United States withholding tax, they generally will be
taken into account for withholding tax purposes only when paid or distributed
(or when the Residual Interest Security is disposed of). The Treasury has
statutory authority, however, to promulgate regulations which would require such
amounts to be taken into account at an earlier time in order to prevent the
avoidance of tax. Such regulations could, for example, require withholding prior
to the distribution of cash in the case of Residual Interest Securities that do
not have significant value. Under the REMIC Regulations, if a Residual Interest
Security has tax avoidance potential, a transfer of a Residual Interest Security
to a Nonresident will be disregarded for all federal tax purposes. A Residual
Interest Security has tax

                                       64



<PAGE>

avoidance potential unless, at the time of the transfer the transferor
reasonably expects that the REMIC will distribute to the transferee residual
interest holder amounts that will equal at least 30% of each excess inclusion,
and that such amounts will be distributed at or after the time at which the
excess inclusions accrue and not later than the calendar year following the
calendar year of accrual. If a Nonresident transfers a Residual Interest
Security to a United States person, and if the transfer has the effect of
allowing the transferor to avoid tax on accrued excess inclusions, then the
transfer is disregarded and the transferor continues to be treated as the owner
of the Residual Interest Security for purposes of the withholding tax provisions
of the Code. See 'Taxation of Holders of Residual Interest Securities -- Excess
Inclusions.'

TAX CHARACTERIZATION OF THE TRUST AS A PARTNERSHIP

     Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its opinion that a Trust Fund for which a
partnership election is made will not be an association (or publicly traded
partnership) taxable as a corporation for federal income tax purposes assuming
that no action will be taken that is inconsistent with the treatment of the
Trust as a partnership (such as an election to treat the Trust as a corporation
for federal income tax purposes ('Corporation Election')). If, however, the
Trust has a single owner for federal income tax purposes, it will be treated as
a division of its owner and as such will be disregarded as an entity separate
from its owner for federal income tax purposes, assuming that no Corporation
Election is made. This opinion will be based on the assumption that the terms of
the Trust Agreement and related documents will be complied with, and on
counsel's conclusions that (1) the Trust Fund will not have certain
characteristics necessary for a business trust to be classified as an
association taxable as a corporation and (2) the nature of the income of the
Trust Fund will exempt it from the rule that certain publicly traded
partnerships are taxable as corporations or the issuance of the Certificates has
been structured as a private placement under an IRS safe harbor, so that the
Trust Fund will not be characterized as a publicly traded partnership taxable as
a corporation.

     If the Trust Fund were taxable as a corporation for federal income tax
purposes, the Trust Fund would be subject to corporate income tax on its taxable
income. The Trust Fund's taxable income would include all its income, possibly
reduced by its interest expense on the Notes. Any such corporate income tax
could materially reduce cash available to make payments on the Notes and
distributions on the Certificates, and Certificateholders could be liable for
any such tax that is unpaid by the Trust Fund.

TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE NOTES

     Treatment of the Notes as Indebtedness. The Trust Fund will agree, and the
Noteholders will agree by their purchase of Notes, to treat the Notes as debt
for federal income tax purposes. Except as otherwise provided in the related
Prospectus Supplement, Federal Tax Counsel will advise the Depositor that the
Notes will be classified as debt for federal income tax purposes. The discussion
below assumes this characterization of the Notes is correct.

     OID, Indexed Securities, etc. The discussion below assumes that all
payments on the Notes are denominated in U.S. dollars, and that the Notes are
not Indexed Securities or Strip Notes. Moreover, the discussion assumes that the
interest formula for the Notes meets the requirements for 'qualified stated
interest' under the OID regulations, and that any OID on the Notes (i.e., any
excess of the principal amount of the Notes over their issue price) does not
exceed a de minimis amount (i.e., 0.25% of their principal amount multiplied by
the number of full years included in their term), all within the meaning of the
OID regulations. If these conditions are not satisfied with respect to any given
Series of Notes, additional tax considerations with respect to such Notes will
be disclosed in the applicable Prospectus Supplement.

     Interest Income on the Notes. Based on the above assumptions, except as
discussed in the following paragraph, the Notes will not be considered issued
with OID. The stated interest thereon will be taxable to a Noteholder as
ordinary interest income when received or accrued in accordance with such
Noteholder's method of tax accounting. Under the OID regulations, a Holder of a
Note issued with a de minimis amount of OID must include such OID in income, on
a pro rata basis, as principal payments are made on the Note. It is believed
that any prepayment premium paid as a result of a mandatory redemption will be
taxable as contingent interest when it becomes fixed and unconditionally
payable. A purchaser who buys a Note for more or less than its principal amount
will generally be subject, respectively, to the premium amortization or market
discount rules of the Code.

                                       65



<PAGE>

     A holder of a Note that has a fixed maturity date of not more than one year
from the issue date of such Note (a 'Short-Term Note') may be subject to special
rules. An accrual basis Holder of a Short-Term Note (and certain cash method
Holders, including regulated investment companies, as set forth in Section 1281
of the Code) generally would be required to report interest income as interest
accrues on a straight-line basis over the term of each interest period. Other
cash basis Holders of a Short-Term Note would, in general, be required to report
interest income as interest is paid (or, if earlier, upon the taxable
disposition of the Short-Term Note). However, a cash basis Holder of a
Short-Term Note reporting interest income as it is paid may be required to defer
a portion of any interest expense otherwise deductible on indebtedness incurred
to purchase or carry the Short-Term Note until the taxable disposition of the
Short-Term Note. A cash basis taxpayer may elect under Section 1281 of the Code
to accrue interest income on all nongovernment debt obligations with a term of
one year or less, in which case the taxpayer would include interest on the
Short-Term Note in income as it accrues, but would not be subject to the
interest expense deferral rule referred to in the preceding sentence. Certain
special rules apply if a Short-Term Note is purchased for more or less than its
principal amount.

     Sale or Other Disposition. If a Noteholder sells a Note, the Holder will
recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the amount
realized on the sale and the Holder's adjusted tax basis in the Note. The
adjusted tax basis of a Note to a particular Noteholder will equal the Holder's
cost for the Note, increased by any market discount, acquisition discount, OID
and gain previously included by such Noteholder in income with respect to the
Note and decreased by the amount of bond premium (if any) previously amortized
and by the amount of principal payments previously received by such Noteholder
with respect to such Note. Any such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss if
the Note was held as a capital asset, except for gain representing accrued
interest and accrued market discount not previously included in income. Capital
losses generally may be used only to offset capital gains.

     Foreign Holders. Interest payments made (or accrued) to a Noteholder who is
a Holder other than a United States Person, as defined below, (a 'foreign
person') generally will be considered 'portfolio interest', and generally will
not be subject to United States federal income tax and withholding tax, if the
interest is not effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business
within the United States by the foreign person and the foreign person (i) is not
actually or constructively a '10 percent shareholder' of the Trust or the Seller
(including a Holder of 10% of the outstanding Certificates) or a 'controlled
foreign corporation' with respect to which the Trust or the Seller is a 'related
person' within the meaning of the Code and (ii) provides the Owner Trustee or
other person who is otherwise required to withhold U.S. tax with respect to the
Notes with an appropriate statement (on Form W-8 or a similar form), signed
under penalties of perjury, certifying that the beneficial owner of the Note is
a foreign person and providing the foreign person's name and address. If a Note
is held through a securities clearing organization or certain other financial
institutions, the organization or institution may provide the relevant signed
statement to the withholding agent; in that case, however, the signed statement
must be accompanied by a Form W-8 or substitute form provided by the foreign
person that owns the Note. If such interest is not portfolio interest, then it
will be subject to United States federal income and withholding tax at a rate of
30 percent, unless reduced or eliminated pursuant to an applicable tax treaty.
For these purposes, the term 'United States person' means (i) a citizen or
resident of the United States, (ii) a corporation or partnership (including an
entity treated as a corporation or partnership for U.S. federal income tax
purposes) created or organized in or under the laws of the United States or any
State thereof or the District of Columbia (unless, in the case of a partnership,
Treasury regulations are adopted that provide otherwise), (iii) an estate whose
income is includable in gross income for United States federal income taxation
regardless of its source, and (iv) a trust for which one or more United States
persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions and for which a
court of the United States can exercise primary supervision over the trust's
administration. In addition, certain trusts that would otherwise not qualify as
U.S. Persons under the foregoing definition can elect to be treated as U.S.
Persons. Recently adopted Treasury regulations make certain modifications to the
withholding, backup withholding, and information reporting rules described in
the prospectus. These new regulations attempt to unify certification
requirements and modify reliance standards and are generally effective for
payments made after December 31, 2000. Prospective investors are urged to
consult their own tax advisors regarding the affect these regulations may have
on their particular circumstances.

     The Final Withholding Regulations consolidate and modify the current
certification requirements and means by which a Non-Resident may claim exemption
from United States federal income tax withholding. All Non-Residents should
consult their tax advisors regarding the application of the Final Withholding
Regulations, which are generally effective with respect to payments made after
December 31, 2000.

                                       66



<PAGE>

     Any capital gain realized on the sale, redemption, retirement or other
taxable disposition of a Note by a foreign person will be exempt from United
States federal income and withholding tax, provided that (i) such gain is not
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person and (ii) in the case of an individual foreign
person, the foreign person is not present in the United States for 183 days or
more in the taxable year.

     Backup Withholding. Each Holder of a Note (other than an exempt Holder such
as a corporation, tax-exempt organization, qualified pension and profit-sharing
trust, individual retirement account or nonresident alien who provides
certification as to status as a nonresident) will be required to provide, under
penalties of perjury, a certificate containing the Holder's name, address,
correct federal taxpayer identification number and a statement that the holder
is not subject to backup withholding. Should a nonexempt Noteholder fail to
provide the required certification, the Trust Fund will be required to withhold
31 percent of the amount otherwise payable to the Holder, and remit the withheld
amount to the IRS as a credit against the Holder's federal income tax liability.

     Possible Alternative Treatments of the Notes. If, contrary to the opinion
of Federal Tax Counsel, the IRS successfully asserted that one or more of the
Notes did not represent debt for federal income tax purposes, the Notes might be
treated as equity interests in the Trust Fund. If so treated, the Trust Fund
might be taxable as a corporation with the adverse consequences described above
(and the taxable corporation would not be able to reduce its taxable income by
deductions for interest expense on Notes recharacterized as equity).
Alternatively, and most likely in the view of Federal Tax Counsel, the Trust
Fund might be treated as a publicly traded partnership that would not be taxable
as a corporation because it would meet certain qualifying income tests.
Nonetheless, treatment of the Notes as equity interests in such a publicly
traded partnership could have adverse tax consequences to certain Holders. For
example, income to certain tax-exempt entities (including pension funds) would
be 'unrelated business taxable income,' income to foreign holders generally
would be subject to U.S. tax and U.S. tax return filing and withholding
requirements, and individual Holders might be subject to certain limitations on
their ability to deduct their share of the Trust Fund's expenses.

TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE CERTIFICATES

     Treatment of the Trust Fund as a Partnership. The Trust Fund and the
Depositor will agree, and the Certificateholders will agree by their purchase of
Certificates, to treat the Trust Fund as a partnership for purposes of federal
and state income tax, franchise tax and any other tax measured in whole or in
part by income, with the assets of the partnership being the assets held by the
Trust Fund, the partners of the partnership being the Certificateholders, and
the Notes being debt of the partnership. However, the proper characterization of
the arrangement involving the Trust Fund, the Certificates, the Notes, the Trust
Fund and the Servicer is not clear because there is no authority on transactions
closely comparable to that contemplated herein.

     A variety of alternative characterizations are possible. For example,
because the Certificates have certain features characteristic of debt, the
Certificates might be considered debt of the Trust Fund. Any such
characterization would not result in materially adverse tax consequences to
Certificateholders as compared to the consequences from treatment of the
Certificates as equity in a partnership, described below. The following
discussion assumes that the Certificates represent equity interests in a
partnership.

     Indexed Securities, etc. The following discussion assumes that all payments
on the Certificates are denominated in U.S. dollars, none of the Certificates
are Indexed Securities or Strip Certificates, and that a Series of Securities
includes a single Class of Certificates. If these conditions are not satisfied
with respect to any given Series of Certificates, additional tax considerations
with respect to such Certificates will be disclosed in the applicable Prospectus
Supplement.

     Partnership Taxation. As a partnership, the Trust Fund will not be subject
to federal income tax. Rather, each Certificateholder will be required to
separately take into account such Holder's allocated share of income, gains,
losses, deductions and credits of the Trust Fund. The Trust Fund's income will
consist primarily of interest and finance charges earned on the Loans (including
appropriate adjustments for market discount, OID and bond premium) and any gain
upon collection or disposition of Loans. The Trust Fund's deductions will
consist primarily of interest accruing with respect to the Notes, servicing and
other fees, and losses or deductions upon collection or disposition of Loans.

                                       67



<PAGE>

     The tax items of a partnership are allocable to the partners in accordance
with the Code, Treasury regulations and the partnership agreement (here, the
Trust Agreement and related documents). Except as disclosed in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Trust Agreement will provide, in general, that the
Certificateholders will be allocated taxable income of the Trust Fund for each
month equal to the sum of (i) the interest that accrues on the Certificates in
accordance with their terms for such month, including interest accruing at the
Pass-Through Rate for such month and interest on amounts previously due on the
Certificates but not yet distributed; (ii) any Trust Fund income attributable to
discount on the Loans that corresponds to any excess of the principal amount of
the Certificates over their initial issue price; (iii) prepayment premium
payable to the Certificateholders for such month; and (iv) any other amounts of
income payable to the Certificateholders for such month. Such allocation will be
reduced by any amortization by the Trust Fund of premium on Loans that
corresponds to any excess of the issue price of Certificates over their
principal amount. All remaining taxable income of the Trust Fund will be
allocated to the Depositor. Based on the economic arrangement of the parties,
this approach for allocating Trust Fund income should be permissible under
applicable Treasury regulations, although no assurance can be given that the IRS
would not require a greater amount of income to be allocated to
Certificateholders. Moreover, even under the foregoing method of allocation,
Certificateholders may be allocated income equal to the entire Pass-Through Rate
plus the other items described above even though the Trust Fund might not have
sufficient cash to make current cash distributions of such amount. Thus, cash
basis Holders will in effect be required to report income from the Certificates
on the accrual basis and Certificateholders may become liable for taxes on Trust
Fund income even if they have not received cash from the Trust Fund to pay such
taxes. In addition, because tax allocations and tax reporting will be done on a
uniform basis for all Certificateholders but Certificateholders may be
purchasing Certificates at different times and at different prices,
Certificateholders may be required to report on their tax returns taxable income
that is greater or less than the amount reported to them by the Trust Fund.

     A Certificateholder that is a pension, profit sharing or employee benefit
plan or other tax-exempt entity (including an individual retirement account)
will realize from a Certificate 'unrelated business taxable income' as a result
of the 'Debt Financed Income' rules under the Code.

     An individual taxpayer's share of expenses of the Trust Fund (including
fees to the Servicer but not interest expense) would be miscellaneous itemized
deductions. Such deductions might be disallowed to the individual in whole or in
part and might result in such Holder being taxed on an amount of income that
exceeds the amount of cash actually distributed to such Holder over the life of
the Trust Fund.

     The Trust Fund intends to make all tax calculations relating to income and
allocations to Certificateholders on an aggregate basis. If the IRS were to
require that such calculations be made separately for each Loan, the Trust Fund
might be required to incur additional expense but it is believed that there
would not be a material adverse effect on Certificateholders.

     Discount and Premium. It is believed that the Loans were not issued with
OID and, therefore, the Trust should not have OID income. However, the purchase
price paid by the Trust Fund for the Loans may be greater or less than the
remaining principal balance of the Loans at the time of purchase. If so, the
Loan will have been acquired at a premium or discount, as the case may be. (As
indicated above, the Trust Fund will make this calculation on an aggregate
basis, but might be required to recompute it on a Loan by Loan basis.)

     If the Trust Fund acquires the Loans at a market discount or premium, the
Trust Fund will elect to include any such discount in income currently as it
accrues over the life of the Loans or to offset any such premium against
interest income on the Loans. As indicated above, a portion of such market
discount income or premium deduction may be allocated to Certificateholders.

     Section 708 Termination. Under Section 708 of the Code, the Trust Fund will
be deemed to terminate for federal income tax purposes if 50% or more of the
capital and profits interests in the Trust Fund are sold or exchanged within a
12-month period. If such a termination occurs, the Trust Fund will be considered
to contribute its assets to a new partnership in exchange for partnership
interests therein, and then dissolve and distribute the new partnership
interests to the partners. The Trust Fund will not comply with certain technical
requirements that might apply when such a constructive termination occurs. As a
result, the Trust Fund may be subject to certain tax penalties and may incur
additional expenses if it is required to comply with those requirements.
Furthermore, the Trust Fund might not be able to comply due to lack of data.

                                       68



<PAGE>

     Disposition of Certificates. Generally, capital gain or loss will be
recognized on a sale of Certificates in an amount equal to the difference
between the amount realized and the seller's tax basis in the Certificates sold.
A Certificateholder's tax basis in a Certificate will generally equal the
Holder's cost increased by the Holder's share of Trust Fund income (includible
in income) and decreased by any distributions received with respect to such
Certificate. In addition, both the tax basis in the Certificates and the amount
realized on a sale of a Certificate would include the Holder's share of the
Notes and other liabilities of the Trust Fund. A Holder acquiring Certificates
at different prices may be required to maintain a single aggregate adjusted tax
basis in such Certificates, and, upon sale or other disposition of some of the
Certificates, allocate a portion of such aggregate tax basis to the Certificates
sold (rather than maintaining a separate tax basis in each Certificate for
purposes of computing gain or loss on a sale of that Certificate).

     Any gain on the sale of a Certificate attributable to the Holder's share of
unrecognized accrued market discount on the Loans would generally be treated as
ordinary income to the Holder and would give rise to special tax reporting
requirements. The Trust Fund does not expect to have any other assets that would
give rise to such special reporting requirements. Thus, to avoid those special
reporting requirements, the Trust Fund will elect to include market discount in
income as it accrues.

     If a Certificateholder is required to recognize an aggregate amount of
income (not including income attributable to disallowed itemized deductions
described above) over the life of the Certificates that exceeds the aggregate
cash distributions with respect thereto, such excess will generally give rise to
a capital loss upon the retirement of the Certificates.

     Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees. In general, the Trust
Fund's taxable income and losses will be determined monthly and the tax items
for a particular calendar month will be apportioned among the Certificateholders
in proportion to the principal amount of Certificates owned by them as of the
close of the last day of such month. As a result, a Holder purchasing
Certificates may be allocated tax items (which will affect its tax liability and
tax basis) attributable to periods before the actual transaction.

     The use of such a monthly convention may not be permitted by existing
regulations. If a monthly convention is not allowed (or only applies to
transfers of less than all of the partner's interest), taxable income or losses
of the Trust Fund might be reallocated among the Certificateholders. The Trust
Fund's method of allocation between transferors and transferees may be revised
to conform to a method permitted by future regulations.

     Section 754 Election. In the event that a Certificateholder sells its
Certificates at a profit (loss), the purchasing Certificateholder will have a
higher (lower) basis in the Certificates than the selling Certificateholder had.
The tax basis of the Trust Fund's assets will not be adjusted to reflect that
higher (or lower) basis unless the Trust Fund were to file an election under
Section 754 of the Code. In order to avoid the administrative complexities that
would be involved in keeping accurate accounting records, as well as potentially
onerous information reporting requirements, the Trust Fund will not make such
election. As a result, Certificateholders might be allocated a greater or lesser
amount of Trust Fund income than would be appropriate based on their own
purchase price for Certificates.

     Administrative Matters. The Owner Trustee is required to keep or have kept
complete and accurate books of the Trust Fund. Such books will be maintained for
financial reporting and tax purposes on an accrual basis and the fiscal year of
the Trust Fund will be the calendar year. The Trustee will file a partnership
information return (IRS Form 1065) with the IRS for each taxable year of the
Trust Fund and will report each Certificateholder's allocable share of items of
Trust Fund income and expense to Holders and the IRS on Schedule K-1. The Trust
Fund will provide the Schedule K-1 information to nominees that fail to provide
the Trust Fund with the information statement described below and such nominees
will be required to forward such information to the beneficial owners of the
Certificates. Generally, Holders must file tax returns that are consistent with
the information return filed by the Trust Fund or be subject to penalties unless
the Holder notifies the IRS of all such inconsistencies.

     Under Section 6031 of the Code, any person that holds Certificates as a
nominee at any time during a calendar year is required to furnish the Trust Fund
with a statement containing certain information on the nominee, the beneficial
owners and the Certificates so held. Such information includes (i) the name,
address and taxpayer identification number of the nominee and (ii) as to each
beneficial owner (x) the name, address and identification number of such person,
(y) whether such person is a United States person, a tax-exempt entity or a

                                       69



<PAGE>

foreign government, an international organization, or any wholly owned agency or
instrumentality of either of the foregoing, and (z) certain information on
Certificates that were held, bought or sold on behalf of such person throughout
the year. In addition, brokers and financial institutions that hold Certificates
through a nominee are required to furnish directly to the Trust Fund information
as to themselves and their ownership of Certificates. A clearing agency
registered under Section 17A of the Exchange Act is not required to furnish any
such information statement to the Trust Fund. The information referred to above
for any calendar year must be furnished to the Trust Fund on or before the
following January 31. Nominees, brokers and financial institutions that fail to
provide the Trust Fund with the information described above may be subject to
penalties.

     The Depositor will be designated as the tax matters partner in the related
Trust Agreement and, as such, will be responsible for representing the
Certificateholders in any dispute with the IRS. The Code provides for
administrative examination of a partnership as if the partnership were a
separate and distinct taxpayer. Generally, the statute of limitations for
partnership items does not expire before three years after the date on which the
partnership information return is filed. Any adverse determination following an
audit of the return of the Trust Fund by the appropriate taxing authorities
could result in an adjustment of the returns of the Certificateholders, and,
under certain circumstances, a Certificateholder may be precluded from
separately litigating a proposed adjustment to the items of the Trust Fund. An
adjustment could also result in an audit of a Certificateholder's returns and
adjustments of items not related to the income and losses of the Trust Fund.

     Tax Consequences to Foreign Certificateholders. It is not clear whether the
Trust Fund would be considered to be engaged in a trade or business in the
United States for purposes of federal withholding taxes with respect to foreign
persons because there is no clear authority dealing with that issue under facts
substantially similar to those described herein. Although it is not expected
that the Trust Fund would be engaged in a trade or business in the United States
for such purposes, the Trust Fund will withhold as if it were so engaged in
order to protect the Trust Fund from possible adverse consequences of a failure
to withhold. The Trust Fund expects to withhold on the portion of its taxable
income that is allocable to a Certificateholder which is a foreign person
pursuant to Section 1446 of the Code, as if such income were effectively
connected to a U.S. trade or business, at a rate of 35% for Holders which are
foreign persons that are taxable as corporations and 39.6% for all other Holders
which are foreign persons. Subsequent adoption of Treasury regulations or the
issuance of other administrative pronouncements may require the Trust Fund to
change its withholding procedures. In determining a Holder's withholding status,
the Trust Fund may rely on IRS Form W-8, IRS Form W-9 or the Holder's
certification of nonforeign status signed under penalties of perjury.

     Each Certificateholder which is a foreign person might be required to file
a U.S. individual or corporate income tax return (including, in the case of a
corporation, the branch profits tax) on its share of the Trust Fund's income.
Each Certificateholder which is a foreign person must obtain a taxpayer
identification number from the IRS and submit that number to the Trust Fund on
Form W-8 in order to assure appropriate crediting of the taxes withheld. A
Certificateholder which is a foreign person generally would be entitled to file
with the IRS a claim for refund with respect to taxes withheld by the Trust Fund
taking the position that no taxes were due because the Trust Fund was not
engaged in a U.S. trade or business. However, interest payments made (or
accrued) to a Certificateholder who is a foreign person generally will be
considered guaranteed payments to the extent such payments are determined
without regard to the income of the Trust Fund. As a result, Certificateholders
which are foreign persons will be subject to United States federal income tax
and withholding tax at a rate of 30%, unless reduced or eliminated pursuant to
an applicable treaty. In such case, a Certificateholder which is a foreign
person would only be entitled to claim a refund for that portion of the taxes in
excess of the taxes that should be withheld with respect to the guaranteed
payments.

     The Final Withholding Regulations consolidate and modify the current
certification requirements and means by which a Non-Resident may claim exemption
from United States federal income tax withholding. All Non-Residents should
consult their tax advisors regarding the application of the Final Withholding
Regulations, which are generally effective with respect to payments made after
December 31, 2000.

     Backup Withholding. Distributions made on the Certificates and proceeds
from the sale of the Certificates will be subject to a 'backup' withholding tax
of 31% if, in general, the Certificateholder fails to comply with certain
identification procedures, unless the Holder is an exempt recipient under
applicable provisions of the Code.

                                       70



<PAGE>

                            STATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS

     In addition to the federal income tax consequences described in 'Certain
Federal Income Tax Considerations,' potential investors should consider the
state and local income tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership, and
disposition of the Securities. State and local income tax law may differ
substantially from the corresponding federal law, and this discussion does not
purport to describe any aspect of the income tax laws of any state or locality.
Therefore, potential investors should consult their own tax advisors with
respect to the various state and local tax consequences of an investment in the
Securities.

                              ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

     The Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ('ERISA')
and Section 4975 of the Code impose certain restrictions on employee benefit
plans subject to ERISA and plans and other arrangements subject to Section 4975
of the Code and on persons who are parties in interest or disqualified persons
('parties in interest') with respect to such plans or arrangements. Certain
employee benefit plans, such as governmental plans and church plans (if no
election has been made under Section 410(d) of the Code), are not subject to the
restrictions of ERISA, and assets of such plans may be invested in the
Securities without regard to the ERISA considerations described below, subject
to other applicable federal and state law. However, any such governmental or
church plan which is qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code and exempt from
taxation under Section 501(a) of the Code is subject to the prohibited
transaction rules set forth in Section 503 of the Code.

     A fiduciary of an employee benefit plan subject to Title I of ERISA should
consider the fiduciary standards under ERISA in the context of the plan's
particular circumstances before authorizing an investment of a portion of such
plan's assets in the Securities. Accordingly, among other factors, such
fiduciary should consider (i) whether the investment is for the exclusive
benefit of plan participants and their beneficiaries; (ii) whether the
investment satisfies the diversification requirements of Section 404 of ERISA;
(iii) whether the investment is in accordance with the documents and instruments
governing the plan and (iv) whether the investment is prudent, considering the
nature of the investment, the overall investment policy of the Plan and the
composition of the Plan's portfolio. Fiduciaries of such plans also should
consider ERISA's prohibition on improper delegation of control over, or
responsibility for, plan assets.

     In addition, fiduciaries of employee benefit plans subject to Title I of
ERISA, as well as of certain plans or other retirement arrangements not subject
to ERISA but subject to Section 4975 of the Code (such as individual retirement
accounts and Keogh plans covering only a sole proprietor or partners) and any
entity, including an insurance company general account, whose underlying assets
include plan assets by reason of such a plan investing in such entity,
(collectively, 'Plans'), should consult with their legal counsel to determine
whether an investment in the Securities will cause the assets of the Trust Fund
to be considered plan assets pursuant to the plan asset regulations set forth at
29 CFR 'SS' 2510.3-101 (the 'Regulation'), thereby subjecting the Trustee and
any entities providing services with respect to the operation of the Trust to
the fiduciary standards of ERISA, and causing the excise tax provisions of
Section 4975 of the Code to apply to the operations of the Trust Fund unless a
statutory or regulatory exception or an administrative exemption granted by the
Department of Labor ('DOL') applies to the purchase, sale, transfer or holding
of the Securities.

     The Regulation contains rules for determining what constitutes the assets
of a Plan. The Regulation provides that, as a general rule, the underlying
assets and properties of corporations, partnerships, trusts and certain other
entities in which a Plan acquires an 'equity interest' will be deemed for
purposes of ERISA to be assets of the Plan unless certain exceptions apply.

     Under the terms of the Regulation, the Trust Fund may be deemed to hold
plan assets by reason of a Plan's investment in a Security if the Security
constitutes an 'equity interest' within the meaning of the Regulation; such plan
assets would include an undivided interest in the Primary Assets and any other
assets held by the Trust Fund. In such an event, persons providing services with
respect to the operation of the Trust Fund may be parties in interest with
respect to Plans that invest in the Trust, and subject to the fiduciary
responsibility provisions of Title I of ERISA, including the prohibited
transaction provisions of Section 406 of ERISA and of Section 4975 of the Code,
with respect to transactions involving such assets unless such transactions are
subject to a statutory or regulatory exception or an administrative exemption.

                                       71



<PAGE>

     The Regulation treats an entity as holding plan assets if a Plan acquires
an 'equity interest' in the entity. Therefore, if such interest is treated as
indebtedness under applicable local law and has no substantial equity features,
ownership of the interest by a Plan will not cause the entity's assets to
constitute plan assets. Generally, a profits interest in a partnership, an
undivided ownership interest in property and a beneficial ownership interest in
a trust are deemed to be 'equity interests' under the Regulation. If Notes of a
particular Series were deemed to be indebtedness under applicable local law
without any substantial equity features, an investing Plan's assets would
include such Notes, but not, by reason of such purchase, the underlying assets
of the Trust Fund. However, without regard to whether the Notes are treated as
an equity interest for such purposes, the purchase, holding or transfer of Notes
by or on behalf of a Plan could be a prohibited transaction if the Depositor or
the Trustee or any of their respective affiliates is, or becomes, a party in
interest or disqualified person with respect to such Plan.

     An exception applies if the class of equity interests in question is: (i)
'widely held' (held by 100 or more investors who are independent of the
Depositor and each other); (ii) freely transferable; and (iii) sold as part of
an offering pursuant to (A) an effective registration statement under the
Securities Act of 1933, and then subsequently registered under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 or (B) an effective registration statement under Section
12(b) or 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 ('Publicly Offered
Securities'). In addition, the Regulation provides that if at all times more
than 75% of the value of each class of equity interests in the Trust Fund is
held by investors other than benefit plan investors (which is defined as
including both Plans and employee benefit plans not subject to ERISA, including
foreign plans and government plans), the investing Plan's assets will not
include any of the underlying assets of the Trust Fund.

     If no exception under the Regulation applies and the assets of the Trust
Fund are treated as plan assets, an exemption may be available for the purchase,
holding and transfer of the Securities. The Department of Labor granted to Bear,
Stearns & Co. Inc., an administrative exemption, Prohibited Transaction
Exemption 90-30 (Application No. D-8207, 55 Fed. Reg. 21461) (1990) (the
'Exemption'), from certain of the prohibited transaction rules of ERISA with
respect to the initial purchase, the holding and the subsequent resale by Plans
of Certificates representing interests in asset-backed pass-through trusts that
consist of certain receivables, loans and other obligations that meet the
conditions and requirements of the Exemption, wherever Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.
or its affiliate is the sole underwriter, the manager or co-manager of an
underwriting syndicate or the selling or placement agent. The obligations
covered by the Exemption include obligations such as the Primary Assets (other
than Private Securities which are not insured or guaranteed by the United States
or an agency or instrumentality thereof, or Home Improvement Contracts that are
unsecured). If the Trust Fund consists solely of assets covered by the
Exemption, the Exemption will apply to the acquisition, holding and transfer of
the Certificates by a Plan, provided that certain conditions (certain of which
are described below) are met.

     Among the conditions which must be satisfied for the Exemption to apply are
the following:

          (i) The acquisition of the Certificates by a Plan is on terms
     (including the price for the Certificates) that are at least as favorable
     to the Plan as they would be in an arm's-length transaction with an
     unrelated party;

          (ii) The rights and interests evidenced by the Certificates acquired
     by the Plan are not subordinated to the rights and interests evidenced by
     other certificates of the trust;

          (iii) The Certificates acquired by the Plan have received a rating at
     the time of such acquisition that is in one of the three highest generic
     rating categories from either Standard & Poor's, a Division of The
     McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., Moody's Investors Service, Inc., Duff & Phelps
     Inc. or Fitch IBCA, Inc. (each, a 'Rating Agency');

          (iv) The sum of all payments made to the underwriter in connection
     with the distribution of the Certificates represents not more than
     reasonable compensation for underwriting the Certificates. The sum of all
     payments made to and retained by the seller pursuant to the sale of the
     obligations to the trust represents not more than the fair market value of
     such obligations. The sum of all payments made to and retained by the
     servicer represents not more than reasonable compensation for the
     servicer's services under the related servicing agreement and reimbursement
     of the servicer's reasonable expenses in connection therewith;

          (v) The Trustee must not be an affiliate of any other member of the
     Restricted Group (as defined below); and

                                       72



<PAGE>

          (vi) The Plan investing in the Certificates is an 'accredited
     investor' as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of the Securities
     and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933.

     The trust also must meet the following requirements:

          (i) the corpus of the trust must consist solely of assets of the type
     which have been included in other investment pools;

          (ii) certificates in such other investment pools must have been rated
     in one of the three highest generic rating categories of a Rating Agency
     for at least one year prior to the Plan's acquisition of securities; and

          (iii) certificates evidencing interests in such other investment pools
     must have been purchased by investors other than Plans for at least one
     year prior to any Plan's acquisition of Securities.

     Moreover, the Exemption provides relief from certain self dealing/conflict
of interest prohibited transactions that may occur when the Plan fiduciary
causes a Plan to acquire securities in a trust holding receivables on which the
fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor; provided that, among other
requirements: (i) in the case of an acquisition in connection with the initial
issuance of Certificates, at least fifty (50) percent of each Class of
Certificates in which Plans have invested is acquired by persons independent of
the Restricted Group and at least fifty (50) percent of the aggregate interest
in the trust is acquired by persons independent of the Restricted Group; (ii)
such fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor with respect to five (5) percent
or less of the fair market value of the obligations contained in the trust;
(iii) the Plan's investment in Certificates does not exceed twenty-five (25)
percent of all of the Certificates outstanding after the acquisition; and (iv)
no more than twenty-five (25) percent of the assets of any Plan for which the
person serves as fiduciary are invested in certificates representing an interest
in one or more trusts containing assets sold or serviced by the same entity. The
Exemption does not apply to Plans sponsored by the Depositor, the underwriters
of the Certificates, the Trustee, the Servicer, any obligor with respect to
obligations included in a Trust Fund constituting more than five (5) percent of
the aggregate unamortized principal balance of the assets in a Trust Fund, or
any affiliate of such parties (the 'Restricted Group').

     On July 21, 1997, the DOL published in the Federal Register an amendment to
the Exemption which extends exemptive relief to certain mortgage-backed
securities transactions using pre-funding accounts for trusts issuing
pass-through certificates. The amendment generally allows a portion of the
mortgages ('Loans') supporting payments to Certificateholders and having a
principal amount equal to no more than 25% of the total principal amount of the
Certificates to be transferred to the Trust within a 90-day or three-month
period following the Closing Date ('Pre-Funding Period'), instead of requiring
that all such Loans be either identified or transferred on or before the Closing
Date. The relief is available when the following conditions are met:

          (1) The ratio of the amount allocated to the Pre-Funding Account to
     the total principal amount of the Certificates being offered ('Pre-Funding
     Limit') must not exceed twenty-five percent (25%).

          (2) All Loans transferred after the Closing Date ('Additional Loans')
     must meet the same terms and conditions for eligibility as the original
     Loans used to create the Trust, which terms and conditions have been
     approved by a Rating Agency.

          (3) The transfer of such Additional Loans to the Trust during the
     Pre-Funding Period must not result in the Certificates receiving a lower
     credit rating from a Rating Agency upon termination of the Pre-Funding
     Period than the rating that was obtained at the time of the initial
     issuance of the Certificates by the Trust.

          (4) Solely as a result of the use of pre-funding, the weighted average
     annual percentage interest rate (the 'average interest rate') for all of
     the Loans in the Trust at the end of the Pre-Funding Period must not be
     more than 100 basis points lower than the average interest rate for the
     Loans which were transferred to the Trust on the Closing Date.

          (5) In order to insure that the characteristics of the Additional
     Loans are substantially similar to the original Loans which were
     transferred to the Trust: (i) the characteristics of the Additional Loans
     must be monitored by an insurer or other credit support provider which is
     independent of the Depositor; or (ii) an independent accountant retained by
     the Depositor must provide the Depositor with a letter (with copies
     provided to each Rating Agency rating the Certificates, the Underwriter and
     the Trustee) stating whether or not the characteristics of the Additional
     Loans conform to the characteristics described in the Prospectus and
     Prospectus Supplement ('Offering Documents') and/or Pooling and Servicing
     Agreement or Sale and

                                       73



<PAGE>

     Servicing Agreement. In preparing such letter, the independent accountant
     must use the same type of procedures as were applicable to the Loans which
     were transferred as of the Closing Date.

          (6) The Pre-Funding Period must end no later than three months or 90
     days after the Closing Date or earlier, in certain circumstances, if the
     amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account is reduced below the minimum
     level specified in the Agreement or an event of default occurs under the
     Agreement.

          (7) Amounts transferred to any Pre-Funding Account and/or Capitalized
     Interest Account used in connection with the pre-funding may be invested
     only in certain permitted investments ('Permitted Investments').

          (8) The Offering Documents must describe: (i) any Pre-Funding Account
     and/or Capitalized Interest Account used in connection with a Pre-Funding
     Account; (ii) the duration of the Pre-Funding Period; (iii) the percentage
     and/or dollar amount of the Pre-Funding Limit for the Trust; and (iv) that
     the amounts remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the
     Pre-Funding Period will be remitted to Certificateholders as repayments of
     principal.

          (9) The Pooling and Servicing Agreement must describe the Permitted
     Investments for the Pre-Funding Account and Capitalized Interest Account
     and, if not disclosed in the Offering Documents, the terms and conditions
     for eligibility of the Additional Loans.

     In the event that the Exemption is not applicable, including, for example,
when the Securities issued by the Trust Fund are Notes rather than Certificates,
some other prohibited transaction class exemption issued by the DOL, such as
PTCE 96-23 (relating to investments by in-house asset managers), PTCE 95-60
(relating to insurance company general accounts), PTCE 91-38 (relating to bank
collective funds), PTCE 90-1 (relating to insurance company pooled separate
accounts) and PTCE 84-14 (relating to investments by qualified plan asset
managers) may apply, depending on the circumstances.

     Prospective Plan investors should consult with their legal advisors
concerning the impact of ERISA and the Code, the potential application of the
Exemption to the purchase and holding of Certificates and the potential
consequences in their specific circumstances, prior to making an investment in
the Securities. Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should determine whether under the
general fiduciary standards of investment procedure and diversification an
investment in the Securities is appropriate for the Plan, taking into account
the overall investment policy of the Plan and the composition of the Plan's
investment portfolio.

                                LEGAL INVESTMENT

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Securities will not constitute 'mortgage-related securities' within the meaning
of SMMEA. Accordingly, investors whose investment authority is subject to legal
restrictions should consult their own legal advisors to determine whether and to
what extent the Securities constitute legal investments for them.

                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

     The Depositor may offer each Series of Securities through Bear, Stearns &
Co. Inc. ('Bear Stearns') or one or more other firms that may be designated at
the time of each offering of such Securities. The participation of Bear Stearns
in any offering will comply with Schedule E to the By-Laws of the National
Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. The Prospectus Supplement relating to
each Series of Securities will set forth the specific terms of the offering of
such Series of Securities and of each Class within such Series, the names of the
underwriters, the purchase price of the Securities, the proceeds to the
Depositor from such sale, any securities exchange on which the Securities may be
listed, and, if applicable, the initial public offering prices, the discounts
and commissions to the underwriters and any discounts and concessions allowed or
reallowed to certain dealers. The place and time of delivery of each Series of
Securities will also be set forth in the Prospectus Supplement relating to such
Series. Bear Stearns is an affiliate of the Depositor.

                                 LEGAL MATTERS

     Certain legal matters in connection with the Securities will be passed upon
for the Depositor by Brown & Brown LLP, New York, New York.

                                       74







<PAGE>

                               GLOSSARY OF TERMS

     The following are abbreviated definitions of certain capitalized terms used
in this Prospectus. Unless otherwise provided in a 'Supplemental Glossary' in
the Prospectus Supplement for a Series, such definitions shall apply to
capitalized terms used in such Prospectus Supplement. The definitions may vary
from those in the related Agreement for a Series and the related Agreement for a
Series generally provides a more complete definition of certain of the terms.
Reference should be made to the related Agreement for a Series for a more
complete definition of such terms.

     'ACCRUAL TERMINATION DATE' means, with respect to a Class of Compound
Interest Securities, the Distribution Date specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     'ADVANCE' means cash advanced by the Servicer in respect of delinquent
payments of principal of and interest on a Loan, and for any other purposes
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     'AGREEMENT' means, with respect to a Series of Certificates, the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement, and, with respect to a Series of
Notes, the Indenture and the Servicing Agreement, as the context requires.

     'APPRAISED VALUE' means, with respect to property securing a Loan, the
lesser of the appraised value determined in an appraisal obtained at origination
of the Loan or sales price of such property at such time.

     'ASSET GROUP' means, with respect to the Primary Assets and other assets
comprising the Trust Fund of a Series, a group of such Primary Assets and other
assets having the characteristics described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     'ASSUMED REINVESTMENT RATE' means, with respect to a Series, the per annum
rate or rates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a particular
period or periods as the 'Assumed Reinvestment Rate' for funds held in any fund
or account for the Series.

     'AVAILABLE DISTRIBUTION AMOUNT' means the amount in the Distribution
Account (including amounts deposited therein from any reserve fund or other fund
or account) eligible for distribution to Holders on a Distribution Date.

     'BANKRUPTCY CODE' means the federal bankruptcy code, 11 United States Code
101 et seq., and related rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

     'BUSINESS DAY' means a day that, in the City of New York or in the city or
cities in which the corporate trust office of the Trustee are located, is
neither a legal holiday nor a day on which banking institutions are authorized
or obligated by law, regulations or executive order to be closed.

     'CERTIFICATE' means the Asset-Backed Certificates.

     'CLASS' means a Class of Securities of a Series.

     'CLOSING DATE' means, with respect to a Series, the date specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement as the date on which Securities of such Series are
first issued.

     'CODE' means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and regulations
(including proposed regulations) or other pronouncements of the Internal Revenue
Service promulgated thereunder.

     'COLLECTION ACCOUNT' means, with respect to a Series, the account
established in the name of the Servicer for the deposit by the Servicer of
payments received from the Primary Assets.

     'COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIO' means, with respect to a Loan, the ratio
determined as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement taking into account
the amounts of any related senior mortgage loans on the related Mortgaged
Property.

     'COMMISSION' means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

     'COMPOUND INTEREST SECURITY' means any Security of a Series on which all or
a portion of the interest accrued thereon is added to the principal balance of
such Security on each Distribution Date, through the Accrual Termination Date,
and with respect to which no interest shall be payable until such Accrual
Termination Date, after which interest payments will be made on the Compound
Value thereof.

     'COMPOUND VALUE' means, with respect to a Class of Compound Interest
Securities, the original principal balance of such Class, plus all accrued and
unpaid interest, if any, previously added to the principal balance

                                       75



<PAGE>

thereof and reduced by any payments of principal previously made on such Class
of Compound Interest Securities.

     'CONDOMINIUM' means a form of ownership of real property wherein each owner
is entitled to the exclusive ownership and possession of his or her individual
Condominium Unit and also owns a proportionate undivided interest in all parts
of the Condominium Building (other than the individual Condominium Units) and
all areas or facilities, if any, for the common use of the Condominium Units.

     'CONDOMINIUM ASSOCIATION' means the person(s) appointed or elected by the
Condominium Unit owners to govern the affairs of the Condominium.

     'CONDOMINIUM BUILDING' means a multi-unit building or buildings, or a group
of buildings whether or not attached to each other, located on property subject
to Condominium ownership.

     'CONDOMINIUM LOAN' means a Loan secured by a Mortgage on a Condominium Unit
(together with its appurtenant interest in the common elements).

     'CONDOMINIUM UNIT' means an individual housing unit in a Condominium
Building.

     'COOPERATIVE' means a corporation owned by tenant-stockholders who, through
the ownership of stock, shares or membership securities in the corporation,
receive proprietary leases or occupancy agreements which confer exclusive rights
to occupy specific units and which is described in Section 216 of the Code.

     'COOPERATIVE DWELLING' means an individual housing unit in a building owned
by a Cooperative.

     'COOPERATIVE LOAN' means a housing loan made with respect to a Cooperative
Dwelling and secured by an assignment by the borrower (tenant-stockholder) or
security interest in shares issued by the applicable Cooperative.

     'CUT-OFF DATE' means the date designated as such in the related Prospectus
Supplement for a Series.

     'DEBT SECURITIES' means Securities characterized as indebtedness for
federal income tax purposes, and Regular Interest Securities.

     'DEFERRED INTEREST' means the excess of the interest accrued on the
outstanding principal balance of a Loan during a specified period over the
amount of interest required to be paid by an obligor on such Loan on the related
Due Date.

     'DEPOSIT AGREEMENT' means a guaranteed investment contract or reinvestment
agreement providing for the investment of funds held in a fund or account,
guaranteeing a minimum or a fixed rate of return on the investment of moneys
deposited therein.

     'DEPOSITOR' means Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc.

     'DISQUALIFIED ORGANIZATION' means the United States, any State or political
subdivision thereof, any possession of the United States, any foreign
government, any international organization, or any agency or instrumentality of
any of the foregoing, a rural electric or telephone cooperative described in
section 1381(a)(2)(C) of the Code, or any entity exempt from the tax imposed by
sections 1-1399 of the Code, if such entity is not subject to tax on its
unrelated business income.

     'DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNT' means, with respect to a Series, the account
established in the name of the Trustee for the deposit of remittances received
from the Servicer with respect to the Primary Assets.

     'DISTRIBUTION DATE' means, with respect to a Series or Class of Securities,
each date specified as a distribution date for such Series or Class in the
related Prospectus Supplement.

     'DUE DATE' means each date, as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement for a Series, on which any payment of principal or interest is due
and payable by the obligor on any Primary Asset pursuant to the terms thereof.

     'ELIGIBLE INVESTMENTS' means any one or more of the obligations or
securities described as such in the related Agreement.

     'ENHANCEMENT' means the enhancement for a Series, if any, specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.

     'ENHANCER' means the provider of the Enhancement for a Series specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.

                                       76



<PAGE>

     'ERISA' means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
amended.

     'ESCROW ACCOUNT' means an account, established and maintained by the
Servicer for a Loan, into which payments by borrowers to pay taxes, assessments,
mortgage and hazard insurance premiums and other comparable items required to be
paid to the mortgagee are deposited.

     'FHLMC' means the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation.

     'FINAL SCHEDULED DISTRIBUTION DATE' means, with respect to a Class of Notes
of a Series, the date no later than which principal thereof will be fully paid
and with respect to a Class of Certificates of a Series, the date after which no
Certificates of such Class will remain outstanding, in each case based on the
assumptions set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     'FNMA' means the Federal National Mortgage Association.

     'HOLDER' means the person or entity in whose name a Security is registered.

     'HOME IMPROVEMENTS' means the home improvements financed by a Home
Improvement Contract.

     'HOME IMPROVEMENT CONTRACT' means any home improvement installment sales
contract and installment loan agreement which may be unsecured or secured by
purchase money security interest in the Home Improvement financed thereby.

     'HUD' means the United States Department of Housing and Urban Development.

     'INDENTURE' means the indenture relating to a Series of Notes between the
Trust Fund and the Trustee.

     'INSURANCE POLICIES' means certain mortgage insurance, hazard insurance and
other insurance policies required to be maintained with respect to Loans.

     'INSURANCE PROCEEDS' means amounts paid by the insurer under any of the
Insurance Policies covering any Loan or Mortgaged Property.

     'INTEREST ONLY SECURITIES' means a Class of Securities entitled solely or
primarily to distributions of interest and which is identified as such in the
related Prospectus Supplement.

     'IRS' means the Internal Revenue Service.

     'LIFETIME RATE CAP' means the lifetime limit if any, on the Loan Rate
during the life of each adjustable rate Loan.

     'LIQUIDATION PROCEEDS' means amounts received by the Servicer in connection
with the liquidation of a Loan, net of liquidation expenses.

     'LOAN RATE' means, unless otherwise indicated herein or in the Prospectus
Supplement, the interest rate borne by a Loan.

     'LOANS' mean Mortgage Loans and/or Home Improvement Contracts,
collectively. A Loan refers to a specific Mortgage Loan or Home Improvement
Contract, as the context requires.

     'LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIO' means, with respect to a Loan, the ratio determined
as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     'MINIMUM RATE' means the lifetime minimum Loan Rate during the life of each
adjustable rate Loan.

     'MINIMUM PRINCIPAL PAYMENT AGREEMENT' means a minimum principal payment
agreement with an entity meeting the criteria of the Rating Agencies.

     'MODIFICATION' means a change in any term of a Loan.

     'MORTGAGE' means the mortgage, deed of trust or other similar security
instrument securing a Mortgage Note.

     'MORTGAGE LOAN' means a closed-end home equity loan secured by a Mortgaged
Property.

     'MORTGAGE NOTE' means the note or other evidence of indebtedness of a
Mortgagor under the Loan.

     'MORTGAGOR' means the obligor on a Mortgage Note.

     '1986 ACT' means the Tax Reform Act of 1986.

     'NOTES' means the Asset-Backed Notes.

                                       77



<PAGE>

     'NOTIONAL AMOUNT' means the amount set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement for a Class of Interest Only Securities.

     'PAC' ('Planned Amortization Class Securities') means a Class of Securities
of a Series on which payments of principal are made in accordance with a
schedule specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, based on certain
assumptions stated therein.

     'PARTICIPATING SECURITIES' means Securities entitled to receive payments of
principal and interest and an additional return on investment as described in
the related Prospectus Supplement.

     'PASS-THROUGH SECURITY' means a security representing an undivided
beneficial interest in a pool of assets, including the right to receive a
portion of all principal and interest payments relating to those assets.

     'PAY THROUGH SECURITY' means Regular Interest Securities and certain Debt
Securities that are subject to acceleration due to prepayment on the underlying
Primary Assets.

     'PERSON' means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture,
association, joint stock company, trust (including any beneficiary thereof),
unincorporated organization, or government or any agency or political
subdivision thereof.

     'POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT' means the pooling and servicing agreement
relating to a Series of Certificates among the Depositor, the Servicer (if such
Series relates to Loans) and the Trustee.

     'PRIMARY ASSETS' means the Private Securities and/or Loans, as the case may
be, which are included in the Trust Fund for such Series. A Primary Asset refers
to a specific Private Security or Loan, as the case may be.

     'PRINCIPAL BALANCE' means, with respect to a Primary Asset and as of a Due
Date, the original principal amount of the Primary Asset, plus the amount of any
Deferred Interest added to such principal amount, reduced by all payments, both
scheduled or otherwise, received on such Primary Asset prior to such Due Date
and applied to principal in accordance with the terms of the Primary Asset.

     'PRINCIPAL ONLY SECURITIES' means a Class of Securities entitled solely or
primarily to distributions of principal and identified as such in the Prospectus
Supplement.

     'PRIVATE SECURITY' means a participation or pass-through certificate
representing a fractional, undivided interest in Underlying Loans or
collateralized obligations secured by Underlying Loans.

     'PROPERTY' means either a Home Improvement or a Mortgaged Property securing
a Loan, as the context requires.

     'PS AGREEMENT' means the pooling and servicing agreement, indenture, trust
agreement or similar agreement pursuant to which a Private Security is issued.

     'PS SERVICER' means the servicer of the Underlying Loans.

     'PS SPONSOR' means, with respect to Private Securities, the sponsor or
depositor under a PS Agreement.

     'PS TRUSTEE' means the trustee designated under a PS Agreement.

     'QUALIFIED INSURER' means a mortgage guarantee or insurance company duly
qualified as such under the laws of the states in which the Mortgaged Properties
are located, duly authorized and licensed in such states to transact the
applicable insurance business and to write the insurance provided.

     'RATING AGENCY' means the nationally recognized statistical rating
organization (or organizations) which was (or were) requested by the Depositor
to rate the Securities upon the original issuance thereof.

     'REGULAR INTEREST' means a regular interest in a REMIC.

     'REMIC' means a real estate mortgage investment conduit.

     'REMIC ADMINISTRATOR' means the Person, if any, specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement for a Series for which a REMIC election is made, to serve
as administrator of the Series.

     'REMIC PROVISIONS' means the provisions of the federal income tax law
relating to real estate mortgage investment conduits, which appear at sections
860A through 860G of Subchapter M of Chapter 1 of the Code, and related
provisions, and regulations, including proposed regulations and rulings, and
administrative pronouncements promulgated thereunder, as the foregoing may be in
effect from time to time.

                                       78



<PAGE>

     'REO PROPERTY' means real property which secured a defaulted Loan,
beneficial ownership of which has been acquired upon foreclosure, deed in lieu
of foreclosure, repossession or otherwise.

     'RESERVE FUND' means, with respect to a Series, any Reserve Fund
established pursuant to the related Agreement.

     'RESIDUAL INTEREST' means a residual interest in a REMIC.

     'RETAINED INTEREST' means, with respect to a Primary Asset, the amount or
percentage specified in the related Prospectus Supplement which is not included
in the Trust Fund for the related Series.

     'SCHEDULED PAYMENTS' means the scheduled payments of principal and interest
to be made by the borrower on a Primary Asset.

     'SECURITIES' means the Notes or the Certificates.

     'SELLER' means the seller of the Primary Assets to the Depositor identified
in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series.

     'SENIOR SECURITYHOLDER' means a holder of a Senior Security.

     'SENIOR SECURITIES' means a Class of Securities as to which the holders'
rights to receive distributions of principal and interest are senior to the
rights of holders of Subordinate Securities, to the extent specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.

     'SERIES' means a separate series of Securities sold pursuant to this
Prospectus and the related Prospectus Supplement.

     'SERVICER' means, with respect to a Series relating to Loans, the Person if
any, designated in the related Prospectus Supplement to service Loans for that
Series, or the successors or assigns of such Person.

     'SINGLE FAMILY PROPERTY' means property securing a Loan consisting of one
to four-family attached or detached residential housing, including Cooperative
Dwellings.

     'STRIPPED SECURITIES' means Pass-Through Securities representing interests
in Primary Assets with respect to which all or a portion of the principal
payments have been separated from all or a portion of the interest payments.

     'SUBORDINATE SECURITYHOLDER' means a Holder of a Subordinate Security.

     'SUBORDINATED SECURITIES' means a Class of Securities as to which the
rights of holders to receive distributions of principal, interest or both is
subordinated to the rights of holders of Senior Securities, and may be allocated
losses and shortfalls prior to the allocation thereof to other Classes of
Securities, to the extent and under the circumstances specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.

     'TRUSTEE' means the trustee under the applicable Agreement and its
successors.

     'TRUST FUND' means, with respect to any Series of Securities, the trust
holding all money, instruments, securities and other property, including all
proceeds thereof, which are, with respect to a Series of Certificates, held for
the benefit of the Holders by the Trustee under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement or Trust Agreement or, with respect to a Series of Notes, pledged to
the Trustee under the Indenture as a security for such Notes, including, without
limitation, the Primary Assets (except any Retained Interests), all amounts in
the Distribution Account, Collection Account or Reserve Funds, distributions on
the Primary Assets (net of servicing fees), and reinvestment earnings on such
net distributions and any Enhancement and all other property and interest held
by or pledged to the Trustee pursuant to the related Agreement for such Series.

     'UCC' means the Uniform Commercial Code.

     'UNDERLYING LOANS' means loans of the type eligible to be Loans underlying
or securing Private Securities.

     'VARIABLE INTEREST SECURITY' means a Security on which interest accrues at
a rate that is adjusted, based upon a predetermined index, at fixed periodic
intervals, all as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     'ZERO COUPON SECURITY' means a Security entitled to receive payments of
principal only.

                                       79



<PAGE>







                      [THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]









<PAGE>







                      [THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]









<PAGE>







                      [THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]










<PAGE>

                                  $298,454,000
                                 (APPROXIMATE)

                   BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES, INC.
                                   DEPOSITOR

                    ASSET-BACKED CERTIFICATES, SERIES 1999-1

                                     [LOGO]

                           SELLER AND MASTER SERVICER


                         ------------------------------
                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
                         ------------------------------


                            BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.

                       COUNTRYWIDE SECURITIES CORPORATION


     You should rely only on the information contained or incorporated by
reference in this prospectus supplement and the accompanying prospectus. We have
not authorized anyone to provide you with different information.

     We are not offering the Series 1999-1 Asset-Backed Certificates in any
state where the offer is not permitted.

     Dealers will deliver a prospectus supplement and prospectus when acting as
underwriters of the Series 1999-1 Asset-Backed Certificates and with respect to
their unsold allotments or subscriptions. In addition, all dealers selling the
Series 1999-1 Asset-Backed Certificates will be required to deliver a prospectus
supplement and prospectus until October 21, 1999.

                                 JULY 23, 1999




                            STATEMENT OF DIFFERENCES
                            ------------------------

The section symbol shall be expressed as ................................. 'SS'




© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission